Revert @documentencoding changes in the docs.
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
CommitLineData
4009494e
GM
1\input texinfo
2
7fbf7cae
TZ
3@include gnus-overrides.texi
4
db78a8cb 5@setfilename ../../info/gnus
4009494e
GM
6@settitle Gnus Manual
7@syncodeindex fn cp
8@syncodeindex vr cp
9@syncodeindex pg cp
10
89b163db 11@documentencoding UTF-8
01c52d31 12
4009494e 13@copying
ab422c4d 14Copyright @copyright{} 1995--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4009494e
GM
15
16@quotation
17Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
6a2c4aec 18under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
4009494e 19any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
debf4439
GM
20Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
21and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
22is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
4009494e 23
6f093307 24(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
6bf430d1 25modify this GNU manual.''
4009494e
GM
26@end quotation
27@end copying
28
29@iftex
30@iflatex
31\documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
32\usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
33\usepackage{pagestyle}
34\usepackage{epsfig}
35\usepackage{pixidx}
36\input{gnusconfig.tex}
37
38\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
39\else
40\usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
41\usepackage{thumbpdf}
42\pdfcompresslevel=9
43\fi
44
45\makeindex
46\begin{document}
47
48% Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
c7ff939a 49\newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
4009494e
GM
50\newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
51\newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
52
53\newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
54
55\newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
56\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
57\newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
58\else
59\newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
60\fi
61\newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62\newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63
64\newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
65\newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66
67\newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
68\newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
69\newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70\newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71\newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72\newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73\newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
74\newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75\newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
76\newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77\newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78\newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
79\newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80\newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
81\newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
82\newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83\newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
84\newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
85\newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
86\newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
87\newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
88\newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
89\newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
90\newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
91
92\newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
93\newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
94\newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
95\newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
96\newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
97\newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
98\newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
99\newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
100\newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
101\newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
102\newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
103\newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
104\newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
105
106\newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
107\newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
108\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
109}
110
111\newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
112
113\newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
114{\mbox{}}
115}
116
117\newdimen{\gnusdimen}
118\gnusdimen 0pt
119
120\newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
121\gnuscleardoublepage
122\ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
123\chapter{#2}
124\renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
125\renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
126\thispagestyle{empty}
127\hspace*{-2cm}
128\begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
129\put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
130\put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
131\end{picture}
132\clearpage
133}
134
135\newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
136\begin{figure}
137\mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
138#3
139\end{picture}
140\caption{#1}
141\end{figure}
142}
143
144\newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
145\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
146}
147
148\newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
149\margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
150}
151
152\newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
153\margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
154}
155
156\newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
157\margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
158}
159
160\newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
161
162\newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
163\renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
164\section{#1}
165}
166
167\newenvironment{codelist}%
168{\begin{list}{}{
169}
170}{\end{list}}
171
172\newenvironment{asislist}%
173{\begin{list}{}{
174}
175}{\end{list}}
176
177\newenvironment{kbdlist}%
178{\begin{list}{}{
179\labelwidth=0cm
180}
181}{\end{list}}
182
183\newenvironment{dfnlist}%
184{\begin{list}{}{
185}
186}{\end{list}}
187
188\newenvironment{stronglist}%
189{\begin{list}{}{
190}
191}{\end{list}}
192
193\newenvironment{samplist}%
194{\begin{list}{}{
195}
196}{\end{list}}
197
198\newenvironment{varlist}%
199{\begin{list}{}{
200}
201}{\end{list}}
202
203\newenvironment{emphlist}%
204{\begin{list}{}{
205}
206}{\end{list}}
207
208\newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
209\setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
210\addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
211
212\newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
213{
214{
215\ifodd\count0
216{
217\hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
218}
219\else
220{
221\hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
222}
223}
224\fi
225}
226}
227{
228\ifodd\count0
229\mbox{} \hfill
230\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
231\else
232\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
233\hfill \mbox{}
234\fi
235}
236
237\newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
238{
239{
240\ifodd\count0
241{
242\hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
243}
244\else
245{
246\hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
247}
248\fi
249}
250}
251{
252\ifodd\count0
253\mbox{} \hfill
254\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
255\else
256\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
257\hfill \mbox{}
258\fi
259}
260
261\newpagestyle{gnus}%
262{
263{
264\ifodd\count0
265{
266\makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
267}
268\else
269{
270\makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
271}
272\fi
273}
274}
275{
276\ifodd\count0
277\mbox{} \hfill
278\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
279\else
280\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
281\hfill \mbox{}
282\fi
283}
284
285\pagenumbering{roman}
286\pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
287
288@end iflatex
289@end iftex
290
291@iftex
292@iflatex
293
294\begin{titlepage}
295{
296
297%\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
298%\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
299\parindent=0cm
300\addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
301
302\gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
303\rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
304\vfill
305\hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
306\vfill
307\rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308\gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
309\newpage
310}
311
312\mbox{}
313\vfill
314
315\thispagestyle{empty}
316
317@c @insertcopying
318\newpage
319\end{titlepage}
320@end iflatex
321@end iftex
322
0c973505 323@dircategory Emacs network features
4009494e 324@direntry
62e034c2 325* Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
4009494e
GM
326@end direntry
327@iftex
328@finalout
329@end iftex
4009494e
GM
330
331
332@titlepage
7fbf7cae
TZ
333@ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
334@title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
335@end ifset
336@ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
4009494e 337@title Gnus Manual
7fbf7cae 338@end ifclear
4009494e
GM
339
340@author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
341@page
342@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
343@insertcopying
344@end titlepage
345
5dc584b5
KB
346@summarycontents
347@contents
4009494e
GM
348
349@node Top
350@top The Gnus Newsreader
351
352@ifinfo
353
354You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
355can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
356spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
357luck.
358
359@c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
c7ff939a 360This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
4009494e 361
5dc584b5
KB
362@ifnottex
363@insertcopying
364@end ifnottex
365
4009494e
GM
366@end ifinfo
367
368@iftex
369
370@iflatex
371\tableofcontents
372\gnuscleardoublepage
373@end iflatex
374
375Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
376unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
377
378Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
379being accused of plagiarism:
380
381Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
382about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
383you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
384can even read news with it!
385
386Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
387people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
388allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
389like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
390people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
391the program.
392
9b3ebcb6 393@c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
2e4089ab 394This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
9b3ebcb6
MB
395
396@heading Other related manuals
397@itemize
398@item Message manual: Composing messages
399@item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
400@item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
3d439cd1 401@item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
2e4089ab 402@item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
9b3ebcb6
MB
403@end itemize
404
4009494e
GM
405@end iftex
406
407@menu
408* Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
409* Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
410* Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
411* Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
412* Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
413* Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
414* Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
8a1cdce5 415* Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
4009494e
GM
416* Various:: General purpose settings.
417* The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
418* Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
419* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
420* Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
421* Key Index:: Key Index.
422
f2a538a2
GM
423@c Doesn't work right in html.
424@c FIXME Do this in a more standard way.
425@ifinfo
4009494e
GM
426Other related manuals
427
428* Message:(message). Composing messages.
429* Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
430* Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
3d439cd1 431* EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
01c52d31 432* SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
f2a538a2 433@end ifinfo
4009494e
GM
434
435@detailmenu
436 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
437
438Starting Gnus
439
440* Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
4009494e
GM
441* The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
442* Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
443* Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
444* New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
445* Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
446* Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
447* Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
448* The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
449* Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
450
451New Groups
452
453* Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
454* Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
455* Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
456
457Group Buffer
458
459* Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
460* Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
461* Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
462* Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
463* Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
464* Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
465* Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
466* Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
467* Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
468* Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
469* Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
470* Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
471* Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
472* Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
473* Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
474* Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
01c52d31 475* Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
4009494e
GM
476* Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
477
478Group Buffer Format
479
480* Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
481* Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
482* Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
483
484Group Topics
485
486* Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
487* Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
488* Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
489* Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
490* Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
491
492Misc Group Stuff
493
494* Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
495* Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
496* Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
497* File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
498* Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
499
500Summary Buffer
501
502* Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
503* Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
504* Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
505* Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
506* Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
507* Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
508* Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
509* Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
510* Threading:: How threads are made.
511* Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
512* Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
513* Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
514* Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
01c52d31 515* Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4009494e
GM
516* Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
517* Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
518* Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
519* Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
520* MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
521* Charsets:: Character set issues.
522* Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
523* Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
524* Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
525* Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
526* Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
527* Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
528* Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
529* Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
530 or reselecting the current group.
531* Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
532* Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
533* Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
534* Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
535
536Summary Buffer Format
537
538* Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
539* To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
540* Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
541* Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
542
543Choosing Articles
544
545* Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
546* Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
547
548Reply, Followup and Post
549
550* Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
551* Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
552* Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
553* Canceling and Superseding::
554
555Marking Articles
556
557* Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
558* Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
559* Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
560* Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
561* Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
562* Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
563
564Threading
565
566* Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
567* Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
568
569Customizing Threading
570
571* Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
572* Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
573* More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
574* Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
575
576Decoding Articles
577
578* Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
579* Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
580* PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
581* Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
582* Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
583* Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
584
585Decoding Variables
586
587* Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
588* Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
589* Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
590
591Article Treatment
592
593* Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
594* Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
595* Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
596* Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
597* Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
598* Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
599* Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
600* Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
61b1af82 601* Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
4009494e
GM
602* Article Signature:: What is a signature?
603* Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
604
605Alternative Approaches
606
607* Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
608* Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
609
610Various Summary Stuff
611
612* Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
613* Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
614* Summary Generation Commands::
615* Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
616
617Article Buffer
618
619* Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
620* Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
621* Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
622* Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
623* Misc Article:: Other stuff.
624
625Composing Messages
626
627* Mail:: Mailing and replying.
628* Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
629* POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
630* Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
631* Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
632* Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
633* Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
634* Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
635* Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
636
637Select Methods
638
639* Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
640* Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
229b59da 641* Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
4009494e
GM
642* Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
643* Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
c4d82de8 644* Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
4009494e
GM
645* Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
646* Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
647* Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
648
649Server Buffer
650
651* Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
652* Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
653* Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
654* Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
655* Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
656* Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
657* Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
658
659Getting News
660
661* NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
662* News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
663
664@acronym{NNTP}
665
666* Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
667* Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
668* Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
669
670Getting Mail
671
672* Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
673* Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
674* Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
675* Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
676* Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
677* Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
678* Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
679* Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
680* Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
681* Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
682* Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
683* Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
684* Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
685
686Mail Sources
687
688* Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
689* Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
690* Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
691
692Choosing a Mail Back End
693
694* Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
bc79f9ab 695* Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
4009494e
GM
696* Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
697* MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
698* Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
699* Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
700* Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
701
702Browsing the Web
703
704* Archiving Mail::
705* Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
4009494e
GM
706* RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
707* Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
708
4009494e
GM
709Other Sources
710
711* Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
712* Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
713* Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
4009494e 714* Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
c5ecc769 715* The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
4009494e
GM
716
717Document Groups
718
719* Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
720
4009494e
GM
721Combined Groups
722
723* Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
4009494e
GM
724
725Email Based Diary
726
727* The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
728* The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
729* Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
730
731The NNDiary Back End
732
733* Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
734* Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
735* Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
736
737The Gnus Diary Library
738
739* Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
740* Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
741* Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
742* Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
743
744Gnus Unplugged
745
746* Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
747* Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
748* Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
749* Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
750* Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
751* Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
752* Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
01c52d31 753* Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
4009494e
GM
754* Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
755* Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
756* Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
757* Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
758* Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
759* Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
760
761Agent Categories
762
763* Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
764* Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
765* Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
766
767Agent Commands
768
769* Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
770* Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
771* Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
772
773Scoring
774
775* Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
776* Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
777* Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
778* Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
779* Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
780* Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
781* Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
782* Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
783* Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
784* Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
785* Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
786* Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
787* Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
788* Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
4009494e
GM
789* Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
790* Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
791
4009494e
GM
792Advanced Scoring
793
794* Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
795* Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
796* Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
797
8a1cdce5
AC
798Searching
799
800* nnir:: Searching with various engines.
801* nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
802
803nnir
804
156e3f9c 805* What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
8a1cdce5
AC
806* Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
807* Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
808
809Setting up nnir
810
811* Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
812
4009494e
GM
813Various
814
815* Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
816* Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
817* Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
818* Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
819* Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
820* Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
4009494e
GM
821* Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
822* Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
4009494e 823* Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
4009494e
GM
824* Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
825* Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
826* Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
827* Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
828* Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
829* Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
830* Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
64763fe3 831* The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
4009494e
GM
832* Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
833* Various Various:: Things that are really various.
834
835Formatting Variables
836
837* Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
838* Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
839* Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
840* User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
841* Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
842* Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
843* Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
844* Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
845
846Image Enhancements
847
848* X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
849* Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
850* Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
851 meant to be shown.
852* Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
fcf2d385 853* Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
4009494e
GM
854* XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
855
856Thwarting Email Spam
857
858* The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
859* Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
860* SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
861* Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
862
863Spam Package
864
865* Spam Package Introduction::
866* Filtering Incoming Mail::
867* Detecting Spam in Groups::
868* Spam and Ham Processors::
869* Spam Package Configuration Examples::
870* Spam Back Ends::
871* Extending the Spam package::
872* Spam Statistics Package::
873
874Spam Statistics Package
875
876* Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
877* Splitting mail using spam-stat::
878* Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
879
880Appendices
881
882* XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
883* History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
884* On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
885* Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
886* Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
887* Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
888* Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
889* Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
890* Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
891
892History
893
894* Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
4009494e
GM
895* Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
896* Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
897* Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
898* Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
899* Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
900* Contributors:: Oodles of people.
901* New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
902
903New Features
904
905* ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
906* September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
907* Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
908* Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
909* Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
910* Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
89b163db
G
911* No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
912* Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
4009494e
GM
913
914Customization
915
916* Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
917* Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
918* Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
919* Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
920
921Gnus Reference Guide
922
923* Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
924* Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
925* Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
926* Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
927* Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
928* Group Info:: The group info format.
929* Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
930* Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
931* Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
932
933Back End Interface
934
935* Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
936* Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
937* Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
938* Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
939* Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
940* Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
941
942Various File Formats
943
944* Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
945* Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
946
947Emacs for Heathens
948
949* Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
950* Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
951
952@end detailmenu
953@end menu
954
955@node Starting Up
956@chapter Starting Gnus
957@cindex starting up
958
959If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
960Heathens} first.
961
962@kindex M-x gnus
963@findex gnus
964If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
965and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
966your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
967@code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
968minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
969@code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
970
971@findex gnus-other-frame
972@kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
973If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
974@kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
975
976If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
977variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
978@file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
979
980If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
981terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
982
983@menu
984* Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
4009494e
GM
985* The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
986* Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
987* New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
988* Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
989* Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
990* Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
991* The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
992* Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
993@end menu
994
995
996@node Finding the News
997@section Finding the News
998@cindex finding news
999
357e2d8e
KY
1000First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
1001@code{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
1002press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
1003you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1004serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1005a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
fe3c5669 1006do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
357e2d8e
KY
1007@xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1008
4009494e
GM
1009@vindex gnus-select-method
1010@c @head
1011The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1012news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1013@dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1014native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
0afb49a1 1015secondary or foreign groups.
4009494e
GM
1016
1017For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1018you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1019
1020@lisp
1021(setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1022@end lisp
1023
1024If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1025
1026@lisp
1027(setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1028@end lisp
1029
1030If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1031certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1032server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1033server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1034
1035@vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1036@cindex NNTPSERVER
1037@cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1038If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1039@env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1040Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1041(@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1042If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1043as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1044
4009494e
GM
1045@findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1046@kindex B (Group)
1047However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1048interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1049better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1050let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1051to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1052maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1053
1054@vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1055@c @head
1056A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1057@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1058listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1059@code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1060files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1061appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1062groups are.
1063
1064For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1065you would typically set this variable to
1066
1067@lisp
1068(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1069@end lisp
1070
01c52d31 1071
4009494e 1072
4009494e
GM
1073@node The Server is Down
1074@section The Server is Down
1075@cindex server errors
1076
1077If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1078problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1079the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1080
1081Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1082without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1083will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1084given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1085for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1086groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1087buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1088
1089@findex gnus-no-server
1090@kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1091@c @head
1092If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1093your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1094@code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1095if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1096your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
10971 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1098levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1099
1100
1101@node Slave Gnusae
1102@section Slave Gnusae
1103@cindex slave
1104
1105You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1106same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1107are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1108that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1109
1110The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1111@file{.newsrc} file.
1112
1113To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1114Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1115@dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1116taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1117conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1118me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1119Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1120
1121@findex gnus-slave
1122Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1123however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1124@kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1125files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1126on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1127starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1128information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1129they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1130
1131Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1132information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1133
1134If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1135slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1136file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1137incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1138messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1139
1140
1141
1142@node New Groups
1143@section New Groups
1144@cindex new groups
1145@cindex subscription
1146
1147@vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1148If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1149you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1150also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1151@code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1152@kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1153is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1154@code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1155when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1156
1157@menu
1158* Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1159* Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1160* Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1161@end menu
1162
1163
1164@node Checking New Groups
1165@subsection Checking New Groups
1166
cd865a33 1167Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
7d1738f1
LMI
1168the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1169subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1170If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1171ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1172faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1173of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
cd865a33
G
1174@code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1175at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1176this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1177command.
4009494e
GM
1178
1179I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1180server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1181fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1182@code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1183few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1184work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1185supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1186You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1187whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1188it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1189@samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1190
1191This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1192issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1193subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1194if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1195that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1196Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1197
1198
1199@node Subscription Methods
1200@subsection Subscription Methods
1201
1202@vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1203What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1204@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1205
1206This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1207with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1208
1209Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1210
1211@table @code
1212
1213@item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1214@vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
cd865a33
G
1215Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1216default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1217kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1218(with @kbd{u}).
4009494e
GM
1219
1220@item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221@vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1222Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1223new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1224
1225@item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226@vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1227Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1228
1229@item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230@vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1231Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1232function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1233@code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1234alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1235hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1236@samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1237up. Or something like that.
1238
1239@item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240@vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1241Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1242you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1243to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1244
1245@item gnus-subscribe-killed
1246@vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1247Kill all new groups.
1248
1249@item gnus-subscribe-topics
1250@vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1251Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1252parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1253topic parameter that looks like
1254
1255@example
77ae8989 1256"nnml"
4009494e
GM
1257@end example
1258
1259will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1260that topic.
1261
1262If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1263top-level topic.
1264
1265@end table
1266
1267@vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1268A closely related variable is
1269@code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1270mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1271hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1272will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1273hierarchy or not.
1274
1275One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1276(@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1277@code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1278will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1279
1280
1281@node Filtering New Groups
1282@subsection Filtering New Groups
1283
1284A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1285subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1286the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1287
1288@example
1289options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1290@end example
1291
1292@vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1293This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1294person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1295groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1296be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1297be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1298subscribing these groups.
1299@code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1300variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1301
0c502747 1302The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
f99f1641 1303that is supports: you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
0c502747
LMI
1304deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1305
4009494e
GM
1306@vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1307@vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1308If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1309set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1310@code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1311same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1312and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1313subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1314
1315@vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1316Yet another variable that meddles here is
1317@code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1318@code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1319but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1320more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1321used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1322groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
7410c270
G
1323@code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1324@code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1325variable to @code{nil}.
1326
1327@vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1328As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
22bcf204 1329allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
7410c270
G
1330category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1331post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1332should be subscribed automatically.
1333
1334New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
4009494e
GM
1335@code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1336
1337
1338@node Changing Servers
1339@section Changing Servers
1340@cindex changing servers
1341
1342Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1343This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1344very flaky and you want to use another.
1345
1346Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1347@code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1348
1349@emph{Wrong!}
1350
1351Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1352@acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1353you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1354change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1355worthless.
1356
4009494e
GM
1357@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1358@findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
f02566ce
KY
1359You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1360command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1361Use with caution.
4009494e
GM
1362
1363@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1364@findex gnus-group-clear-data
1365Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1366list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1367
1368After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1369since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1370affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1371@code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1372to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1373can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1374cache for all groups).
1375
1376
1377@node Startup Files
1378@section Startup Files
1379@cindex startup files
1380@cindex .newsrc
1381@cindex .newsrc.el
1382@cindex .newsrc.eld
1383
1384Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1385@file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1386groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1387read.
1388
1389Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1390keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1391@file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1392the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1393the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1394files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1395@sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1396
1397That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1398@file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1399@file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1400recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1401never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1402not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1403
1404@vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1405@vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1406You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1407@code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1408the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1409However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1410Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1411@code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1412@file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1413convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1414want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1415news reader.
1416
1417@vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1418If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1419will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1420save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1421will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1422so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1423You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1424@code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1425Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1426the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1427saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1428several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1429
1430@vindex gnus-startup-file
1431@vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1432@vindex version-control
1433The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1434The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1435file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
cd865a33 1436If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
4009494e
GM
1437@code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1438@code{version-control} variable.
1439
1440@vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1441@vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1442@vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1443@code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1444files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1445saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1446@code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1447@file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1448control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1449startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1450
1451@lisp
1452(defun turn-off-backup ()
1453 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1454
1455(add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1456(add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1457@end lisp
1458
1459@vindex gnus-init-file
1460@vindex gnus-site-init-file
1461When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1462(@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1463(@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1464and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1465@file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1466with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1467suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1468@file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1469and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1470the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1471Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1472@code{gnus-init-file}.
1473
1474
1475@node Auto Save
1476@section Auto Save
1477@cindex dribble file
1478@cindex auto-save
1479
1480Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1481catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1482special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1483Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1484@file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1485this file.
1486
1487If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1488read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1489saved.
1490
1491@vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1492If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1493maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1494
1495@vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1496Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1497this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1498into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1499normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1500file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1501
1502@vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1503If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1504read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1505
1506
1507@node The Active File
1508@section The Active File
1509@cindex active file
1510@cindex ignored groups
1511
1512When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1513articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1514file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1515
1516@vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1517Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1518regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1519any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1520ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1521recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1522Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1523
1524@c This variable is
1525@c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1526@c if you set it to anything else.
1527
1528@vindex gnus-read-active-file
1529@c @head
1530The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1531can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1532reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1533
1534Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1535you actually subscribe to.
1536
1537Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1538variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1539present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1540considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1541
1542This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1543attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1544servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1545support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1546at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1547is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1548
1549Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1550instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1551servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1552variable.
1553
1554If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1555lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1556@acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1557read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1558performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1559@code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1560
1561If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1562different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1563
1564In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1565kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1566
1567Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1568secondary select methods.
1569
1570
1571@node Startup Variables
1572@section Startup Variables
1573
1574@table @code
1575
1576@item gnus-load-hook
1577@vindex gnus-load-hook
1578A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1579normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1580times you start Gnus.
1581
1582@item gnus-before-startup-hook
1583@vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
e3e955fe 1584A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
4009494e 1585
5b4d7e52
SS
1586@item gnus-before-resume-hook
1587@vindex gnus-before-resume-hook
1588A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is resumed after a suspend.
1589
4009494e
GM
1590@item gnus-startup-hook
1591@vindex gnus-startup-hook
1592A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1593
1594@item gnus-started-hook
1595@vindex gnus-started-hook
1596A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1597successfully.
1598
1599@item gnus-setup-news-hook
1600@vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1601A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1602generating the group buffer.
1603
1604@item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1605@vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1606If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1607startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1608@file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1609bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1610best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1611in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1612
1613@item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1614@vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1615If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1616your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1617of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1618@file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1619
1620@item gnus-no-groups-message
1621@vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1622Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1623
b1ae92ba
G
1624@item gnus-use-backend-marks
1625@vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1626If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1627@file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1628group operation some.
1629
4009494e
GM
1630@end table
1631
1632
1633@node Group Buffer
1634@chapter Group Buffer
1635@cindex group buffer
1636
1637@c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1638@c
1639@c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1640@c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1641@c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1642@c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1643@c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1644@c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1645@c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1646@c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1647@c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1648@c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1649@c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1650@c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1651@c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1652@c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1653@c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1654@c human rights at 9...
1655
1656
1657The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1658is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1659long as Gnus is active.
1660
1661@iftex
1662@iflatex
1663\gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1664\put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1665\put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1666\put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1667\put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1668\put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1669\put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1670\put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1671}
1672@end iflatex
1673@end iftex
1674
1675@menu
1676* Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1677* Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1678* Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1679* Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1680* Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1681* Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1682* Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1683* Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1684* Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1685* Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1686* Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1687* Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1688* Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1689* Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1690* Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1691* Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
01c52d31 1692* Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
4009494e
GM
1693* Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1694@end menu
1695
1696
1697@node Group Buffer Format
1698@section Group Buffer Format
1699
1700@menu
1701* Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1702* Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1703* Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1704@end menu
1705
1706You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1707customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1708available in Emacs.
1709
1710The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1711cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1712slower. You can disable this via the variable
1713@code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1714Emacs version.
1715
1716@node Group Line Specification
1717@subsection Group Line Specification
1718@cindex group buffer format
1719
1720The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1721make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1722
1723Here's a couple of example group lines:
1724
1725@example
1726 25: news.announce.newusers
1727 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1728@end example
1729
1730Quite simple, huh?
1731
1732You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1733@samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1734ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1735asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1736
1737@vindex gnus-group-line-format
1738You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1739@code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1740lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1df7defd 1741a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C@.
4009494e
GM
1742@xref{Formatting Variables}.
1743
1744@samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1745
1746There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1747the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1748Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1749displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1750Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1751
1752(Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1753layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1754instead of wasting time reading news.)
1755
1756Here's a list of all available format characters:
1757
1758@table @samp
1759
1760@item M
1761An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1762
1763@item S
1764Whether the group is subscribed.
1765
1766@item L
1767Level of subscribedness.
1768
1769@item N
1770Number of unread articles.
1771
1772@item I
1773Number of dormant articles.
1774
1775@item T
1776Number of ticked articles.
1777
1778@item R
1779Number of read articles.
1780
1781@item U
1782Number of unseen articles.
1783
1784@item t
1785Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1786minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1787
1788Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1789efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1790the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1791hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1792unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1793interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
01c52d31
MB
1794end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1795
1796The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1797compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1798renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1799getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1800future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1801date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1802server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
4009494e
GM
1803
1804@item y
1805Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1806
1807@item i
1808Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1809
1810@item g
1811Full group name.
1812
1813@item G
1814Group name.
1815
1816@item C
1817Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1818comment element in the group parameters.
1819
1820@item D
1821Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1822before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1823@code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1824command.
1825
1826@item o
1827@samp{m} if moderated.
1828
1829@item O
1830@samp{(m)} if moderated.
1831
1832@item s
1833Select method.
1834
1835@item B
1836If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1837
1838@item n
1839Select from where.
1840
1841@item z
1842A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1843used.
1844
1845@item P
1846Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1847
1848@item c
1849@vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1850Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1851variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1852The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1853@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1854
1855@item m
1856@vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1857@cindex %
1858@samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1859the group lately.
1860
1861@item p
1862@samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1863
1864@item d
1865A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1866Timestamp}).
1867
01c52d31
MB
1868@item F
1869The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1870agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1871megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1872of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1873
4009494e
GM
1874@item u
1875User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1876be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1877@code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1878following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1879parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1880be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1881specifier.
1882@end table
1883
1884@cindex *
1885All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1886if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1887group, or a bogus native group.
1888
1889
1890@node Group Mode Line Specification
1891@subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1892@cindex group mode line
1893
1894@vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1895The mode line can be changed by setting
1896@code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1897doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1898
1899@table @samp
1900@item S
1901The native news server.
1902@item M
1903The native select method.
1904@end table
1905
1906
1907@node Group Highlighting
1908@subsection Group Highlighting
1909@cindex highlighting
1910@cindex group highlighting
1911
1912@vindex gnus-group-highlight
1913Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1914@code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1915that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1916something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1917
1918Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1919background is dark:
1920
1921@lisp
1922(cond (window-system
1923 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1924 (defface my-group-face-1
1925 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1926 (defface my-group-face-2
1927 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1928 "Second group face")
1929 (defface my-group-face-3
1930 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1931 (defface my-group-face-4
1932 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1933 (defface my-group-face-5
1934 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1935
1936(setq gnus-group-highlight
1937 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1938 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1939 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1940 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1941 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1942@end lisp
1943
1944Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1945
1946Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1947include:
1948
1949@table @code
1950@item group
1951The group name.
1952@item unread
1953The number of unread articles in the group.
1954@item method
1955The select method.
1956@item mailp
1957Whether the group is a mail group.
1958@item level
1959The level of the group.
1960@item score
1961The score of the group.
1962@item ticked
1963The number of ticked articles in the group.
1964@item total
1965The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1966@var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1967@item topic
1968When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1969topic being inserted.
1970@end table
1971
1972When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1973of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1974functions for snarfing info on the group.
1975
1976@vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1977@findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1978@code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
b069e5a6 1979It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4009494e
GM
1980
1981
1982@node Group Maneuvering
1983@section Group Maneuvering
1984@cindex group movement
1985
1986All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1987expected, hopefully.
1988
1989@table @kbd
1990
1991@item n
1992@kindex n (Group)
1993@findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1994Go to the next group that has unread articles
1995(@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1996
1997@item p
1998@itemx DEL
1999@kindex DEL (Group)
2000@kindex p (Group)
2001@findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2002Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2003(@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2004
2005@item N
2006@kindex N (Group)
2007@findex gnus-group-next-group
2008Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2009
2010@item P
2011@kindex P (Group)
2012@findex gnus-group-prev-group
2013Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2014
2015@item M-n
2016@kindex M-n (Group)
2017@findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2018Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2019(@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2020
2021@item M-p
2022@kindex M-p (Group)
2023@findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2024Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2025(@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2026@end table
2027
2028Three commands for jumping to groups:
2029
2030@table @kbd
2031
2032@item j
2033@kindex j (Group)
2034@findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2035Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2036(@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2037like living groups.
2038
2039@item ,
2040@kindex , (Group)
2041@findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2042Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2043(@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2044
2045@item .
2046@kindex . (Group)
2047@findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2048Jump to the first group with unread articles
2049(@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2050@end table
2051
2052@vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2053If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2054commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2055the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2056is @code{t}.
2057
01c52d31
MB
2058@vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2059If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2060exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2061Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2062@code{t}.
4009494e
GM
2063
2064@node Selecting a Group
2065@section Selecting a Group
2066@cindex group selection
2067
2068@table @kbd
2069
2070@item SPACE
2071@kindex SPACE (Group)
2072@findex gnus-group-read-group
2073Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2074first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2075unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2076this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2077group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2078determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2079positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2080negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2081
2082Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2083articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2084- 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2085
2086When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2087@kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2088ones.
2089
2090@item RET
2091@kindex RET (Group)
2092@findex gnus-group-select-group
2093Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2094(@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2095@code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2096does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2097entry.
2098
2099@item M-RET
2100@kindex M-RET (Group)
2101@findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2102This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2103minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2104scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2105expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2106enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2107(i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2108which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2109summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2110
2111@item M-SPACE
2112@kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2113@findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2114This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2115command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2116(@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2117
2118@item C-M-RET
2119@kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2120@findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2121Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2122doing any processing of its contents
2123(@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2124turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2125manner will have no permanent effects.
2126
2127@end table
2128
2129@vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2130The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2131consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2132considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2133(unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2134before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2135articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2136negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2137fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2138most recently will be fetched.
2139
2140@vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2141@code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2142@code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2143newsgroups.
2144
4b70e299 2145@vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
4009494e
GM
2146In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2147very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2148such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2149for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
f99f1641 2150are actually only the articles 1--10 and 29999900--30000000, Gnus doesn't
4009494e
GM
2151know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2152it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2153stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
4b70e299
MB
2154variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2155The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2156latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
f99f1641 2157get only the articles 29990001--30000000 (if the latest article number is
4b70e299
MB
215830000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2159prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2160variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2161means Gnus never ignores old articles.
4009494e
GM
2162
2163@vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2164@vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2165@vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2166If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2167automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
867d4bb3 2168Which article this is controlled by the
4009494e
GM
2169@code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2170variable are:
2171
2172@table @code
2173
2174@item unread
2175Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2176
2177@item first
2178Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2179
2180@item unseen
2181Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2182
2183@item unseen-or-unread
2184Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2185there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2186unread article.
2187
2188@item best
2189Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2190
2191@end table
2192
2193This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2194will be called to place point on a subject line.
2195
2196If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2197binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2198@code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2199@code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2200selected.
2201
2202
2203@node Subscription Commands
2204@section Subscription Commands
2205@cindex subscription
2206
280f417b
G
2207The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2208Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2209more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2210server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2211commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2212
4009494e
GM
2213@table @kbd
2214
2215@item S t
2216@itemx u
2217@kindex S t (Group)
2218@kindex u (Group)
2219@findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2220@c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2221Toggle subscription to the current group
2222(@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2223
2224@item S s
2225@itemx U
2226@kindex S s (Group)
2227@kindex U (Group)
2228@findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2229Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2230subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2231(@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2232
2233@item S k
2234@itemx C-k
2235@kindex S k (Group)
2236@kindex C-k (Group)
2237@findex gnus-group-kill-group
2238@c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2239Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2240
2241@item S y
2242@itemx C-y
2243@kindex S y (Group)
2244@kindex C-y (Group)
2245@findex gnus-group-yank-group
2246Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2247
2248@item C-x C-t
2249@kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2250@findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2251Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2252really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2253kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2254
2255@item S w
2256@itemx C-w
2257@kindex S w (Group)
2258@kindex C-w (Group)
2259@findex gnus-group-kill-region
2260Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2261
2262@item S z
2263@kindex S z (Group)
2264@findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2265Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2266
2267@item S C-k
2268@kindex S C-k (Group)
2269@findex gnus-group-kill-level
2270Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2271These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2272be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2273really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2274groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2275kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2276@file{.newsrc} file.
2277
2278@end table
2279
2280Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2281
2282
2283@node Group Data
2284@section Group Data
2285
2286@table @kbd
2287
2288@item c
2289@kindex c (Group)
2290@findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2291@vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2292@c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2293Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2294(@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2295@code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2296the group buffer.
2297
2298@item C
2299@kindex C (Group)
2300@findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2301Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2302(@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2303
2304@item M-c
2305@kindex M-c (Group)
2306@findex gnus-group-clear-data
2307Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2308read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2309
2310@item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2311@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2312@findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2313If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2314and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2315clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2316caution.
2317
2318@end table
2319
2320
2321@node Group Levels
2322@section Group Levels
2323@cindex group level
2324@cindex level
2325
2326All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2327group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2328can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2329(@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2330a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2331
2332Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2333
2334@table @kbd
2335
2336@item S l
2337@kindex S l (Group)
2338@findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2339Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2340next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2341prompted for a level.
2342@end table
2343
2344@vindex gnus-level-killed
2345@vindex gnus-level-zombie
2346@vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2347@vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2348Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2349@code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2350@code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2351@code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2352unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2353(default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2354(default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
65e7ca35
PE
2355same, but zombie and killed groups store no information on what articles
2356you have read, etc. This distinction between dead and living
4009494e
GM
2357groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2358reasons of efficiency.
2359
2360It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
1df7defd 2361low levels (e.g., 1 or 2).
4009494e
GM
2362
2363Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2364understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2365subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2366empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2367go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2368groups are hidden, in a way.
2369
cd865a33 2370@cindex zombie groups
4009494e
GM
2371Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2372are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2373unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2374information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2375and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2376aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2377
2378Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2379a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2380group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2381but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2382the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2383list of killed groups.)
2384
2385If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2386Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2387them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2388
2389@vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2390@vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2391Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2392(default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2393which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2394(un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2395relevant valid ranges.
2396
2397@vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2398If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2399will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2400particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2401will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2402handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2403rest.
2404
2405If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2406one with the best level.
2407
2408@vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2409All groups with a level less than or equal to
2410@code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2411by default.
11a5db4a
JD
2412This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2413be called and the result will be used as value.
2414
4009494e
GM
2415
2416@vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2417If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2418groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2419@code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2420listed.
2421
2422@vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2423If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2424give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2425use this level as the ``work'' level.
2426
2427@vindex gnus-activate-level
1df7defd 2428Gnus will normally just activate (i.e., query the server about) groups
4009494e
GM
2429on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2430activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2431to 5. The default is 6.
2432
2433
2434@node Group Score
2435@section Group Score
2436@cindex group score
2437@cindex group rank
2438@cindex rank
2439
2440You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2441is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2442group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2443reason?
2444
2445This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2446to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2447the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2448score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2449called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2450a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2451of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2452least significant part.))
2453
2454@findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2455If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2456read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2457the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2458sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2459action after each summary exit, you can add
2460@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2461@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2462slow things down somewhat.
2463
2464
2465@node Marking Groups
2466@section Marking Groups
2467@cindex marking groups
2468
2469If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2470subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2471numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2472bidding on those groups.
2473
2474However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2475perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2476with the process mark and then execute the command.
2477
2478@table @kbd
2479
2480@item #
2481@kindex # (Group)
2482@itemx M m
2483@kindex M m (Group)
2484@findex gnus-group-mark-group
2485Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2486
2487@item M-#
2488@kindex M-# (Group)
2489@itemx M u
2490@kindex M u (Group)
2491@findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2492Remove the mark from the current group
2493(@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2494
2495@item M U
2496@kindex M U (Group)
2497@findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2498Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2499
2500@item M w
2501@kindex M w (Group)
2502@findex gnus-group-mark-region
2503Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2504
2505@item M b
2506@kindex M b (Group)
2507@findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2508Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2509
2510@item M r
2511@kindex M r (Group)
2512@findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2513Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2514(@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2515@end table
2516
2517Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2518
2519@findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2520If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2521with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2522(@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2523the command to be executed.
2524
2525
2526@node Foreign Groups
2527@section Foreign Groups
2528@cindex foreign groups
2529
549c9aed
G
2530If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2531you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2532@code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2533what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2534approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2535they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2536configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2537@file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2538
4009494e
GM
2539Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2540groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2541special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2542groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2543consulted.
2544
2545Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2546@file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2547variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2548
2549@table @kbd
2550
2551@item G m
2552@kindex G m (Group)
2553@findex gnus-group-make-group
2554@cindex making groups
2555Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2556for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2557to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2558
2559@item G M
2560@kindex G M (Group)
2561@findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2562Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2563will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2564
2565@item G r
2566@kindex G r (Group)
2567@findex gnus-group-rename-group
2568@cindex renaming groups
2569Rename the current group to something else
2570(@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2571groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2572on some back ends.
2573
2574@item G c
2575@kindex G c (Group)
2576@cindex customizing
2577@findex gnus-group-customize
2578Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2579
2580@item G e
2581@kindex G e (Group)
2582@findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2583@cindex renaming groups
2584Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2585group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2586
2587@item G p
2588@kindex G p (Group)
2589@findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2590Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2591(@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2592
2593@item G E
2594@kindex G E (Group)
2595@findex gnus-group-edit-group
2596Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2597(@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2598
2599@item G d
2600@kindex G d (Group)
2601@findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2602@cindex nndir
2603Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2604for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2605
2606@item G h
2607@kindex G h (Group)
2608@cindex help group
2609@findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2610Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2611
4009494e
GM
2612@item G D
2613@kindex G D (Group)
2614@findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2615@cindex nneething
2616Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2617@code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2618@xref{Anything Groups}.
2619
2620@item G f
2621@kindex G f (Group)
2622@findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2623@cindex ClariNet Briefs
2624@cindex nndoc
2625Make a group based on some file or other
2626(@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2627command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2628Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2629@code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2630@code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2631@code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2632@code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2633you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2634type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2635
2636@item G u
2637@kindex G u (Group)
2638@vindex gnus-useful-groups
2639@findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2640Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2641(@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2642
2643@item G w
2644@kindex G w (Group)
2645@findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2646@cindex Google
2647@cindex nnweb
2648@cindex gmane
2649Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2650(@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2651command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2652search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2653include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2654@xref{Web Searches}.
2655
2656If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2657to a particular group by using a match string like
2658@samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2659
2660@item G R
2661@kindex G R (Group)
2662@findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2663Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
1df7defd 2664(@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL@.
4009494e
GM
2665@xref{RSS}.
2666
2667@item G DEL
2668@kindex G DEL (Group)
2669@findex gnus-group-delete-group
2670This function will delete the current group
2671(@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2672actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2673group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2674absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2675read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2676
2677@item G V
2678@kindex G V (Group)
2679@findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2680Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2681(@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2682
2683@item G v
2684@kindex G v (Group)
2685@findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2686Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2687(@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2688@end table
2689
2690@xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2691methods.
2692
2693@vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2694If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2695Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2696This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2697groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2698@code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2699newsgroups.
2700
2701
9b3ebcb6
MB
2702The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2703only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2704
2705@table @code
2706@item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2707@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2708@vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2709Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2710HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2711Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2712the article range.
2713
2714@item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2715@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2716This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2717the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
1df7defd 2718given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include:
f2a538a2
GM
2719@indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2720@indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2721@indicateurl{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2722@indicateurl{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2723@indicateurl{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
9b3ebcb6
MB
2724
2725@item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2726@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2727Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2728bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2729specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2730
2731@item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2732@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2733Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2734@code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2735@end table
2736
2737Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2738Buttons}.
2739
2740Here is an example:
2741@lisp
2742(require 'gnus-art)
2743(add-to-list
2744 'gnus-button-alist
2745 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2746 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2747 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2748@end lisp
2749
2750
4009494e
GM
2751@node Group Parameters
2752@section Group Parameters
2753@cindex group parameters
2754
2755The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
87035689
MB
2756
2757Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2758group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2759presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2760silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2761parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2762Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2763@code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2764
4009494e
GM
2765Here's an example group parameter list:
2766
2767@example
2768((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2769 (auto-expire . t))
2770@end example
2771
2772We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2773the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2774parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2775not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2776
2777Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2778is an alist of regexps and values.
2779
2780The following group parameters can be used:
2781
2782@table @code
2783@item to-address
2784@cindex to-address
2785Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2786
2787@example
2788(to-address . "some@@where.com")
2789@end example
2790
2791This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2792lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2793the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2794ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2795that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2796
2797Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2798or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2799@samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2800the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2801group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2802list address instead.
2803
2804See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2805
2806@item to-list
2807@cindex to-list
2808Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2809
2810@example
2811(to-list . "some@@where.com")
2812@end example
2813
2814It is totally ignored
2815when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2816you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2817
2818If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2819@code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2820then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2821sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2822@vindex gnus-add-to-list
2823
2824@findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2825@cindex mail list groups
2826If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2827entering summary buffer.
2828
2829See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2830
2831@anchor{subscribed}
2832@item subscribed
2833@cindex subscribed
2834@cindex Mail-Followup-To
2835@findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2836If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2837to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2838mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2839(only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2840headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2841following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2842
2843@lisp
2844(setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2845 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2846@end lisp
2847
2848@xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2849a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2850
2851@item visible
2852@cindex visible
2853If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2854that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2855of whether it has any unread articles.
2856
2857This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2858@code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2859
2860@item broken-reply-to
2861@cindex broken-reply-to
2862Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2863headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2864if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2865can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2866has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2867itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2868
2869@item to-group
2870@cindex to-group
2871Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2872posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2873
2874@item newsgroup
2875@cindex newsgroup
2876If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2877will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2878This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2879news group.
2880
2881@item gcc-self
2882@cindex gcc-self
2883If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2884composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2885@code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2886generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2887be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2888precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
89b163db 2889(@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for messages to resend.
4009494e
GM
2890
2891@strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2892@code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2893doesn't accept articles.
2894
2895@item auto-expire
2896@cindex auto-expire
2897@cindex expiring mail
2898If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2899. t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2900alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2901
2902See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2903
2904@item total-expire
2905@cindex total-expire
2906@cindex expiring mail
2907If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2908@code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2909expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2910caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2911expiry.
2912
2913See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2914
2915@item expiry-wait
2916@cindex expiry-wait
2917@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2918If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2919@code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2920@code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2921(@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2922can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2923symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2924
2925@item expiry-target
2926@cindex expiry-target
2927Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2928@code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2929
2930@item score-file
2931@cindex score file group parameter
2932Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2933@file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2934interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2935
2936@item adapt-file
2937@cindex adapt file group parameter
2938Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2939@file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2940All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2941
2942@item admin-address
2943@cindex admin-address
2944When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2945unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2946messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2947put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2948
2949@item display
2950@cindex display
2951Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2952display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2953
2954@table @code
2955@item all
2956Display all articles, both read and unread.
2957
2958@item an integer
2959Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2960entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2961
2962@item default
2963Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2964ticked articles.
2965
2966@item an array
2967Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2968
2969Here are some examples:
2970
2971@table @code
2972@item [unread]
2973Display only unread articles.
2974
2975@item [not expire]
2976Display everything except expirable articles.
2977
2978@item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2979Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2980responded to.
2981@end table
2982
2983The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2984Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2985@code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2986@code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
e21bac42 2987@code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
4009494e
GM
2988
2989@end table
2990
2991The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2992the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2993command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2994
2995@item comment
2996@cindex comment
2997Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2998arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2999group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
3000
3001@item charset
3002@cindex charset
3003Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3004@code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3005used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3006
3007See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3008
3009@item ignored-charsets
3010@cindex ignored-charset
3011Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3012will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3013default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3014
3015See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3016
3017@item posting-style
3018@cindex posting-style
3019You can store additional posting style information for this group
3020here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3021@code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3022the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3023take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3024
3025For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3026instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3027like this in the group parameters:
3028
3029@example
3030(posting-style
3031 (name "Funky Name")
89b163db 3032 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
4009494e
GM
3033 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3034 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3035@end example
3036
01c52d31
MB
3037If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3038(@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3039the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3040groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3041group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3042entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3043to.
3044
3045
4009494e
GM
3046@item post-method
3047@cindex post-method
3048If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3049instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3050
a1da1e37
MB
3051@item mail-source
3052@cindex mail-source
3053If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3054@code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3055mail source for this group.
3056
4009494e
GM
3057@item banner
3058@cindex banner
3059An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3060that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3061@var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3062last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3063@code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3064
3065@item sieve
3066@cindex sieve
3067This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3068that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3069Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3070condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3071
3072For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3073address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3074translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3075Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3076
3077@example
01c52d31
MB
3078if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3079 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3080@}
3081@end example
3082
3083To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3084like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3085When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3086like the following is generated:
3087
3088@example
3089if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3090 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
4009494e
GM
3091@}
3092@end example
3093
6ed7a66a
G
3094You can also use regexp expansions in the rules:
3095
3096@example
3097(sieve header :regex "list-id" "<c++std-\\1.accu.org>")
3098@end example
3099
01c52d31
MB
3100See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3101interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3102
4009494e
GM
3103The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3104Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3105
3106@item (agent parameters)
88dbda51
JB
3107If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3108control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
4009494e
GM
3109Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3110agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3111minimize the configuration effort.
3112
3113@item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3114You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3115are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3116you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3117that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3118in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3119@code{eval}ed there.
3120
e3e955fe
MB
3121Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3122if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3123only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3124variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3125form needs to be set to it.
3126
4009494e
GM
3127But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3128message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3129message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3130question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3131Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3132parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
e6d2d263 3133@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e
GM
3134
3135@lisp
3136(add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3137@end lisp
3138
3139@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3140A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
1df7defd 3141the subject fields of articles. E.g., if the news group
4009494e
GM
3142
3143@example
3144nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3145@end example
3146
3147has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3148tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3149the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3150into the group parameters for the group.
3151
3152This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3153hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
e3e955fe
MB
3154@code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3155@code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3156(meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
4009494e
GM
3157
3158Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3159pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3160following is added to a group parameter
3161
3162@lisp
3163(gnus-summary-prepared-hook
d1069532 3164 (lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
4009494e
GM
3165@end lisp
3166
3167when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3168expired.
3169
3170@end table
3171
4009494e
GM
3172@vindex gnus-parameters
3173Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3174But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3175case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3176For example:
3177
3178@lisp
3179(setq gnus-parameters
3180 '(("mail\\..*"
3181 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3182 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3183 (gnus-summary-line-format
3184 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3185 (gcc-self . t)
3186 (display . all))
3187
3188 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3189 (to-group . "\\1"))
3190
3191 ("mail\\.me"
e7719ea1 3192 (gnus-use-scoring t))
4009494e
GM
3193
3194 ("list\\..*"
3195 (total-expire . t)
3196 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3197@end lisp
3198
e7719ea1
G
3199All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3200setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3201group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3202override the first.
9937bef4
G
3203
3204Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3205as the @code{to-group} example shows.
4009494e
GM
3206
3207@vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3208By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3209specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3210or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3211@code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3212value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3213example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3214applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3215group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3216value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3217@code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3218always in a case-insensitive manner.
3219
01c52d31
MB
3220You can define different sorting to different groups via
3221@code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3222group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3223@acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3224Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3225news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3226weekly news RSS feed
3227@url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3228@xref{RSS}.
3229
3230@lisp
3231(setq
3232 gnus-parameters
3233 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3234 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3235 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3236 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3237 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3238 ("nnrss.*debian"
3239 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3240 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3241 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3242 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3243 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3244 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3245@end lisp
3246
4009494e
GM
3247
3248@node Listing Groups
3249@section Listing Groups
3250@cindex group listing
3251
3252These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3253
3254@table @kbd
3255
3256@item l
3257@itemx A s
3258@kindex A s (Group)
3259@kindex l (Group)
3260@findex gnus-group-list-groups
3261List all groups that have unread articles
3262(@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3263command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3264only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3265@code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3266groups).
3267
3268@item L
3269@itemx A u
3270@kindex A u (Group)
3271@kindex L (Group)
3272@findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3273List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3274(@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3275this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3276it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3277unsubscribed groups).
3278
3279@item A l
3280@kindex A l (Group)
3281@findex gnus-group-list-level
3282List all unread groups on a specific level
3283(@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3284with no unread articles.
3285
3286@item A k
3287@kindex A k (Group)
3288@findex gnus-group-list-killed
3289List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3290prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3291currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3292from the server.
3293
3294@item A z
3295@kindex A z (Group)
3296@findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3297List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3298
3299@item A m
3300@kindex A m (Group)
3301@findex gnus-group-list-matching
3302List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3303(@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3304
3305@item A M
3306@kindex A M (Group)
3307@findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3308List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3309
3310@item A A
3311@kindex A A (Group)
3312@findex gnus-group-list-active
3313List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3314server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3315might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3316to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3317thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3318don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3319Take the output with some grains of salt.
3320
3321@item A a
3322@kindex A a (Group)
3323@findex gnus-group-apropos
3324List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3325(@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3326
3327@item A d
3328@kindex A d (Group)
3329@findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3330List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3331(@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3332
3333@item A c
3334@kindex A c (Group)
3335@findex gnus-group-list-cached
3336List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3337
3338@item A ?
3339@kindex A ? (Group)
3340@findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3341List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3342
a5954fa5
G
3343@item A !
3344@kindex A ! (Group)
3345@findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3346List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3347
4009494e
GM
3348@item A /
3349@kindex A / (Group)
3350@findex gnus-group-list-limit
0afb49a1
LMI
3351Further limit groups within the current selection
3352(@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3353with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3354@kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3355giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3356articles.
4009494e
GM
3357
3358@item A f
3359@kindex A f (Group)
3360@findex gnus-group-list-flush
3361Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3362
3363@item A p
3364@kindex A p (Group)
3365@findex gnus-group-list-plus
3366List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3367
3368@end table
3369
3370@vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3371@cindex visible group parameter
3372Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3373always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3374add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3375get the same effect.
3376
3377@vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3378Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3379group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3380@code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3381groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3382
3383
3384@node Sorting Groups
3385@section Sorting Groups
3386@cindex sorting groups
3387
3388@kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3389@findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3390@vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3391The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3392group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3393@code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3394include:
3395
3396@table @code
3397
3398@item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3399@findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3400Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3401
3402@item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3403@findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3404Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3405
3406@item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3407@findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3408Sort by group level.
3409
3410@item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3411@findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3412Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3413
3414@item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3415@findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3416Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3417are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3418
3419@item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3420@findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3421Sort by number of unread articles.
3422
3423@item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3424@findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3425Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3426
3427@item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3428@findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3429Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3430
3431
3432@end table
3433
3434@code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3435functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3436the last one.
3437
3438
3439There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3440some sorting criteria:
3441
3442@table @kbd
3443@item G S a
3444@kindex G S a (Group)
3445@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3446Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3447(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3448
3449@item G S u
3450@kindex G S u (Group)
3451@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3452Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3453(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3454
3455@item G S l
3456@kindex G S l (Group)
3457@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3458Sort the group buffer by group level
3459(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3460
3461@item G S v
3462@kindex G S v (Group)
3463@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3464Sort the group buffer by group score
3465(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3466
3467@item G S r
3468@kindex G S r (Group)
3469@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3470Sort the group buffer by group rank
3471(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3472
3473@item G S m
3474@kindex G S m (Group)
3475@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3476Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3477(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3478
3479@item G S n
3480@kindex G S n (Group)
3481@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3482Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3483(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3484
3485@end table
3486
3487All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3488(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3489
3490When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3491commands will sort in reverse order.
3492
3493You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3494
3495@table @kbd
3496@item G P a
3497@kindex G P a (Group)
3498@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3499Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3500(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3501
3502@item G P u
3503@kindex G P u (Group)
3504@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3505Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3506(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3507
3508@item G P l
3509@kindex G P l (Group)
3510@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3511Sort the groups by group level
3512(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3513
3514@item G P v
3515@kindex G P v (Group)
3516@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3517Sort the groups by group score
3518(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3519
3520@item G P r
3521@kindex G P r (Group)
3522@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3523Sort the groups by group rank
3524(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3525
3526@item G P m
3527@kindex G P m (Group)
3528@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3529Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3530(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3531
3532@item G P n
3533@kindex G P n (Group)
3534@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3535Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3536(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3537
3538@item G P s
3539@kindex G P s (Group)
3540@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3541Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3542
3543@end table
3544
3545And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3546move groups around.
3547
3548
3549@node Group Maintenance
3550@section Group Maintenance
3551@cindex bogus groups
3552
3553@table @kbd
3554@item b
3555@kindex b (Group)
3556@findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3557Find bogus groups and delete them
3558(@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3559
3560@item F
3561@kindex F (Group)
3562@findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3563Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3564With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3565for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3566to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3567zombies.
3568
3569@item C-c C-x
3570@kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3571@findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3572@cindex expiring mail
3573Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3574process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3575all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3576(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3577
3578@item C-c C-M-x
3579@kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3580@findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3581@cindex expiring mail
3582Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3583(@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3584
3585@end table
3586
3587
3588@node Browse Foreign Server
3589@section Browse Foreign Server
3590@cindex foreign servers
3591@cindex browsing servers
3592
3593@table @kbd
3594@item B
3595@kindex B (Group)
3596@findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3597You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3598then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3599(@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3600@end table
3601
3602@findex gnus-browse-mode
3603A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3604will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3605a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3606
3607Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3608
3609@table @kbd
3610@item n
3611@kindex n (Browse)
3612@findex gnus-group-next-group
3613Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3614
3615@item p
3616@kindex p (Browse)
3617@findex gnus-group-prev-group
3618Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3619
3620@item SPACE
3621@kindex SPACE (Browse)
3622@findex gnus-browse-read-group
3623Enter the current group and display the first article
3624(@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3625
3626@item RET
3627@kindex RET (Browse)
3628@findex gnus-browse-select-group
3629Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3630
3631@item u
3632@kindex u (Browse)
3633@findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
8ccbef23 3634@vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
4009494e 3635Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
8ccbef23
G
3636subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3637can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3638using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3639@pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
4009494e
GM
3640
3641@item l
3642@itemx q
3643@kindex q (Browse)
3644@kindex l (Browse)
3645@findex gnus-browse-exit
3646Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3647
3648@item d
3649@kindex d (Browse)
3650@findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3651Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3652
3653@item ?
3654@kindex ? (Browse)
3655@findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3656Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3657there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
61bbede6
LI
3658
3659@item DEL
3660@kindex DEL (Browse)
3661@findex gnus-browse-delete-group
3662This function will delete the current group
3663(@code{gnus-browse-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function
3664will actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly
3665remove the group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only
3666if you are absolutely sure of what you are doing.
4009494e
GM
3667@end table
3668
3669
3670@node Exiting Gnus
3671@section Exiting Gnus
3672@cindex exiting Gnus
3673
3674Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3675
3676@table @kbd
3677@item z
3678@kindex z (Group)
3679@findex gnus-group-suspend
3680Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3681but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3682is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3683
3684@item q
3685@kindex q (Group)
3686@findex gnus-group-exit
3687@c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3688Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3689
3690@item Q
3691@kindex Q (Group)
3692@findex gnus-group-quit
3693Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3694The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3695@end table
3696
3697@vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3698@vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3699@vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3700@code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3701@code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3702@code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3703exiting Gnus.
3704
3705Note:
3706
3707@quotation
3708Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3709numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3710behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3711plastic chair.
3712@end quotation
3713
3714
3715@node Group Topics
3716@section Group Topics
3717@cindex topics
3718
3719If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3720them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3721here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3722you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3723even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3724groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3725
3726@iftex
3727@iflatex
3728\gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3729\put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3730}
3731@end iflatex
3732@end iftex
3733
3734Here's an example:
3735
3736@example
3737Gnus
3738 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3739 3: comp.emacs
3740 2: alt.religion.emacs
3741 Naughty Emacs
3742 452: alt.sex.emacs
3743 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3744 Misc
3745 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3746 13: comp.sources.unix
3747@end example
3748
3749@findex gnus-topic-mode
3750@kindex t (Group)
3751To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3752@code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3753is a toggling command.)
3754
3755Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3756dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3757Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3758under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3759Hot and bothered?
3760
3761If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3762the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3763@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3764
3765@lisp
3766(add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3767@end lisp
3768
3769@menu
3770* Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3771* Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3772* Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3773* Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3774* Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3775@end menu
3776
3777
3778@node Topic Commands
3779@subsection Topic Commands
3780@cindex topic commands
3781
3782When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3783available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3784definitions slightly.
3785
3786In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3787First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3788groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3789like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3790shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3791groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3792
3793Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3794the way you like.
3795
3796@table @kbd
3797
3798@item T n
3799@kindex T n (Topic)
3800@findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3801Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3802(@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3803
3804@item T TAB
3805@itemx TAB
3806@kindex T TAB (Topic)
3807@kindex TAB (Topic)
3808@findex gnus-topic-indent
3809``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3810previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3811``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3812
3813@item M-TAB
3814@kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3815@findex gnus-topic-unindent
3816``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3817parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3818
3819@end table
3820
3821The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3822They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3823@kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3824kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3825
3826@table @kbd
3827
3828@item C-k
3829@kindex C-k (Topic)
3830@findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3831Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3832topic will be removed along with the topic.
3833
3834@item C-y
3835@kindex C-y (Topic)
3836@findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3837Yank the previously killed group or topic
3838(@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3839before all groups.
3840
3841So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3842@kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3843move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3844topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
f99f1641 3845paste. Like I said---E-Z.
4009494e
GM
3846
3847You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3848you can move topics around as well as groups.
3849
3850@end table
3851
3852After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3853hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3854key.
3855
3856@table @kbd
3857
3858@item RET
3859@kindex RET (Topic)
3860@findex gnus-topic-select-group
3861@itemx SPACE
3862Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3863When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3864usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3865visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3866toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3867prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3868
3869@end table
3870
3871Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3872
3873@table @kbd
3874
3875@item T m
3876@kindex T m (Topic)
3877@findex gnus-topic-move-group
3878Move the current group to some other topic
3879(@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3880convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3881
3882@item T j
3883@kindex T j (Topic)
3884@findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3885Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3886
3887@item T c
3888@kindex T c (Topic)
3889@findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3890Copy the current group to some other topic
3891(@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3892convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3893
3894@item T h
3895@kindex T h (Topic)
3896@findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3897Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3898a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3899
3900@item T s
3901@kindex T s (Topic)
3902@findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3903Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3904a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3905
3906@item T D
3907@kindex T D (Topic)
3908@findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3909Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3910This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3911topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3912remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3913the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3914(which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3915topic.
3916
3917This command uses the process/prefix convention
3918(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3919
3920@item T M
3921@kindex T M (Topic)
3922@findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3923Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3924(@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3925
3926@item T C
3927@kindex T C (Topic)
3928@findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3929Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3930(@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3931
3932@item T H
3933@kindex T H (Topic)
3934@findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3935Toggle hiding empty topics
3936(@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3937
3938@item T #
3939@kindex T # (Topic)
3940@findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3941Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3942(@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3943sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3944
3945@item T M-#
3946@kindex T M-# (Topic)
3947@findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3948Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3949(@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3950sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3951
3952@item C-c C-x
3953@kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3954@findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3955@cindex expiring mail
3956Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3957expiry process (if any)
3958(@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3959
3960@item T r
3961@kindex T r (Topic)
3962@findex gnus-topic-rename
3963Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3964
3965@item T DEL
3966@kindex T DEL (Topic)
3967@findex gnus-topic-delete
3968Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3969
3970@item A T
3971@kindex A T (Topic)
3972@findex gnus-topic-list-active
3973List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3974(@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3975
3976@item T M-n
3977@kindex T M-n (Topic)
3978@findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3979Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3980
3981@item T M-p
3982@kindex T M-p (Topic)
3983@findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
01c52d31 3984Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
4009494e
GM
3985
3986@item G p
3987@kindex G p (Topic)
3988@findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3989@cindex group parameters
3990@cindex topic parameters
3991@cindex parameters
3992Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3993@xref{Topic Parameters}.
3994
3995@end table
3996
3997
3998@node Topic Variables
3999@subsection Topic Variables
4000@cindex topic variables
4001
4002The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
4003This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
4004
4005@vindex gnus-topic-line-format
4006The topic lines themselves are created according to the
4007@code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4008Valid elements are:
4009
4010@table @samp
4011@item i
4012Indentation.
4013@item n
4014Topic name.
4015@item v
4016Visibility.
4017@item l
4018Level.
4019@item g
4020Number of groups in the topic.
4021@item a
4022Number of unread articles in the topic.
4023@item A
4024Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4025@end table
4026
4027@vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4028Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4029@code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4030The default is 2.
4031
4032@vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4033@code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4034
4035@vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4036The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4037topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4038
4039
4040@node Topic Sorting
4041@subsection Topic Sorting
4042@cindex topic sorting
4043
4044You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4045commands:
4046
4047
4048@table @kbd
4049@item T S a
4050@kindex T S a (Topic)
4051@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4052Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4053(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4054
4055@item T S u
4056@kindex T S u (Topic)
4057@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4058Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4059(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4060
4061@item T S l
4062@kindex T S l (Topic)
4063@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4064Sort the current topic by group level
4065(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4066
4067@item T S v
4068@kindex T S v (Topic)
4069@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4070Sort the current topic by group score
4071(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4072
4073@item T S r
4074@kindex T S r (Topic)
4075@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4076Sort the current topic by group rank
4077(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4078
4079@item T S m
4080@kindex T S m (Topic)
4081@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4082Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4083(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4084
4085@item T S e
4086@kindex T S e (Topic)
4087@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4088Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4089(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4090
4091@item T S s
4092@kindex T S s (Topic)
4093@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4094Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4095@code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4096(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4097
4098@end table
4099
4100When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4101order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4102sorting.
4103
4104
4105@node Topic Topology
4106@subsection Topic Topology
4107@cindex topic topology
4108@cindex topology
4109
4110So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4111
4112@example
4113@group
4114Gnus
4115 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4116 3: comp.emacs
4117 2: alt.religion.emacs
4118 Naughty Emacs
4119 452: alt.sex.emacs
4120 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4121 Misc
4122 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4123 13: comp.sources.unix
4124@end group
4125@end example
4126
4127So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4128that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4129just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4130follows:
4131
4132@lisp
4133(("Gnus" visible)
4134 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4135 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4136 (("Misc" visible)))
4137@end lisp
4138
4139@vindex gnus-topic-topology
4140This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4141for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4142file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4143to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4144setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4145
4146This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4147and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4148allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4149
4150
4151@node Topic Parameters
4152@subsection Topic Parameters
4153@cindex topic parameters
4154
4155All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4156(and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4157topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4158enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4159Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4160
4161In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4162parameters:
4163
4164@table @code
4165@item subscribe
4166When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4167@code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4168value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4169topic.
4170
4171@item subscribe-level
4172When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4173the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4174@code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4175
4176@end table
4177
4178Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4179parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4180know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4181verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4182
4183@example
4184@group
4185Gnus
4186 Emacs
4187 3: comp.emacs
4188 2: alt.religion.emacs
4189 452: alt.sex.emacs
4190 Relief
4191 452: alt.sex.emacs
4192 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4193 Misc
4194 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4195 13: comp.sources.unix
4196 452: alt.sex.emacs
4197@end group
4198@end example
4199
4200The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4201. "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4202@code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4203topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4204@* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4205. "religion.SCORE")}.
4206
4207Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4208will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4209group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4210score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4211get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4212
4213This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4214there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4215parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4216@code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4217gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4218of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4219happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4220happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4221
4222
01c52d31
MB
4223@node Non-ASCII Group Names
4224@section Accessing groups of non-English names
4225@cindex non-ascii group names
4226
4227There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4228expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4229certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4230spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4231course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4232supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4233back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4234back end.
4235
4236Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4237side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4238charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4239Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4240article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4241with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4242non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4243the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4244
4245@table @code
4246@item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4247@vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4248An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4249@code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4250method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4251
4252@lisp
4253(setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4254 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4255@end lisp
4256
4257Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4258ones specified for the same groups with the
4259@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4260
4261A select method can be very long, like:
4262
4263@lisp
4264(nntp "gmane"
4265 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4266 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4267 (nntp-open-connection-function
4268 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4269 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4270 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4271 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4272 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4273@end lisp
4274
4275In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4276variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4277the server name.
4278
4279@item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4280@cindex UTF-8 group names
4281@vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4282An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4283@code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4284otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4285
4286@lisp
4287(setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4288 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4289 (".*" . utf-8)))
4290@end lisp
4291
4292Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4293@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4294@end table
4295
4296Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4297and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4298other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4299you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4300all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4301@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4302
4303There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
26b9f88d 4304names:
01c52d31
MB
4305
4306@table @code
4307@item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
26b9f88d
MB
4308@vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4309The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4310default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4311named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4312@code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4313
89b163db
G
4314The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4315the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4316directories. This variable overrides the value of
4317@code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4318when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
01c52d31
MB
4319
4320In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4321is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
26b9f88d 4322file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
01c52d31 4323@code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
26b9f88d
MB
4324is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4325@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4326
4327Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4328@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4329to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4330to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
01c52d31
MB
4331
4332The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4333does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4334@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4335@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4336
26b9f88d
MB
4337If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4338initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4339want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4340typical case where you have to customize
4341@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4342a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4343system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4344may be initialized to an appropriate value.
01c52d31
MB
4345@end table
4346
4347Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4348group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4349names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4350header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4351
4352
8a1cdce5
AC
4353@node Misc Group Stuff
4354@section Misc Group Stuff
e6d2d263
MB
4355
4356@menu
8a1cdce5
AC
4357* Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4358* Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4359* Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4360* File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4361* Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
e6d2d263
MB
4362@end menu
4363
8a1cdce5 4364@table @kbd
e6d2d263 4365
8a1cdce5
AC
4366@item v
4367@kindex v (Group)
4368@cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4369The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4370command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
e6d2d263 4371
8a1cdce5
AC
4372@lisp
4373(define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4374 (lambda ()
4375 (interactive)
4376 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4377@end lisp
e6d2d263 4378
8a1cdce5
AC
4379On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4380@xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
e6d2d263 4381
8a1cdce5
AC
4382@item ^
4383@kindex ^ (Group)
4384@findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4385Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4386@xref{Server Buffer}.
e6d2d263 4387
8a1cdce5
AC
4388@item a
4389@kindex a (Group)
4390@findex gnus-group-post-news
4391Start composing a message (a news by default)
4392(@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4393under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4394Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4395article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4396with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
e6d2d263 4397
8a1cdce5
AC
4398@item m
4399@kindex m (Group)
4400@findex gnus-group-mail
4401Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4402use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4403prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4404@xref{Composing Messages}.
e6d2d263 4405
8a1cdce5
AC
4406@item i
4407@kindex i (Group)
4408@findex gnus-group-news
4409Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4410post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4411for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
e6d2d263 4412
8a1cdce5
AC
4413This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4414This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4415sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4416in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4417for this to work though.
e6d2d263 4418
8a1cdce5
AC
4419@item G z
4420@kindex G z (Group)
4421@findex gnus-group-compact-group
e6d2d263 4422
8a1cdce5
AC
4423Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4424Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4425gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4426count.
e6d2d263 4427
8a1cdce5 4428@end table
e6d2d263 4429
8a1cdce5 4430Variables for the group buffer:
e6d2d263 4431
8a1cdce5 4432@table @code
e6d2d263 4433
8a1cdce5
AC
4434@item gnus-group-mode-hook
4435@vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4436is called after the group buffer has been
4437created.
e6d2d263 4438
8a1cdce5
AC
4439@item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4440@vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4441is called after the group buffer is
4442generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4443unnatural way.
e6d2d263 4444
8a1cdce5
AC
4445@item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4446@vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4447is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4448generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
e6d2d263 4449
8a1cdce5
AC
4450@item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4451@vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4452Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4453whether they are empty or not.
e6d2d263 4454
8a1cdce5 4455@end table
e6d2d263 4456
8a1cdce5
AC
4457@node Scanning New Messages
4458@subsection Scanning New Messages
4459@cindex new messages
4460@cindex scanning new news
e6d2d263 4461
8a1cdce5 4462@table @kbd
e6d2d263 4463
8a1cdce5
AC
4464@item g
4465@kindex g (Group)
4466@findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4467@c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4468Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4469this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4470(@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4471command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4472back end(s).
e6d2d263 4473
8a1cdce5
AC
4474@item M-g
4475@kindex M-g (Group)
4476@findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4477@vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4478@c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4479Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4480(@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4481@code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4482to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
e6d2d263 4483
8a1cdce5
AC
4484@findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4485@cindex activating groups
4486@item C-c M-g
4487@kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4488Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
e6d2d263 4489
8a1cdce5
AC
4490@item R
4491@kindex R (Group)
4492@cindex restarting
4493@findex gnus-group-restart
4494Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4495file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4496Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
e6d2d263 4497
8a1cdce5 4498@end table
e6d2d263 4499
8a1cdce5
AC
4500@vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4501@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
e6d2d263 4502
8a1cdce5
AC
4503@vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4504@code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4505news.
e6d2d263 4506
e6d2d263 4507
8a1cdce5
AC
4508@node Group Information
4509@subsection Group Information
4510@cindex group information
4511@cindex information on groups
e6d2d263 4512
8a1cdce5 4513@table @kbd
e6d2d263 4514
e6d2d263 4515
8a1cdce5
AC
4516@item H d
4517@itemx C-c C-d
4518@c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4519@kindex H d (Group)
4520@kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4521@cindex describing groups
4522@cindex group description
4523@findex gnus-group-describe-group
4524Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4525a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
2b968687 4526
8a1cdce5
AC
4527@item M-d
4528@kindex M-d (Group)
4529@findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4530Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4531prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
2b968687 4532
8a1cdce5
AC
4533@item H v
4534@itemx V
4535@kindex V (Group)
4536@kindex H v (Group)
4537@cindex version
4538@findex gnus-version
4539Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
2b968687 4540
8a1cdce5
AC
4541@item ?
4542@kindex ? (Group)
4543@findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4544Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
2b968687 4545
8a1cdce5
AC
4546@item C-c C-i
4547@kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4548@cindex info
4549@cindex manual
4550@findex gnus-info-find-node
4551Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4552@end table
e6d2d263 4553
e6d2d263 4554
8a1cdce5
AC
4555@node Group Timestamp
4556@subsection Group Timestamp
4557@cindex timestamps
4558@cindex group timestamps
e6d2d263 4559
8a1cdce5
AC
4560It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4561group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4562@code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
e6d2d263 4563
8a1cdce5
AC
4564@lisp
4565(add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4566@end lisp
e6d2d263 4567
8a1cdce5 4568After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
e6d2d263 4569
8a1cdce5
AC
4570This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4571use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
e6d2d263 4572
8a1cdce5
AC
4573@lisp
4574(setq gnus-group-line-format
4575 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4576@end lisp
e6d2d263 4577
8a1cdce5 4578This will result in lines looking like:
e6d2d263 4579
8a1cdce5
AC
4580@example
4581* 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4582 0: custom 19961002T012713
4583@end example
e6d2d263 4584
8a1cdce5
AC
4585As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4586may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4587something like:
e6d2d263 4588
8a1cdce5
AC
4589@lisp
4590(setq gnus-group-line-format
4591 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4592@end lisp
e6d2d263 4593
8a1cdce5
AC
4594If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4595user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4596trick:
e6d2d263 4597
8a1cdce5
AC
4598@lisp
4599(setq gnus-group-line-format
4600 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4601(defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4602 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4603 (if time
4604 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4605 "")))
4606@end lisp
e6d2d263 4607
71cca84d
G
4608To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4609@code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4610variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4611either.
4612
e6d2d263 4613
8a1cdce5
AC
4614@node File Commands
4615@subsection File Commands
4616@cindex file commands
e6d2d263 4617
8a1cdce5 4618@table @kbd
e6d2d263 4619
8a1cdce5
AC
4620@item r
4621@kindex r (Group)
4622@findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4623@vindex gnus-init-file
4624@cindex reading init file
4625Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4626@file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
e6d2d263 4627
8a1cdce5
AC
4628@item s
4629@kindex s (Group)
4630@findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4631@cindex saving .newsrc
4632Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4633(@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4634file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
e6d2d263 4635
8a1cdce5
AC
4636@c @item Z
4637@c @kindex Z (Group)
4638@c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4639@c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
e6d2d263 4640
8a1cdce5 4641@end table
e6d2d263 4642
e6d2d263 4643
8a1cdce5
AC
4644@node Sieve Commands
4645@subsection Sieve Commands
4646@cindex group sieve commands
e6d2d263 4647
8a1cdce5
AC
4648Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4649the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4650sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4651commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
333f9019 4652script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
e6d2d263 4653
8a1cdce5
AC
4654@vindex gnus-sieve-file
4655@vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4656@vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4657The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4658default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4659between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4660@code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4661outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4662regenerate the Sieve script.
e6d2d263 4663
8a1cdce5
AC
4664@vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4665The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4666is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4667placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4668is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4669example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4670"owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4671code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4672@code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4673except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
e6d2d263 4674
8a1cdce5
AC
4675@example
4676if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4677 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4678 stop;
4679@}
4680@end example
e6d2d263 4681
8a1cdce5 4682@xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
e6d2d263
MB
4683
4684@table @kbd
4685
8a1cdce5
AC
4686@item D g
4687@kindex D g (Group)
4688@findex gnus-sieve-generate
4689@vindex gnus-sieve-file
4690@cindex generating sieve script
4691Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4692put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
e6d2d263 4693
8a1cdce5
AC
4694@item D u
4695@kindex D u (Group)
4696@findex gnus-sieve-update
4697@vindex gnus-sieve-file
4698@cindex updating sieve script
4699Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4700@code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4701server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
e6d2d263
MB
4702
4703@end table
4704
e6d2d263 4705
8a1cdce5
AC
4706@node Summary Buffer
4707@chapter Summary Buffer
4708@cindex summary buffer
e6d2d263 4709
8a1cdce5
AC
4710A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4711move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
e6d2d263 4712
8a1cdce5
AC
4713The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4714group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
e6d2d263 4715
8a1cdce5 4716You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
e6d2d263 4717
8a1cdce5
AC
4718You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4719customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4720available in Emacs.
e6d2d263 4721
8a1cdce5
AC
4722@kindex v (Summary)
4723@cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4724The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4725command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4726@lisp
4727(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4728@end lisp
e6d2d263 4729
8a1cdce5
AC
4730@menu
4731* Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4732* Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4733* Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4734* Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4735* Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4736* Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4737* Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4738* Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4739* Threading:: How threads are made.
4740* Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4741* Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4742* Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4743* Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4744* Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4745* Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4746* Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4747* Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4748* Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4749* MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4750* Charsets:: Character set issues.
4751* Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4752* Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4753* Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4754* Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4755* Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4756* Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4757* Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4758* Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4759 or reselecting the current group.
4760* Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4761* Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4762* Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4763* Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4764@end menu
e6d2d263 4765
e6d2d263 4766
8a1cdce5
AC
4767@node Summary Buffer Format
4768@section Summary Buffer Format
4769@cindex summary buffer format
e6d2d263 4770
8a1cdce5
AC
4771@iftex
4772@iflatex
4773\gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4774\put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4775\put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4776}
4777@end iflatex
4778@end iftex
e6d2d263 4779
8a1cdce5
AC
4780@menu
4781* Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4782* To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4783* Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4784* Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4785@end menu
e6d2d263 4786
8a1cdce5
AC
4787@findex mail-extract-address-components
4788@findex gnus-extract-address-components
4789@vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4790Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4791variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4792@code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4793@code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4794fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4795@code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4796slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4797cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
e6d2d263
MB
4798
4799@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
4800(setq gnus-extract-address-components
4801 'mail-extract-address-components)
e6d2d263
MB
4802@end lisp
4803
8a1cdce5
AC
4804@vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4805@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4806article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4807with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
e6d2d263 4808
e6d2d263 4809
8a1cdce5
AC
4810@node Summary Buffer Lines
4811@subsection Summary Buffer Lines
e6d2d263 4812
8a1cdce5
AC
4813@vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4814You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4815the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4816lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4817(@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
e6d2d263 4818
8a1cdce5
AC
4819There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4820the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4821performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4822possible to change this. Just write a new function
4823@code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4824@xref{Positioning Point}.
e6d2d263 4825
8a1cdce5 4826The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
e6d2d263 4827
8a1cdce5
AC
4828The following format specification characters and extended format
4829specification(s) are understood:
e6d2d263 4830
8a1cdce5
AC
4831@table @samp
4832@item N
4833Article number.
4834@item S
4835Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4836@code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4837@item s
4838Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4839had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4840(@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4841@item F
4842Full @code{From} header.
4843@item n
4844The name (from the @code{From} header).
4845@item f
4846The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4847From Newsgroups}).
4848@item a
4849The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4850spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4851@code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4852may be more thorough.
4853@item A
4854The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4855the @code{a} spec.
4856@item L
4857Number of lines in the article.
4858@item c
4859Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4860in some methods (like nnfolder).
4861@item k
4862Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4863for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4864@item I
4865Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4866@item B
4867A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4868lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
e6d2d263 4869
8a1cdce5
AC
4870@example
4871>
4872+->
4873| +->
4874| | \->
4875| | \->
4876| \->
4877+->
4878\->
4879@end example
e6d2d263 4880
8a1cdce5
AC
4881You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4882that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4883replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4884line-drawing glyphs.
4885@table @code
4886@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4887@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4888Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4889instead. The default is @samp{> }.
e6d2d263 4890
8a1cdce5
AC
4891@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4892@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4893Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4894@code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
e6d2d263 4895
8a1cdce5
AC
4896@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4897@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4898Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4899instead. The default is @samp{}.
030cca00 4900
8a1cdce5
AC
4901@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4902@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4903Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
030cca00 4904
8a1cdce5
AC
4905@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4906@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4907Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
e6d2d263 4908
8a1cdce5
AC
4909@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4910@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4911Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
e6d2d263 4912
8a1cdce5
AC
4913@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4914@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4915Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
e6d2d263 4916
8a1cdce5 4917@end table
030cca00 4918
8a1cdce5
AC
4919@item T
4920Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4921pushes everything after it off the screen).
4922@item [
4923Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4924for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4925@item ]
4926Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4927for adopted articles.
4928@item >
4929One space for each thread level.
4930@item <
4931Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4932@item U
4933Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
e6d2d263 4934
8a1cdce5
AC
4935@item R
4936This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4937mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4938or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
e6d2d263 4939
8a1cdce5
AC
4940@item i
4941Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4942@item z
4943@vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4944Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4945default level. If the difference between
4946@code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4947@code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4948@item V
4949Total thread score.
4950@item x
4951@code{Xref}.
4952@item D
4953@code{Date}.
4954@item d
4955The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4956@item o
4957The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4958@item M
4959@code{Message-ID}.
4960@item r
4961@code{References}.
4962@item t
4963Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4964down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4965@item e
4966An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4967article has any children.
4968@item P
4969The line number.
4970@item O
4971Download mark.
4972@item *
4973Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4974@item &user-date;
4975Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
c2f51e23 4976@code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
8a1cdce5
AC
4977@item u
4978User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4979be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4980@code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4981following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4982argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4983into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4984@end table
e6d2d263 4985
8a1cdce5
AC
4986Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4987@code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4988There can only be one such area.
e6d2d263 4989
8a1cdce5
AC
4990The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4991have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4992compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4993that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4994variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4995buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
e6d2d263 4996
8a1cdce5
AC
4997The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4998(Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
e6d2d263 4999
8a1cdce5 5000This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
e6d2d263 5001
4009494e 5002
8a1cdce5
AC
5003@node To From Newsgroups
5004@subsection To From Newsgroups
5005@cindex To
5006@cindex Newsgroups
4009494e 5007
8a1cdce5
AC
5008In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
5009isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
5010you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
5011headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
5012gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4009494e 5013
8a1cdce5
AC
5014@enumerate
5015@item
5016@vindex gnus-extra-headers
5017The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
5018@code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5019instance:
4009494e
GM
5020
5021@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
5022(setq gnus-extra-headers
5023 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4009494e
GM
5024@end lisp
5025
8a1cdce5
AC
5026This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5027storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4009494e 5028
8a1cdce5
AC
5029@item
5030@findex gnus-extra-header
5031The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5032@code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5033access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4009494e 5034
8a1cdce5
AC
5035@example
5036"%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5037@end example
4009494e 5038
8a1cdce5
AC
5039@item
5040@vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5041The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5042summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5043@code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5044@code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5045headers are used instead.
4009494e 5046
8a1cdce5
AC
5047To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5048has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5049@code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5050@samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5051customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5052@code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
4009494e 5053
8a1cdce5 5054@end enumerate
4009494e 5055
8a1cdce5
AC
5056@vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5057A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5058to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5059If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5060changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
1df7defd 5061and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g., nnml) to cause
8a1cdce5 5062regeneration.
01c52d31 5063
8a1cdce5
AC
5064@vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5065You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5066@code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5067@code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
01c52d31 5068
8a1cdce5
AC
5069In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5070@file{~/.gnus.el}:
4009494e 5071
8a1cdce5
AC
5072@lisp
5073(setq gnus-extra-headers
5074 '(To Newsgroups))
5075(setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5076(setq gnus-summary-line-format
5077 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5078(setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5079 "Your Name Here")
5080@end lisp
4009494e 5081
8a1cdce5
AC
5082(The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5083to fit your needs.)
4009494e 5084
8a1cdce5
AC
5085A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5086convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5087support:
4009494e 5088
8a1cdce5
AC
5089The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5090the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5091nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4009494e 5092
8a1cdce5
AC
5093@example
5094Newsgroups:full
5095@end example
4009494e 5096
8a1cdce5
AC
5097to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5098as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4009494e 5099
4009494e 5100
8a1cdce5
AC
5101@node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5102@subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4009494e 5103
8a1cdce5
AC
5104@vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5105You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5106Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5107like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5108
5109Here are the elements you can play with:
4009494e 5110
8a1cdce5
AC
5111@table @samp
5112@item G
5113Group name.
5114@item p
5115Unprefixed group name.
5116@item A
5117Current article number.
5118@item z
5119Current article score.
5120@item V
5121Gnus version.
5122@item U
5123Number of unread articles in this group.
5124@item e
5125Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5126summary buffer.
5127@item Z
5128A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5129either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5130articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5131and no unselected ones.
4009494e 5132@item g
8a1cdce5
AC
5133Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5134shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5135@item S
5136Subject of the current article.
5137@item u
5138User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5139@item s
5140Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5141@item d
5142Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5143@item t
5144Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5145@item r
5146Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5147@item E
5148Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5149@end table
4009494e 5150
4009494e 5151
8a1cdce5
AC
5152@node Summary Highlighting
5153@subsection Summary Highlighting
4009494e 5154
8a1cdce5
AC
5155@table @code
5156
5157@item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5158@vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5159This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5160highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5161@code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5162
5163@item gnus-summary-update-hook
5164@vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5165This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5166@code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5167
5168@item gnus-summary-selected-face
5169@vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5170This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5171highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4009494e 5172
8a1cdce5
AC
5173@item gnus-summary-highlight
5174@vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5175Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5176list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5177. @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5178italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5179to something like
5180@lisp
5181(((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5182 ((> score default) . bold))
5183@end lisp
5184As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5185@var{face} will be applied to the line.
4009494e
GM
5186@end table
5187
4009494e 5188
8a1cdce5
AC
5189@node Summary Maneuvering
5190@section Summary Maneuvering
5191@cindex summary movement
4009494e 5192
8a1cdce5
AC
5193All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5194behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4009494e 5195
8a1cdce5 5196None of these commands select articles.
4009494e
GM
5197
5198@table @kbd
8a1cdce5
AC
5199@item G M-n
5200@itemx M-n
5201@kindex M-n (Summary)
5202@kindex G M-n (Summary)
5203@findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5204Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5205(@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4009494e 5206
8a1cdce5
AC
5207@item G M-p
5208@itemx M-p
5209@kindex M-p (Summary)
5210@kindex G M-p (Summary)
5211@findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5212Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5213(@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4009494e 5214
8a1cdce5
AC
5215@item G g
5216@kindex G g (Summary)
5217@findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5218Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5219without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5220@end table
4009494e 5221
8a1cdce5
AC
5222If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5223can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5224buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5225to the group buffer.
4009494e 5226
8a1cdce5 5227Variables related to summary movement:
4009494e 5228
8a1cdce5 5229@table @code
4009494e 5230
8a1cdce5
AC
5231@vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5232@item gnus-auto-select-next
5233If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5234no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5235the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5236empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5237this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5238next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5239is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5240confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5241will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5242Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5243command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5244@pxref{Group Levels}.
4009494e 5245
8a1cdce5
AC
5246@item gnus-auto-select-same
5247@vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5248If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5249article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5250mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5251for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5252articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4009494e 5253
8a1cdce5 5254This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4009494e 5255
8a1cdce5
AC
5256@item gnus-summary-check-current
5257@vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5258If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5259to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5260Instead, they will choose the current article.
4009494e 5261
8a1cdce5
AC
5262@item gnus-auto-center-summary
5263@vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5264If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5265centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5266slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5267set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5268action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5269buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5270threads.
4009494e 5271
8a1cdce5
AC
5272This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5273the given number of lines from the top.
4009494e 5274
8a1cdce5
AC
5275@item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5276@vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5277If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5278@kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
4009494e 5279
8a1cdce5 5280@end table
4009494e 5281
4009494e 5282
8a1cdce5
AC
5283@node Choosing Articles
5284@section Choosing Articles
5285@cindex selecting articles
4009494e 5286
8a1cdce5
AC
5287@menu
5288* Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5289* Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5290@end menu
4009494e 5291
4009494e 5292
8a1cdce5
AC
5293@node Choosing Commands
5294@subsection Choosing Commands
4009494e 5295
8a1cdce5
AC
5296None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5297and they all select and display an article.
4009494e 5298
8a1cdce5
AC
5299If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5300@ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4009494e 5301
8a1cdce5
AC
5302@table @kbd
5303@item SPACE
5304@kindex SPACE (Summary)
5305@findex gnus-summary-next-page
5306Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5307unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4009494e 5308
8a1cdce5
AC
5309If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5310again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5311@kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
4009494e 5312
8a1cdce5
AC
5313@item G n
5314@itemx n
5315@kindex n (Summary)
5316@kindex G n (Summary)
5317@findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5318@c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5319Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
4009494e 5320
8a1cdce5
AC
5321@item G p
5322@itemx p
5323@kindex p (Summary)
5324@findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5325@c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5326Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
4009494e 5327
8a1cdce5
AC
5328@item G N
5329@itemx N
5330@kindex N (Summary)
5331@kindex G N (Summary)
5332@findex gnus-summary-next-article
5333Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
4009494e 5334
8a1cdce5
AC
5335@item G P
5336@itemx P
5337@kindex P (Summary)
5338@kindex G P (Summary)
5339@findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5340Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
4009494e 5341
8a1cdce5
AC
5342@item G C-n
5343@kindex G C-n (Summary)
5344@findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5345Go to the next article with the same subject
5346(@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
4009494e 5347
8a1cdce5
AC
5348@item G C-p
5349@kindex G C-p (Summary)
5350@findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5351Go to the previous article with the same subject
5352(@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
4009494e 5353
8a1cdce5
AC
5354@item G f
5355@itemx .
5356@kindex G f (Summary)
5357@kindex . (Summary)
5358@findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5359Go to the first unread article
5360(@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
4009494e 5361
8a1cdce5
AC
5362@item G b
5363@itemx ,
5364@kindex G b (Summary)
5365@kindex , (Summary)
5366@findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5367Go to the unread article with the highest score
5368(@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5369go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
4009494e 5370
8a1cdce5
AC
5371@item G l
5372@itemx l
5373@kindex l (Summary)
5374@kindex G l (Summary)
5375@findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5376Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
4009494e 5377
8a1cdce5
AC
5378@item G o
5379@kindex G o (Summary)
5380@findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5381@cindex history
5382@cindex article history
5383Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5384(@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5385command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5386history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5387For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5388@pxref{Article Backlog}.
4009494e 5389
8a1cdce5
AC
5390@item G j
5391@itemx j
5392@kindex j (Summary)
5393@kindex G j (Summary)
5394@findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5395Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5396article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
4009494e 5397
8a1cdce5 5398@end table
4009494e 5399
4009494e 5400
8a1cdce5
AC
5401@node Choosing Variables
5402@subsection Choosing Variables
4009494e 5403
8a1cdce5 5404Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
4009494e 5405
8a1cdce5
AC
5406@table @code
5407@item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5408@vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5409All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5410article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5411this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5412the server and display it in the article buffer.
4009494e 5413
8a1cdce5
AC
5414@item gnus-select-article-hook
5415@vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5416This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5417@code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5418you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5419hook will do so.
4009494e 5420
8a1cdce5
AC
5421@item gnus-mark-article-hook
5422@vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5423@findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5424@findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5425@findex gnus-unread-mark
5426This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5427be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5428@code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5429mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5430articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5431expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5432marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5433instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5434@code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
4009494e 5435
8a1cdce5 5436@end table
4009494e 5437
4009494e 5438
8a1cdce5
AC
5439@node Paging the Article
5440@section Scrolling the Article
5441@cindex article scrolling
4009494e 5442
8a1cdce5 5443@table @kbd
4009494e 5444
8a1cdce5
AC
5445@item SPACE
5446@kindex SPACE (Summary)
5447@findex gnus-summary-next-page
5448Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5449or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5450next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4009494e 5451
8a1cdce5
AC
5452@vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5453@vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5454If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5455the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5456skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5457what is considered uninteresting with
5458@code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5459pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
4009494e 5460
8a1cdce5
AC
5461@item DEL
5462@kindex DEL (Summary)
5463@findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5464Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
4009494e 5465
8a1cdce5
AC
5466@item RET
5467@kindex RET (Summary)
5468@findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5469Scroll the current article one line forward
5470(@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
4009494e 5471
8a1cdce5
AC
5472@item M-RET
5473@kindex M-RET (Summary)
5474@findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5475Scroll the current article one line backward
5476(@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
4009494e 5477
8a1cdce5
AC
5478@item A g
5479@itemx g
5480@kindex A g (Summary)
5481@kindex g (Summary)
5482@findex gnus-summary-show-article
5483@vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5484(Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5485given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5486came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5487g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5488treatment functions.
4009494e 5489
8a1cdce5
AC
5490@cindex charset, view article with different charset
5491If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5492@kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5493encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
4009494e
GM
5494
5495@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
5496(setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5497 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5498 (2 . big5)))
4009494e
GM
5499@end lisp
5500
8a1cdce5 5501then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
4009494e 5502
8a1cdce5
AC
5503@item A <
5504@itemx <
5505@kindex < (Summary)
5506@kindex A < (Summary)
5507@findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5508Scroll to the beginning of the article
5509(@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
4009494e 5510
8a1cdce5
AC
5511@item A >
5512@itemx >
5513@kindex > (Summary)
5514@kindex A > (Summary)
5515@findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5516Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
4009494e 5517
8a1cdce5
AC
5518@item A s
5519@itemx s
5520@kindex A s (Summary)
5521@kindex s (Summary)
5522@findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5523Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5524(@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
4009494e 5525
8a1cdce5
AC
5526@item h
5527@kindex h (Summary)
5528@findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5529Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
4009494e 5530
8a1cdce5 5531@end table
4009494e 5532
4009494e 5533
8a1cdce5
AC
5534@node Reply Followup and Post
5535@section Reply, Followup and Post
4009494e 5536
8a1cdce5
AC
5537@menu
5538* Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5539* Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5540* Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5541* Canceling and Superseding::
5542@end menu
4009494e 5543
4009494e 5544
8a1cdce5
AC
5545@node Summary Mail Commands
5546@subsection Summary Mail Commands
5547@cindex mail
5548@cindex composing mail
4009494e 5549
8a1cdce5 5550Commands for composing a mail message:
4009494e 5551
8a1cdce5 5552@table @kbd
4009494e 5553
8a1cdce5
AC
5554@item S r
5555@itemx r
5556@kindex S r (Summary)
5557@kindex r (Summary)
5558@findex gnus-summary-reply
5559@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5560@c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5561Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5562(@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
4009494e 5563
8a1cdce5
AC
5564@item S R
5565@itemx R
5566@kindex R (Summary)
5567@kindex S R (Summary)
5568@findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5569@c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5570Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5571original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5572command uses the process/prefix convention.
4009494e 5573
8a1cdce5
AC
5574@item S w
5575@kindex S w (Summary)
5576@findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5577Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5578(@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5579goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5580@code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5581present, that's used instead.
4009494e 5582
8a1cdce5
AC
5583@item S W
5584@kindex S W (Summary)
5585@findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5586Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5587message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5588the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5589first article to determine the recipients.
5590
60a0884e
G
5591@item S L
5592@kindex S L (Summary)
5593@findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5594When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5595message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5596(@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5597
8a1cdce5
AC
5598@item S v
5599@kindex S v (Summary)
5600@findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5601Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5602(@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5603that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5604@code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5605articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5606
5607@item S V
5608@kindex S V (Summary)
5609@findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5610Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5611original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5612command uses the process/prefix convention.
5613
5614@item S B r
5615@kindex S B r (Summary)
5616@findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5617Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5618@code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5619If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5620@code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5621the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5622correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5623
5624@item S B R
5625@kindex S B R (Summary)
5626@findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5627Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5628original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5629(@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5630
5631@item S o m
5632@itemx C-c C-f
5633@kindex S o m (Summary)
5634@kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5635@findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5636@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5637Forward the current article to some other person
5638(@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5639is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5640and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5641message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5642as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5643forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5644directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5645but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5646default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5647section.
5648
5649@item S m
5650@itemx m
5651@kindex m (Summary)
5652@kindex S m (Summary)
5653@findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5654@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5655Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5656the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5657If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5658
5659@item S i
5660@kindex S i (Summary)
5661@findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5662Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5663post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5664prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5665
5666This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5667This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5668sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5669in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5670for this to work though.
5671
5672@item S D b
5673@kindex S D b (Summary)
5674@findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5675@cindex bouncing mail
5676If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5677reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5678resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5679will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5680sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5681the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5682that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5683very well fail, though.
5684
5685@item S D r
5686@kindex S D r (Summary)
5687@findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5688Not to be confused with the previous command,
5689@code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5690send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5691headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5692@code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5693means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5694header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5695So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5696
5697This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5698ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5699@code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5700to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5701@code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5702
5703This command understands the process/prefix convention
5704(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5705
5706@item S D e
5707@kindex S D e (Summary)
5708@findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5709
5710Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5711if it were a new message before resending.
5712
5713@item S O m
5714@kindex S O m (Summary)
5715@findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5716Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5717result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5718uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5719
5720@item S M-c
5721@kindex S M-c (Summary)
5722@findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5723@cindex crossposting
5724@cindex excessive crossposting
5725Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5726current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5727
5728@findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5729This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5730crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5731using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5732command understands the process/prefix convention
5733(@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
4009494e 5734
4009494e
GM
5735@end table
5736
8a1cdce5
AC
5737Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5738Manual}, for more information.
4009494e 5739
4009494e 5740
8a1cdce5
AC
5741@node Summary Post Commands
5742@subsection Summary Post Commands
5743@cindex post
5744@cindex composing news
4009494e 5745
8a1cdce5 5746Commands for posting a news article:
4009494e 5747
8a1cdce5
AC
5748@table @kbd
5749@item S p
5750@itemx a
5751@kindex a (Summary)
5752@kindex S p (Summary)
5753@findex gnus-summary-post-news
5754@c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5755Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5756default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5757If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
4009494e 5758
8a1cdce5
AC
5759@item S f
5760@itemx f
5761@kindex f (Summary)
5762@kindex S f (Summary)
5763@findex gnus-summary-followup
5764@c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5765Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
4009494e 5766
8a1cdce5
AC
5767@item S F
5768@itemx F
5769@kindex S F (Summary)
5770@kindex F (Summary)
5771@c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5772@findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5773Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5774(@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5775process/prefix convention.
4009494e 5776
8a1cdce5
AC
5777@item S n
5778@kindex S n (Summary)
5779@findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5780Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5781message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5782
5783@item S N
5784@kindex S N (Summary)
5785@findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5786Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5787message through mail and include the original message
5788(@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5789the process/prefix convention.
5790
5791@item S o p
5792@kindex S o p (Summary)
5793@findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5794Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5795(@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5796 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5797of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5798(@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5799message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5800as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5801forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5802directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5803but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5804default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
4009494e 5805
8a1cdce5
AC
5806@item S O p
5807@kindex S O p (Summary)
5808@findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5809@cindex digests
5810@cindex making digests
5811Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5812(@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5813process/prefix convention.
4009494e 5814
8a1cdce5
AC
5815@item S u
5816@kindex S u (Summary)
5817@findex gnus-uu-post-news
5818@c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5819Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5820(@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5821@end table
4009494e 5822
8a1cdce5
AC
5823Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5824Manual}, for more information.
4009494e 5825
4009494e 5826
8a1cdce5
AC
5827@node Summary Message Commands
5828@subsection Summary Message Commands
4009494e 5829
8a1cdce5
AC
5830@table @kbd
5831@item S y
5832@kindex S y (Summary)
5833@findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5834Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5835buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5836what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5837process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
01c52d31 5838
8a1cdce5 5839@end table
4009494e 5840
4009494e 5841
8a1cdce5
AC
5842@node Canceling and Superseding
5843@subsection Canceling Articles
5844@cindex canceling articles
5845@cindex superseding articles
4009494e 5846
8a1cdce5
AC
5847Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5848really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
4009494e 5849
8a1cdce5 5850Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
4009494e 5851
8a1cdce5
AC
5852@findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5853@kindex C (Summary)
5854@c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5855Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5856articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5857c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5858canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5859This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 5860
8a1cdce5
AC
5861Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5862live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5863question.
4009494e 5864
8a1cdce5
AC
5865Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5866want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5867prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
4009494e 5868
8a1cdce5
AC
5869Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5870@code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5871message, Message Manual}).
4009494e 5872
8a1cdce5
AC
5873If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5874corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5875your original article.
4009494e 5876
8a1cdce5
AC
5877@findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5878@kindex S (Summary)
5879Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5880(@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5881where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5882usual way.
4009494e 5883
8a1cdce5
AC
5884The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5885sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5886have posted almost the same article twice.
4009494e 5887
8a1cdce5
AC
5888If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5889there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5890waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5891to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5892find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5893the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5894header by substituting one of those words for the word
5895@code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5896you would do normally. The previous article will be
5897canceled/superseded.
4009494e 5898
8a1cdce5 5899Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
4009494e 5900
8a1cdce5
AC
5901@node Delayed Articles
5902@section Delayed Articles
5903@cindex delayed sending
5904@cindex send delayed
5905
5906Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5907example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5908to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5909there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
4009494e 5910
8a1cdce5
AC
5911@lisp
5912(gnus-delay-initialize)
5913@end lisp
4009494e 5914
8a1cdce5
AC
5915@findex gnus-delay-article
5916Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5917Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5918(@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5919message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
4009494e 5920
8a1cdce5
AC
5921@itemize @bullet
5922@item
5923A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5924@code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5925(minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5926(months) and @code{Y} (years).
4009494e 5927
8a1cdce5
AC
5928@item
5929A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5930delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5931See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
4009494e 5932
8a1cdce5
AC
5933@item
5934A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5935stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5936already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5937o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5938is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5939that means a time tomorrow.
5940@end itemize
4009494e 5941
8a1cdce5
AC
5942The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5943couple of variables:
4009494e 5944
8a1cdce5
AC
5945@table @code
5946@item gnus-delay-default-hour
5947@vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5948When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5949on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
4009494e 5950
8a1cdce5
AC
5951@item gnus-delay-default-delay
5952@vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5953This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5954formats described above.
4009494e 5955
8a1cdce5
AC
5956@item gnus-delay-group
5957@vindex gnus-delay-group
5958Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5959they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5960value is @code{"delayed"}.
4009494e 5961
8a1cdce5
AC
5962@item gnus-delay-header
5963@vindex gnus-delay-header
5964The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5965is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5966change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5967@end table
4009494e 5968
8a1cdce5
AC
5969The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5970@code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5971calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5972@code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5973@code{nndraft:delayed} group.
4009494e 5974
8a1cdce5
AC
5975@findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5976And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5977which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5978function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5979@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5980Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5981execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
4009494e 5982
8a1cdce5
AC
5983@table @code
5984@item gnus-delay-initialize
5985@findex gnus-delay-initialize
5986By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5987@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5988argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5989@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5990argument is ignored.
4009494e 5991
8a1cdce5
AC
5992For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5993Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5994Just don't forget to set that up :-)
4009494e
GM
5995@end table
5996
8a1cdce5
AC
5997When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
5998automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
5999many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
6000time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
6001@code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
4009494e 6002
4009494e 6003
8a1cdce5
AC
6004@node Marking Articles
6005@section Marking Articles
6006@cindex article marking
6007@cindex article ticking
6008@cindex marks
4009494e 6009
8a1cdce5 6010There are several marks you can set on an article.
4009494e 6011
8a1cdce5
AC
6012You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
6013neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
6014@dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
4009494e 6015
8a1cdce5 6016In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
4009494e 6017
8a1cdce5
AC
6018@ifinfo
6019There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6020@end ifinfo
4009494e 6021
8a1cdce5
AC
6022@menu
6023* Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6024* Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6025* Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6026* Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6027* Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6028* Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6029@end menu
4009494e 6030
4009494e 6031
8a1cdce5
AC
6032@node Unread Articles
6033@subsection Unread Articles
85115796 6034
8a1cdce5
AC
6035The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6036other.
4009494e 6037
8a1cdce5
AC
6038@table @samp
6039@item !
6040@vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6041Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
4009494e 6042
8a1cdce5
AC
6043@dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6044you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6045reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6046tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6047news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6048you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6049(@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
4009494e 6050
8a1cdce5
AC
6051@item ?
6052@vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6053Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
4009494e 6054
8a1cdce5
AC
6055@dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6056are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6057followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6058Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6059messages.
4009494e 6060
8a1cdce5
AC
6061@item SPACE
6062@vindex gnus-unread-mark
6063Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
4009494e 6064
8a1cdce5
AC
6065@dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6066@end table
4009494e 6067
4009494e 6068
8a1cdce5
AC
6069@node Read Articles
6070@subsection Read Articles
6071@cindex expirable mark
4009494e 6072
8a1cdce5 6073All the following marks mark articles as read.
4009494e 6074
8a1cdce5 6075@table @samp
4009494e 6076
8a1cdce5
AC
6077@item r
6078@vindex gnus-del-mark
6079These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6080command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
4009494e 6081
8a1cdce5
AC
6082@item R
6083@vindex gnus-read-mark
6084Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
4009494e 6085
8a1cdce5
AC
6086@item O
6087@vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6088Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6089@dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
4009494e 6090
8a1cdce5
AC
6091@item K
6092@vindex gnus-killed-mark
6093Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
4009494e 6094
8a1cdce5
AC
6095@item X
6096@vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6097Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
4009494e 6098
8a1cdce5
AC
6099@item Y
6100@vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6101Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
4009494e 6102
8a1cdce5
AC
6103@item C
6104@vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6105Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
4009494e 6106
8a1cdce5
AC
6107@item G
6108@vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6109Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
4009494e 6110
8a1cdce5
AC
6111@item Q
6112@vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6113Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6114Threading}.
4009494e 6115
8a1cdce5
AC
6116@item M
6117@vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6118Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6119(@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
4009494e
GM
6120
6121@end table
6122
8a1cdce5
AC
6123All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6124They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
4009494e 6125
8a1cdce5 6126One more special mark, though:
4009494e 6127
8a1cdce5
AC
6128@table @samp
6129@item E
6130@vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6131Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
4009494e 6132
8a1cdce5
AC
6133Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6134automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6135control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6136articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6137any time.
6138@end table
4009494e 6139
4009494e 6140
8a1cdce5
AC
6141@node Other Marks
6142@subsection Other Marks
6143@cindex process mark
6144@cindex bookmarks
4009494e 6145
8a1cdce5
AC
6146There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6147read or not.
4009494e 6148
8a1cdce5 6149@itemize @bullet
4009494e 6150
8a1cdce5
AC
6151@item
6152You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6153long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6154before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6155in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6156encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
4009494e 6157
8a1cdce5
AC
6158@item
6159@vindex gnus-replied-mark
6160All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6161answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6162(@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
4009494e 6163
8a1cdce5
AC
6164@item
6165@vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6166All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6167the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
4009494e 6168
8a1cdce5
AC
6169@item
6170@vindex gnus-cached-mark
6171Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6172the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
4009494e 6173
8a1cdce5
AC
6174@item
6175@vindex gnus-saved-mark
6176Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6177religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6178(@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
4009494e 6179
8a1cdce5
AC
6180@item
6181@vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6182Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6183with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
4009494e 6184
8a1cdce5
AC
6185@item
6186@vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6187When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6188downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6189@samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6190(The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6191use.)
4009494e 6192
8a1cdce5
AC
6193@item
6194@vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6195When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6196not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6197are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6198articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6199@code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
4009494e 6200
8a1cdce5
AC
6201@item
6202@vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6203The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6204automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6205download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6206explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6207(The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6208use.)
4009494e 6209
8a1cdce5
AC
6210@item
6211@vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6212@vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6213If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6214marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6215@code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
4009494e 6216
8a1cdce5
AC
6217@item
6218@vindex gnus-process-mark
6219Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6220variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6221instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6222all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6223marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
4009494e 6224
8a1cdce5 6225@end itemize
4009494e 6226
8a1cdce5
AC
6227You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6228appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6229replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
4009494e 6230
8a1cdce5
AC
6231Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6232replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6233you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
4009494e 6234
4009494e 6235
8a1cdce5
AC
6236@node Setting Marks
6237@subsection Setting Marks
6238@cindex setting marks
6239
6240All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
4009494e 6241
8a1cdce5
AC
6242@table @kbd
6243@item M c
6244@itemx M-u
6245@kindex M c (Summary)
6246@kindex M-u (Summary)
6247@findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6248@cindex mark as unread
6249Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6250(@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6251article as unread.
4009494e 6252
8a1cdce5
AC
6253@item M t
6254@itemx !
6255@kindex ! (Summary)
6256@kindex M t (Summary)
6257@findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6258Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6259@xref{Article Caching}.
4009494e 6260
8a1cdce5
AC
6261@item M ?
6262@itemx ?
6263@kindex ? (Summary)
6264@kindex M ? (Summary)
6265@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6266Mark the current article as dormant
6267(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
4009494e 6268
8a1cdce5
AC
6269@item M d
6270@itemx d
6271@kindex M d (Summary)
6272@kindex d (Summary)
6273@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6274Mark the current article as read
6275(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
4009494e 6276
8a1cdce5
AC
6277@item D
6278@kindex D (Summary)
6279@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6280Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6281(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
4009494e 6282
8a1cdce5
AC
6283@item M k
6284@itemx k
6285@kindex k (Summary)
6286@kindex M k (Summary)
6287@findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6288Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6289and then select the next unread article
6290(@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
4009494e 6291
8a1cdce5
AC
6292@item M K
6293@itemx C-k
6294@kindex M K (Summary)
6295@kindex C-k (Summary)
6296@findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6297Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6298(@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
4009494e 6299
8a1cdce5
AC
6300@item M C
6301@kindex M C (Summary)
6302@findex gnus-summary-catchup
6303@c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6304Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
4009494e 6305
8a1cdce5
AC
6306@item M C-c
6307@kindex M C-c (Summary)
6308@findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6309Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6310articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
4009494e 6311
8a1cdce5
AC
6312@item M H
6313@kindex M H (Summary)
6314@findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6315Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6316(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
4009494e 6317
8a1cdce5
AC
6318@item M h
6319@kindex M h (Summary)
6320@findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6321Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6322(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
4009494e 6323
8a1cdce5
AC
6324@item C-w
6325@kindex C-w (Summary)
6326@findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6327Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6328(@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
4009494e 6329
8a1cdce5
AC
6330@item M V k
6331@kindex M V k (Summary)
6332@findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6333Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6334numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
4009494e 6335
8a1cdce5
AC
6336@item M e
6337@itemx E
6338@kindex M e (Summary)
6339@kindex E (Summary)
6340@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6341Mark the current article as expirable
6342(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
4009494e 6343
8a1cdce5
AC
6344@item M b
6345@kindex M b (Summary)
6346@findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6347Set a bookmark in the current article
6348(@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
4009494e 6349
8a1cdce5
AC
6350@item M B
6351@kindex M B (Summary)
6352@findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6353Remove the bookmark from the current article
6354(@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
4009494e 6355
8a1cdce5
AC
6356@item M V c
6357@kindex M V c (Summary)
6358@findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6359Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6360over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
4009494e 6361
8a1cdce5
AC
6362@item M V u
6363@kindex M V u (Summary)
6364@findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6365Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6366numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
4009494e 6367
8a1cdce5
AC
6368@item M V m
6369@kindex M V m (Summary)
6370@findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6371Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6372score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6373(@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6374@end table
4009494e 6375
8a1cdce5
AC
6376@vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6377The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6378be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6379the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6380one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6381@code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6382@kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6383The default is @code{t}.
4009494e 6384
4009494e 6385
8a1cdce5
AC
6386@node Generic Marking Commands
6387@subsection Generic Marking Commands
4009494e 6388
6ed7a66a
G
6389Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) to
6390go to the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6391article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article.
6392And even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
8a1cdce5
AC
6393previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6394well.
4009494e 6395
8a1cdce5
AC
6396Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6397you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6398command should do.
4009494e 6399
8a1cdce5
AC
6400To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6401different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6402buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6403to list in this manual.
4009494e 6404
8a1cdce5
AC
6405While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6406altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6407@kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6408article, you could say something like:
4009494e 6409
8a1cdce5
AC
6410@lisp
6411@group
6412(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6413(defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6414 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6415@end group
6416@end lisp
4009494e 6417
8a1cdce5
AC
6418@noindent
6419or
4009494e 6420
8a1cdce5
AC
6421@lisp
6422(defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6423 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6424@end lisp
4009494e
GM
6425
6426
8a1cdce5
AC
6427@node Setting Process Marks
6428@subsection Setting Process Marks
6429@cindex setting process marks
4009494e 6430
8a1cdce5
AC
6431Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6432used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6433process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6434articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6435articles into the cache. For more information,
6436@pxref{Process/Prefix}.
4009494e
GM
6437
6438@table @kbd
4009494e 6439
8a1cdce5
AC
6440@item M P p
6441@itemx #
6442@kindex # (Summary)
6443@kindex M P p (Summary)
6444@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6445Mark the current article with the process mark
6446(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6447@findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
4009494e 6448
8a1cdce5
AC
6449@item M P u
6450@itemx M-#
6451@kindex M P u (Summary)
6452@kindex M-# (Summary)
6453Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6454(@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
4009494e 6455
8a1cdce5
AC
6456@item M P U
6457@kindex M P U (Summary)
6458@findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6459Remove the process mark from all articles
6460(@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
4009494e 6461
8a1cdce5
AC
6462@item M P i
6463@kindex M P i (Summary)
6464@findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6465Invert the list of process marked articles
6466(@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
4009494e 6467
8a1cdce5
AC
6468@item M P R
6469@kindex M P R (Summary)
6470@findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6471Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6472expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
4009494e 6473
8a1cdce5
AC
6474@item M P G
6475@kindex M P G (Summary)
6476@findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6477Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6478expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
4009494e 6479
8a1cdce5
AC
6480@item M P r
6481@kindex M P r (Summary)
6482@findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6483Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
4009494e 6484
8a1cdce5
AC
6485@item M P g
6486@kindex M P g (Summary)
6487@findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6488Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
4009494e 6489
8a1cdce5
AC
6490@item M P t
6491@kindex M P t (Summary)
6492@findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6493Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6494(@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
4009494e 6495
8a1cdce5
AC
6496@item M P T
6497@kindex M P T (Summary)
6498@findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6499Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6500(@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
4009494e 6501
8a1cdce5
AC
6502@item M P v
6503@kindex M P v (Summary)
6504@findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6505Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6506(@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
4009494e 6507
8a1cdce5
AC
6508@item M P s
6509@kindex M P s (Summary)
6510@findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6511Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
4009494e 6512
8a1cdce5
AC
6513@item M P S
6514@kindex M P S (Summary)
6515@findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6516Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6517(@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
4009494e 6518
8a1cdce5
AC
6519@item M P a
6520@kindex M P a (Summary)
6521@findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6522Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6523
6524@item M P b
6525@kindex M P b (Summary)
6526@findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6527Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6528(@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6529
6530@item M P k
6531@kindex M P k (Summary)
6532@findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6533Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6534(@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6535
6536@item M P y
6537@kindex M P y (Summary)
6538@findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6539Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6540(@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
4009494e 6541
8a1cdce5
AC
6542@item M P w
6543@kindex M P w (Summary)
6544@findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6545Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6546(@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
4009494e 6547
8a1cdce5 6548@end table
4009494e 6549
8a1cdce5
AC
6550Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6551set process marks based on article body contents.
4009494e 6552
4009494e 6553
8a1cdce5
AC
6554@node Limiting
6555@section Limiting
6556@cindex limiting
4009494e 6557
8a1cdce5
AC
6558It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6559subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6560commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6561buffer.
4009494e 6562
8a1cdce5
AC
6563Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6564the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6565articles.
4009494e 6566
8a1cdce5 6567@table @kbd
4009494e 6568
8a1cdce5
AC
6569@item / /
6570@itemx / s
6571@kindex / / (Summary)
6572@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6573Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6574(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6575matching articles.
4009494e 6576
8a1cdce5
AC
6577@item / a
6578@kindex / a (Summary)
6579@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6580Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6581(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6582matching articles.
4009494e 6583
8a1cdce5
AC
6584@item / R
6585@kindex / R (Summary)
6586@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6587Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6588(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6589matching articles.
4009494e 6590
8a1cdce5
AC
6591@item / A
6592@kindex / A (Summary)
6593@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6594Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6595header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6596given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
4009494e 6597
8a1cdce5
AC
6598@item / S
6599@kindex / S (Summary)
6600@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6601Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6602threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6603limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
4009494e 6604
8a1cdce5
AC
6605@item / x
6606@kindex / x (Summary)
6607@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6608Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6609headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6610(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6611matching articles.
4009494e 6612
8a1cdce5
AC
6613@item / u
6614@itemx x
6615@kindex / u (Summary)
6616@kindex x (Summary)
6617@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6618Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6619(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6620buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6621dormant articles will also be excluded.
4009494e 6622
8a1cdce5
AC
6623@item / m
6624@kindex / m (Summary)
6625@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6626Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6627with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
4009494e 6628
8a1cdce5
AC
6629@item / t
6630@kindex / t (Summary)
6631@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6632Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6633(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6634articles younger than that number of days.
4009494e 6635
8a1cdce5
AC
6636@item / n
6637@kindex / n (Summary)
6638@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6639With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6640articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6641instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
4009494e 6642
8a1cdce5
AC
6643@item / w
6644@kindex / w (Summary)
6645@findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6646Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6647(@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6648the stack.
4009494e 6649
8a1cdce5
AC
6650@item / .
6651@kindex / . (Summary)
6652@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6653Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6654(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
4009494e 6655
8a1cdce5
AC
6656@item / v
6657@kindex / v (Summary)
6658@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6659Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6660score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
4009494e 6661
8a1cdce5
AC
6662@item / p
6663@kindex / p (Summary)
6664@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6665Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6666group parameter predicate
6667(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6668Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
4009494e 6669
8a1cdce5
AC
6670@item / r
6671@kindex / r (Summary)
6672@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6673Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6674(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6675replied articles.
4009494e 6676
8a1cdce5
AC
6677@item / E
6678@itemx M S
6679@kindex M S (Summary)
6680@kindex / E (Summary)
6681@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6682Include all expunged articles in the limit
6683(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
4009494e 6684
8a1cdce5
AC
6685@item / D
6686@kindex / D (Summary)
6687@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6688Include all dormant articles in the limit
6689(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
4009494e 6690
8a1cdce5
AC
6691@item / *
6692@kindex / * (Summary)
6693@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6694Include all cached articles in the limit
6695(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
4009494e 6696
8a1cdce5
AC
6697@item / d
6698@kindex / d (Summary)
6699@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6700Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6701(@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
4009494e 6702
8a1cdce5
AC
6703@item / M
6704@kindex / M (Summary)
6705@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6706Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
e7842e69 6707
8a1cdce5
AC
6708@item / T
6709@kindex / T (Summary)
6710@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6711Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
4009494e 6712
8a1cdce5
AC
6713@item / c
6714@kindex / c (Summary)
6715@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6716Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6717(@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
4009494e 6718
8a1cdce5
AC
6719@item / C
6720@kindex / C (Summary)
6721@findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6722Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6723(@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6724also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
4009494e 6725
8a1cdce5
AC
6726@item / b
6727@kindex / b (Summary)
6728@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6729Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6730certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6731prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6732requires selecting each article to find the matches.
4009494e 6733
8a1cdce5
AC
6734@item / h
6735@kindex / h (Summary)
6736@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6737Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6738(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
4009494e 6739
8a1cdce5 6740@end table
4009494e 6741
4009494e 6742
8a1cdce5
AC
6743The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6744prefix as well.
4009494e 6745
8a1cdce5
AC
6746@table @kbd
6747@item / N
6748@kindex / N (Summary)
6749@findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6750Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6751if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
4009494e 6752
8a1cdce5
AC
6753@item / o
6754@kindex / o (Summary)
6755@findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6756Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6757prefix, fetch this number of articles.
4009494e 6758
8a1cdce5 6759@end table
4009494e 6760
4009494e 6761
8a1cdce5
AC
6762@node Threading
6763@section Threading
6764@cindex threading
6765@cindex article threading
4009494e 6766
8a1cdce5
AC
6767Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6768to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6769hierarchical fashion.
4009494e 6770
8a1cdce5
AC
6771Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6772articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6773trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6774or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6775so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6776plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6777@ref{Customizing Threading}.
4009494e 6778
8a1cdce5 6779First, a quick overview of the concepts:
4009494e 6780
8a1cdce5
AC
6781@table @dfn
6782@item root
6783The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
4009494e 6784
8a1cdce5
AC
6785@item thread
6786A tree-like article structure.
4009494e 6787
8a1cdce5
AC
6788@item sub-thread
6789A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
4009494e 6790
8a1cdce5
AC
6791@item loose threads
6792Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6793already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6794summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6795belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6796called loose threads.
4009494e 6797
8a1cdce5
AC
6798@item thread gathering
6799An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
4009494e 6800
8a1cdce5
AC
6801@item sparse threads
6802A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6803displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
4009494e 6804
8a1cdce5 6805@end table
4009494e 6806
4009494e 6807
8a1cdce5
AC
6808@menu
6809* Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6810* Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6811@end menu
4009494e 6812
4009494e 6813
8a1cdce5
AC
6814@node Customizing Threading
6815@subsection Customizing Threading
6816@cindex customizing threading
4009494e 6817
8a1cdce5
AC
6818@menu
6819* Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6820* Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6821* More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6822* Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6823@end menu
4009494e 6824
4009494e 6825
8a1cdce5
AC
6826@node Loose Threads
6827@subsubsection Loose Threads
6828@cindex <
6829@cindex >
6830@cindex loose threads
4009494e 6831
8a1cdce5
AC
6832@table @code
6833@item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6834@vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6835If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6836and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6837Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6838read or killed the root in a previous session.
4009494e 6839
8a1cdce5
AC
6840When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6841something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6842There are four possible values:
4009494e 6843
8a1cdce5
AC
6844@iftex
6845@iflatex
6846\gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6847\put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6848\put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6849\put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6850\put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6851}
6852@end iflatex
6853@end iftex
4009494e 6854
8a1cdce5 6855@cindex adopting articles
4009494e 6856
8a1cdce5 6857@table @code
4009494e 6858
8a1cdce5
AC
6859@item adopt
6860Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6861parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6862marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6863square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
4009494e 6864
8a1cdce5
AC
6865@item dummy
6866@vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6867@vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6868Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6869parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6870selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6871article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6872format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6873which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6874If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6875ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
4009494e 6876
8a1cdce5
AC
6877@item empty
6878Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6879subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6880use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6881Buffer Format}).)
4009494e 6882
8a1cdce5
AC
6883@item none
6884Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6885display them after one another.
4009494e 6886
8a1cdce5
AC
6887@item nil
6888Don't gather loose threads.
6889@end table
4009494e 6890
8a1cdce5
AC
6891@item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6892@vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6893Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6894variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6895subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6896super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6897presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6898you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6899first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6900variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6901everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
4009494e 6902
8a1cdce5
AC
6903@cindex fuzzy article gathering
6904If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6905use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6906Matching}).
4009494e 6907
8a1cdce5
AC
6908@item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6909@vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6910This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6911that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6912simplification is used.
4009494e 6913
8a1cdce5
AC
6914@item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6915@vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6916If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6917as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
4009494e 6918
8a1cdce5
AC
6919@c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6920@lisp
6921(setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6922 (concat
6923 "\\`\\[?\\("
6924 (mapconcat
6925 'identity
6926 '("looking"
6927 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6928 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6929 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6930 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6931 ;; ...
6932 )
6933 "\\|")
6934 "\\)\\s *\\("
6935 (mapconcat 'identity
6936 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6937 "\\|")
6938 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6939@end lisp
4009494e 6940
8a1cdce5
AC
6941All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6942subjects.
4009494e 6943
8a1cdce5
AC
6944@item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6945@vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6946If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6947@code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6948list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6949arrive at the simplified version of the string.
4009494e 6950
8a1cdce5 6951Useful functions to put in this list include:
4009494e 6952
8a1cdce5
AC
6953@table @code
6954@item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6955@findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6956Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
4009494e 6957
8a1cdce5
AC
6958@item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6959@findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6960Simplify fuzzily.
4009494e 6961
8a1cdce5
AC
6962@item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6963@findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6964Remove excessive whitespace.
4009494e 6965
8a1cdce5
AC
6966@item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6967@findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6968Remove all whitespace.
6969@end table
4009494e 6970
8a1cdce5 6971You may also write your own functions, of course.
4009494e 6972
4009494e 6973
8a1cdce5
AC
6974@item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6975@vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6976Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6977to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6978@samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6979you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6980what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6981The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
4009494e 6982
8a1cdce5
AC
6983@item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6984@vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6985Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6986that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6987is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6988@code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6989This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6990articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6991newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6992cholera:
4009494e 6993
8a1cdce5
AC
6994@table @code
6995@item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6996@findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6997This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6998@code{Subject}s exclusively.
4009494e 6999
8a1cdce5
AC
7000@item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7001@findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7002This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
7003@end table
4009494e 7004
8a1cdce5
AC
7005If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
7006something like:
4009494e 7007
8a1cdce5
AC
7008@lisp
7009(setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7010 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
7011@end lisp
4009494e 7012
8a1cdce5 7013@end table
4009494e 7014
4009494e 7015
8a1cdce5
AC
7016@node Filling In Threads
7017@subsubsection Filling In Threads
4009494e 7018
8a1cdce5
AC
7019@table @code
7020@item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7021@vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7022If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7023more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7024like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7025many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7026@code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7027number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7028old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7029files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7030@code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7031the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7032do about that.
4009494e 7033
8a1cdce5
AC
7034This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7035visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7036(@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
4009494e 7037
8a1cdce5 7038The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
4009494e 7039
8a1cdce5
AC
7040@cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7041This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7042cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7043that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7044slow summary generation.
4009494e 7045
8a1cdce5
AC
7046@item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7047@vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7048Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7049newsgroups.
4009494e 7050
8a1cdce5
AC
7051@item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7052@vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7053Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7054gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7055the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7056together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7057@dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7058is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7059lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7060question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7061``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7062thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7063off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7064@code{nil} by default.
4009494e 7065
8a1cdce5
AC
7066@item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7067@vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7068This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7069intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7070quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7071go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7072web-based groups.
4009494e 7073
8a1cdce5
AC
7074If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7075@code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7076that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
4009494e 7077
8a1cdce5 7078@end table
4009494e 7079
4009494e 7080
8a1cdce5
AC
7081@node More Threading
7082@subsubsection More Threading
4009494e 7083
8a1cdce5
AC
7084@table @code
7085@item gnus-show-threads
7086@vindex gnus-show-threads
7087If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7088the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7089off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7090slower and more awkward.
4009494e 7091
8a1cdce5
AC
7092@item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7093@vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7094If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7095generated.
4009494e 7096
8a1cdce5
AC
7097This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7098Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7099@code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
4009494e 7100
8a1cdce5 7101Here's an example:
4009494e 7102
8a1cdce5
AC
7103@lisp
7104(setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7105 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7106 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7107@end lisp
4009494e 7108
8a1cdce5
AC
7109(It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7110unread, but you get my drift.)
4009494e 7111
4009494e 7112
8a1cdce5
AC
7113@item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7114@vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7115All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7116@code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7117expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7118threads are expunged.
4009494e 7119
8a1cdce5
AC
7120@item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7121@vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7122if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7123will be hidden.
4009494e 7124
8a1cdce5
AC
7125@item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7126@vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7127Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7128this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7129change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7130result in a new thread.
4009494e 7131
8a1cdce5
AC
7132@item gnus-thread-indent-level
7133@vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7134This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7135The default is 4.
4009494e 7136
8a1cdce5
AC
7137@item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7138@vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7139Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7140arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7141arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7142using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7143up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7144Setting this variable to an alternate value
1df7defd
PE
7145(e.g., @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7146appropriate hook (e.g., @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
8a1cdce5 7147more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
4009494e 7148
8a1cdce5 7149@end table
4009494e 7150
4009494e 7151
8a1cdce5
AC
7152@node Low-Level Threading
7153@subsubsection Low-Level Threading
4009494e 7154
8a1cdce5 7155@table @code
4009494e 7156
8a1cdce5
AC
7157@item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7158@vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7159Hook run before parsing any headers.
4009494e 7160
8a1cdce5
AC
7161@item gnus-alter-header-function
7162@vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7163If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7164article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7165the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7166if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7167in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7168variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7169meaningful. Here's one example:
4009494e 7170
8a1cdce5
AC
7171@lisp
7172(setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7173
7174(defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7175 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7176 (when (string-match
7177 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7178 (mail-header-set-id
7179 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7180 header))))
7181@end lisp
4009494e 7182
8a1cdce5 7183@end table
4009494e 7184
4009494e 7185
8a1cdce5
AC
7186@node Thread Commands
7187@subsection Thread Commands
7188@cindex thread commands
4009494e 7189
8a1cdce5 7190@table @kbd
4009494e 7191
8a1cdce5
AC
7192@item T k
7193@itemx C-M-k
7194@kindex T k (Summary)
7195@kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7196@findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7197Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7198(@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7199remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7200articles instead.
4009494e 7201
8a1cdce5
AC
7202@item T l
7203@itemx C-M-l
7204@kindex T l (Summary)
7205@kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7206@findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7207Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7208(@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7209
7210@item T i
7211@kindex T i (Summary)
7212@findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7213Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7214(@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7215
7216@item T #
7217@kindex T # (Summary)
4009494e 7218@findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
8a1cdce5 7219Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
4009494e
GM
7220(@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7221
8a1cdce5
AC
7222@item T M-#
7223@kindex T M-# (Summary)
4009494e 7224@findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
8a1cdce5 7225Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
4009494e
GM
7226(@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7227
8a1cdce5
AC
7228@item T T
7229@kindex T T (Summary)
7230@findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7231Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
4009494e 7232
8a1cdce5
AC
7233@item T s
7234@kindex T s (Summary)
7235@findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7236Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7237(@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
4009494e 7238
8a1cdce5
AC
7239@item T h
7240@kindex T h (Summary)
7241@findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7242Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
4009494e 7243
8a1cdce5
AC
7244@item T S
7245@kindex T S (Summary)
7246@findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7247Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
4009494e 7248
8a1cdce5
AC
7249@item T H
7250@kindex T H (Summary)
7251@findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7252Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
4009494e 7253
8a1cdce5
AC
7254@item T t
7255@kindex T t (Summary)
7256@findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7257Re-thread the current article's thread
7258(@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7259summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
4009494e 7260
8a1cdce5
AC
7261@item T ^
7262@kindex T ^ (Summary)
7263@findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7264Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7265(@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
4009494e 7266
8a1cdce5
AC
7267@item T M-^
7268@kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7269@findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7270Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7271(@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
4009494e
GM
7272
7273@end table
7274
8a1cdce5
AC
7275The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7276understand the numeric prefix.
4009494e
GM
7277
7278@table @kbd
7279
8a1cdce5
AC
7280@item T n
7281@kindex T n (Summary)
7282@itemx C-M-f
7283@kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7284@itemx M-down
7285@kindex M-down (Summary)
7286@findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7287Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
01c52d31 7288
8a1cdce5
AC
7289@item T p
7290@kindex T p (Summary)
7291@itemx C-M-b
7292@kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7293@itemx M-up
7294@kindex M-up (Summary)
7295@findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7296Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
01c52d31 7297
8a1cdce5
AC
7298@item T d
7299@kindex T d (Summary)
7300@findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7301Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
4009494e 7302
8a1cdce5
AC
7303@item T u
7304@kindex T u (Summary)
7305@findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7306Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
4009494e 7307
8a1cdce5
AC
7308@item T o
7309@kindex T o (Summary)
7310@findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7311Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7312@end table
4009494e 7313
8a1cdce5
AC
7314@vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7315If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7316threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7317a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7318wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7319have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7320you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7321is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7322when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7323the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7324operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7325that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7326Matching}).
4009494e 7327
4009494e 7328
8a1cdce5
AC
7329@node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7330@section Sorting the Summary Buffer
4009494e 7331
8a1cdce5
AC
7332@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7333@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7334@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7335@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7336@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7337@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7338@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7339@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7340@vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7341@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7342@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7343If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7344setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7345function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7346@code{(not some-function)} elements.
4009494e 7347
8a1cdce5
AC
7348By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7349predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7350@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7351@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7352@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7353@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7354@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7355@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7356@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7357@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
4009494e 7358
8a1cdce5
AC
7359Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7360thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
c2f51e23
G
7361normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7362to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7363@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
4009494e 7364
8a1cdce5
AC
7365If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7366last function in the list. You should probably always include
7367@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7368functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7369equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7370ascending article order.
01c52d31 7371
8a1cdce5
AC
7372If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7373by number, you could do something like:
4009494e 7374
8a1cdce5
AC
7375@lisp
7376(setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7377 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7378 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7379 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7380@end lisp
4009494e 7381
8a1cdce5
AC
7382The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7383summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7384alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7385subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7386which the articles arrived.
4009494e 7387
8a1cdce5
AC
7388If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7389say something like:
4009494e 7390
8a1cdce5
AC
7391@lisp
7392(setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7393 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7394 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7395@end lisp
4009494e 7396
a3fd87cb
TH
7397By default, threads including their subthreads are sorted according to
7398the value of @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}. By customizing
7399@code{gnus-subthread-sort-functions} you can define a custom sorting
7400order for subthreads. This allows for example to sort threads from
7401high score to low score in the summary buffer, but to have subthreads
7402still sorted chronologically from old to new without taking their
7403score into account.
13afd560 7404
8a1cdce5
AC
7405@vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7406The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7407@code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7408functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7409tickles your fancy.
4009494e 7410
8a1cdce5
AC
7411@findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7412@findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7413@findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7414@findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7415@findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7416@findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7417@findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7418@findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7419@findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7420If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7421other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7422variable. It is very similar to the
7423@code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7424different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7425predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7426@code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7427@code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7428@code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7429@code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
4009494e 7430
8a1cdce5
AC
7431If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7432say something like:
4009494e 7433
8a1cdce5
AC
7434@lisp
7435(setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7436 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7437 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7438@end lisp
01c52d31 7439
8a1cdce5
AC
7440You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7441@xref{Group Parameters}.
01c52d31 7442
4009494e 7443
8a1cdce5
AC
7444@node Asynchronous Fetching
7445@section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7446@cindex asynchronous article fetching
7447@cindex article pre-fetch
7448@cindex pre-fetch
4009494e 7449
8a1cdce5
AC
7450If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7451network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7452for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7453article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7454while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
26b9f88d 7455
8a1cdce5
AC
7456First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7457article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
26b9f88d 7458
8a1cdce5
AC
7459Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7460quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7461know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7462article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7463connection is blocked.
26b9f88d 7464
8a1cdce5
AC
7465To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7466connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7467thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7468extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
26b9f88d 7469
8a1cdce5
AC
7470Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7471the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7472loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7473also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7474extra connection.
26b9f88d 7475
8a1cdce5
AC
7476Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7477you really want to.
4009494e 7478
8a1cdce5
AC
7479@vindex gnus-asynchronous
7480Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7481happen automatically.
4009494e 7482
8a1cdce5
AC
7483@vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7484You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7485@code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7486that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7487the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7488pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7489@code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7490
7491@vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7492@findex gnus-async-unread-p
7493There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7494articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7495variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7496function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7497to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7498returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7499article data structure as the only parameter.
4009494e 7500
8a1cdce5
AC
7501If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7502than 100 lines, you could say something like:
4009494e 7503
8a1cdce5
AC
7504@lisp
7505(defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7506 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7507 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7508 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7509 100)))
4009494e 7510
8a1cdce5
AC
7511(setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7512@end lisp
4009494e 7513
8a1cdce5
AC
7514These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7515preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7516It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
4009494e 7517
8a1cdce5
AC
7518@vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7519@findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7520After an article has been prefetched, this
7521@code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7522be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7523value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7524and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7525wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7526for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
4009494e 7527
8a1cdce5
AC
7528@vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7529Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7530@code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7531articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
4009494e 7532
8a1cdce5
AC
7533@table @code
7534@item read
7535Remove articles when they are read.
4009494e 7536
8a1cdce5
AC
7537@item exit
7538Remove articles when exiting the group.
4009494e
GM
7539@end table
7540
8a1cdce5 7541The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
4009494e 7542
8a1cdce5
AC
7543@c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7544@c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7545@c from the next group.
4009494e 7546
4009494e 7547
8a1cdce5
AC
7548@node Article Caching
7549@section Article Caching
7550@cindex article caching
7551@cindex caching
4009494e 7552
8a1cdce5
AC
7553If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7554consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7555locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7556potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7557your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
4009494e 7558
8a1cdce5 7559Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
4009494e 7560
8a1cdce5
AC
7561@vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7562@vindex gnus-cache-directory
7563@vindex gnus-use-cache
7564To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7565all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7566over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7567cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7568@code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
4009494e 7569
8a1cdce5
AC
7570When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7571cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7572expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7573keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7574as dormant, and don't worry.
4009494e 7575
8a1cdce5 7576When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
4009494e 7577
8a1cdce5
AC
7578@vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7579@vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7580The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7581@code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7582variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7583dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7584put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7585articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7586symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7587@code{unread} and @code{read}.
4009494e 7588
8a1cdce5
AC
7589@findex gnus-jog-cache
7590So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7591picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7592subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7593store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7594command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7595really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7596Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7597to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7598not then be downloaded by this command.
4009494e 7599
8a1cdce5
AC
7600@vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7601@vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7602It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7603if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7604sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7605feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
4009494e 7606
8a1cdce5
AC
7607To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7608regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7609@code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7610Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7611variables, the group is not cached.
4009494e 7612
8a1cdce5
AC
7613@findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7614@findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7615@vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7616The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7617file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7618of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7619offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7620gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7621files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7622file.
4009494e 7623
8a1cdce5
AC
7624@findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7625@code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7626@code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7627where, isn't that cool?
4009494e 7628
8a1cdce5
AC
7629@node Persistent Articles
7630@section Persistent Articles
7631@cindex persistent articles
4009494e 7632
8a1cdce5
AC
7633Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7634In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7635useful in my opinion.
4009494e 7636
8a1cdce5
AC
7637Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7638that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7639(using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7640that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7641the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7642the expiry going on at the news server.
4009494e 7643
8a1cdce5
AC
7644This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7645be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7646you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
4009494e 7647
8a1cdce5 7648@table @kbd
4009494e 7649
8a1cdce5
AC
7650@item *
7651@kindex * (Summary)
7652@findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7653Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7654
7655@item M-*
7656@kindex M-* (Summary)
7657@findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7658Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7659(@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7660article.
7661@end table
7662
7663Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7664
7665To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7666you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7667interested in persistent articles:
7668
7669@lisp
7670(setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
4009494e
GM
7671@end lisp
7672
8a1cdce5
AC
7673@node Sticky Articles
7674@section Sticky Articles
7675@cindex sticky articles
4009494e 7676
8a1cdce5
AC
7677When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7678according to the value of the variable
7679@code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7680default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7681has its own article buffer.
4009494e 7682
8a1cdce5
AC
7683This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7684in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7685latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
da6062e6 7686your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
4009494e 7687
8a1cdce5
AC
7688That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7689basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7690select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
4009494e 7691
8a1cdce5
AC
7692@table @kbd
7693@item A S
7694@kindex A S (Summary)
7695@findex gnus-sticky-article
7696Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7697name for this sticky article buffer.
7698@end table
4009494e 7699
8a1cdce5 7700To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
4009494e 7701
8a1cdce5
AC
7702@table @kbd
7703@item q
7704@kindex q (Article)
7705@findex bury-buffer
7706Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7707
7708@item k
7709@kindex k (Article)
7710@findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7711Kills this sticky article buffer.
4009494e
GM
7712@end table
7713
8a1cdce5 7714To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
4009494e 7715
8a1cdce5
AC
7716@defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7717Kill all sticky article buffers.
7718If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7719@end defun
4009494e 7720
8a1cdce5
AC
7721@node Article Backlog
7722@section Article Backlog
7723@cindex backlog
7724@cindex article backlog
4009494e 7725
8a1cdce5
AC
7726If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7727unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7728by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7729already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7730you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7731re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7732that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7733increase memory usage some.
4009494e 7734
8a1cdce5
AC
7735@vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7736If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7737at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7738variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7739@emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7740bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7741that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
4009494e 7742
8a1cdce5 7743The default value is 20.
4009494e 7744
4009494e 7745
8a1cdce5
AC
7746@node Saving Articles
7747@section Saving Articles
7748@cindex saving articles
4009494e 7749
8a1cdce5
AC
7750Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7751for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7752processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7753approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7754(@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
4009494e 7755
8a1cdce5
AC
7756For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7757save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7758command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
4009494e 7759
8a1cdce5
AC
7760@vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7761If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7762unwanted headers before saving the article.
4009494e 7763
8a1cdce5
AC
7764@vindex gnus-saved-headers
7765If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7766@code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7767deleted before saving.
4009494e 7768
8a1cdce5 7769@table @kbd
4009494e 7770
8a1cdce5
AC
7771@item O o
7772@itemx o
7773@kindex O o (Summary)
7774@kindex o (Summary)
7775@findex gnus-summary-save-article
7776@c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7777Save the current article using the default article saver
7778(@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
f394fa25 7779
8a1cdce5
AC
7780@item O m
7781@kindex O m (Summary)
7782@findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7783Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7784(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
f394fa25 7785
8a1cdce5
AC
7786@item O r
7787@kindex O r (Summary)
7788@findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7789Save the current article in Rmail format
7790(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7791Babyl in older versions.
4009494e 7792
8a1cdce5
AC
7793@item O f
7794@kindex O f (Summary)
7795@findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7796@c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7797Save the current article in plain file format
7798(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
4009494e 7799
8a1cdce5
AC
7800@item O F
7801@kindex O F (Summary)
7802@findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7803Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7804file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7805
7806@item O b
7807@kindex O b (Summary)
7808@findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7809Save the current article body in plain file format
7810(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7811
7812@item O h
7813@kindex O h (Summary)
7814@findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7815Save the current article in mh folder format
7816(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7817
7818@item O v
7819@kindex O v (Summary)
7820@findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7821Save the current article in a VM folder
7822(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7823
7824@item O p
7825@itemx |
7826@kindex O p (Summary)
7827@kindex | (Summary)
7828@findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7829@vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7830Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7831the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7832If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7833complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7834special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7835The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7836to a string containing the default command and options (default
7837@code{nil}).
4009494e 7838
8a1cdce5
AC
7839@item O P
7840@kindex O P (Summary)
7841@findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7842@vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7843Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7844external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7845Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7846variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7847(@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
4009494e
GM
7848
7849@end table
7850
8a1cdce5
AC
7851@vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7852All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7853(@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7854functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7855and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7856the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7857default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7858loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7859just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7860have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7861to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7862save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7863files.
7864
4009494e 7865
8a1cdce5
AC
7866@vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7867You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7868Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7869functions below, or you can create your own.
4009494e
GM
7870
7871@table @code
4009494e 7872
8a1cdce5
AC
7873@item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7874@findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7875@vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7876@findex gnus-plain-save-name
7877This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
787823, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7879@dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7880Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7881of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7882@code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7883article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
4009494e 7884
8a1cdce5
AC
7885@item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7886@findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7887@vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7888Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7889@code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7890article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
4009494e 7891
8a1cdce5
AC
7892@item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7893@findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7894@vindex gnus-file-save-name
7895@findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7896Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7897the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7898article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
4009494e 7899
8a1cdce5
AC
7900@item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7901@findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7902Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7903overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7904@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7905article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
4009494e 7906
8a1cdce5
AC
7907@item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7908@findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7909Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7910@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7911article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
4009494e 7912
8a1cdce5
AC
7913@item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7914@findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7915Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7916overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7917@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7918article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
4009494e 7919
8a1cdce5
AC
7920@item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7921@findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7922@findex gnus-folder-save-name
7923@findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7924@vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7925@cindex rcvstore
7926@cindex MH folders
7927Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7928library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7929to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7930@code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7931@code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
4009494e 7932
8a1cdce5
AC
7933@item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7934@findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7935Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7936reader to use this setting.
4009494e 7937
8a1cdce5
AC
7938@item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7939@findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7940Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
1df7defd 7941arguments COMMAND and RAW@. Valid values for COMMAND include:
4009494e 7942
8a1cdce5
AC
7943@itemize @bullet
7944@item a string@*
7945The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7946@item @code{nil}@*
7947You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7948@item the symbol @code{default}@*
7949It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7950@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7951last used for saving.
7952@end itemize
4009494e 7953
8a1cdce5
AC
7954Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7955@code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7956headers will be piped.
4009494e
GM
7957@end table
7958
8a1cdce5 7959The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
4009494e
GM
7960
7961@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
7962@item :decode
7963The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7964meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7965@code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7966@code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7967@code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7968@code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
4009494e 7969
8a1cdce5
AC
7970@item :function
7971The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7972overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7973articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7974@code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7975meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7976@code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
4009494e 7977
8a1cdce5
AC
7978@item :headers
7979The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7980specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7981@code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7982headers should be saved.
4009494e
GM
7983@end table
7984
8a1cdce5
AC
7985@vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7986All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7987in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7988@env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7989default.
4009494e 7990
8a1cdce5
AC
7991As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7992suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7993available functions that generate names:
4009494e 7994
8a1cdce5 7995@table @code
4009494e 7996
8a1cdce5
AC
7997@item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7998@findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7999File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
4009494e 8000
8a1cdce5
AC
8001@item gnus-numeric-save-name
8002@findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8003File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
4009494e 8004
8a1cdce5
AC
8005@item gnus-Plain-save-name
8006@findex gnus-Plain-save-name
8007File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
4009494e 8008
8a1cdce5
AC
8009@item gnus-plain-save-name
8010@findex gnus-plain-save-name
8011File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
4009494e 8012
8a1cdce5
AC
8013@item gnus-sender-save-name
8014@findex gnus-sender-save-name
8015File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
8016@end table
4009494e 8017
8a1cdce5
AC
8018@vindex gnus-split-methods
8019You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
8020the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
8021save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
8022related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
8023like:
4009494e 8024
8a1cdce5
AC
8025@lisp
8026(("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8027 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8028 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8029 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8030@end lisp
4009494e 8031
8a1cdce5
AC
8032We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8033elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8034a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8035head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8036group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8037@code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8038the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8039result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8040called returns a string or a list of strings.
01c52d31 8041
8a1cdce5
AC
8042You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8043saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8044then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8045name completion over the results from applying this variable.
4009494e 8046
8a1cdce5
AC
8047This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8048means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8049@code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8050name.
4009494e 8051
8a1cdce5
AC
8052Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8053lots of mail groups called things like
8054@samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8055these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8056following will do just that:
4009494e 8057
8a1cdce5
AC
8058@lisp
8059(defun my-save-name (group)
8060 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8061 (substring group (match-end 0))))
4009494e 8062
8a1cdce5
AC
8063(setq gnus-split-methods
8064 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8065 (my-save-name)))
8066@end lisp
4009494e 8067
4009494e 8068
8a1cdce5
AC
8069@vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8070Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8071@code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8072(@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8073the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8074all the files in the top level directory
8075(@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8076@file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8077on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8078Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
4009494e 8079
8a1cdce5
AC
8080This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8081is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8082names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8083@code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8084contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8085for kill files.
4009494e 8086
8a1cdce5
AC
8087If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8088a spool, you could
4009494e 8089
8a1cdce5
AC
8090@lisp
8091(setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8092(setq gnus-default-article-saver
8093 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8094@end lisp
4009494e 8095
8a1cdce5
AC
8096Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8097ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8098the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8099around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
4009494e 8100
4009494e 8101
8a1cdce5
AC
8102@node Decoding Articles
8103@section Decoding Articles
8104@cindex decoding articles
4009494e 8105
8a1cdce5
AC
8106Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8107encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
4009494e 8108
8a1cdce5
AC
8109@menu
8110* Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8111* Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8112* PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8113* Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8114* Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8115* Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8116@end menu
4009494e 8117
8a1cdce5
AC
8118@cindex series
8119@cindex article series
8120All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8121(@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8122the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8123can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8124articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
4009494e 8125
8a1cdce5
AC
8126Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8127simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8128last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
4009494e 8129
8a1cdce5
AC
8130For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8131will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8132([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
4009494e 8133
8a1cdce5
AC
8134Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8135series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8136commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
4009494e 8137
4009494e 8138
8a1cdce5
AC
8139@node Uuencoded Articles
8140@subsection Uuencoded Articles
8141@cindex uudecode
8142@cindex uuencoded articles
4009494e 8143
8a1cdce5 8144@table @kbd
4009494e 8145
8a1cdce5
AC
8146@item X u
8147@kindex X u (Summary)
8148@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8149@c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8150Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
4009494e 8151
8a1cdce5
AC
8152@item X U
8153@kindex X U (Summary)
8154@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8155Uudecodes and saves the current series
8156(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
4009494e 8157
8a1cdce5
AC
8158@item X v u
8159@kindex X v u (Summary)
8160@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8161Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
4009494e 8162
8a1cdce5
AC
8163@item X v U
8164@kindex X v U (Summary)
8165@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8166Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8167(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
4009494e 8168
8a1cdce5 8169@end table
4009494e 8170
8a1cdce5
AC
8171Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8172the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8173entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8174(@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8175(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
4009494e 8176
8a1cdce5
AC
8177All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8178@sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8179the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8180articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8181@kbd{X u}.
4009494e 8182
8a1cdce5
AC
8183@vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8184Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8185@code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8186@samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8187automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8188you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8189off.
4009494e 8190
4009494e 8191
8a1cdce5
AC
8192@node Shell Archives
8193@subsection Shell Archives
8194@cindex unshar
8195@cindex shell archives
8196@cindex shared articles
4009494e 8197
8a1cdce5
AC
8198Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8199sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8200some commands to deal with these:
4009494e 8201
8a1cdce5 8202@table @kbd
4009494e 8203
8a1cdce5
AC
8204@item X s
8205@kindex X s (Summary)
8206@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8207Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
4009494e 8208
8a1cdce5
AC
8209@item X S
8210@kindex X S (Summary)
8211@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8212Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
4009494e 8213
8a1cdce5
AC
8214@item X v s
8215@kindex X v s (Summary)
8216@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8217Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
4009494e 8218
8a1cdce5
AC
8219@item X v S
8220@kindex X v S (Summary)
8221@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8222Unshars, views and saves the current series
8223(@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8224@end table
4009494e 8225
4009494e 8226
8a1cdce5
AC
8227@node PostScript Files
8228@subsection PostScript Files
8229@cindex PostScript
4009494e 8230
8a1cdce5 8231@table @kbd
85115796 8232
8a1cdce5
AC
8233@item X p
8234@kindex X p (Summary)
8235@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8236Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
4009494e 8237
8a1cdce5
AC
8238@item X P
8239@kindex X P (Summary)
8240@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8241Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8242(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
4009494e 8243
8a1cdce5
AC
8244@item X v p
8245@kindex X v p (Summary)
8246@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8247View the current PostScript series
8248(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
4009494e 8249
8a1cdce5
AC
8250@item X v P
8251@kindex X v P (Summary)
8252@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8253View and save the current PostScript series
8254(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8255@end table
4009494e 8256
4009494e 8257
8a1cdce5
AC
8258@node Other Files
8259@subsection Other Files
4009494e 8260
8a1cdce5
AC
8261@table @kbd
8262@item X o
8263@kindex X o (Summary)
8264@findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8265Save the current series
8266(@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
4009494e 8267
8a1cdce5
AC
8268@item X b
8269@kindex X b (Summary)
8270@findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8271Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8272doesn't really work yet.
4009494e 8273
8a1cdce5
AC
8274@item X Y
8275@kindex X Y (Summary)
8276@findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8277yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8278@end table
4009494e 8279
4009494e 8280
8a1cdce5
AC
8281@node Decoding Variables
8282@subsection Decoding Variables
4009494e 8283
8a1cdce5 8284Adjective, not verb.
4009494e 8285
8a1cdce5
AC
8286@menu
8287* Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8288* Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8289* Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8290@end menu
4009494e 8291
4009494e 8292
8a1cdce5
AC
8293@node Rule Variables
8294@subsubsection Rule Variables
8295@cindex rule variables
4009494e 8296
8a1cdce5
AC
8297Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8298variables are of the form
4009494e 8299
8a1cdce5
AC
8300@lisp
8301 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8302 '(regexp2 command2)
8303 ...)
8304@end lisp
4009494e 8305
8a1cdce5 8306@table @code
4009494e 8307
8a1cdce5
AC
8308@item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8309@vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8310@cindex sox
8311This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8312for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8313say something like:
8314@lisp
8315(setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8316 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8317@end lisp
4009494e 8318
8a1cdce5
AC
8319@item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8320@vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8321This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8322user and default view rules.
4009494e 8323
8a1cdce5
AC
8324@item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8325@vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8326This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8327archives.
8328@end table
4009494e 8329
4009494e 8330
8a1cdce5
AC
8331@node Other Decode Variables
8332@subsubsection Other Decode Variables
4009494e 8333
8a1cdce5
AC
8334@table @code
8335@vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
4009494e 8336
8a1cdce5
AC
8337@item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8338All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8339successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8340and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8341anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
4009494e 8342
8a1cdce5 8343@table @code
4009494e 8344
8a1cdce5
AC
8345@item gnus-uu-grab-view
8346@findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8347View the file.
4009494e 8348
8a1cdce5
AC
8349@item gnus-uu-grab-move
8350@findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8351Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8352@end table
4009494e 8353
8a1cdce5
AC
8354@item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8355@vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8356Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8357@code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8358that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8359time.
01c52d31 8360
8a1cdce5
AC
8361@item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8362@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8363Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
01c52d31 8364
8a1cdce5
AC
8365@item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8366@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8367Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8368Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8369@code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
333f9019 8370kludgy.
01c52d31 8371
8a1cdce5
AC
8372@item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8373@vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8374Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
01c52d31 8375
8a1cdce5
AC
8376@item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8377@vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8378Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8379looking for files to display.
01c52d31 8380
8a1cdce5
AC
8381@item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8382@vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8383Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8384after viewing it.
01c52d31 8385
8a1cdce5
AC
8386@item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8387@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8388Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8389rules.
01c52d31 8390
8a1cdce5
AC
8391@item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8392@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8393Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8394unpacking commands.
01c52d31 8395
8a1cdce5
AC
8396@item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8397@vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8398Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8399from articles.
01c52d31 8400
8a1cdce5
AC
8401@item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8402@vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8403Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8404decoded articles as unread.
4009494e 8405
8a1cdce5
AC
8406@item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8407@vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8408Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8409uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
4009494e 8410
8a1cdce5
AC
8411@item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8412@vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8413Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
4009494e 8414
8a1cdce5
AC
8415@item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8416@vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8417@cindex metamail
8418Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8419commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8420content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8421@code{metamail} for viewing.
4009494e 8422
8a1cdce5
AC
8423@item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8424@vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8425Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8426decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8427@code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8428embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8429to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8430simply dropped them.
4009494e 8431
8a1cdce5 8432@end table
4009494e 8433
4009494e 8434
8a1cdce5
AC
8435@node Uuencoding and Posting
8436@subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
4009494e 8437
8a1cdce5 8438@table @code
4009494e 8439
8a1cdce5
AC
8440@item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8441@vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8442Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8443before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8444either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8445for you when you post the article.
4009494e 8446
8a1cdce5
AC
8447@item gnus-uu-post-length
8448@vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8449Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8450many articles it takes to post the entire file.
4009494e 8451
8a1cdce5
AC
8452@item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8453@vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8454Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8455thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8456to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8457seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8458think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 8459
8a1cdce5
AC
8460@item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8461@vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8462Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8463article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8464variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8465at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8466Default is @code{t}.
4009494e 8467
8a1cdce5 8468@end table
4009494e 8469
4009494e 8470
8a1cdce5
AC
8471@node Viewing Files
8472@subsection Viewing Files
8473@cindex viewing files
8474@cindex pseudo-articles
4009494e 8475
8a1cdce5
AC
8476After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8477to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8478viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8479containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8480uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8481This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8482of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
4009494e 8483
8a1cdce5
AC
8484Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8485extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8486``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8487will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
4009494e 8488
8a1cdce5
AC
8489@vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8490If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8491until the viewing is done before proceeding.
4009494e 8492
8a1cdce5
AC
8493@vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8494If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8495the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8496immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8497be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
4009494e 8498
8a1cdce5
AC
8499@vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8500If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8501pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8502@code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8503a list of parameters to that command.
4009494e 8504
8a1cdce5
AC
8505@vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8506If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8507pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
4009494e 8508
8a1cdce5
AC
8509So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8510@emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8511Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
4009494e 8512
4009494e 8513
8a1cdce5
AC
8514@node Article Treatment
8515@section Article Treatment
4009494e 8516
8a1cdce5
AC
8517Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8518object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8519written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8520writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8521these articles easier.
4009494e 8522
8a1cdce5
AC
8523@menu
8524* Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8525* Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8526* Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8527* Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8528* Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8529* Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8530* Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8531* Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8532* Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8533 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8534* Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8535* Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8536@end menu
4009494e 8537
4009494e 8538
8a1cdce5
AC
8539@node Article Highlighting
8540@subsection Article Highlighting
8541@cindex highlighting
4009494e 8542
8a1cdce5
AC
8543Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8544you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
4009494e 8545
8a1cdce5 8546@table @kbd
4009494e 8547
8a1cdce5
AC
8548@item W H a
8549@kindex W H a (Summary)
8550@findex gnus-article-highlight
8551@findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8552Do much highlighting of the current article
8553(@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8554text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
4009494e 8555
8a1cdce5
AC
8556@item W H h
8557@kindex W H h (Summary)
8558@findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8559@vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8560Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8561highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8562variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8563@code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8564@var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8565header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8566(@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8567the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8568@var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
4009494e 8569
8a1cdce5
AC
8570@item W H c
8571@kindex W H c (Summary)
8572@findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8573Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
4009494e 8574
8a1cdce5 8575Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
89167438 8576
8a1cdce5
AC
8577@table @code
8578@vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
d62672f3 8579
8a1cdce5
AC
8580@item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8581If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
858225000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
d62672f3 8583
8a1cdce5
AC
8584@item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8585@vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8586Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
4009494e 8587
8a1cdce5
AC
8588@item gnus-cite-face-list
8589@vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8590List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8591When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8592Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8593This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
4009494e 8594
8a1cdce5
AC
8595@item gnus-supercite-regexp
8596@vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8597Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
4009494e 8598
8a1cdce5
AC
8599@item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8600@vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8601Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
4009494e 8602
8a1cdce5
AC
8603@item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8604@vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8605Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8606that it's a citation.
4009494e 8607
8a1cdce5
AC
8608@item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8609@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8610Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
4009494e 8611
8a1cdce5
AC
8612@item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8613@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8614Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
4009494e 8615
8a1cdce5
AC
8616@item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8617@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8618Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8619cited text belonging to the attribution.
4009494e 8620
8a1cdce5
AC
8621@item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8622@vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8623If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8624beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8625in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8626is @code{t}.
4009494e 8627
8a1cdce5 8628@end table
4009494e 8629
4009494e 8630
8a1cdce5
AC
8631@item W H s
8632@kindex W H s (Summary)
8633@vindex gnus-signature-separator
8634@vindex gnus-signature-face
8635@findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8636Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8637Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8638Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8639highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8640default.
4009494e 8641
4009494e
GM
8642@end table
8643
8a1cdce5 8644@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
4009494e 8645
4009494e 8646
8a1cdce5
AC
8647@node Article Fontisizing
8648@subsection Article Fontisizing
8649@cindex emphasis
8650@cindex article emphasis
4009494e 8651
8a1cdce5
AC
8652@findex gnus-article-emphasize
8653@kindex W e (Summary)
8654People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8655like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8656this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8657(@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
4009494e 8658
8a1cdce5
AC
8659@vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8660How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8661@code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8662element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8663that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8664emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8665should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8666groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8667highlighting.
4009494e
GM
8668
8669@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
8670(setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8671 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8672 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
4009494e
GM
8673@end lisp
8674
8a1cdce5
AC
8675@cindex slash
8676@cindex asterisk
8677@cindex underline
8678@cindex /
8679@cindex *
4009494e 8680
8a1cdce5
AC
8681@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8682@vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8683@vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8684@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8685@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8686@vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8687@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8688By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8689@code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8690@code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8691@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8692@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8693@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
4009494e 8694
8a1cdce5
AC
8695If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8696customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8697to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8698say something like:
4009494e
GM
8699
8700@lisp
8a1cdce5 8701(copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
4009494e
GM
8702@end lisp
8703
8a1cdce5 8704@vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
4009494e 8705
8a1cdce5
AC
8706If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8707@code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8708syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8709parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
4009494e 8710
8a1cdce5 8711@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
4009494e 8712
4009494e 8713
8a1cdce5
AC
8714@node Article Hiding
8715@subsection Article Hiding
8716@cindex article hiding
4009494e 8717
8a1cdce5
AC
8718Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8719too much cruft in most articles.
4009494e 8720
8a1cdce5 8721@table @kbd
4009494e 8722
8a1cdce5
AC
8723@item W W a
8724@kindex W W a (Summary)
8725@findex gnus-article-hide
8726Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8727(@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8728headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
4009494e 8729
8a1cdce5
AC
8730@item W W h
8731@kindex W W h (Summary)
8732@findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8733Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8734Headers}.
4009494e 8735
8a1cdce5
AC
8736@item W W b
8737@kindex W W b (Summary)
8738@findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8739Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8740(@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
4009494e 8741
8a1cdce5
AC
8742@item W W s
8743@kindex W W s (Summary)
8744@findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8745Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8746Signature}.
4009494e 8747
8a1cdce5
AC
8748@item W W l
8749@kindex W W l (Summary)
8750@findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8751@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8752Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8753are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8754@code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8755@samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8756may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
4009494e 8757
8a1cdce5 8758@table @code
4009494e 8759
8a1cdce5
AC
8760@item gnus-list-identifiers
8761@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8762A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8763subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
4009494e 8764
8a1cdce5 8765@end table
4009494e 8766
8a1cdce5
AC
8767@item W W P
8768@kindex W W P (Summary)
8769@findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8770Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8771(@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
4009494e 8772
8a1cdce5
AC
8773@item W W B
8774@kindex W W B (Summary)
8775@findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8776@vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8777@vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8778@cindex banner
8779@cindex OneList
8780@cindex stripping advertisements
8781@cindex advertisements
8782Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8783(@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8784annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8785groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8786the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8787group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8788which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8789removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8790signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8791corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8792used.
4009494e 8793
8a1cdce5 8794For instance:
4009494e 8795
8a1cdce5
AC
8796@lisp
8797(setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8798 ((googleGroups .
8799 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8800@end lisp
4009494e 8801
8a1cdce5
AC
8802Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8803the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8804@code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
4009494e 8805
8a1cdce5 8806@table @code
4009494e 8807
8a1cdce5
AC
8808@item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8809@vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8810Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8811@code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8812matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8813symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8814a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8815address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8816sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8817banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8818sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
4009494e 8819
8a1cdce5
AC
8820@lisp
8821("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8822 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8823@end lisp
4009494e 8824
8a1cdce5 8825@end table
4009494e 8826
8a1cdce5
AC
8827@item W W c
8828@kindex W W c (Summary)
8829@findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8830Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8831customizing the hiding:
4009494e 8832
8a1cdce5 8833@table @code
4009494e 8834
8a1cdce5
AC
8835@item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8836@itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8837@vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8838@vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8839Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8840allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8841by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8842specs are valid:
4009494e 8843
8a1cdce5
AC
8844@table @samp
8845@item b
8846Starting point of the hidden text.
8847@item e
8848Ending point of the hidden text.
8849@item l
8850Number of characters in the hidden region.
8851@item n
8852Number of lines of hidden text.
4009494e
GM
8853@end table
8854
8a1cdce5
AC
8855@item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8856@vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8857The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8858shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8859and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
4009494e 8860
8a1cdce5 8861@end table
4009494e 8862
8a1cdce5
AC
8863@item W W C-c
8864@kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8865@findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
4009494e 8866
8a1cdce5
AC
8867Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8868following two variables:
4009494e 8869
8a1cdce5
AC
8870@table @code
8871@item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8872@vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8873If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
887450), hide the cited text.
4009494e 8875
8a1cdce5
AC
8876@item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8877@vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8878The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8879is hidden.
4009494e
GM
8880@end table
8881
8a1cdce5
AC
8882@item W W C
8883@kindex W W C (Summary)
8884@findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8885Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8886(@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8887useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8888have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
4009494e 8889
8a1cdce5 8890@end table
4009494e 8891
8a1cdce5
AC
8892All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8893prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8894hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
b890d447 8895
8a1cdce5
AC
8896Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8897citation customization.
4009494e 8898
8a1cdce5
AC
8899@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8900automatically.
4009494e 8901
4009494e 8902
8a1cdce5
AC
8903@node Article Washing
8904@subsection Article Washing
8905@cindex washing
8906@cindex article washing
4009494e 8907
8a1cdce5
AC
8908We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8909@kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
4009494e 8910
8a1cdce5
AC
8911@dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8912something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8913Cleaner, perhaps.
4009494e 8914
8a1cdce5
AC
8915@xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8916articles by default.
4009494e 8917
8a1cdce5 8918@table @kbd
4009494e 8919
8a1cdce5
AC
8920@item C-u g
8921This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8922you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8923the server.
4009494e 8924
8a1cdce5
AC
8925@item g
8926Force redisplaying of the current article
8927(@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8928If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8929interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8930(@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
4009494e 8931
8a1cdce5
AC
8932@item W l
8933@kindex W l (Summary)
8934@findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8935Remove page breaks from the current article
8936(@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8937delimiters.
4009494e 8938
8a1cdce5
AC
8939@item W r
8940@kindex W r (Summary)
8941@findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8942@c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8943Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8944(@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8945Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8946(Typically offensive jokes and such.)
4009494e 8947
8a1cdce5 8948It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
1df7defd 8949positions in the alphabet, e.g., @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8a1cdce5
AC
8950#15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8951is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
4009494e 8952
8a1cdce5
AC
8953@item W m
8954@kindex W m (Summary)
8955@findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8956Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
4009494e 8957
8a1cdce5
AC
8958@item W i
8959@kindex W i (Summary)
8960@findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8961Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8962encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8963unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8964string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8965(@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8966to work.
4009494e 8967
8a1cdce5
AC
8968@item W t
8969@item t
8970@kindex W t (Summary)
8971@kindex t (Summary)
8972@findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8973Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8974(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
4009494e 8975
8a1cdce5
AC
8976@item W v
8977@kindex W v (Summary)
8978@findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8979Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8980(@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
4009494e 8981
8a1cdce5
AC
8982@item W o
8983@kindex W o (Summary)
8984@findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8985Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
4009494e 8986
8a1cdce5
AC
8987@item W d
8988@kindex W d (Summary)
8989@findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8990@vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8991@cindex Smartquotes
8992@cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8993@cindex Latin 1
8994Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8995@code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8996(@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8997whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8998interactively.
4009494e 8999
8a1cdce5
AC
9000Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
9001an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
9002like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
9003apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
4009494e 9004
8a1cdce5
AC
9005@item W U
9006@kindex W U (Summary)
9007@findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
9008@cindex Unicode
9009@cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
9010Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
9011@acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
9012This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
fe7a3057 9013and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
89b163db 9014like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
4009494e 9015
8a1cdce5
AC
9016@item W Y f
9017@kindex W Y f (Summary)
9018@findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
9019@cindex Outlook Express
9020Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
9021unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
9022(@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
4009494e 9023
8a1cdce5
AC
9024@item W Y u
9025@kindex W Y u (Summary)
9026@findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9027@vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9028@vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9029Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9030what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9031@code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9032@code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9033maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9034(@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
4009494e 9035
8a1cdce5
AC
9036@item W Y a
9037@kindex W Y a (Summary)
9038@findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9039Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9040(@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
4009494e 9041
8a1cdce5
AC
9042@item W Y c
9043@kindex W Y c (Summary)
9044@findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9045Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9046(@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
4009494e 9047
8a1cdce5
AC
9048@item W w
9049@kindex W w (Summary)
9050@findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9051Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
4009494e 9052
8a1cdce5
AC
9053You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9054when filling.
4009494e 9055
8a1cdce5
AC
9056@item W Q
9057@kindex W Q (Summary)
9058@findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9059Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
4009494e 9060
8a1cdce5
AC
9061@item W C
9062@kindex W C (Summary)
9063@findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9064Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9065(@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
4009494e 9066
8a1cdce5
AC
9067@item W c
9068@kindex W c (Summary)
9069@findex gnus-article-remove-cr
1df7defd 9070Translate CRLF pairs (i.e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8a1cdce5
AC
9071(this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9072CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9073(@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
4009494e 9074
8a1cdce5
AC
9075@item W q
9076@kindex W q (Summary)
9077@findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9078Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9079Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9080sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9081makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9082which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9083done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9084@code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9085has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
4009494e 9086
8a1cdce5
AC
9087@item W 6
9088@kindex W 6 (Summary)
9089@findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9090Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9091one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9092non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9093usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9094@code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9095has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
4009494e 9096
8a1cdce5
AC
9097@item W Z
9098@kindex W Z (Summary)
9099@findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9100Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9101common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9102makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
4009494e 9103
8a1cdce5
AC
9104@item W A
9105@kindex W A (Summary)
9106@findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9107@cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9108Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9109extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9110sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
4009494e 9111
8a1cdce5
AC
9112@item W u
9113@kindex W u (Summary)
9114@findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9115Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9116outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9117split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9118the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
4009494e 9119
8a1cdce5
AC
9120@item W h
9121@kindex W h (Summary)
9122@findex gnus-article-wash-html
9123Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9124usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9125@code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
4009494e 9126
8a1cdce5
AC
9127If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9128the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9129(@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9130
9131The default is to use the function specified by
9132@code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9133Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9134@acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
4009494e
GM
9135
9136@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
9137@item shr
9138Use Gnus simple html renderer.
4009494e 9139
8a1cdce5
AC
9140@item gnus-w3m
9141Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
4009494e 9142
8a1cdce5
AC
9143@item w3
9144Use Emacs/W3.
4009494e 9145
8a1cdce5
AC
9146@item w3m
9147Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
4009494e 9148
8a1cdce5
AC
9149@item w3m-standalone
9150Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
4009494e 9151
8a1cdce5
AC
9152@item links
9153Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
4009494e 9154
8a1cdce5
AC
9155@item lynx
9156Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
4009494e 9157
8a1cdce5
AC
9158@item html2text
9159Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
4009494e 9160
8a1cdce5 9161@end table
4009494e 9162
8a1cdce5
AC
9163@item W b
9164@kindex W b (Summary)
9165@findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9166Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9167@xref{Article Buttons}.
4009494e 9168
8a1cdce5
AC
9169@item W B
9170@kindex W B (Summary)
9171@findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9172Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9173(@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
4009494e 9174
8a1cdce5
AC
9175@item W p
9176@kindex W p (Summary)
9177@findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9178Verify a signed control message
9179(@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9180@code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9181hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9182the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9183message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9184available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
4009494e 9185
8a1cdce5
AC
9186@item W s
9187@kindex W s (Summary)
9188@findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9189Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9190@acronym{S/MIME}) message
9191(@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
4009494e 9192
8a1cdce5
AC
9193@item W a
9194@kindex W a (Summary)
9195@findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9196Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9197article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
4009494e 9198
8a1cdce5
AC
9199@item W E l
9200@kindex W E l (Summary)
9201@findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9202Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9203(@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
4009494e 9204
8a1cdce5
AC
9205@item W E m
9206@kindex W E m (Summary)
9207@findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9208Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9209lines with a single empty line.
9210(@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
4009494e 9211
8a1cdce5
AC
9212@item W E t
9213@kindex W E t (Summary)
9214@findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9215Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9216(@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
4009494e 9217
8a1cdce5
AC
9218@item W E a
9219@kindex W E a (Summary)
9220@findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9221Do all the three commands above
9222(@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
4009494e 9223
8a1cdce5
AC
9224@item W E A
9225@kindex W E A (Summary)
9226@findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9227Remove all blank lines
9228(@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9229
9230@item W E s
9231@kindex W E s (Summary)
9232@findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9233Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9234body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
4009494e 9235
8a1cdce5
AC
9236@item W E e
9237@kindex W E e (Summary)
9238@findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9239Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9240body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
4009494e 9241
8a1cdce5 9242@end table
4009494e 9243
8a1cdce5 9244@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
4009494e 9245
4009494e 9246
8a1cdce5
AC
9247@node Article Header
9248@subsection Article Header
4009494e 9249
8a1cdce5 9250These commands perform various transformations of article header.
4009494e 9251
8a1cdce5 9252@table @kbd
4009494e 9253
8a1cdce5
AC
9254@item W G u
9255@kindex W G u (Summary)
9256@findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9257Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
4009494e 9258
8a1cdce5
AC
9259@item W G n
9260@kindex W G n (Summary)
9261@findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9262Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9263(@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
4009494e 9264
8a1cdce5
AC
9265@item W G f
9266@kindex W G f (Summary)
9267@findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9268Fold all the message headers
9269(@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
4009494e 9270
8a1cdce5
AC
9271@item W E w
9272@kindex W E w (Summary)
9273@findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9274Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9275(@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
4009494e 9276
8a1cdce5 9277@end table
4009494e 9278
4009494e 9279
8a1cdce5
AC
9280@node Article Buttons
9281@subsection Article Buttons
9282@cindex buttons
4009494e 9283
8a1cdce5
AC
9284People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9285be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9286with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9287button on these references.
4009494e 9288
8a1cdce5
AC
9289@vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9290Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9291Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9292Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9293one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
4009494e 9294
8a1cdce5 9295@table @code
4009494e 9296
8a1cdce5
AC
9297@item gnus-button-alist
9298@vindex gnus-button-alist
9299This is an alist where each entry has this form:
4009494e 9300
8a1cdce5
AC
9301@lisp
9302(@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9303@end lisp
4009494e 9304
8a1cdce5 9305@table @var
4009494e 9306
8a1cdce5
AC
9307@item regexp
9308All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9309considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9310embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9311variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9312@code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
4009494e 9313
8a1cdce5
AC
9314@item button-par
9315Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9316is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9317highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
4009494e 9318
8a1cdce5
AC
9319@item use-p
9320This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9321this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9322avoid false matches. Often variables named
9323@code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9324Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
4009494e 9325
8a1cdce5 9326@c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
4009494e 9327
8a1cdce5
AC
9328@item function
9329This function will be called when you click on this button.
4009494e 9330
8a1cdce5
AC
9331@item data-par
9332As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9333says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
4009494e 9334
8a1cdce5 9335@end table
4009494e 9336
8a1cdce5 9337So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
4009494e
GM
9338
9339@lisp
8a1cdce5 9340("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
4009494e
GM
9341@end lisp
9342
8a1cdce5
AC
9343@item gnus-header-button-alist
9344@vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9345This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9346article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9347used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
4009494e
GM
9348
9349@lisp
8a1cdce5 9350(@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
4009494e
GM
9351@end lisp
9352
8a1cdce5
AC
9353@var{header} is a regular expression.
9354@end table
4009494e 9355
8a1cdce5 9356@subsubsection Related variables and functions
4009494e 9357
8a1cdce5
AC
9358@table @code
9359@item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9360@xref{Article Button Levels}.
4009494e 9361
8a1cdce5 9362@c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
4009494e 9363
8a1cdce5
AC
9364@item gnus-button-url-regexp
9365@vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9366A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9367default values of the variables above.
4009494e 9368
8a1cdce5 9369@c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
4009494e 9370
8a1cdce5
AC
9371@item gnus-button-man-handler
9372@vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9373The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9374argument with a string naming the man page.
4009494e 9375
8a1cdce5
AC
9376@c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9377
9378@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9379@vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9380Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
4009494e 9381
8a1cdce5
AC
9382@item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9383@vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9384This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9385@samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9386message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9387@code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9388a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9389@code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9390function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9391function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9392@code{ask}. The default value is the function
9393@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
4009494e 9394
8a1cdce5
AC
9395@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9396@findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9397Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9398address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9399it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9400string is invalid.
4009494e 9401
8a1cdce5
AC
9402@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9403@vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9404An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9405@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
4009494e 9406
8a1cdce5 9407@c Misc stuff
4009494e 9408
8a1cdce5
AC
9409@item gnus-article-button-face
9410@vindex gnus-article-button-face
9411Face used on buttons.
4009494e 9412
8a1cdce5
AC
9413@item gnus-article-mouse-face
9414@vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9415Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
4009494e
GM
9416
9417@end table
9418
8a1cdce5 9419@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
4009494e 9420
4009494e 9421
8a1cdce5
AC
9422@node Article Button Levels
9423@subsection Article button levels
9424@cindex button levels
9425The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9426the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9427buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9428already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9429more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9430you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9431specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9432variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
a3f57c41
G
9433
9434@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
9435;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9436(setq gnus-parameters
9437 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9438 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9439 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
a3f57c41
G
9440@end lisp
9441
4009494e
GM
9442@table @code
9443
8a1cdce5
AC
9444@item gnus-button-browse-level
9445@vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9446Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9447news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9448@code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9449@code{browse-url-browser-function}.
4009494e 9450
8a1cdce5
AC
9451@item gnus-button-emacs-level
9452@vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9453Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9454@code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9455@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9456@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9457@code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9458@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9459@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9460@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9461@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9462@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9463@code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9464
9465@item gnus-button-man-level
9466@vindex gnus-button-man-level
9467Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9468See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9469
9470@item gnus-button-message-level
9471@vindex gnus-button-message-level
9472Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9473Related variables and functions include
9474@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9475@code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9476@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9477@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
4009494e
GM
9478
9479@end table
9480
4009494e 9481
8a1cdce5
AC
9482@node Article Date
9483@subsection Article Date
4009494e 9484
8a1cdce5
AC
9485The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9486heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9487when the article was sent.
4009494e 9488
8a1cdce5 9489@table @kbd
4009494e 9490
8a1cdce5
AC
9491@item W T u
9492@kindex W T u (Summary)
9493@findex gnus-article-date-ut
9494Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9495(@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
4009494e 9496
8a1cdce5
AC
9497@item W T i
9498@kindex W T i (Summary)
9499@findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9500@cindex ISO 8601
9501Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9502(@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
4009494e 9503
8a1cdce5
AC
9504@item W T l
9505@kindex W T l (Summary)
9506@findex gnus-article-date-local
9507Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
4009494e 9508
8a1cdce5
AC
9509@item W T p
9510@kindex W T p (Summary)
9511@findex gnus-article-date-english
9512Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9513(@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
4009494e 9514
8a1cdce5
AC
9515@item W T s
9516@kindex W T s (Summary)
9517@vindex gnus-article-time-format
9518@findex gnus-article-date-user
9519@findex format-time-string
9520Display the date using a user-defined format
9521(@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9522@code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9523to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9524for a list of possible format specs.
4009494e 9525
8a1cdce5
AC
9526@item W T e
9527@kindex W T e (Summary)
9528@findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9529@findex gnus-start-date-timer
9530@findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9531Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9532(@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9533
9534@example
12e3ca0a 9535Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
8a1cdce5
AC
9536@end example
9537
cdebc6dd
KY
9538To make this line updated continually, set the
9539@code{gnus-article-update-date-headers} variable to the frequency in
9540seconds (the default is @code{nil}).
4009494e 9541
8a1cdce5
AC
9542@item W T o
9543@kindex W T o (Summary)
9544@findex gnus-article-date-original
9545Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9546be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9547worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9548that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9549@emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
4009494e 9550
8a1cdce5 9551@end table
4009494e 9552
8a1cdce5
AC
9553@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9554preferred format automatically.
4009494e 9555
4009494e 9556
8a1cdce5
AC
9557@node Article Display
9558@subsection Article Display
9559@cindex picons
9560@cindex x-face
9561@cindex smileys
9562@cindex gravatars
4009494e 9563
8a1cdce5
AC
9564These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9565buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
4009494e 9566
8a1cdce5
AC
9567@code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9568message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
4009494e 9569
8a1cdce5
AC
9570@code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9571headers (@pxref{Face}).
4009494e 9572
8a1cdce5
AC
9573Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9574their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
4009494e 9575
8a1cdce5
AC
9576Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9577try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
4009494e 9578
8a1cdce5
AC
9579Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9580@uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
4009494e 9581
8a1cdce5
AC
9582All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9583they'll be removed.
4009494e 9584
8a1cdce5
AC
9585@table @kbd
9586@item W D x
9587@kindex W D x (Summary)
9588@findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9589Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9590(@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
4009494e 9591
8a1cdce5
AC
9592@item W D d
9593@kindex W D d (Summary)
9594@findex gnus-article-display-face
9595Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9596(@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
4009494e 9597
8a1cdce5
AC
9598@item W D s
9599@kindex W D s (Summary)
9600@findex gnus-treat-smiley
9601Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
01c52d31 9602
8a1cdce5
AC
9603@item W D f
9604@kindex W D f (Summary)
9605@findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9606Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
4009494e 9607
8a1cdce5
AC
9608@item W D m
9609@kindex W D m (Summary)
9610@findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
1df7defd 9611Piconify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
8a1cdce5 9612(@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
4009494e 9613
8a1cdce5
AC
9614@item W D n
9615@kindex W D n (Summary)
9616@findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
1df7defd 9617Piconify all news headers (i.e., @code{Newsgroups} and
8a1cdce5 9618@code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
4009494e 9619
8a1cdce5
AC
9620@item W D g
9621@kindex W D g (Summary)
9622@findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9623Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
4009494e 9624
8a1cdce5
AC
9625@item W D h
9626@kindex W D h (Summary)
9627@findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
1df7defd 9628Gravatarify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
8a1cdce5 9629(@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
4009494e 9630
8a1cdce5
AC
9631@item W D D
9632@kindex W D D (Summary)
9633@findex gnus-article-remove-images
9634Remove all images from the article buffer
9635(@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
be3c11b3 9636
8a1cdce5
AC
9637@item W D W
9638@kindex W D W (Summary)
9639@findex gnus-html-show-images
9640If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9641@code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9642the buffer with this command.
9643(@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
4009494e 9644
8a1cdce5 9645@end table
4009494e 9646
4009494e 9647
4009494e 9648
8a1cdce5
AC
9649@node Article Signature
9650@subsection Article Signature
9651@cindex signatures
9652@cindex article signature
4009494e 9653
8a1cdce5
AC
9654@vindex gnus-signature-separator
9655Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9656body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9657that says what is to be considered a signature is
9658@code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9659@samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9660non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9661of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9662from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
4009494e 9663
8a1cdce5
AC
9664@lisp
9665(setq gnus-signature-separator
9666 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9667 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9668 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9669 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9670 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9671 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9672 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9673@end lisp
4009494e 9674
8a1cdce5
AC
9675The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9676positives.
4009494e 9677
8a1cdce5
AC
9678@vindex gnus-signature-limit
9679@code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9680signature when displaying articles.
4009494e 9681
8a1cdce5
AC
9682@enumerate
9683@item
9684If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9685that integer.
9686@item
9687If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9688than that number.
9689@item
9690If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9691and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9692@item
9693If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9694in question is not a signature.
9695@end enumerate
4009494e 9696
8a1cdce5
AC
9697This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9698listed above. Here's an example:
4009494e 9699
8a1cdce5
AC
9700@lisp
9701(setq gnus-signature-limit
9702 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9703@end lisp
4009494e 9704
8a1cdce5
AC
9705This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9706separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9707the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9708signature after all.
01c52d31 9709
4009494e 9710
8a1cdce5
AC
9711@node Article Miscellanea
9712@subsection Article Miscellanea
4009494e 9713
8a1cdce5
AC
9714@table @kbd
9715@item A t
9716@kindex A t (Summary)
9717@findex gnus-article-babel
9718Translate the article from one language to another
9719(@code{gnus-article-babel}).
4009494e 9720
8a1cdce5 9721@end table
4009494e 9722
36d3245f 9723
8a1cdce5
AC
9724@node MIME Commands
9725@section MIME Commands
9726@cindex MIME decoding
9727@cindex attachments
9728@cindex viewing attachments
0e6b7ca0 9729
8a1cdce5
AC
9730The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9731instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
4009494e 9732
8a1cdce5
AC
9733@table @kbd
9734@item b
9735@itemx K v
9736@kindex b (Summary)
9737@kindex K v (Summary)
9738View the @acronym{MIME} part.
4009494e 9739
8a1cdce5
AC
9740@item K o
9741@kindex K o (Summary)
9742Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
4009494e 9743
8a1cdce5
AC
9744@item K O
9745@kindex K O (Summary)
9746Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9747from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9748via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
4009494e 9749
8a1cdce5
AC
9750@item K r
9751@kindex K r (Summary)
9752Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
4009494e 9753
8a1cdce5
AC
9754@item K d
9755@kindex K d (Summary)
9756Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9757removed part.
4009494e 9758
8a1cdce5
AC
9759@item K c
9760@kindex K c (Summary)
9761Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
4009494e 9762
8a1cdce5
AC
9763@item K e
9764@kindex K e (Summary)
9765View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
4009494e 9766
8a1cdce5
AC
9767@item K i
9768@kindex K i (Summary)
9769View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
4009494e 9770
8a1cdce5
AC
9771@item K |
9772@kindex K | (Summary)
9773Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9774@end table
4009494e 9775
8a1cdce5
AC
9776The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9777the same manner:
4009494e 9778
8a1cdce5
AC
9779@table @kbd
9780@item K H
9781@kindex K H (Summary)
9782@findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9783View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9784Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9785are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9786message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9787unless the prefix argument is given.
4009494e 9788
8a1cdce5
AC
9789Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9790@acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9791this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9792eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9793trusted senders.
4009494e 9794
8a1cdce5
AC
9795If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9796@code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
4009494e 9797
8a1cdce5
AC
9798This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9799including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9800the group (if you want).
4009494e 9801
8a1cdce5
AC
9802@item K b
9803@kindex K b (Summary)
9804Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9805mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9806parts.
4009494e 9807
8a1cdce5
AC
9808@item K m
9809@kindex K m (Summary)
9810@findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9811Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9812This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9813be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9814(@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
4009494e 9815
8a1cdce5
AC
9816@item X m
9817@kindex X m (Summary)
9818@findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9819Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9820(@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9821convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 9822
8a1cdce5
AC
9823@item M-t
9824@kindex M-t (Summary)
9825@findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9826Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9827(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
4009494e 9828
8a1cdce5
AC
9829@item W M w
9830@kindex W M w (Summary)
9831@findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9832Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9833(@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
4009494e 9834
8a1cdce5
AC
9835@item W M c
9836@kindex W M c (Summary)
9837@findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9838Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9839(@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
4009494e 9840
8a1cdce5
AC
9841This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9842charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9843prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9844groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9845include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9846parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
4009494e 9847
8a1cdce5
AC
9848@item W M v
9849@kindex W M v (Summary)
9850@findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9851View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9852(@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
4009494e 9853
8a1cdce5 9854@end table
4009494e 9855
8a1cdce5 9856Relevant variables:
4009494e 9857
8a1cdce5
AC
9858@table @code
9859@item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9860@vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9861This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9862this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9863@code{nil}.
4009494e 9864
8a1cdce5 9865To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
4009494e 9866
8a1cdce5
AC
9867@lisp
9868(setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9869 '("text/x-vcard"))
9870@end lisp
4009494e 9871
8a1cdce5
AC
9872@item gnus-article-loose-mime
9873@vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9874If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9875before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9876when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9877default is @code{t}.
4009494e 9878
8a1cdce5
AC
9879@item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9880@vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9881@cindex uuencode
9882@cindex yEnc
9883There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9884is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9885this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9886see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9887Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9888single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9889for encoding in Gnus.
4009494e 9890
8a1cdce5
AC
9891@item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9892@vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9893This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9894this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9895displayed or this variable is overridden by
9896@code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9897@code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9898@code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
4009494e 9899
8a1cdce5
AC
9900@item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9901@vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9902This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9903this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9904displayed. This variable overrides
9905@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9906This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9907is @code{nil}.
4009494e 9908
1df7defd 9909E.g., to see security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
8a1cdce5
AC
9910variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9911@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
4009494e 9912
8a1cdce5
AC
9913You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9914display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9915those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9916(@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9917Emacs MIME Manual}).
4009494e 9918
8a1cdce5
AC
9919@item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9920@vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9921If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9922default value is @code{nil}.
4009494e 9923
8a1cdce5
AC
9924@item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9925@vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9926For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9927handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
1df7defd
PE
9928users to gather information from the article (e.g., add Vcard info to
9929the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e.g., automatically
8a1cdce5
AC
9930save all jpegs into some directory).
9931
9932Here's an example function the does the latter:
4009494e
GM
9933
9934@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
9935(defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9936 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9937 (with-temp-buffer
9938 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9939 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9940 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9941(setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9942 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
4009494e
GM
9943@end lisp
9944
8a1cdce5
AC
9945@vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9946@item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9947Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
4009494e 9948
8a1cdce5
AC
9949@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9950@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9951Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
4009494e 9952
8a1cdce5
AC
9953@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9954@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9955Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
4009494e 9956
8a1cdce5
AC
9957If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9958@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9959"multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9960@code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9961emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
4009494e 9962
8a1cdce5
AC
9963@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9964@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9965Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9966overrides @code{nil} values of
9967@code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9968@code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
4009494e 9969
8a1cdce5
AC
9970@vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9971@item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9972List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9973Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
4009494e 9974
8a1cdce5
AC
9975Ready-made functions include@*
9976@code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9977@code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9978@code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9979@code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9980the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9981whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9982is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9983@findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9984@findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9985@findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9986@findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9987@vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
4009494e 9988
8a1cdce5
AC
9989The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9990@code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
4009494e 9991
8a1cdce5
AC
9992Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9993except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9994such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
4009494e
GM
9995
9996@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
9997(setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9998 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9999 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10000 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
4009494e
GM
10001@end lisp
10002
8a1cdce5
AC
10003@noindent
10004to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
4009494e 10005
4009494e
GM
10006@end table
10007
4009494e 10008
8a1cdce5
AC
10009@node Charsets
10010@section Charsets
10011@cindex charsets
4009494e 10012
8a1cdce5
AC
10013People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
10014charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
10015newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
10016just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
10017help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10018what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10019hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
4009494e 10020
8a1cdce5
AC
10021@vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10022This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10023variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10024group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
4009494e 10025
8a1cdce5
AC
10026@vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10027In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10028aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10029even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10030@code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10031charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10032set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10033Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10034which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
4009494e 10035
8a1cdce5
AC
10036@vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10037When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10038determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10039encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10040quoted-printable header encoding.
4009494e 10041
8a1cdce5
AC
10042This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10043for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10044header body-list}@code{)}, where:
4009494e 10045
8a1cdce5
AC
10046@table @var
10047@item test
10048is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10049variable to query,
10050@item header
10051is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10052means encode all charsets),
10053@item body-list
10054is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10055encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10056encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10057@end table
4009494e 10058
8a1cdce5
AC
10059@cindex Russian
10060@cindex koi8-r
10061@cindex koi8-u
10062@cindex iso-8859-5
10063@cindex coding system aliases
10064@cindex preferred charset
4009494e 10065
8a1cdce5
AC
10066@xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10067The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10068MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
4009494e 10069
8a1cdce5 10070Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
4009494e 10071
8a1cdce5
AC
10072If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10073charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
4009494e 10074
8a1cdce5
AC
10075@lisp
10076(put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10077 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10078@end lisp
4009494e 10079
8a1cdce5
AC
10080This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10081the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
4009494e 10082
8a1cdce5 10083If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
4009494e 10084
8a1cdce5
AC
10085@lisp
10086(define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10087@end lisp
4009494e 10088
8a1cdce5 10089This will almost do the right thing.
4009494e 10090
8a1cdce5
AC
10091And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10092something like
4009494e
GM
10093
10094@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
10095(codepage-setup 1251)
10096(define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
4009494e
GM
10097@end lisp
10098
4009494e 10099
8a1cdce5
AC
10100@node Article Commands
10101@section Article Commands
4009494e 10102
8a1cdce5 10103@table @kbd
4009494e 10104
8a1cdce5
AC
10105@item A P
10106@cindex PostScript
10107@cindex printing
10108@kindex A P (Summary)
10109@vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10110@findex gnus-summary-print-article
10111Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10112(@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10113be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10114article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
4009494e 10115
8a1cdce5
AC
10116@item A C
10117@vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10118@findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10119If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10120fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10121it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10122partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10123the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10124do so.
4009494e 10125
4009494e
GM
10126@end table
10127
10128
8a1cdce5
AC
10129@node Summary Sorting
10130@section Summary Sorting
10131@cindex summary sorting
4009494e 10132
8a1cdce5
AC
10133You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10134can't really see why you'd want that.
4009494e
GM
10135
10136@table @kbd
10137
8a1cdce5
AC
10138@item C-c C-s C-n
10139@kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10140@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10141Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
4009494e 10142
8a1cdce5
AC
10143@item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10144@kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10145@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10146Sort by most recent article number
10147(@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
4009494e 10148
8a1cdce5
AC
10149@item C-c C-s C-a
10150@kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10151@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10152Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
4009494e 10153
8a1cdce5
AC
10154@item C-c C-s C-t
10155@kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10156@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10157Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
4009494e 10158
8a1cdce5
AC
10159@item C-c C-s C-s
10160@kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10161@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10162Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
4009494e 10163
8a1cdce5
AC
10164@item C-c C-s C-d
10165@kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10166@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10167Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
4009494e 10168
8a1cdce5
AC
10169@item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10170@kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10171@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10172Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
4009494e 10173
8a1cdce5
AC
10174@item C-c C-s C-l
10175@kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10176@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10177Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
4009494e 10178
8a1cdce5
AC
10179@item C-c C-s C-c
10180@kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10181@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10182Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
4009494e 10183
8a1cdce5
AC
10184@item C-c C-s C-i
10185@kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10186@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10187Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
4009494e 10188
8a1cdce5
AC
10189@item C-c C-s C-r
10190@kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10191@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10192Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
4009494e 10193
8a1cdce5
AC
10194@item C-c C-s C-o
10195@kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10196@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10197Sort using the default sorting method
10198(@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
4009494e
GM
10199@end table
10200
8a1cdce5
AC
10201These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10202use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10203line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10204root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10205toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10206Commands}).
4009494e 10207
8a1cdce5 10208If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
4009494e 10209
4009494e 10210
8a1cdce5
AC
10211@node Finding the Parent
10212@section Finding the Parent
10213@cindex parent articles
10214@cindex referring articles
4009494e 10215
8a1cdce5
AC
10216@table @kbd
10217@item ^
10218@kindex ^ (Summary)
10219@findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10220If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10221displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10222if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10223and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10224can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10225(@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10226you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10227summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
4009494e 10228
8a1cdce5
AC
10229If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10230the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10231ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10232grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10233@kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10234article.
4009494e 10235
8a1cdce5
AC
10236@item A R (Summary)
10237@findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10238@kindex A R (Summary)
10239Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10240article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
4009494e 10241
8a1cdce5
AC
10242@item A T (Summary)
10243@findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10244@kindex A T (Summary)
10245Display the full thread where the current article appears
10246(@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10247headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10248you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10249to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10250visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10251faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
4009494e 10252
8a1cdce5 10253@vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
1df7defd 10254The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i.e.,
8a1cdce5
AC
10255articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10256fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10257the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10258by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
61b1af82 10259
8a1cdce5
AC
10260@item M-^ (Summary)
10261@findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10262@kindex M-^ (Summary)
10263@cindex Message-ID
10264@cindex fetching by Message-ID
10265You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10266belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10267for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10268thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10269You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
4009494e 10270
8a1cdce5
AC
10271Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10272been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10273@code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10274@end table
4009494e 10275
8a1cdce5
AC
10276@vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10277If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10278support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10279you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10280would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10281updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10282necessary.
4009494e 10283
8a1cdce5
AC
10284It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10285@code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10286is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10287match.
4009494e 10288
8a1cdce5
AC
10289Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10290then ask Google if that fails:
4009494e 10291
8a1cdce5
AC
10292@lisp
10293(setq gnus-refer-article-method
10294 '(current
10295 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10296@end lisp
4009494e 10297
8a1cdce5
AC
10298Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10299do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10300@code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10301articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10302only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10303group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
4009494e 10304
8a1cdce5
AC
10305Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10306articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10307Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10308registry}).
61b1af82 10309
8a1cdce5
AC
10310@node Alternative Approaches
10311@section Alternative Approaches
61b1af82 10312
8a1cdce5
AC
10313Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10314Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
4009494e 10315
8a1cdce5
AC
10316@menu
10317* Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10318* Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10319@end menu
25f28806 10320
4009494e 10321
8a1cdce5
AC
10322@node Pick and Read
10323@subsection Pick and Read
10324@cindex pick and read
10325
10326Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10327a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10328buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10329articles with just an article buffer displayed.
4009494e 10330
8a1cdce5
AC
10331@findex gnus-pick-mode
10332@kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10333Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10334this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10335mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10336it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
4009494e 10337
8a1cdce5 10338Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
4009494e 10339
8a1cdce5
AC
10340@table @kbd
10341@item .
10342@kindex . (Pick)
10343@findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10344Pick the article or thread on the current line
10345(@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10346@code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10347entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10348it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10349thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10350at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
4009494e 10351
8a1cdce5
AC
10352@item SPACE
10353@kindex SPACE (Pick)
10354@findex gnus-pick-next-page
10355Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10356at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
4009494e 10357
8a1cdce5
AC
10358@item u
10359@kindex u (Pick)
10360@findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10361Unpick the thread or article
10362(@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10363@code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10364thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10365just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10366the thread or article at that line.
4009494e 10367
8a1cdce5
AC
10368@item RET
10369@kindex RET (Pick)
10370@findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10371@vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10372Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10373given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10374@code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10375will still be visible when you are reading.
4009494e 10376
8a1cdce5 10377@end table
4009494e 10378
8a1cdce5
AC
10379All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10380pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10381which is mapped to the same function
10382@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10383
10384If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
4009494e
GM
10385
10386@lisp
8a1cdce5 10387(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
4009494e
GM
10388@end lisp
10389
8a1cdce5
AC
10390@vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10391@code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
4009494e 10392
8a1cdce5
AC
10393@vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10394If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10395all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 10396
8a1cdce5
AC
10397@vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10398The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10399standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10400displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10401@code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10402Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10403@code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
4009494e 10404
4009494e 10405
8a1cdce5
AC
10406@node Binary Groups
10407@subsection Binary Groups
10408@cindex binary groups
4009494e 10409
8a1cdce5
AC
10410@findex gnus-binary-mode
10411@kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10412If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10413@kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10414is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10415selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10416instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
4009494e 10417
8a1cdce5
AC
10418@kindex g (Binary)
10419@findex gnus-binary-show-article
10420The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10421command, when you have turned on this mode
10422(@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
4009494e 10423
8a1cdce5
AC
10424@vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10425@code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
4009494e 10426
4009494e 10427
8a1cdce5
AC
10428@node Tree Display
10429@section Tree Display
10430@cindex trees
01c52d31 10431
8a1cdce5
AC
10432@vindex gnus-use-trees
10433If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10434@code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10435additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10436in the tree buffer.
01c52d31 10437
8a1cdce5 10438There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
01c52d31 10439
8a1cdce5
AC
10440@table @code
10441@item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10442@vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10443A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
4009494e 10444
8a1cdce5
AC
10445@item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10446@vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10447A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10448Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10449of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
4009494e 10450
8a1cdce5
AC
10451@item gnus-selected-tree-face
10452@vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10453Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10454default is @code{modeline}.
4009494e 10455
8a1cdce5
AC
10456@item gnus-tree-line-format
10457@vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10458A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10459though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10460is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10461the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10462length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
4009494e 10463
8a1cdce5 10464Valid specs are:
4009494e 10465
8a1cdce5
AC
10466@table @samp
10467@item n
10468The name of the poster.
10469@item f
10470The @code{From} header.
10471@item N
10472The number of the article.
10473@item [
10474The opening bracket.
10475@item ]
10476The closing bracket.
10477@item s
10478The subject.
10479@end table
9b3ebcb6 10480
8a1cdce5 10481@xref{Formatting Variables}.
9b3ebcb6 10482
8a1cdce5 10483Variables related to the display are:
9b3ebcb6 10484
8a1cdce5
AC
10485@table @code
10486@item gnus-tree-brackets
10487@vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10488This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10489``sparse'' articles. The format is
10490@example
10491((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10492 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10493 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10494@end example
10495and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
1d4d7664 10496
8a1cdce5
AC
10497@item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10498@vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10499This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10500nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
4009494e 10501
8a1cdce5 10502@end table
4009494e 10503
8a1cdce5
AC
10504@item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10505@vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10506If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10507buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10508windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10509higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10510have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10511buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10512other windows displayed next to it.
4009494e 10513
8a1cdce5
AC
10514You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10515at all times:
4009494e 10516
8a1cdce5
AC
10517@lisp
10518(add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10519 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10520@end lisp
4009494e 10521
8a1cdce5
AC
10522@item gnus-generate-tree-function
10523@vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10524@findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10525@findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10526The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10527functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10528@code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
4009494e 10529
8a1cdce5 10530@end table
4009494e 10531
8a1cdce5 10532Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
4009494e 10533
8a1cdce5
AC
10534@example
10535@{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10536 | \[Jan]
10537 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10538 | \(***)-[Eri]
10539 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10540 \[Bjo]
10541 \[Gun]
10542 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10543@end example
4009494e 10544
8a1cdce5 10545Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
4009494e 10546
8a1cdce5
AC
10547@example
10548@group
10549@{***@}
10550 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10551(***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10552 |--\-----\-----\ |
10553[odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10554 | | |--\
10555[Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10556 |
10557 [Paa]
10558@end group
10559@end example
4009494e 10560
8a1cdce5
AC
10561If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10562side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10563following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e
GM
10564
10565@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
10566(setq gnus-use-trees t
10567 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10568 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10569(gnus-add-configuration
10570 '(article
10571 (vertical 1.0
10572 (horizontal 0.25
10573 (summary 0.75 point)
10574 (tree 1.0))
10575 (article 1.0))))
4009494e
GM
10576@end lisp
10577
8a1cdce5 10578@xref{Window Layout}.
4009494e 10579
4009494e 10580
8a1cdce5
AC
10581@node Mail Group Commands
10582@section Mail Group Commands
10583@cindex mail group commands
4009494e 10584
8a1cdce5
AC
10585Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10586invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
4009494e 10587
8a1cdce5
AC
10588All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10589process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 10590
8a1cdce5 10591@table @kbd
4009494e 10592
8a1cdce5
AC
10593@item B e
10594@kindex B e (Summary)
10595@findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10596@cindex expiring mail
10597Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10598process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10599expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10600(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
4009494e 10601
8a1cdce5
AC
10602@item B C-M-e
10603@kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10604@findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10605@cindex expiring mail
10606Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10607(@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10608articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10609disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
4009494e 10610
8a1cdce5
AC
10611@item B DEL
10612@kindex B DEL (Summary)
10613@cindex deleting mail
10614@findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10615@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10616Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10617disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10618(@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
4009494e 10619
8a1cdce5
AC
10620@item B m
10621@kindex B m (Summary)
10622@cindex move mail
10623@findex gnus-summary-move-article
10624@vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10625Move the article from one mail group to another
10626(@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10627@code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
4009494e 10628
8a1cdce5
AC
10629@item B c
10630@kindex B c (Summary)
10631@cindex copy mail
10632@findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10633@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10634Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10635(@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10636@code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
4009494e 10637
8a1cdce5
AC
10638@item B B
10639@kindex B B (Summary)
10640@cindex crosspost mail
10641@findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10642Crosspost the current article to some other group
10643(@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10644the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10645be properly updated.
4009494e 10646
8a1cdce5
AC
10647@item B i
10648@kindex B i (Summary)
10649@findex gnus-summary-import-article
10650Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10651(@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10652name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10653
10654@item B I
10655@kindex B I (Summary)
10656@findex gnus-summary-create-article
10657Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10658(@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10659@code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10660
10661@item B r
10662@kindex B r (Summary)
10663@findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10664@vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10665Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10666@code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10667select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10668which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10669Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10670(which is the default).
10671
10672@item B w
10673@itemx e
10674@kindex B w (Summary)
10675@kindex e (Summary)
10676@findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10677@kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10678@findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10679Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10680editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10681(@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10682@kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
4009494e 10683
8a1cdce5
AC
10684@item B q
10685@kindex B q (Summary)
10686@findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10687If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10688the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10689will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
4009494e 10690
8a1cdce5
AC
10691@item B t
10692@kindex B t (Summary)
10693@findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10694Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10695when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
4009494e 10696
8a1cdce5
AC
10697@item B p
10698@kindex B p (Summary)
10699@findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10700Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10701follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10702@code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10703(@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10704article from your news server (or rather, from
10705@code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10706report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10707it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10708propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10709just not have arrived yet.
4009494e 10710
8a1cdce5
AC
10711@item K E
10712@kindex K E (Summary)
10713@findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10714@vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10715Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10716The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10717variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
4009494e 10718
8a1cdce5 10719@end table
4009494e 10720
8a1cdce5
AC
10721@vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10722@cindex moving articles
10723If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10724suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10725variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10726(@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10727suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10728@code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10729@code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
4009494e
GM
10730
10731@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
10732(setq gnus-move-split-methods
10733 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10734 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10735 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
4009494e
GM
10736@end lisp
10737
4009494e 10738
8a1cdce5
AC
10739@node Various Summary Stuff
10740@section Various Summary Stuff
4009494e 10741
8a1cdce5
AC
10742@menu
10743* Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10744* Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10745* Summary Generation Commands::
10746* Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10747@end menu
4009494e 10748
8a1cdce5
AC
10749@table @code
10750@vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10751@item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10752If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10753built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10754If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10755lines. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 10756
8a1cdce5
AC
10757@vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10758@item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10759If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10760current article.
4009494e 10761
8a1cdce5
AC
10762@vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10763@item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10764This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
4009494e 10765
8a1cdce5
AC
10766@vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10767@item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10768This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10769generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10770the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10771is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10772have been set.
4009494e 10773
8a1cdce5
AC
10774@vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10775@item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10776It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10777it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10778some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
4009494e 10779
8a1cdce5
AC
10780@vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10781@item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10782A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10783generated.
4009494e 10784
8a1cdce5
AC
10785@vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10786@item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10787When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10788it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10789same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10790sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10791If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10792@code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10793any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10794article---it'll be as if it never existed.
4009494e 10795
8a1cdce5
AC
10796@vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10797@item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10798This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10799of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10800list of articles to be selected.
4009494e 10801
8a1cdce5
AC
10802For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10803the list in one particular group:
4009494e
GM
10804
10805@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
10806(defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10807 (if (string= group "some.group")
10808 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10809 articles))
4009494e
GM
10810@end lisp
10811
8a1cdce5
AC
10812@vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10813@item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10814A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10815variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10816values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10817buffer is active.
4009494e 10818
8a1cdce5
AC
10819Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10820@code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10821assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10822that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10823variable will be used instead.
10824
10825These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10826while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10827buffers. For example:
4009494e
GM
10828
10829@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
10830(setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10831 '(message-use-followup-to
10832 (gnus-visible-headers .
10833 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
4009494e
GM
10834@end lisp
10835
8a1cdce5 10836Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
4009494e 10837
8a1cdce5 10838@end table
4009494e
GM
10839
10840
8a1cdce5
AC
10841@node Summary Group Information
10842@subsection Summary Group Information
4009494e
GM
10843
10844@table @kbd
10845
8a1cdce5
AC
10846@item H d
10847@kindex H d (Summary)
10848@findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10849Give a brief description of the current group
10850(@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10851rereading the description from the server.
4009494e 10852
8a1cdce5
AC
10853@item H h
10854@kindex H h (Summary)
10855@findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10856Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10857keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
8ccbef23 10858
8a1cdce5
AC
10859@item H i
10860@kindex H i (Summary)
10861@findex gnus-info-find-node
10862Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4009494e
GM
10863@end table
10864
10865
8a1cdce5
AC
10866@node Searching for Articles
10867@subsection Searching for Articles
4009494e
GM
10868
10869@table @kbd
10870
8a1cdce5
AC
10871@item M-s
10872@kindex M-s (Summary)
10873@findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10874Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10875(@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
4009494e 10876
8a1cdce5
AC
10877@item M-r
10878@kindex M-r (Summary)
10879@findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10880Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10881(@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
6ecfe5c2 10882
8a1cdce5
AC
10883@item M-S
10884@kindex M-S (Summary)
10885@findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10886Repeat the previous search forwards
10887(@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
4009494e 10888
8a1cdce5
AC
10889@item M-R
10890@kindex M-R (Summary)
10891@findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10892Repeat the previous search backwards
10893(@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
01c52d31 10894
8a1cdce5
AC
10895@item &
10896@kindex & (Summary)
10897@findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10898This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10899on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10900(@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10901string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10902search backward instead.
4009494e 10903
8a1cdce5
AC
10904For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10905all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
4009494e 10906
8a1cdce5
AC
10907@item M-&
10908@kindex M-& (Summary)
10909@findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10910Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10911the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10912@end table
6ecfe5c2 10913
8a1cdce5
AC
10914@node Summary Generation Commands
10915@subsection Summary Generation Commands
4009494e 10916
8a1cdce5 10917@table @kbd
4009494e 10918
8a1cdce5
AC
10919@item Y g
10920@kindex Y g (Summary)
10921@findex gnus-summary-prepare
10922Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
4009494e 10923
8a1cdce5
AC
10924@item Y c
10925@kindex Y c (Summary)
10926@findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10927Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10928(@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
4009494e 10929
8a1cdce5
AC
10930@item Y d
10931@kindex Y d (Summary)
10932@findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10933Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10934(@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
4009494e 10935
8a1cdce5
AC
10936@item Y t
10937@kindex Y t (Summary)
10938@findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10939Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10940(@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
4009494e 10941
8a1cdce5 10942@end table
6ecfe5c2 10943
4009494e 10944
8a1cdce5
AC
10945@node Really Various Summary Commands
10946@subsection Really Various Summary Commands
4009494e
GM
10947
10948@table @kbd
4009494e 10949
8a1cdce5
AC
10950@item A D
10951@itemx C-d
10952@kindex C-d (Summary)
10953@kindex A D (Summary)
10954@findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10955If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10956a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10957article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10958guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10959to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10960whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10961some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10962fashion.
4009494e 10963
8a1cdce5
AC
10964@vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10965The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10966article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10967include:
4009494e 10968
8a1cdce5
AC
10969@table @code
10970@item next
10971Select the next article.
4009494e 10972
8a1cdce5
AC
10973@item next-unread
10974Select the next unread article.
4009494e 10975
8a1cdce5
AC
10976@item next-noselect
10977Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
4009494e 10978
8a1cdce5
AC
10979@item next-unread-noselect
10980Move the cursor to the next unread article.
4009494e
GM
10981@end table
10982
8a1cdce5
AC
10983If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10984article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
4009494e 10985
8a1cdce5
AC
10986@item C-M-d
10987@kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10988@findex gnus-summary-read-document
10989This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10990several documents into one biiig group
10991(@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10992@code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10993@code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10994command understands the process/prefix convention
10995(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 10996
8a1cdce5
AC
10997@item C-t
10998@kindex C-t (Summary)
10999@findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
11000Toggle truncation of summary lines
11001(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
11002line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
11003to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
4009494e 11004
8a1cdce5
AC
11005@item =
11006@kindex = (Summary)
11007@findex gnus-summary-expand-window
11008Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
11009If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
4009494e 11010
8a1cdce5
AC
11011@item C-M-e
11012@kindex C-M-e (Summary)
11013@findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
11014Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11015group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
4009494e 11016
8a1cdce5
AC
11017@item C-M-a
11018@kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11019@findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11020Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11021group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
4009494e 11022
8a1cdce5 11023@end table
4009494e 11024
4009494e 11025
8a1cdce5
AC
11026@node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11027@section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11028@cindex summary exit
11029@cindex exiting groups
4009494e 11030
8a1cdce5
AC
11031Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11032group and return you to the group buffer.
4009494e 11033
8a1cdce5 11034@table @kbd
4009494e 11035
8a1cdce5
AC
11036@item Z Z
11037@itemx Z Q
11038@itemx q
11039@kindex Z Z (Summary)
11040@kindex Z Q (Summary)
11041@kindex q (Summary)
11042@findex gnus-summary-exit
11043@vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11044@vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11045@vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11046@c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11047Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11048(@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11049called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11050@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11051@code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11052process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11053group mode having no more (unread) groups.
4009494e 11054
8a1cdce5
AC
11055@item Z E
11056@itemx Q
11057@kindex Z E (Summary)
11058@kindex Q (Summary)
11059@findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11060Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11061(@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
4009494e 11062
8a1cdce5
AC
11063@item Z c
11064@itemx c
11065@kindex Z c (Summary)
11066@kindex c (Summary)
11067@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11068@c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11069Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11070(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
4009494e 11071
8a1cdce5
AC
11072@item Z C
11073@kindex Z C (Summary)
11074@findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11075Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11076(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
4009494e 11077
8a1cdce5
AC
11078@item Z n
11079@kindex Z n (Summary)
11080@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11081Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11082(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
4009494e 11083
8a1cdce5
AC
11084@item Z p
11085@kindex Z p (Summary)
11086@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11087Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11088(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
4009494e 11089
8a1cdce5
AC
11090@item Z R
11091@itemx C-x C-s
11092@kindex Z R (Summary)
11093@kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11094@findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11095Exit this group, and then enter it again
11096(@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11097all articles, both read and unread.
4009494e 11098
8a1cdce5
AC
11099@item Z G
11100@itemx M-g
11101@kindex Z G (Summary)
11102@kindex M-g (Summary)
11103@findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11104@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11105Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11106group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11107articles, both read and unread.
4009494e 11108
8a1cdce5
AC
11109@item Z N
11110@kindex Z N (Summary)
11111@findex gnus-summary-next-group
11112Exit the group and go to the next group
11113(@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
4009494e 11114
8a1cdce5
AC
11115@item Z P
11116@kindex Z P (Summary)
11117@findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11118Exit the group and go to the previous group
11119(@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
4009494e 11120
8a1cdce5
AC
11121@item Z s
11122@kindex Z s (Summary)
11123@findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11124Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11125and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11126given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11127command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11128@end table
4009494e 11129
8a1cdce5
AC
11130@vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11131@code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11132with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11133(@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
4009494e 11134
8a1cdce5
AC
11135@findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11136@findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11137@vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11138If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11139about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11140If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11141(Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11142something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11143called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11144buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11145@code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11146summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
4009494e 11147
8a1cdce5 11148There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
4009494e 11149
8a1cdce5
AC
11150@vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11151The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
65e7ca35 11152read, which articles you have replied to, etc.)@: when you exit the
8a1cdce5
AC
11153summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11154@code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11155this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11156other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11157neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11158both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
4009494e 11159
4009494e 11160
8a1cdce5
AC
11161@node Crosspost Handling
11162@section Crosspost Handling
4009494e 11163
8a1cdce5
AC
11164@cindex velveeta
11165@cindex spamming
11166Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11167read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11168posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11169several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11170by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11171heinous crime.
4009494e 11172
8a1cdce5
AC
11173Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11174separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11175@dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11176@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11177excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
4009494e 11178
8a1cdce5
AC
11179@cindex cross-posting
11180@cindex Xref
11181@cindex @acronym{NOV}
11182One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11183correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11184(which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11185does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11186Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11187even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11188articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11189them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11190the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11191the cross reference mechanism.
4009494e 11192
8a1cdce5
AC
11193@cindex LIST overview.fmt
11194@cindex overview.fmt
11195To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11196in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11197@samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11198overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11199get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11200your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11201overview files.
4009494e 11202
8a1cdce5
AC
11203If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11204set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11205considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
4009494e 11206
8a1cdce5 11207C'est la vie.
4009494e 11208
8a1cdce5 11209For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
4009494e 11210
4009494e 11211
8a1cdce5
AC
11212@node Duplicate Suppression
11213@section Duplicate Suppression
4009494e 11214
8a1cdce5
AC
11215By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11216article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11217(@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11218approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11219reasons.
4009494e 11220
8a1cdce5
AC
11221@enumerate
11222@item
11223The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11224is evil and not very common.
4009494e 11225
8a1cdce5
AC
11226@item
11227The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11228@file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
4009494e 11229
8a1cdce5
AC
11230@item
11231You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11232different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
4009494e 11233
8a1cdce5
AC
11234@item
11235You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11236@end enumerate
4009494e 11237
8a1cdce5
AC
11238I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11239well, but these four are the most common situations.
4009494e 11240
8a1cdce5
AC
11241If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11242consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11243will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11244otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11245all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11246mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11247so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11248once.
4009494e 11249
8a1cdce5
AC
11250Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11251sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11252fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11253to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11254article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11255saw the article in.
4009494e 11256
8a1cdce5
AC
11257@table @code
11258@item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11259@vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11260If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
4009494e 11261
8a1cdce5
AC
11262@item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11263@vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11264If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11265make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11266However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11267session are suppressed.
4009494e 11268
8a1cdce5
AC
11269@item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11270@vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11271This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11272suppression list. The default is 10000.
4009494e 11273
8a1cdce5
AC
11274@item gnus-duplicate-file
11275@vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11276The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11277default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
4009494e
GM
11278@end table
11279
8a1cdce5
AC
11280If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11281@code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11282you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11283the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11284so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11285@code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11286to you to figure out, I think.
4009494e 11287
8a1cdce5
AC
11288@node Security
11289@section Security
4009494e 11290
8a1cdce5
AC
11291Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11292The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11293and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11294things to work:
4009494e 11295
8a1cdce5
AC
11296@enumerate
11297@item
11298To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
1df7defd 11299install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG@. The Lisp interface
8a1cdce5
AC
11300to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11301epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11302PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
4009494e 11303
8a1cdce5 11304@item
1df7defd 11305To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL@. OpenSSL 0.9.6
8a1cdce5 11306or newer is recommended.
4009494e 11307
8a1cdce5 11308@end enumerate
4009494e 11309
8a1cdce5
AC
11310The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11311messages include:
11312
11313@table @code
11314@item mm-verify-option
11315@vindex mm-verify-option
11316Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11317@code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11318protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
4009494e 11319
8a1cdce5
AC
11320@item mm-decrypt-option
11321@vindex mm-decrypt-option
11322Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11323@code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11324protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
4009494e 11325
8a1cdce5
AC
11326@item mm-sign-option
11327@vindex mm-sign-option
11328Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11329keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
4009494e 11330
8a1cdce5
AC
11331@item mm-encrypt-option
11332@vindex mm-encrypt-option
11333Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11334public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11335@code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
4009494e 11336
8a1cdce5
AC
11337@item mml1991-use
11338@vindex mml1991-use
11339Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11340@acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11341and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11342deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11343this order.
4009494e 11344
8a1cdce5
AC
11345@item mml2015-use
11346@vindex mml2015-use
11347Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11348@acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11349@code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11350although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11351interface in this order.
4009494e 11352
8a1cdce5 11353@end table
4009494e 11354
8a1cdce5
AC
11355By default the buttons that display security information are not
11356shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11357@kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11358@code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11359@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11360permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11361how to customize these variables to always display security
11362information.
4009494e 11363
8a1cdce5
AC
11364@cindex snarfing keys
11365@cindex importing PGP keys
11366@cindex PGP key ring import
11367Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11368key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11369rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11370allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11371through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11372@file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11373Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11374Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11375(@pxref{Using MIME}).
4009494e 11376
8a1cdce5
AC
11377@example
11378application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11379@end example
11380@noindent
11381This happens to also be the default action defined in
11382@code{mailcap-mime-data}.
4009494e 11383
8a1cdce5
AC
11384More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11385encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11386(@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
4009494e 11387
8a1cdce5
AC
11388@node Mailing List
11389@section Mailing List
11390@cindex mailing list
11391@cindex RFC 2396
4009494e 11392
8a1cdce5
AC
11393@kindex A M (summary)
11394@findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11395Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11396add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11397possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11398summary buffer.
4009494e 11399
8a1cdce5 11400That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
4009494e 11401
8a1cdce5 11402@table @kbd
4009494e 11403
8a1cdce5
AC
11404@item C-c C-n h
11405@kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11406@findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11407Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
4009494e 11408
8a1cdce5
AC
11409@item C-c C-n s
11410@kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11411@findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11412Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
4009494e 11413
8a1cdce5
AC
11414@item C-c C-n u
11415@kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11416@findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11417Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11418field exists.
4009494e 11419
8a1cdce5
AC
11420@item C-c C-n p
11421@kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11422@findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11423Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
4009494e 11424
8a1cdce5
AC
11425@item C-c C-n o
11426@kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11427@findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11428Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
4009494e 11429
8a1cdce5
AC
11430@item C-c C-n a
11431@kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11432@findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11433Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
4009494e 11434
8a1cdce5 11435@end table
4009494e 11436
4009494e 11437
8a1cdce5
AC
11438@node Article Buffer
11439@chapter Article Buffer
11440@cindex article buffer
4009494e 11441
8a1cdce5
AC
11442The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11443one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11444tell Gnus otherwise.
4009494e
GM
11445
11446@menu
8a1cdce5
AC
11447* Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11448* Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11449* HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11450* Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11451* Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11452* Misc Article:: Other stuff.
4009494e
GM
11453@end menu
11454
4009494e 11455
8a1cdce5
AC
11456@node Hiding Headers
11457@section Hiding Headers
11458@cindex hiding headers
11459@cindex deleting headers
4009494e 11460
8a1cdce5
AC
11461The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11462@dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
4009494e 11463
8a1cdce5
AC
11464@vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11465There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11466who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11467article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11468most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11469through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11470@code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11471of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11472article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
4009494e 11473
8a1cdce5 11474Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
4009494e 11475
8a1cdce5 11476@table @code
4009494e 11477
8a1cdce5
AC
11478@item gnus-visible-headers
11479@vindex gnus-visible-headers
11480If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11481that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11482headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
4009494e 11483
8a1cdce5
AC
11484For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11485the article and the subject, you'd say:
4009494e
GM
11486
11487@lisp
8a1cdce5 11488(setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
4009494e
GM
11489@end lisp
11490
8a1cdce5
AC
11491This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11492remain visible.
4009494e 11493
8a1cdce5
AC
11494@item gnus-ignored-headers
11495@vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11496This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11497variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11498should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11499hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
4009494e 11500
8a1cdce5
AC
11501For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11502and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
4009494e
GM
11503
11504@lisp
8a1cdce5 11505(setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
4009494e
GM
11506@end lisp
11507
8a1cdce5
AC
11508This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11509be removed.
3a23a519 11510
8a1cdce5
AC
11511Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11512variable will have no effect.
3a23a519 11513
4009494e
GM
11514@end table
11515
8a1cdce5
AC
11516@vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11517Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11518can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11519variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11520the headers are to be displayed.
4009494e 11521
8a1cdce5
AC
11522For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11523and then the subject, you might say something like:
4009494e 11524
8a1cdce5
AC
11525@lisp
11526(setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11527@end lisp
4009494e 11528
8a1cdce5
AC
11529Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11530variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
4009494e 11531
8a1cdce5
AC
11532@findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11533@vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11534You can hide further boring headers by setting
11535@code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11536does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11537list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11538lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11539from sight.
4009494e 11540
8a1cdce5
AC
11541These conditions are:
11542@table @code
11543@item empty
11544Remove all empty headers.
11545@item followup-to
11546Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11547@code{Newsgroups} header.
11548@item reply-to
11549Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11550the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11551parameter is set.
11552@item newsgroups
11553Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11554name.
11555@item to-address
11556Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11557the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11558@item to-list
11559Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11560the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11561@item cc-list
11562Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11563the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11564@item date
11565Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11566old.
11567@item long-to
11568Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11569@item many-to
11570Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
4009494e
GM
11571@end table
11572
8a1cdce5 11573To include these three elements, you could say something like:
4009494e 11574
8a1cdce5
AC
11575@lisp
11576(setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11577 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11578@end lisp
4009494e 11579
8a1cdce5 11580This is also the default value for this variable.
4009494e 11581
4009494e 11582
8a1cdce5
AC
11583@node Using MIME
11584@section Using MIME
11585@cindex @acronym{MIME}
4009494e 11586
8a1cdce5
AC
11587Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11588while people stand around yawning.
01c52d31 11589
8a1cdce5
AC
11590@acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11591while all newsreaders die of fear.
01c52d31 11592
8a1cdce5
AC
11593@acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11594of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11595other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
4009494e 11596
8a1cdce5
AC
11597@vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11598@findex gnus-display-mime
11599Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11600to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11601default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11602display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
4009494e 11603
8a1cdce5
AC
11604The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11605@acronym{MIME} button:
11606
11607@table @kbd
11608@findex gnus-article-press-button
11609@item RET (Article)
11610@kindex RET (Article)
11611@itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11612Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11613(@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11614the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11615files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11616object is displayed inline.
11617
11618@findex gnus-mime-view-part
11619@item M-RET (Article)
11620@kindex M-RET (Article)
11621@itemx v (Article)
11622Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11623method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11624
11625@findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11626@item t (Article)
11627@kindex t (Article)
11628View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11629(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11630
11631@findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11632@item C (Article)
11633@kindex C (Article)
11634Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11635charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
4009494e 11636
8a1cdce5
AC
11637@findex gnus-mime-save-part
11638@item o (Article)
11639@kindex o (Article)
11640Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11641(@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
4009494e 11642
8a1cdce5
AC
11643@findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11644@item C-o (Article)
11645@kindex C-o (Article)
11646Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11647the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11648suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11649like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11650message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11651(@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
4009494e 11652
8a1cdce5
AC
11653@findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11654@item r (Article)
11655@kindex r (Article)
11656Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
fac916bf 11657external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
8a1cdce5 11658@acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
4009494e 11659
8a1cdce5
AC
11660@findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11661@item d (Article)
11662@kindex d (Article)
11663Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11664information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11665(@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
4009494e 11666
8a1cdce5 11667@c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
4009494e 11668
8a1cdce5
AC
11669@findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11670@item c (Article)
11671@kindex c (Article)
11672Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11673(@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11674without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11675charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11676@ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11677@file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11678@code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11679Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
01c52d31 11680
8a1cdce5
AC
11681@findex gnus-mime-print-part
11682@item p (Article)
11683@kindex p (Article)
11684Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11685command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11686@file{.mailcap} file.
4009494e 11687
8a1cdce5
AC
11688@findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11689@item i (Article)
11690@kindex i (Article)
11691Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11692(@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11693the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11694do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11695@code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11696Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11697automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11698@code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11699Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
4009494e 11700
8a1cdce5
AC
11701@findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11702@item E (Article)
11703@kindex E (Article)
11704View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11705viewer is available, use an external viewer
11706(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
4009494e 11707
8a1cdce5
AC
11708@findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11709@item e (Article)
11710@kindex e (Article)
11711View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11712(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
4009494e 11713
8a1cdce5
AC
11714@findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11715@item | (Article)
11716@kindex | (Article)
11717Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
4009494e 11718
8a1cdce5
AC
11719@findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11720@item . (Article)
11721@kindex . (Article)
11722Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11723(@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
01c52d31 11724
8a1cdce5 11725@end table
01c52d31 11726
8a1cdce5
AC
11727Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11728determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11729@acronym{MIME} manual.
01c52d31 11730
8a1cdce5
AC
11731It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11732buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11733group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11734decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11735comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11736because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11737try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11738to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11739to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
01c52d31 11740
8a1cdce5 11741Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
01c52d31 11742
8a1cdce5 11743Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
01c52d31 11744
4009494e 11745
8a1cdce5
AC
11746@node HTML
11747@section @acronym{HTML}
11748@cindex @acronym{HTML}
4009494e 11749
8a1cdce5
AC
11750If you have @code{w3m} installed on your system, Gnus can display
11751@acronym{HTML} articles in the article buffer. There are many Gnus
11752add-ons for doing this, using various approaches, but there's one
11753(sort of) built-in method that's used by default.
4009494e 11754
8a1cdce5
AC
11755For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization,
11756,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This
11757section only describes the default method.
4009494e 11758
8a1cdce5
AC
11759@table @code
11760@item mm-text-html-renderer
11761@vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11762If set to @code{gnus-article-html}, Gnus will use the built-in method,
11763that's based on @code{w3m}.
4009494e 11764
8a1cdce5
AC
11765@item gnus-blocked-images
11766@vindex gnus-blocked-images
11767External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11768be fetched and displayed. For instance, do block all @acronym{URL}s
11769that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
4009494e 11770
8a1cdce5
AC
11771@lisp
11772(setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11773@end lisp
4009494e 11774
8a1cdce5
AC
11775This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11776called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11777@code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11778anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11779will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11780web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
4009494e 11781
8a1cdce5 11782Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
4009494e 11783
8a1cdce5
AC
11784@item gnus-html-cache-directory
11785@vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11786Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11787@code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11788this directory.
4009494e 11789
8a1cdce5
AC
11790@item gnus-html-cache-size
11791@vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11792When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11793directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
4009494e 11794
8a1cdce5
AC
11795@item gnus-html-frame-width
11796@vindex gnus-html-frame-width
1df7defd 11797The width to use when rendering HTML@. The default is 70.
4009494e 11798
8a1cdce5
AC
11799@item gnus-max-image-proportion
11800@vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11801How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11802A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
1180370% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11804this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11805fit these criteria.
4009494e 11806
8a1cdce5 11807@end table
4009494e 11808
8a1cdce5
AC
11809To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11810installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
fe3c5669 11811automatically.
4009494e 11812
01c52d31 11813
4009494e 11814
8a1cdce5
AC
11815@node Customizing Articles
11816@section Customizing Articles
11817@cindex article customization
4009494e 11818
8a1cdce5
AC
11819A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11820exist. You can call these functions interactively
11821(@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11822called automatically when you select the articles.
4009494e 11823
8a1cdce5
AC
11824To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11825``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11826@code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11827be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
4009494e 11828
8a1cdce5
AC
11829Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11830for sensible values.
4009494e 11831
8a1cdce5
AC
11832@enumerate
11833@item
11834@code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
4009494e 11835
8a1cdce5
AC
11836@item
11837@code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
4009494e 11838
8a1cdce5
AC
11839@item
11840@code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
4009494e 11841
8a1cdce5
AC
11842@item
11843@code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
4009494e 11844
8a1cdce5
AC
11845@item
11846@code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
4009494e 11847
8a1cdce5
AC
11848@item
11849An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11850than this number.
4009494e 11851
8a1cdce5
AC
11852@item
11853A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11854articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11855regexps in the list.
4009494e 11856
8a1cdce5
AC
11857@item
11858A list where the first element is not a string:
4009494e 11859
8a1cdce5
AC
11860The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11861predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11862@code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
4009494e 11863
8a1cdce5
AC
11864@lisp
11865(or last
11866 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11867@end lisp
4009494e 11868
47cc1156
G
11869@item
11870A function: the function is called with no arguments and should return
11871@code{nil} or non-@code{nil}. The current article is available in the
11872buffer named by @code{gnus-article-buffer}.
11873
8a1cdce5 11874@end enumerate
4009494e 11875
8a1cdce5
AC
11876You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11877to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11878be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11879considered to contain just a single part.
4009494e 11880
8a1cdce5
AC
11881@vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11882Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11883want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11884treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11885variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11886type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11887controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
4009494e 11888
8a1cdce5
AC
11889@ifinfo
11890@c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11891@c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11892@c `i foo-bar'.
11893@vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11894@vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11895@vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11896@vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11897@vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11898@vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11899@vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11900@vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11901@vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11902@vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11903@vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11904@vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
12e3ca0a 11905@vindex gnus-treat-date
8a1cdce5
AC
11906@vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11907@vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11908@vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11909@vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11910@vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11911@vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11912@vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11913@vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11914@vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11915@vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11916@vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11917@vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11918@vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11919@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11920@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11921@vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11922@vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11923@vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11924@vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11925@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11926@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11927@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11928@vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11929@vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11930@vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11931@vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11932@vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11933@vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11934@end ifinfo
4009494e 11935
8a1cdce5
AC
11936The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11937customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11938group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11939possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
4009494e 11940
8a1cdce5
AC
11941@table @code
11942@item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11943@item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
4009494e 11944
8a1cdce5 11945@xref{Article Buttons}.
4009494e 11946
8a1cdce5
AC
11947@item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11948@item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11949@item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11950@item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11951@item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11952@item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11953@item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11954@item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11955@item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11956@item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
4009494e 11957
8a1cdce5 11958@xref{Article Washing}.
4009494e 11959
12e3ca0a
LI
11960@item gnus-treat-date (head)
11961
11962This will transform/add date headers according to the
11963@code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11964headers to display. The formats available are:
11965
11966@table @code
11967@item ut
11968Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11969
11970@item local
11971The user's local time zone.
11972
11973@item english
11974A semi-readable English sentence.
11975
11976@item lapsed
11977The time elapsed since the message was posted.
11978
d76c843e 11979@item combined-lapsed
12e3ca0a
LI
11980Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
11981
11982@item original
11983The original date header.
11984
11985@item iso8601
11986ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
11987
11988@item user-defined
11989A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
11990variable.
11991
11992@end table
4009494e 11993
8a1cdce5 11994@xref{Article Date}.
4009494e 11995
8a1cdce5
AC
11996@item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11997@item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11998@item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
4009494e 11999
8a1cdce5 12000@xref{Picons}.
4009494e 12001
8a1cdce5
AC
12002@item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
12003@item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
4009494e 12004
8a1cdce5 12005@xref{Gravatars}.
4009494e 12006
8a1cdce5 12007@item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
4009494e 12008
8a1cdce5 12009@item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
4009494e 12010
8a1cdce5
AC
12011@vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
12012Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
12013is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
4009494e 12014
8a1cdce5 12015@xref{Smileys}.
4009494e 12016
8a1cdce5
AC
12017@vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12018@item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
4009494e 12019
8a1cdce5 12020@xref{X-Face}.
4009494e 12021
8a1cdce5
AC
12022@vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12023@item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
4009494e 12024
8a1cdce5 12025@xref{Face}.
4009494e 12026
8a1cdce5
AC
12027@vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12028@item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12029@vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12030@item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12031@vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12032@item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12033@vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12034@item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12035@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12036@item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12037@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12038@item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12039@vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12040@item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12041@vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12042@item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12043@vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12044@item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12045@vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12046@item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
4009494e 12047
8a1cdce5 12048@xref{Article Hiding}.
4009494e 12049
8a1cdce5
AC
12050@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12051@item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12052@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12053@item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12054@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12055@item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
4009494e 12056
8a1cdce5 12057@xref{Article Highlighting}.
4146636e 12058
8a1cdce5
AC
12059@vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12060@item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12061@item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12062@vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12063@item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
4146636e 12064
8a1cdce5
AC
12065@vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12066@item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12067@vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12068@item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12069@vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12070@item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12071@vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12072@item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12073
12074@xref{Article Header}.
4009494e 12075
4009494e
GM
12076
12077@end table
12078
8a1cdce5
AC
12079@vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12080You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12081@code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12082part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12083information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12084everything.
4009494e 12085
4009494e 12086
8a1cdce5
AC
12087@node Article Keymap
12088@section Article Keymap
4009494e 12089
8a1cdce5
AC
12090Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12091article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12092buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12093buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12094buffer.
4009494e 12095
8a1cdce5
AC
12096@kindex v (Article)
12097@cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12098The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12099command or better use it as a prefix key.
4009494e 12100
8a1cdce5 12101A few additional keystrokes are available:
4009494e 12102
8a1cdce5
AC
12103@table @kbd
12104
12105@item SPACE
12106@kindex SPACE (Article)
12107@findex gnus-article-next-page
12108Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12109This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12110
12111@item DEL
12112@kindex DEL (Article)
12113@findex gnus-article-prev-page
12114Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12115This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
4009494e 12116
8a1cdce5
AC
12117@item C-c ^
12118@kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12119@findex gnus-article-refer-article
12120If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12121@kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12122(@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
4009494e 12123
8a1cdce5
AC
12124@item C-c C-m
12125@kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12126@findex gnus-article-mail
12127Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12128given a prefix, include the mail.
4009494e 12129
8a1cdce5
AC
12130@item s
12131@kindex s (Article)
12132@findex gnus-article-show-summary
12133Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12134(@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
4009494e 12135
8a1cdce5
AC
12136@item ?
12137@kindex ? (Article)
12138@findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12139Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12140(@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
4009494e 12141
8a1cdce5
AC
12142@item TAB
12143@kindex TAB (Article)
12144@findex gnus-article-next-button
12145Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12146only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
4009494e 12147
8a1cdce5
AC
12148@item M-TAB
12149@kindex M-TAB (Article)
12150@findex gnus-article-prev-button
12151Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
4009494e 12152
8a1cdce5
AC
12153@item R
12154@kindex R (Article)
12155@findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12156Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12157(@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12158only yank the text in the region.
4009494e 12159
8a1cdce5
AC
12160@item S W
12161@kindex S W (Article)
12162@findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12163Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12164(@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12165active, only yank the text in the region.
4009494e 12166
8a1cdce5
AC
12167@item F
12168@kindex F (Article)
12169@findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12170Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12171(@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12172only yank the text in the region.
4009494e 12173
4009494e 12174
8a1cdce5 12175@end table
4009494e 12176
4009494e 12177
8a1cdce5
AC
12178@node Misc Article
12179@section Misc Article
4009494e 12180
8a1cdce5 12181@table @code
4009494e 12182
8a1cdce5
AC
12183@item gnus-single-article-buffer
12184@vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12185@cindex article buffers, several
12186If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12187(This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12188article buffer.
4009494e 12189
8a1cdce5
AC
12190@item gnus-widen-article-window
12191@cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12192If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12193command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
4009494e 12194
8a1cdce5
AC
12195@vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12196@item gnus-article-decode-hook
12197@cindex @acronym{MIME}
12198Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12199@code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
4009494e 12200
8a1cdce5
AC
12201@vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12202@item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12203This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12204article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12205depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12206the contents of the article buffer.
4009494e 12207
8a1cdce5
AC
12208@item gnus-article-mode-hook
12209@vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12210Hook called in article mode buffers.
4009494e 12211
8a1cdce5
AC
12212@item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12213@vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12214Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12215@code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
4009494e 12216
8a1cdce5
AC
12217@vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12218@item gnus-article-over-scroll
12219If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12220no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 12221
8a1cdce5
AC
12222@vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12223@item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12224This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12225@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12226Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12227with two extensions:
4009494e 12228
8a1cdce5 12229@table @samp
4009494e 12230
8a1cdce5
AC
12231@item w
12232The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12233character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12234performed. The characters and their meaning:
4009494e 12235
8a1cdce5 12236@table @samp
4009494e 12237
8a1cdce5
AC
12238@item c
12239Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
4009494e 12240
8a1cdce5
AC
12241@item h
12242Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
4009494e 12243
8a1cdce5
AC
12244@item p
12245Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12246hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
1df7defd 12247security status, i.e., good or bad signature.)
4009494e 12248
8a1cdce5
AC
12249@item s
12250Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
4009494e 12251
8a1cdce5
AC
12252@item o
12253Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
4009494e 12254
8a1cdce5
AC
12255@item e
12256Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
4009494e 12257
8a1cdce5 12258@end table
4009494e 12259
8a1cdce5
AC
12260@item m
12261The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
4009494e 12262
4009494e
GM
12263@end table
12264
8a1cdce5
AC
12265@vindex gnus-break-pages
12266
12267@item gnus-break-pages
12268Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12269is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12270page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12271paging will not be done.
4009494e 12272
8a1cdce5
AC
12273@item gnus-page-delimiter
12274@vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12275This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12276(formfeed).
4009494e 12277
8a1cdce5
AC
12278@cindex IDNA
12279@cindex internationalized domain names
12280@vindex gnus-use-idna
12281@item gnus-use-idna
12282This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12283internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12284@samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12285for how to compose such messages. This requires
12286@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12287variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
4009494e 12288
8a1cdce5
AC
12289@vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12290@item gnus-inhibit-images
12291If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12292article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12293@acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12294when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12295,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12296@code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
4009494e 12297
8a1cdce5 12298@end table
4009494e 12299
4009494e 12300
8a1cdce5
AC
12301@node Composing Messages
12302@chapter Composing Messages
12303@cindex composing messages
12304@cindex messages
12305@cindex mail
12306@cindex sending mail
12307@cindex reply
12308@cindex followup
12309@cindex post
12310@cindex using gpg
12311@cindex using s/mime
12312@cindex using smime
4009494e 12313
8a1cdce5
AC
12314@kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12315All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12316where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12317article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12318Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12319on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
4009494e 12320
8a1cdce5
AC
12321@menu
12322* Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12323* Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12324* POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12325* Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12326* Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12327* Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12328* Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12329* Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12330* Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12331@end menu
4009494e 12332
8a1cdce5
AC
12333Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12334remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
4009494e 12335
4009494e 12336
8a1cdce5
AC
12337@node Mail
12338@section Mail
4009494e 12339
8a1cdce5 12340Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
4009494e 12341
8a1cdce5
AC
12342@table @code
12343@item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12344@vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12345List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12346headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12347@code{nil} include all headers.
4009494e 12348
8a1cdce5
AC
12349@item gnus-add-to-list
12350@vindex gnus-add-to-list
12351If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12352that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
4009494e 12353
8a1cdce5
AC
12354@item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12355@vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12356If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12357about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12358interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12359receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12360non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12361matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
4009494e 12362
8a1cdce5
AC
12363If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12364press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
01c52d31 12365
8a1cdce5
AC
12366@item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12367@vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12368If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12369@code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12370useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
4009494e 12371
8a1cdce5 12372@end table
01c52d31 12373
4009494e 12374
8a1cdce5
AC
12375@node Posting Server
12376@section Posting Server
4009494e 12377
8a1cdce5
AC
12378When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12379(extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
4009494e 12380
8a1cdce5 12381Thank you for asking. I hate you.
4009494e 12382
8a1cdce5 12383It can be quite complicated.
4009494e 12384
8a1cdce5
AC
12385@vindex gnus-post-method
12386When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12387(@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12388Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12389reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12390groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12391you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12392want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12393fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12394@code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
4009494e 12395
8a1cdce5
AC
12396@lisp
12397(setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12398@end lisp
4009494e 12399
8a1cdce5
AC
12400Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12401this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12402can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12403the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
4009494e 12404
8a1cdce5
AC
12405If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12406Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
4009494e 12407
8a1cdce5
AC
12408You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12409If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12410for posting.
12411
12412Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12413you can set this variable to @code{native}.
4009494e 12414
8a1cdce5
AC
12415@vindex message-send-mail-function
12416When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12417variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12418value suitable for your system.
12419@xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12420information.
4009494e 12421
89b163db 12422
8a1cdce5
AC
12423@node POP before SMTP
12424@section POP before SMTP
12425@cindex pop before smtp
8a1cdce5 12426@findex mail-source-touch-pop
4009494e 12427
89b163db
G
12428Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12429authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12430contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12431put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e 12432
8a1cdce5 12433@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
12434(add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12435@end lisp
85115796 12436
8a1cdce5 12437@noindent
89b163db
G
12438The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12439authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12440fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
85115796 12441
8a1cdce5
AC
12442If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12443@code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12444@code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12445used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12446is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12447mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
85115796 12448
8a1cdce5
AC
12449@lisp
12450(setq mail-source-primary-source
12451 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12452 :password "secret"))
12453@end lisp
85115796 12454
8a1cdce5
AC
12455@noindent
12456Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12457@acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
51dee5ef
KY
12458
12459@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
12460(add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12461 (lambda ()
12462 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12463 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12464 :password "secret")))
12465 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
51dee5ef
KY
12466@end lisp
12467
89b163db 12468
8a1cdce5
AC
12469@node Mail and Post
12470@section Mail and Post
51dee5ef 12471
8a1cdce5
AC
12472Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12473posting:
239661c0 12474
8a1cdce5
AC
12475@table @code
12476@item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12477@findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12478@cindex mailing lists
85115796 12479
8a1cdce5
AC
12480If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12481gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12482problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12483One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12484(@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12485@code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12486really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12487lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12488still a pain, though.
85115796 12489
8a1cdce5
AC
12490@item gnus-user-agent
12491@vindex gnus-user-agent
12492@cindex User-Agent
85115796 12493
8a1cdce5
AC
12494This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12495User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12496symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12497version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12498(show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12499configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12500string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
59d09f15 12501
85115796
KY
12502@end table
12503
8a1cdce5
AC
12504You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12505you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12506spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
85115796 12507
8a1cdce5
AC
12508@cindex ispell
12509@findex ispell-message
12510@lisp
12511(add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12512@end lisp
85115796 12513
8a1cdce5
AC
12514If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12515you're in, you could say something like the following:
85115796 12516
8a1cdce5
AC
12517@lisp
12518(add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12519 (lambda ()
12520 (cond
12521 ((string-match
12522 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12523 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12524 (t
12525 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12526@end lisp
4009494e 12527
8a1cdce5 12528Modify to suit your needs.
4009494e 12529
8a1cdce5
AC
12530@vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12531If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12532citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12533mode buffers.
4009494e 12534
8a1cdce5
AC
12535@node Archived Messages
12536@section Archived Messages
12537@cindex archived messages
12538@cindex sent messages
4009494e 12539
8a1cdce5
AC
12540Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12541send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12542store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
005a89ff
G
12543@code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12544default is "sent.%Y-%m", which gives you one archive group per month.
4009494e 12545
8a1cdce5
AC
12546For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12547@kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12548Group Commands}).
4009494e 12549
8a1cdce5
AC
12550@vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12551@code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12552use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12553actually being used it is expanded into:
4009494e 12554
8a1cdce5
AC
12555@lisp
12556(nnfolder "archive"
12557 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12558 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12559 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12560 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12561@end lisp
01c52d31 12562
8a1cdce5
AC
12563@quotation
12564@vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12565Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12566so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12567@code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12568@code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12569since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12570even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12571afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12572mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12573saved method to reflect always the value of
12574@code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12575@code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12576value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12577@end quotation
4009494e 12578
8a1cdce5
AC
12579You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12580@code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12581for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12582directory chosen, you could say something like:
4009494e 12583
8a1cdce5
AC
12584@lisp
12585(setq gnus-message-archive-method
12586 '(nnfolder "archive"
12587 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12588 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12589 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12590@end lisp
4009494e 12591
8a1cdce5
AC
12592@vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12593@cindex Gcc
12594Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12595to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12596determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
4009494e 12597
8a1cdce5
AC
12598This variable can be used to do the following:
12599
12600@table @asis
12601@item a string
12602Messages will be saved in that group.
12603
12604Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12605message will not be stored in the select method given by
12606@code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12607by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12608has the default value shown above. Then setting
12609@code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12610messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12611value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12612@samp{nnml:foo}.
4009494e 12613
8a1cdce5
AC
12614@item a list of strings
12615Messages will be saved in all those groups.
4009494e 12616
8a1cdce5
AC
12617@item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12618When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
4009494e 12619
8a1cdce5 12620@item @code{nil}
a5166359 12621No message archiving will take place.
8a1cdce5 12622@end table
4009494e 12623
8a1cdce5 12624Let's illustrate:
4009494e 12625
8a1cdce5
AC
12626Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12627@lisp
12628(setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12629@end lisp
4009494e 12630
8a1cdce5
AC
12631Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12632@lisp
12633(setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12634@end lisp
4009494e 12635
8a1cdce5
AC
12636Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12637@lisp
12638(setq gnus-message-archive-group
12639 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12640 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12641 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12642@end lisp
4009494e 12643
8a1cdce5
AC
12644More complex stuff:
12645@lisp
12646(setq gnus-message-archive-group
12647 '((if (message-news-p)
12648 "misc-news"
12649 "misc-mail")))
12650@end lisp
4009494e 12651
8a1cdce5
AC
12652How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12653messages in one file per month:
4009494e 12654
8a1cdce5
AC
12655@lisp
12656(setq gnus-message-archive-group
12657 '((if (message-news-p)
12658 "misc-news"
12659 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12660@end lisp
4009494e 12661
8a1cdce5
AC
12662Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12663group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12664you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12665archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12666Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12667enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12668group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12669if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12670nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12671continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
4009494e 12672
8a1cdce5
AC
12673@table @code
12674@item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12675@vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12676If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
4009494e 12677
8a1cdce5
AC
12678@item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12679@vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12680If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12681and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12682@code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12683non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12684changed in the future.
61b1af82 12685
89b163db
G
12686@item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12687@vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12688Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12689messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12690Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12691precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12692
12693If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12694@code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12695group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12696messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12697will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12698this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12699@code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12700except for the current group.
12701
12702@item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12703@vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12704@itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12705@vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12706
12707These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12708copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12709contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12710the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12711message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
1df7defd 12712subsequent transformations), e.g., remove MML secure tags
89b163db
G
12713(@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12714
8a1cdce5 12715@end table
61b1af82 12716
4009494e 12717
8a1cdce5
AC
12718@node Posting Styles
12719@section Posting Styles
12720@cindex posting styles
12721@cindex styles
4009494e 12722
8a1cdce5 12723All them variables, they make my head swim.
4009494e 12724
8a1cdce5
AC
12725So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12726on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12727and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12728on?
4009494e 12729
8a1cdce5
AC
12730@vindex gnus-posting-styles
12731One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12732variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12733came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12734a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12735variable:
4009494e 12736
8a1cdce5
AC
12737@lisp
12738((".*"
12739 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12740 (organization "What me?"))
12741 ("^comp"
12742 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12743 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12744 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12745@end lisp
4009494e 12746
8a1cdce5
AC
12747As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12748@dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12749``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12750over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12751applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12752the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12753@samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12754signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
4009494e 12755
8a1cdce5
AC
12756The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12757string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12758If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12759will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12760@var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12761@var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12762replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12763followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12764@code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12765no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12766referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12767any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12768said to @dfn{match}.
4009494e 12769
8a1cdce5
AC
12770Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12771attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12772addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12773form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12774@code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12775contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12776@var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12777name can be one of:
4009494e 12778
8a1cdce5
AC
12779@itemize @bullet
12780@item @code{signature}
12781@item @code{signature-file}
12782@item @code{x-face-file}
12783@item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12784@item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12785@item @code{body}
12786@end itemize
4009494e 12787
8a1cdce5
AC
12788Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12789@code{message-signature-directory}.
4009494e 12790
8a1cdce5
AC
12791The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12792this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12793the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12794name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12795is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
4009494e 12796
8a1cdce5
AC
12797The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12798(the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12799or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12800used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12801message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12802article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12803variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12804from date id references chars lines xref extra.
4009494e 12805
8a1cdce5
AC
12806In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12807expression, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed on
12808the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by the
0fd2c9a3
GM
12809corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12810Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
4009494e 12811
8a1cdce5 12812@vindex message-reply-headers
4009494e 12813
8a1cdce5
AC
12814If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12815meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12816of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
4009494e 12817
8a1cdce5
AC
12818@findex message-mail-p
12819@findex message-news-p
4009494e 12820
8a1cdce5 12821So here's a new example:
4009494e 12822
8a1cdce5
AC
12823@lisp
12824(setq gnus-posting-styles
12825 '((".*"
12826 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12827 (name "User Name")
12828 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12829 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12830 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12831 ("^rec.humor"
12832 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12833 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12834 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12835 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12836 (signature my-news-signature))
12837 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12838 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12839 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12840 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12841 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12842 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12843 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12844 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12845 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
89b163db 12846 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
8a1cdce5
AC
12847 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12848 ("nnml:.*"
12849 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12850 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12851 ("^nn.+:"
12852 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12853@end lisp
4009494e 12854
8a1cdce5
AC
12855The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12856@code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12857if you fill many roles.
12858You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12859@xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
4009494e 12860
89b163db
G
12861Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12862@samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12863outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12864@acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12865@xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12866
12867
8a1cdce5
AC
12868@node Drafts
12869@section Drafts
12870@cindex drafts
4009494e 12871
8a1cdce5
AC
12872If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12873you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12874craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12875the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12876other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
4009494e 12877
8a1cdce5
AC
12878Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12879some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12880automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12881If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12882article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12883group.)
4009494e 12884
8a1cdce5
AC
12885@cindex nndraft
12886@vindex nndraft-directory
12887The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12888@code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12889@samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12890@code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12891that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12892read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
4009494e 12893
8a1cdce5
AC
12894If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12895to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12896unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12897a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12898behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12899be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12900simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12901Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12902correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
4009494e 12903
8a1cdce5
AC
12904@c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12905@c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12906@c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12907@c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12908@c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12909@c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12910@c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12911@c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12912@c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12913@c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12914@c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12915@c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12916@c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12917@c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12918@c
12919@c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12920@c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12921@c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
4009494e 12922
8a1cdce5
AC
12923@findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12924@kindex D e (Draft)
12925When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12926draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12927that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
4009494e 12928
8a1cdce5
AC
12929Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12930Articles}).
4009494e 12931
8a1cdce5
AC
12932@findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12933@kindex D s (Draft)
12934@findex gnus-draft-send-message
12935@kindex D S (Draft)
12936If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12937doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12938(@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12939process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12940command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12941in the buffer.
4009494e 12942
8a1cdce5
AC
12943@findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12944@kindex D t (Draft)
12945If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12946@kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12947as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
4009494e 12948
8a1cdce5
AC
12949Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12950command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
4009494e 12951
4009494e 12952
8a1cdce5
AC
12953@node Rejected Articles
12954@section Rejected Articles
12955@cindex rejected articles
95838435 12956
8a1cdce5
AC
12957Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12958doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12959@emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12960Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
4009494e 12961
8a1cdce5
AC
12962These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12963(Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12964fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12965you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12966articles until some later time when the server feels better.
4009494e 12967
8a1cdce5
AC
12968The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12969(@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12970typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
4009494e 12971
8a1cdce5
AC
12972@node Signing and encrypting
12973@section Signing and encrypting
12974@cindex using gpg
12975@cindex using s/mime
12976@cindex using smime
4009494e 12977
8a1cdce5
AC
12978Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12979@acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12980decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12981@code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
4009494e 12982
8a1cdce5
AC
12983@vindex gnus-message-replysign
12984@vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12985@vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12986Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12987messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12988are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12989@code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12990@code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12991@code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12992automatically encrypted messages.
4009494e 12993
8a1cdce5
AC
12994Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12995@acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12996signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
4009494e 12997
8a1cdce5 12998@table @kbd
4009494e 12999
8a1cdce5
AC
13000@item C-c C-m s s
13001@kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
13002@findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
71e691a5 13003
8a1cdce5 13004Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
4009494e 13005
8a1cdce5
AC
13006@item C-c C-m s o
13007@kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
13008@findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
4009494e 13009
8a1cdce5 13010Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
4009494e 13011
8a1cdce5
AC
13012@item C-c C-m s p
13013@kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
13014@findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
4009494e 13015
8a1cdce5 13016Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
4009494e 13017
8a1cdce5
AC
13018@item C-c C-m c s
13019@kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
13020@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
4009494e 13021
8a1cdce5 13022Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
4009494e 13023
8a1cdce5
AC
13024@item C-c C-m c o
13025@kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13026@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
4009494e 13027
8a1cdce5 13028Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
4009494e 13029
8a1cdce5
AC
13030@item C-c C-m c p
13031@kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13032@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
4009494e 13033
8a1cdce5 13034Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
4009494e 13035
8a1cdce5
AC
13036@item C-c C-m C-n
13037@kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13038@findex mml-unsecure-message
13039Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
4009494e 13040
8a1cdce5 13041@end table
4009494e 13042
8a1cdce5 13043@xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
4009494e 13044
8a1cdce5
AC
13045@node Select Methods
13046@chapter Select Methods
13047@cindex foreign groups
13048@cindex select methods
4009494e 13049
8a1cdce5
AC
13050A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13051default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13052@acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13053personal mail group.
4009494e 13054
8a1cdce5
AC
13055A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13056a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
1df7defd 13057list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g., @code{nntp},
8a1cdce5
AC
13058@code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13059name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13060value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
4009494e 13061
8a1cdce5
AC
13062One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13063we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
4009494e 13064
8a1cdce5
AC
13065The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13066group as.
4009494e 13067
8a1cdce5
AC
13068For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13069@samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13070method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13071@samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13072back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
4009494e 13073
8a1cdce5 13074The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
4009494e 13075
8a1cdce5
AC
13076@menu
13077* Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13078* Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13079* Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13080* Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13081* Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13082* Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13083* Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13084* Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13085* Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13086@end menu
4009494e 13087
239661c0 13088
8a1cdce5
AC
13089@node Server Buffer
13090@section Server Buffer
13091
13092Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13093one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13094connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13095one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13096the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13097back end represents a virtual server.
4009494e 13098
8a1cdce5
AC
13099For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13100different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13101on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13102use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
4009494e 13103
8a1cdce5
AC
13104These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13105complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13106@acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13107hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13108Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13109server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13110select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
4009494e 13111
8a1cdce5
AC
13112To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13113(@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
4009494e
GM
13114
13115@menu
8a1cdce5
AC
13116* Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13117* Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13118* Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13119* Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13120* Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13121* Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13122* Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
4009494e
GM
13123@end menu
13124
8a1cdce5
AC
13125@vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13126@code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13127
13128
13129@node Server Buffer Format
13130@subsection Server Buffer Format
13131@cindex server buffer format
13132
13133@vindex gnus-server-line-format
13134You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13135@code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13136variable, with some simple extensions:
4009494e 13137
8a1cdce5 13138@table @samp
4009494e 13139
8a1cdce5
AC
13140@item h
13141How the news is fetched---the back end name.
4009494e 13142
8a1cdce5
AC
13143@item n
13144The name of this server.
4009494e 13145
8a1cdce5
AC
13146@item w
13147Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
4009494e 13148
8a1cdce5
AC
13149@item s
13150The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
4009494e 13151
8a1cdce5
AC
13152@item a
13153Whether this server is agentized.
13154@end table
4009494e 13155
8a1cdce5
AC
13156@vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13157The mode line can also be customized by using the
13158@code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13159Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
4009494e 13160
8a1cdce5
AC
13161@table @samp
13162@item S
13163Server name.
4009494e 13164
8a1cdce5
AC
13165@item M
13166Server method.
4009494e
GM
13167@end table
13168
8a1cdce5 13169Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
4009494e 13170
4009494e 13171
8a1cdce5
AC
13172@node Server Commands
13173@subsection Server Commands
13174@cindex server commands
4009494e 13175
8a1cdce5 13176@table @kbd
4009494e 13177
8a1cdce5
AC
13178@item v
13179@kindex v (Server)
13180@cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13181The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13182command or better use it as a prefix key.
4009494e 13183
8a1cdce5
AC
13184@item a
13185@kindex a (Server)
13186@findex gnus-server-add-server
13187Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
4009494e 13188
8a1cdce5
AC
13189@item e
13190@kindex e (Server)
13191@findex gnus-server-edit-server
13192Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
4009494e 13193
8a1cdce5
AC
13194@item S
13195@kindex S (Server)
13196@findex gnus-server-show-server
13197Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
4009494e 13198
8a1cdce5
AC
13199@item SPACE
13200@kindex SPACE (Server)
13201@findex gnus-server-read-server
13202Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
4009494e 13203
8a1cdce5
AC
13204@item q
13205@kindex q (Server)
13206@findex gnus-server-exit
13207Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
4009494e 13208
8a1cdce5
AC
13209@item k
13210@kindex k (Server)
13211@findex gnus-server-kill-server
13212Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
4009494e 13213
8a1cdce5
AC
13214@item y
13215@kindex y (Server)
13216@findex gnus-server-yank-server
13217Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
4009494e 13218
8a1cdce5
AC
13219@item c
13220@kindex c (Server)
13221@findex gnus-server-copy-server
13222Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
4009494e 13223
8a1cdce5
AC
13224@item l
13225@kindex l (Server)
13226@findex gnus-server-list-servers
13227List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
4009494e 13228
8a1cdce5
AC
13229@item s
13230@kindex s (Server)
13231@findex gnus-server-scan-server
13232Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13233(@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13234servers.
4009494e 13235
8a1cdce5
AC
13236@item g
13237@kindex g (Server)
13238@findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13239Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13240(@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13241a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
4009494e 13242
8a1cdce5
AC
13243@item z
13244@kindex z (Server)
13245@findex gnus-server-compact-server
4009494e 13246
8a1cdce5
AC
13247Compact all groups in the server under point
13248(@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13249nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13250hence getting a correct total article count.
13251
13252@end table
13253
13254Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13255listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
4009494e 13256
8a1cdce5
AC
13257
13258@node Example Methods
13259@subsection Example Methods
13260
13261Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
4009494e
GM
13262
13263@lisp
8a1cdce5 13264(nntp "news.funet.fi")
4009494e
GM
13265@end lisp
13266
8a1cdce5 13267Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
4009494e 13268
8a1cdce5
AC
13269@lisp
13270(nnspool "")
13271@end lisp
4009494e 13272
8a1cdce5
AC
13273As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13274back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13275will.
4009494e 13276
8a1cdce5
AC
13277After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13278@code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
4009494e 13279
8a1cdce5
AC
13280To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13281port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13282look like then:
4009494e 13283
8a1cdce5
AC
13284@lisp
13285(nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13286@end lisp
4009494e 13287
8a1cdce5
AC
13288You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13289variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
4009494e 13290
8a1cdce5
AC
13291@code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13292you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13293mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13294your private mail:
4009494e 13295
4009494e 13296@lisp
8a1cdce5 13297(nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
4009494e
GM
13298@end lisp
13299
8a1cdce5
AC
13300(This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13301that.)
13302
13303Here's the method for a public spool:
4009494e
GM
13304
13305@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
13306(nnmh "public"
13307 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13308 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
4009494e
GM
13309@end lisp
13310
8a1cdce5
AC
13311@cindex proxy
13312@cindex firewall
4009494e 13313
8a1cdce5
AC
13314If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13315server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13316on the firewall machine and connect with
13317@uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13318@acronym{NNTP} server.
13319Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13320should probably look something like this:
4009494e 13321
8a1cdce5
AC
13322@lisp
13323(nntp "firewall"
13324 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13325 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13326 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13327@end lisp
4009494e 13328
8a1cdce5
AC
13329If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13330compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13331configuration to the example above:
4009494e 13332
8a1cdce5
AC
13333@lisp
13334 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13335@end lisp
4009494e 13336
8a1cdce5
AC
13337See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13338an indirect connection:
4009494e
GM
13339
13340@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
13341(setq gnus-select-method
13342 '(nntp "indirect"
13343 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13344 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13345 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13346 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13347 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13348 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
4009494e
GM
13349@end lisp
13350
8a1cdce5
AC
13351This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13352provide automatic authorization, of course.
01c52d31 13353
8a1cdce5
AC
13354If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13355through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13356netcat connection to the news server as follows:
4009494e
GM
13357
13358@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
13359(nntp "outside"
13360 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13361 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13362 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
4009494e
GM
13363@end lisp
13364
4009494e 13365
8a1cdce5
AC
13366@node Creating a Virtual Server
13367@subsection Creating a Virtual Server
4009494e 13368
8a1cdce5
AC
13369If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13370articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
4009494e 13371
8a1cdce5
AC
13372First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13373would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13374could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
4009494e 13375
8a1cdce5 13376Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
4009494e 13377
8a1cdce5
AC
13378You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13379@samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13380Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13381will contain the following:
4009494e 13382
4009494e 13383@lisp
8a1cdce5 13384(nnml "cache")
4009494e
GM
13385@end lisp
13386
8a1cdce5 13387Change that to:
4009494e 13388
4009494e 13389@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
13390(nnml "cache"
13391 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13392 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
4009494e
GM
13393@end lisp
13394
8a1cdce5
AC
13395Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13396@kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13397buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
4009494e 13398
8a1cdce5
AC
13399
13400@node Server Variables
13401@subsection Server Variables
13402@cindex server variables
13403@cindex server parameters
13404
13405One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13406in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13407variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13408change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13409won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13410
13411This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13412@code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13413directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13414@code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13415new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13416@code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13417variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13418variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13419manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
4009494e
GM
13420
13421@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
13422(nnml "public"
13423 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13424 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13425 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
4009494e
GM
13426@end lisp
13427
8a1cdce5 13428Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
4009494e 13429
8a1cdce5
AC
13430@node Servers and Methods
13431@subsection Servers and Methods
4009494e 13432
8a1cdce5 13433Wherever you would normally use a select method
1df7defd 13434(e.g., @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
8a1cdce5
AC
13435when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13436instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13437over.
13438
13439
13440@node Unavailable Servers
13441@subsection Unavailable Servers
13442
13443If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13444@code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13445with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13446will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13447actually the case or not.
13448
13449That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13450Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13451@samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13452away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13453to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13454attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13455attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13456it will regard that server as ``down''.
13457
13458So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13459How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13460
13461You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13462with the following commands:
4009494e 13463
8a1cdce5 13464@table @kbd
4009494e 13465
8a1cdce5
AC
13466@item O
13467@kindex O (Server)
13468@findex gnus-server-open-server
13469Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13470(@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
4009494e 13471
8a1cdce5
AC
13472@item C
13473@kindex C (Server)
13474@findex gnus-server-close-server
13475Close the connection (if any) to the server
13476(@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
4009494e 13477
8a1cdce5
AC
13478@item D
13479@kindex D (Server)
13480@findex gnus-server-deny-server
13481Mark the current server as unreachable
13482(@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
4009494e 13483
8a1cdce5
AC
13484@item M-o
13485@kindex M-o (Server)
13486@findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13487Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13488(@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
4009494e 13489
8a1cdce5
AC
13490@item M-c
13491@kindex M-c (Server)
13492@findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13493Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13494(@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
4009494e 13495
8a1cdce5
AC
13496@item R
13497@kindex R (Server)
13498@findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13499Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13500(@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
4009494e 13501
8a1cdce5
AC
13502@item c
13503@kindex c (Server)
13504@findex gnus-server-copy-server
13505Copy a server and give it a new name
13506(@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13507complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13508a different (physical) server.
4009494e 13509
8a1cdce5
AC
13510@item L
13511@kindex L (Server)
13512@findex gnus-server-offline-server
13513Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
4009494e 13514
8a1cdce5 13515@end table
4009494e 13516
4009494e 13517
8a1cdce5
AC
13518@node Getting News
13519@section Getting News
13520@cindex reading news
13521@cindex news back ends
4009494e 13522
8a1cdce5
AC
13523A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13524only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13525or it can read from a local spool.
4009494e 13526
8a1cdce5
AC
13527@menu
13528* NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13529* News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13530@end menu
01c52d31 13531
4009494e 13532
8a1cdce5
AC
13533@node NNTP
13534@subsection NNTP
13535@cindex nntp
389b76fa 13536
8a1cdce5
AC
13537Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13538You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13539server as the, uhm, address.
4009494e 13540
8a1cdce5
AC
13541If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13542third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13543to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13544that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
4009494e 13545
8a1cdce5
AC
13546The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13547fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13548you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
4009494e 13549
8a1cdce5
AC
13550The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13551server:
4009494e 13552
8a1cdce5 13553@table @code
4009494e 13554
8a1cdce5
AC
13555@item nntp-server-opened-hook
13556@vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13557@cindex @sc{mode reader}
13558@cindex authinfo
13559@cindex authentication
13560@cindex nntp authentication
13561@findex nntp-send-authinfo
13562@findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13563is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13564commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13565default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13566@code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13567present in this hook.
4009494e 13568
8a1cdce5
AC
13569@item nntp-authinfo-function
13570@vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13571@findex nntp-send-authinfo
13572@vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13573This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13574server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13575through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13576@code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13577are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13578format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13579@code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13580manual page, but here are the salient facts:
4009494e 13581
8a1cdce5
AC
13582@enumerate
13583@item
13584The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
4009494e 13585
8a1cdce5
AC
13586@item
13587Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
4009494e 13588
8a1cdce5
AC
13589The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13590@samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13591in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13592@samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13593deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13594indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13595@samp{force} is explained below.
4009494e 13596
8a1cdce5 13597@end enumerate
4009494e 13598
8a1cdce5 13599Here's an example file:
4009494e 13600
8a1cdce5
AC
13601@example
13602machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13603machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13604@end example
4009494e 13605
8a1cdce5
AC
13606The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13607have to be first, for instance.
4009494e 13608
8a1cdce5
AC
13609In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13610former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13611user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13612@samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13613@var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13614@samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13615until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
4009494e 13616
8a1cdce5
AC
13617You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13618that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
4009494e 13619
8a1cdce5
AC
13620@example
13621default force yes
13622@end example
4009494e 13623
8a1cdce5
AC
13624This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13625previously mentioned.
598451ed 13626
8a1cdce5 13627Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
4009494e 13628
8a1cdce5
AC
13629@item nntp-server-action-alist
13630@vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13631This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13632taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13633every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
4009494e 13634
8a1cdce5
AC
13635@lisp
13636(setq nntp-server-action-alist
13637 '(("innd" (ding))))
13638@end lisp
4009494e 13639
8a1cdce5 13640You probably don't want to do that, though.
4009494e 13641
8a1cdce5 13642The default value is
4009494e 13643
8a1cdce5
AC
13644@lisp
13645'(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13646 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13647 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13648@end lisp
4009494e 13649
8a1cdce5
AC
13650This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13651nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
4009494e 13652
8a1cdce5
AC
13653@item nntp-maximum-request
13654@vindex nntp-maximum-request
13655If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13656will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13657speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13658waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13659by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13660your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
4009494e 13661
8a1cdce5
AC
13662@item nntp-connection-timeout
13663@vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13664If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13665regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13666responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13667time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13668somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13669that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13670connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13671no timeouts are done.
4009494e 13672
8a1cdce5
AC
13673@item nntp-nov-is-evil
13674@vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13675If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13676variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13677can be used.
4009494e 13678
8a1cdce5
AC
13679@item nntp-xover-commands
13680@vindex nntp-xover-commands
13681@cindex @acronym{NOV}
13682@cindex XOVER
13683List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13684server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13685"XOVERVIEW")}.
4009494e 13686
8a1cdce5
AC
13687@item nntp-nov-gap
13688@vindex nntp-nov-gap
13689@code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13690the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
f99f1641 13691if you have read articles 2--5000 in the group, and only want to read
8a1cdce5
AC
13692article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13693lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13694big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13695@code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13696network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13697that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13698@code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
4009494e 13699
8a1cdce5
AC
13700@item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13701@vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13702When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13703specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13704current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13705command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13706returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13707in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13708refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13709current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13710some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13711having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13712between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13713@code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13714to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13715you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13716value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
4009494e 13717
8a1cdce5
AC
13718@lisp
13719(setq gnus-select-method
13720 '(nntp "newszilla"
13721 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13722 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13723 @dots{}))
13724@end lisp
4009494e 13725
8a1cdce5 13726The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
4009494e 13727
8a1cdce5
AC
13728@item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13729@vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13730A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
4009494e 13731
8a1cdce5
AC
13732@item nntp-record-commands
13733@vindex nntp-record-commands
13734If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13735@acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13736buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13737that doesn't seem to work.
4009494e 13738
8a1cdce5
AC
13739@item nntp-open-connection-function
13740@vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13741It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13742be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13743parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13744Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13745in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13746indirect ones (three pre-made).
13747
13748@item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13749@vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13750Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13751reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13752to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13753@code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13754example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13755@code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13756overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13757
13758@item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13759@vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13760List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13761you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13762not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13763@code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13764default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
4009494e 13765
8a1cdce5
AC
13766@item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13767@vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13768A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13769@code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13770recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13771hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13772inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
4009494e 13773
8a1cdce5
AC
13774@lisp
13775(add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13776@end lisp
4009494e 13777
1df7defd 13778Note that not all servers support the recommended ID@. This works for
8a1cdce5 13779INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
4009494e 13780
8a1cdce5
AC
13781@item nntp-server-list-active-group
13782If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13783ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13784don't update their active files often, this can help.
4009494e 13785
4009494e
GM
13786
13787@end table
13788
8a1cdce5
AC
13789@menu
13790* Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13791* Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13792* Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
8a1cdce5 13793@end menu
4009494e 13794
4009494e 13795
8a1cdce5
AC
13796@node Direct Functions
13797@subsubsection Direct Functions
13798@cindex direct connection functions
4009494e 13799
8a1cdce5
AC
13800These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13801between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13802functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13803(@pxref{Common Variables}).
4009494e 13804
8a1cdce5
AC
13805@table @code
13806@findex nntp-open-network-stream
13807@item nntp-open-network-stream
13808This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13809remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13810connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13811connection automatically.
4009494e 13812
8a1cdce5
AC
13813@item network-only
13814The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
4009494e 13815
8a1cdce5
AC
13816@findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13817@item nntp-open-tls-stream
13818Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
321decc8 13819this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
8a1cdce5 13820installed. You then define a server as follows:
4009494e 13821
8a1cdce5
AC
13822@lisp
13823;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13824;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13825;;
13826(nntp "snews.bar.com"
13827 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13828 (nntp-port-number 563)
13829 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13830@end lisp
4009494e 13831
8a1cdce5
AC
13832@findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13833@item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13834Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
f2a538a2
GM
13835this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL}
13836@ignore
13837@c Defunct URL, ancient package, so don't mention it.
13838or @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay}
13839@end ignore
13840installed. You then define a server as follows:
4009494e 13841
8a1cdce5
AC
13842@lisp
13843;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13844;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13845;;
13846(nntp "snews.bar.com"
13847 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13848 (nntp-port-number 563)
13849 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13850@end lisp
4009494e 13851
8a1cdce5
AC
13852@findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13853@item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13854Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13855program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13856the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13857of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13858connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13859@code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
4009494e 13860
8a1cdce5
AC
13861@lisp
13862(nntp "socksified"
13863 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13864 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13865 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13866@end lisp
4009494e 13867
8a1cdce5
AC
13868With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13869session, which is not a good idea.
4009494e 13870
8a1cdce5
AC
13871@findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13872@item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13873Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13874@code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13875like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13876not available. The previous example would turn into:
4009494e 13877
8a1cdce5
AC
13878@lisp
13879(nntp "socksified"
13880 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13881 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13882 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13883 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13884@end lisp
13885@end table
4009494e
GM
13886
13887
8a1cdce5
AC
13888@node Indirect Functions
13889@subsubsection Indirect Functions
13890@cindex indirect connection functions
4009494e 13891
8a1cdce5
AC
13892These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13893intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13894All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13895the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13896things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13897commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
4009494e 13898
8a1cdce5
AC
13899@table @code
13900@item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13901@findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13902Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13903to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13904you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
4009494e 13905
8a1cdce5 13906@code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
4009494e 13907
8a1cdce5
AC
13908@table @code
13909@item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13910@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13911Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13912@samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
4009494e 13913
8a1cdce5
AC
13914@item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13915@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13916List of strings to be used as the switches to
13917@code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13918@samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13919@samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13920@end table
4009494e 13921
8a1cdce5
AC
13922@item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13923@findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13924Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13925to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13926@code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13927line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
4009494e 13928
8a1cdce5 13929@code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
4009494e 13930
8a1cdce5
AC
13931@table @code
13932@item nntp-telnet-command
13933@vindex nntp-telnet-command
13934Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13935intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
4009494e 13936
8a1cdce5
AC
13937@item nntp-telnet-switches
13938@vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13939List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13940@code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
4009494e 13941
8a1cdce5
AC
13942@item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13943@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13944Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13945@samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
4009494e 13946
8a1cdce5
AC
13947@item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13948@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13949List of strings to be used as the switches to
13950@code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13951this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13952the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13953host. The default is @code{nil}.
13954@end table
4009494e 13955
8a1cdce5
AC
13956Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13957to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
4009494e 13958
8a1cdce5
AC
13959@item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13960@findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13961Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13962@samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
4009494e 13963
8a1cdce5 13964@code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
4009494e 13965
8a1cdce5
AC
13966@table @code
13967@item nntp-via-telnet-command
13968@vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13969Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13970@samp{telnet}.
4009494e 13971
8a1cdce5
AC
13972@item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13973@vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13974List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13975@code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
4009494e 13976
8a1cdce5
AC
13977@item nntp-via-user-password
13978@vindex nntp-via-user-password
13979Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
4009494e 13980
8a1cdce5
AC
13981@item nntp-via-envuser
13982@vindex nntp-via-envuser
13983If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13984server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13985login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
59e75882 13986
8a1cdce5
AC
13987@item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13988@vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13989Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13990is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
4009494e 13991
8a1cdce5 13992@end table
4009494e 13993
8a1cdce5
AC
13994Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13995to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13996@end table
4009494e 13997
4009494e 13998
8a1cdce5
AC
13999Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
14000functions:
4009494e 14001
8a1cdce5 14002@table @code
4009494e 14003
8a1cdce5
AC
14004@item nntp-via-user-name
14005@vindex nntp-via-user-name
14006User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
4009494e 14007
8a1cdce5
AC
14008@item nntp-via-address
14009@vindex nntp-via-address
14010Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
4009494e 14011
8a1cdce5 14012@end table
01c52d31 14013
01c52d31 14014
8a1cdce5
AC
14015@node Common Variables
14016@subsubsection Common Variables
4009494e 14017
8a1cdce5
AC
14018The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
14019pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
14020affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
14021default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
14022variables individually).
516aa569 14023
8a1cdce5 14024@table @code
4009494e 14025
8a1cdce5
AC
14026@item nntp-pre-command
14027@vindex nntp-pre-command
14028A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14029connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14030@code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14031where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
4009494e 14032
8a1cdce5
AC
14033@item nntp-address
14034@vindex nntp-address
14035The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
4009494e 14036
8a1cdce5
AC
14037@item nntp-port-number
14038@vindex nntp-port-number
14039Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14040@samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14041@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
65e7ca35 14042than named ports (i.e., use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
8a1cdce5
AC
14043@samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14044not work with named ports.
4009494e 14045
8a1cdce5
AC
14046@item nntp-end-of-line
14047@vindex nntp-end-of-line
14048String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14049server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14050using a non native telnet connection function.
4009494e 14051
8a1cdce5
AC
14052@item nntp-netcat-command
14053@vindex nntp-netcat-command
14054Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14055@samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14056just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14057@samp{nc}.
4009494e 14058
8a1cdce5
AC
14059@item nntp-netcat-switches
14060@vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14061A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14062is @samp{()}.
4009494e 14063
8a1cdce5 14064@end table
4009494e 14065
8a1cdce5
AC
14066@node News Spool
14067@subsection News Spool
14068@cindex nnspool
14069@cindex news spool
4009494e 14070
8a1cdce5
AC
14071Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14072and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14073contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14074instance.
4009494e 14075
8a1cdce5
AC
14076Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14077anything else) as the address.
fbcbb58c 14078
8a1cdce5
AC
14079If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14080native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14081than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14082You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
4009494e 14083
8a1cdce5 14084@table @code
fbcbb58c 14085
8a1cdce5
AC
14086@item nnspool-inews-program
14087@vindex nnspool-inews-program
14088Program used to post an article.
4009494e 14089
8a1cdce5
AC
14090@item nnspool-inews-switches
14091@vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14092Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
4009494e 14093
8a1cdce5
AC
14094@item nnspool-spool-directory
14095@vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14096Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14097@file{/usr/spool/news/}.
4009494e 14098
8a1cdce5
AC
14099@item nnspool-nov-directory
14100@vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14101Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14102@file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
4009494e 14103
8a1cdce5
AC
14104@item nnspool-lib-dir
14105@vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14106Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
4009494e 14107
8a1cdce5
AC
14108@item nnspool-active-file
14109@vindex nnspool-active-file
14110The name of the active file.
4009494e 14111
8a1cdce5
AC
14112@item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14113@vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14114The name of the group descriptions file.
4009494e 14115
8a1cdce5
AC
14116@item nnspool-history-file
14117@vindex nnspool-history-file
14118The name of the news history file.
4009494e 14119
8a1cdce5
AC
14120@item nnspool-active-times-file
14121@vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14122The name of the active date file.
4009494e 14123
8a1cdce5
AC
14124@item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14125@vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14126If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14127that it finds.
4009494e 14128
8a1cdce5
AC
14129@item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14130@vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14131@cindex sed
14132If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14133relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14134@code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14135there.
4009494e 14136
8a1cdce5 14137@end table
4009494e
GM
14138
14139
8a1cdce5
AC
14140@node Using IMAP
14141@section Using IMAP
14142@cindex imap
4009494e 14143
8a1cdce5
AC
14144The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14145provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14146store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14147This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14148from different locations, or with different user agents.
4009494e 14149
8a1cdce5
AC
14150@menu
14151* Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14152* Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14153* Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14154@end menu
4009494e 14155
4009494e 14156
8a1cdce5
AC
14157@node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14158@subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
4009494e 14159
8a1cdce5
AC
14160Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14161group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14162something like:
4009494e 14163
8a1cdce5
AC
14164@example
14165(setq gnus-select-method
14166 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14167@end example
4009494e 14168
8a1cdce5
AC
14169You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14170that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
4009494e 14171
8a1cdce5
AC
14172@example
14173machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14174@end example
4009494e 14175
8a1cdce5 14176That should basically be it for most users.
4009494e 14177
4009494e 14178
8a1cdce5
AC
14179@node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14180@subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
4009494e 14181
8a1cdce5 14182Here's an example method that's more complex:
4009494e 14183
8a1cdce5
AC
14184@example
14185(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14186 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14187 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14188 (nnimap-expunge t)
14189 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14190@end example
4009494e 14191
8a1cdce5
AC
14192@table @code
14193@item nnimap-address
14194The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
4009494e 14195
8a1cdce5
AC
14196@item nnimap-server-port
14197If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14198typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
4009494e 14199
8a1cdce5
AC
14200@item nnimap-stream
14201How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
4009494e 14202
8a1cdce5
AC
14203@table @code
14204@item undecided
14205This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14206then tries the @code{network} setting.
4009494e 14207
8a1cdce5
AC
14208@item ssl
14209This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
4009494e 14210
8a1cdce5
AC
14211@item network
14212Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14213to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14214supports it.
4009494e 14215
8a1cdce5
AC
14216@item starttls
14217Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
8ccbef23 14218
8a1cdce5
AC
14219@item shell
14220If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14221can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14222what you need.
4009494e
GM
14223
14224@end table
14225
8a1cdce5
AC
14226@item nnimap-authenticator
14227Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
45dd6480
LI
14228this should be set to @code{anonymous}. If this variable isn't set,
14229the normal login methods will be used. If you wish to specify a
14230specific login method to be used, you can set this variable to either
14231@code{login} (the traditional @acronym{IMAP} login method),
14232@code{plain} or @code{cram-md5}.
4009494e 14233
8a1cdce5
AC
14234@item nnimap-expunge
14235If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14236if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14237servers that doesn't support that command.
4009494e 14238
8a1cdce5 14239@item nnimap-streaming
3d2af193
LI
14240Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14241If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14242@code{nil}.
4009494e 14243
8a1cdce5
AC
14244@item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14245If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14246a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14247matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14248fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
4009494e 14249
3d2af193
LI
14250@item nnimap-record-commands
14251If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14252@samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14253
8a1cdce5 14254@end table
4009494e 14255
4009494e 14256
8a1cdce5
AC
14257@node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14258@subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
4009494e 14259
8a1cdce5
AC
14260Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14261boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14262download the mail they're not all that interested in.
4009494e 14263
8a1cdce5
AC
14264If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14265variables are relevant:
4009494e
GM
14266
14267@table @code
8a1cdce5 14268@item nnimap-inbox
eaa610c3
KY
14269This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new
14270mail. This can also be a list of mail box names.
4009494e 14271
8a1cdce5
AC
14272@item nnimap-split-methods
14273Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14274Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14275use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
4009494e 14276
8a1cdce5
AC
14277@item nnimap-split-fancy
14278Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
4009494e 14279
8a1cdce5
AC
14280@item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14281List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14282articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14283The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
4009494e 14284
8a1cdce5 14285@end table
4009494e 14286
fe72c8fa
LI
14287Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14288``fancy'' splitting method:
14289
14290@example
14291(nnimap "imap.example.com"
14292 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14293 (nnimap-split-methods
14294 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14295 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14296 "undecided")))
14297@end example
14298
4009494e 14299
8a1cdce5
AC
14300@node Getting Mail
14301@section Getting Mail
14302@cindex reading mail
14303@cindex mail
4009494e 14304
1df7defd 14305Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD@? But of
8a1cdce5 14306course.
4009494e 14307
8a1cdce5
AC
14308@menu
14309* Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14310* Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14311* Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14312* Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14313* Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14314* Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14315* Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14316* Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14317* Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14318* Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14319* Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14320* Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14321* Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14322@end menu
4009494e 14323
4009494e 14324
8a1cdce5
AC
14325@node Mail in a Newsreader
14326@subsection Mail in a Newsreader
4009494e 14327
8a1cdce5
AC
14328If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14329to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14330of a culture shock.
4009494e 14331
8a1cdce5
AC
14332Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14333it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
4009494e 14334
8a1cdce5
AC
14335Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14336approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14337messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14338you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
4009494e 14339
8a1cdce5 14340In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
4009494e 14341
8a1cdce5
AC
14342Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14343deleted? How awful!
4009494e 14344
8a1cdce5
AC
14345But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14346scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14347the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14348you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14349Mail}.
4009494e 14350
8a1cdce5
AC
14351What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14352mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14353they want to treat a message.
4009494e 14354
8a1cdce5
AC
14355Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14356via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14357answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14358need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14359archived somewhere else.
4009494e 14360
8a1cdce5
AC
14361Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14362These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14363to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14364order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14365to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
4009494e 14366
8a1cdce5
AC
14367The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14368but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14369or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
4009494e 14370
8a1cdce5
AC
14371Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14372like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14373differently.
4009494e 14374
8a1cdce5
AC
14375Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14376that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14377to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14378not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14379instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
4009494e 14380
8a1cdce5
AC
14381I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14382may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14383you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14384guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14385Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14386Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14387You Do.)
4009494e 14388
4009494e 14389
8a1cdce5
AC
14390@node Getting Started Reading Mail
14391@subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14392
14393It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14394mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14395and things will happen automatically.
14396
14397For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14398mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14399
14400@lisp
14401(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14402@end lisp
14403
14404Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14405articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14406directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14407be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14408like any other group.
4009494e 14409
8a1cdce5 14410You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
4009494e
GM
14411
14412@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
14413(setq nnmail-split-methods
14414 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14415 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14416 ("other" "")))
4009494e
GM
14417@end lisp
14418
8a1cdce5
AC
14419This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14420@samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14421mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14422last group.
4009494e 14423
8a1cdce5
AC
14424This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14425give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14426Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
4009494e 14427
4009494e 14428
8a1cdce5
AC
14429@node Splitting Mail
14430@subsection Splitting Mail
14431@cindex splitting mail
14432@cindex mail splitting
14433@cindex mail filtering (splitting)
4009494e 14434
8a1cdce5
AC
14435@vindex nnmail-split-methods
14436The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14437to be split into groups.
4009494e 14438
8a1cdce5
AC
14439@lisp
14440(setq nnmail-split-methods
14441 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14442 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14443 ("mail.other" "")))
14444@end lisp
4009494e 14445
8a1cdce5
AC
14446This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14447these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14448something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14449element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14450determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14451contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14452insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
4009494e
GM
14453
14454@lisp
8a1cdce5 14455("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
4009494e
GM
14456@end lisp
14457
8a1cdce5
AC
14458@noindent
14459In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14460the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
4009494e 14461
8a1cdce5
AC
14462The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14463called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14464argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14465mail belongs in that group.
6b958814 14466
8a1cdce5
AC
14467@cindex @samp{bogus} group
14468The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14469expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14470that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14471processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14472to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14473that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14474will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14475splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14476see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
6b958814 14477
8a1cdce5
AC
14478If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14479function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14480arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14481message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14482thinks should carry this mail message.
4009494e 14483
8a1cdce5
AC
14484This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14485see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
4009494e 14486
8a1cdce5
AC
14487Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14488incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14489some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14490@code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
4009494e 14491
8a1cdce5
AC
14492@vindex nnmail-crosspost
14493The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14494the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14495@code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14496that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
4009494e 14497
8a1cdce5
AC
14498@vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14499@cindex crosspost
14500@cindex links
14501@code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14502the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14503links. If that's the case for you, set
14504@code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14505variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
4009494e 14506
8a1cdce5
AC
14507@kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14508@findex nnmail-split-history
14509If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14510can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14511where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14512@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14513Group Commands}).
4009494e 14514
8a1cdce5
AC
14515@vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14516Header lines longer than the value of
14517@code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14518function.
3b84b005 14519
8a1cdce5
AC
14520@vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14521@vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14522By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14523non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14524articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14525@code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14526In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14527variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14528@code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14529value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14530string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14531charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14532
14533@vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14534By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14535specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14536(@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14537@emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14538@code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14539splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14540other kinds of entries.)
14541
14542Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14543yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14544all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14545unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14546boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14547that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14548come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14549you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14550month's rent money.
14551
14552
14553@node Mail Sources
14554@subsection Mail Sources
14555
14556Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14557a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14558maildir, for instance.
14559
14560@menu
14561* Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
2fce4cd8 14562* Mail Source Functions::
8a1cdce5
AC
14563* Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14564* Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14565@end menu
4009494e 14566
4009494e 14567
8a1cdce5
AC
14568@node Mail Source Specifiers
14569@subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14570@cindex POP
14571@cindex mail server
14572@cindex procmail
14573@cindex mail spool
14574@cindex mail source
4009494e 14575
8a1cdce5
AC
14576You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14577(@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
4009494e 14578
8a1cdce5 14579Here's an example:
4009494e
GM
14580
14581@lisp
8a1cdce5 14582(pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
4009494e
GM
14583@end lisp
14584
8a1cdce5
AC
14585As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14586element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14587@dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14588default values.
31fe2b00 14589
8a1cdce5
AC
14590The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14591an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14592@code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14593@code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14594a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14595typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14596group might look like this:
31fe2b00
SM
14597
14598@lisp
8a1cdce5 14599(mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
31fe2b00 14600@end lisp
4009494e 14601
8a1cdce5
AC
14602This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14603fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
4009494e 14604
8a1cdce5 14605The following mail source types are available:
4009494e
GM
14606
14607@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
14608@item file
14609Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
4009494e 14610
8a1cdce5 14611Keywords:
4009494e
GM
14612
14613@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
14614@item :path
14615The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14616environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14617(usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
4009494e 14618
8a1cdce5
AC
14619@item :prescript
14620@itemx :postscript
14621Script run before/after fetching mail.
4009494e
GM
14622@end table
14623
8a1cdce5 14624An example file mail source:
01c52d31 14625
8a1cdce5
AC
14626@lisp
14627(file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14628@end lisp
01c52d31 14629
8a1cdce5 14630Or using the default file name:
01c52d31 14631
8a1cdce5
AC
14632@lisp
14633(file)
14634@end lisp
31fe2b00 14635
8a1cdce5
AC
14636If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14637to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14638You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14639mail spool while moving the mail.
4009494e 14640
8a1cdce5 14641If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
4009494e 14642
8a1cdce5
AC
14643@lisp
14644(setq mail-sources
14645 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14646@end lisp
4009494e 14647
8a1cdce5 14648The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
4009494e 14649
8a1cdce5
AC
14650@example
14651#!/bin/sh
14652# getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14653# flu@@iki.fi
4009494e 14654
8a1cdce5
AC
14655MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14656TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14657rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14658@end example
4009494e 14659
8a1cdce5
AC
14660Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14661file you want to use.
4009494e 14662
4009494e 14663
8a1cdce5
AC
14664@item directory
14665@vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14666Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14667when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14668That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14669directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14670will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14671to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14672@code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14673Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14674if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
4009494e 14675
8a1cdce5
AC
14676@vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14677There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14678that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14679applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
4009494e 14680
8a1cdce5 14681Keywords:
4009494e
GM
14682
14683@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
14684@item :path
14685The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14686value.
4009494e 14687
8a1cdce5
AC
14688@item :suffix
14689Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14690@samp{.spool}.
4009494e 14691
8a1cdce5
AC
14692@item :predicate
14693Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14694The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14695filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14696predicate are considered.
4009494e 14697
8a1cdce5
AC
14698@item :prescript
14699@itemx :postscript
14700Script run before/after fetching mail.
4009494e 14701
8a1cdce5 14702@end table
4009494e 14703
8a1cdce5 14704An example directory mail source:
4009494e 14705
8a1cdce5
AC
14706@lisp
14707(directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14708 :suffix ".prcml")
14709@end lisp
4009494e 14710
8a1cdce5
AC
14711@item pop
14712Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
4009494e 14713
8a1cdce5 14714Keywords:
4009494e 14715
8a1cdce5
AC
14716@table @code
14717@item :server
14718The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14719@env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
4009494e 14720
8a1cdce5 14721@item :port
1df7defd
PE
14722The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (e.g.,
14723@samp{:port 1234}) or a string (e.g., @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
8a1cdce5
AC
14724string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14725Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14726need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
01c52d31 14727
8a1cdce5
AC
14728@item :user
14729The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14730name.
01c52d31 14731
8a1cdce5
AC
14732@item :password
14733The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14734the user is prompted.
01c52d31 14735
8a1cdce5
AC
14736@item :program
14737The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14738should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
01c52d31 14739
8a1cdce5
AC
14740@example
14741fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14742@end example
01c52d31 14743
8a1cdce5 14744The valid format specifier characters are:
01c52d31 14745
8a1cdce5
AC
14746@table @samp
14747@item t
14748The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14749included in this string.
01c52d31 14750
8a1cdce5
AC
14751@item s
14752The name of the server.
01c52d31 14753
8a1cdce5
AC
14754@item P
14755The port number of the server.
01c52d31 14756
8a1cdce5
AC
14757@item u
14758The user name to use.
01c52d31 14759
8a1cdce5
AC
14760@item p
14761The password to use.
14762@end table
4009494e 14763
8a1cdce5
AC
14764The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14765corresponding keywords.
4009494e 14766
8a1cdce5
AC
14767@item :prescript
14768A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14769the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
4009494e 14770
7c4bbb69
LI
14771One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14772@acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14773
14774@lisp
14775(pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14776 :port 1234
14777 :user "foo"
14778 :password "secret"
14779 :prescript
14780 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14781@end lisp
14782
8a1cdce5
AC
14783@item :postscript
14784A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14785the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
4009494e 14786
8a1cdce5
AC
14787@item :function
14788The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14789function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14790mail should be moved to.
4009494e 14791
8a1cdce5
AC
14792@item :authentication
14793This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14794and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14795@code{password}.
4009494e 14796
a71e2379
G
14797@item :leave
14798Non-@code{nil} if the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
d401ef43
KY
14799after fetching. Only the built-in @code{pop3-movemail} program (the
14800default) supports this keyword.
14801
14802If this is a number, leave mails on the server for this many days since
14803you first checked new mails. In that case, mails once fetched will
14804never be fetched again by the @acronym{UIDL} control. If this is
14805@code{nil} (the default), mails will be deleted on the server right
14806after fetching. If this is neither @code{nil} nor a number, all mails
14807will be left on the server, and you will end up getting the same mails
14808again and again.
a71e2379
G
14809
14810@vindex pop3-uidl-file
14811The @code{pop3-uidl-file} variable specifies the file to which the
14812@acronym{UIDL} data are locally stored. The default value is
14813@file{~/.pop3-uidl}.
14814
14815Note that @acronym{POP} servers maintain no state information between
14816sessions, so what the client believes is there and what is actually
14817there may not match up. If they do not, then you may get duplicate
14818mails or the whole thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt
14819mailbox.
14820
8a1cdce5 14821@end table
4009494e 14822
a71e2379 14823@findex pop3-movemail
8a1cdce5
AC
14824@vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14825If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
a71e2379 14826@code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
4009494e 14827
8a1cdce5 14828Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
a71e2379 14829
8a1cdce5
AC
14830Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14831name, and default fetcher:
4009494e 14832
8a1cdce5
AC
14833@lisp
14834(pop)
14835@end lisp
4009494e 14836
8a1cdce5 14837Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
4009494e 14838
8a1cdce5
AC
14839@lisp
14840(pop :server "my.pop.server"
14841 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14842@end lisp
4009494e 14843
a71e2379
G
14844Leave mails on the server for 14 days:
14845
14846@lisp
14847(pop :server "my.pop.server"
14848 :user "user-name" :password "secret"
14849 :leave 14)
14850@end lisp
14851
8a1cdce5 14852Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
4009494e 14853
8a1cdce5
AC
14854@lisp
14855(pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14856@end lisp
4009494e 14857
8a1cdce5
AC
14858@item maildir
14859Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14860at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14861contains exactly one mail.
4009494e 14862
8a1cdce5 14863Keywords:
4009494e 14864
8a1cdce5
AC
14865@table @code
14866@item :path
14867The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14868taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14869@file{~/Maildir/}.
14870@item :subdirs
14871The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14872@samp{("new" "cur")}.
4009494e 14873
8a1cdce5
AC
14874@c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14875@c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14876@c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14877@c below.
4009494e 14878
8a1cdce5
AC
14879You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14880from locking problems).
4009494e 14881
8a1cdce5 14882@end table
8ccbef23 14883
8a1cdce5 14884Two example maildir mail sources:
8ccbef23 14885
8a1cdce5
AC
14886@lisp
14887(maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14888 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14889@end lisp
8ccbef23 14890
8a1cdce5
AC
14891@lisp
14892(maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14893 :subdirs ("new"))
14894@end lisp
8ccbef23 14895
8a1cdce5
AC
14896@item imap
14897Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
1df7defd 14898@acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (i.e.,
8a1cdce5
AC
14899with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14900to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14901@acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
8ccbef23 14902
8a1cdce5 14903Keywords:
8ccbef23 14904
8a1cdce5
AC
14905@table @code
14906@item :server
14907The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14908@env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
8ccbef23 14909
8a1cdce5
AC
14910@item :port
14911The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14912@samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
8ccbef23 14913
8a1cdce5
AC
14914@item :user
14915The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14916name.
8ccbef23 14917
8a1cdce5
AC
14918@item :password
14919The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14920prompted.
8ccbef23 14921
8a1cdce5
AC
14922@item :stream
14923What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14924symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14925@samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14926@samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
8ccbef23 14927
8a1cdce5
AC
14928@item :authentication
14929Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14930one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14931this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14932@samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
8ccbef23 14933
8a1cdce5
AC
14934@item :program
14935When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14936mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14937@code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
8ccbef23
G
14938
14939@example
8a1cdce5 14940ssh %s imapd
8ccbef23
G
14941@end example
14942
8a1cdce5
AC
14943Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14944don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14945specifier characters are:
8ccbef23 14946
8a1cdce5
AC
14947@table @samp
14948@item s
14949The name of the server.
8ccbef23 14950
8a1cdce5
AC
14951@item l
14952User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
8ccbef23 14953
8a1cdce5
AC
14954@item p
14955The port number of the server.
14956@end table
ed797193 14957
8a1cdce5
AC
14958The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14959corresponding keywords.
8ccbef23 14960
8a1cdce5
AC
14961@item :mailbox
14962The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14963which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
8ccbef23 14964
8a1cdce5
AC
14965@item :predicate
14966The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14967UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14968sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14969articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14970Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14971complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
8ccbef23 14972
8a1cdce5
AC
14973@item :fetchflag
14974How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14975will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14976would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14977but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
8ccbef23 14978
8a1cdce5
AC
14979@item :dontexpunge
14980If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14981mailbox after finishing the fetch.
8ccbef23 14982
8a1cdce5 14983@end table
8ccbef23 14984
8a1cdce5 14985An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
181cb5fb 14986
8a1cdce5
AC
14987@lisp
14988(imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14989 :stream kerberos4
14990 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14991@end lisp
8ccbef23 14992
8a1cdce5
AC
14993@item group
14994Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
14995@xref{Group Parameters}.
229b59da 14996
8ccbef23
G
14997@end table
14998
8a1cdce5
AC
14999@table @dfn
15000@item Common Keywords
15001Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
8ccbef23 15002
8a1cdce5 15003Keywords:
8ccbef23
G
15004
15005@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
15006@item :plugged
15007If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
15008use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
15009example:
8ccbef23 15010
8a1cdce5
AC
15011@lisp
15012(setq mail-sources
15013 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
15014 :suffix ""
15015 :plugged t)))
15016@end lisp
6b958814 15017
8a1cdce5
AC
15018Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
15019useful when you use local mail and news.
99e65b2d 15020
8a1cdce5 15021@end table
8ccbef23
G
15022@end table
15023
2fce4cd8 15024@node Mail Source Functions
8a1cdce5 15025@subsubsection Function Interface
8ccbef23 15026
8a1cdce5
AC
15027Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
15028For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
15029the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
15030consider the following mail-source setting:
4009494e 15031
8a1cdce5
AC
15032@lisp
15033(setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
15034 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15035@end lisp
4009494e 15036
8a1cdce5
AC
15037While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15038is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15039@code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15040@code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15041and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
4009494e 15042
8a1cdce5 15043See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
4009494e 15044
4009494e 15045
8a1cdce5
AC
15046@node Mail Source Customization
15047@subsubsection Mail Source Customization
4009494e 15048
8a1cdce5
AC
15049The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15050fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15051variables.
4009494e 15052
8a1cdce5
AC
15053@table @code
15054@item mail-source-crash-box
15055@vindex mail-source-crash-box
15056File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15057@file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
4009494e 15058
8a1cdce5
AC
15059@cindex Incoming*
15060@item mail-source-delete-incoming
15061@vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15062If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15063@code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15064files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15065(the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15066set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15067@code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15068@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15069and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
4009494e 15070
8a1cdce5
AC
15071@item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15072@vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15073If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15074files. This variable only applies when
15075@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
4009494e 15076
8a1cdce5
AC
15077@item mail-source-ignore-errors
15078@vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15079If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15080
15081@item mail-source-directory
15082@vindex mail-source-directory
15083Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15084default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15085is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15086@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
4009494e 15087
8a1cdce5
AC
15088@item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15089@vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15090Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15091@file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15092@file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15093relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15094number.
4009494e 15095
8a1cdce5
AC
15096@item mail-source-default-file-modes
15097@vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
8d80ef01 15098All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
4009494e 15099
8a1cdce5
AC
15100@item mail-source-movemail-program
15101@vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15102If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15103@code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
4009494e 15104
8a1cdce5 15105@end table
4009494e 15106
4009494e 15107
8a1cdce5
AC
15108@node Fetching Mail
15109@subsubsection Fetching Mail
4009494e 15110
8a1cdce5
AC
15111@vindex mail-sources
15112The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15113@code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15114(@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
4009494e 15115
8a1cdce5
AC
15116If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15117fetch mail by themselves.
4009494e 15118
8a1cdce5
AC
15119If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15120@acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
4009494e 15121
8a1cdce5
AC
15122@lisp
15123(setq mail-sources
15124 '((file)
15125 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15126 :password "secret")))
15127@end lisp
4009494e 15128
8a1cdce5 15129Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
4009494e
GM
15130
15131@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15132(setq mail-sources
15133 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15134 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15135 :user "user-name"
15136 :port "pop3"
15137 :password "secret")))
4009494e
GM
15138@end lisp
15139
4009494e 15140
8a1cdce5
AC
15141When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15142inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15143mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15144invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15145pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15146shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
4009494e 15147
4009494e 15148
4009494e 15149
8a1cdce5
AC
15150@node Mail Back End Variables
15151@subsection Mail Back End Variables
4009494e 15152
8a1cdce5
AC
15153These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15154mail back ends.
4009494e 15155
8a1cdce5
AC
15156@table @code
15157@vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15158@item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15159The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15160use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
4009494e 15161
8a1cdce5
AC
15162@vindex nnmail-split-hook
15163@item nnmail-split-hook
15164@findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15165@cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15166@cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15167Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15168just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15169free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15170is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15171in the buffer will show up in any files.
15172@code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15173to this hook.
15174
15175@vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15176@vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15177@item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15178@itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15179These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15180mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15181starting to handle the new mail) and
15182@code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15183is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15184default file modes the new mail files get:
4009494e
GM
15185
15186@lisp
8a1cdce5 15187(add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
8d80ef01 15188 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
8a1cdce5
AC
15189
15190(add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
8d80ef01 15191 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
4009494e
GM
15192@end lisp
15193
8a1cdce5
AC
15194@item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15195@vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15196If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15197names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15198(assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15199@code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15200the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
4009494e 15201
8a1cdce5
AC
15202@item nnmail-delete-file-function
15203@vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15204@findex delete-file
15205Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
4009494e 15206
8a1cdce5
AC
15207@item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15208@vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15209If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15210the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15211discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 15212
8a1cdce5
AC
15213@item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15214@vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15215This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15216Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15217recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
4009494e 15218
8a1cdce5
AC
15219This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15220(@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15221@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
4009494e 15222
8a1cdce5 15223@end table
4009494e 15224
a3f57c41 15225
8a1cdce5
AC
15226@node Fancy Mail Splitting
15227@subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15228@cindex mail splitting
15229@cindex fancy mail splitting
15230
15231@vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15232@findex nnmail-split-fancy
15233If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15234doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15235@code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15236play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15237
15238Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15239
15240@lisp
15241;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15242;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15243;; @r{from real errors.}
15244(| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15245 "mail.misc"))
15246 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15247 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15248 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15249 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15250 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15251 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15252 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15253 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15254 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15255 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15256 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15257 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15258 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15259 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15260 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15261 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15262 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15263 "misc.misc")
15264@end lisp
15265
15266This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15267(possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15268splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
4009494e 15269
8a1cdce5 15270@table @code
4009494e 15271
8a1cdce5
AC
15272@item group
15273If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15274regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
4009494e 15275
8a1cdce5
AC
15276@c Don't fold this line.
15277@item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15278The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15279first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15280@var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15281@var{split}.
4009494e 15282
8a1cdce5
AC
15283If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15284@var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15285@var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15286@var{split} is processed.
4009494e 15287
8a1cdce5
AC
15288The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15289non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15290variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15291be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
4009494e 15292
8a1cdce5
AC
15293@item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15294If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15295bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15296@var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15297stored in one or more groups.
4009494e 15298
8a1cdce5
AC
15299@item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15300If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15301process all @var{split}s in the list.
4009494e 15302
8a1cdce5
AC
15303@item junk
15304If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15305this message. Use with extreme caution.
4009494e 15306
8a1cdce5
AC
15307@item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15308If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15309second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15310arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
4009494e 15311
8a1cdce5
AC
15312@cindex body split
15313For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15314body of the messages:
4009494e 15315
8a1cdce5
AC
15316@lisp
15317(defun split-on-body ()
15318 (save-excursion
15319 (save-restriction
15320 (widen)
15321 (goto-char (point-min))
15322 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15323 "string.group"))))
15324@end lisp
4009494e 15325
8a1cdce5
AC
15326The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15327@var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15328after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15329above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15330not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15331@code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15332(@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
4009494e 15333
8a1cdce5
AC
15334@item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15335If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15336@var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15337function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15338should return a split.
4009494e 15339
8a1cdce5
AC
15340@item nil
15341If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
4009494e 15342
8a1cdce5 15343@end table
4009494e 15344
8a1cdce5 15345In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
4009494e 15346
8a1cdce5
AC
15347Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15348according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15349@var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15350which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15351for example,
4009494e 15352
8a1cdce5
AC
15353@example
15354(any "joe" "joemail")
15355@end example
a1da1e37 15356
8a1cdce5
AC
15357@noindent
15358messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15359in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15360of the following three ways:
a1da1e37 15361
8a1cdce5
AC
15362@enumerate
15363@item
15364@vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15365You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15366to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15367match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15368words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15369@code{nil}.
a1da1e37 15370
8a1cdce5 15371Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
4009494e 15372
8a1cdce5
AC
15373@item
15374@var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15375a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15376in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15377@code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15378@code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
4009494e 15379
8a1cdce5
AC
15380@item
15381You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15382@samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15383section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15384are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15385@code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15386ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15387non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15388@end enumerate
4009494e 15389
8a1cdce5
AC
15390@vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15391@var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15392they are expanded as specified by the variable
15393@code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15394where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15395contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15396@code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
4009494e 15397
8a1cdce5
AC
15398@table @code
15399@item from
15400Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15401@item to
15402Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15403@samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15404@item any
15405Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
4009494e
GM
15406@end table
15407
8a1cdce5
AC
15408@vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15409@code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15410when all this splitting is performed.
4009494e 15411
8a1cdce5
AC
15412If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15413information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15414substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
4009494e 15415
8a1cdce5
AC
15416@example
15417(any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15418@end example
4009494e 15419
8a1cdce5
AC
15420In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15421will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
4009494e 15422
172f73b1 15423If the string contains the element @samp{\\&}, then the previously
8a1cdce5
AC
15424matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15425up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15426groupings 1 through 9.
4009494e 15427
8a1cdce5
AC
15428@vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15429Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15430lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15431Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15432groups when users send to an address using different case
1df7defd 15433(i.e., mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
8a1cdce5
AC
15434is @code{t}.
15435
15436@findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15437@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15438split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15439you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15440boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15441working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15442string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15443messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15444it once per thread.
4009494e 15445
8a1cdce5
AC
15446To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15447and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15448value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15449using the colon feature, like so:
4009494e 15450@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15451(setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15452 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15453 nnmail-split-fancy
15454 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15455 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15456 ))
4009494e
GM
15457@end lisp
15458
8a1cdce5
AC
15459This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15460non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15461in the file specified by the variable
15462@code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15463(the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15464invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15465at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15466and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15467for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15468corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15469@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15470recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15471somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15472still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15473300 kBytes in size.)
15474@vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15475When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15476also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15477messages goes into the new group.
4009494e 15478
8a1cdce5
AC
15479Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15480want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15481outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15482@code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15483Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15484``outgoing'' group.
4009494e
GM
15485
15486
8a1cdce5
AC
15487@node Group Mail Splitting
15488@subsection Group Mail Splitting
15489@cindex mail splitting
15490@cindex group mail splitting
4009494e 15491
8a1cdce5
AC
15492@findex gnus-group-split
15493If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15494maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15495You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15496parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15497@code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15498for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15499from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15500@code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
4009494e 15501
8a1cdce5
AC
15502Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15503splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15504parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15505rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
4009494e 15506
8a1cdce5
AC
15507All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15508@code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15509the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15510@code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15511matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15512group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15513@code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
4009494e 15514
8a1cdce5
AC
15515If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15516parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15517parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15518this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15519@code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15520@code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15521@code{gnus-group-split}.
4009494e 15522
8a1cdce5
AC
15523@vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15524@code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15525by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15526group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15527group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15528some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15529that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15530often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15531complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15532may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15533personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15534element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15535with the rules extracted from group parameters.
4009494e 15536
8a1cdce5
AC
15537It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15538been defined:
4009494e 15539
8a1cdce5
AC
15540@example
15541nnml:mail.bar:
15542((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15543 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15544nnml:mail.foo:
15545((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15546 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15547 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15548 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15549nnml:mail.others:
15550((split-spec . catch-all))
15551@end example
4009494e 15552
8a1cdce5
AC
15553Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15554behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15555@code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
4009494e
GM
15556
15557@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15558(| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15559 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15560 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15561 "mail.others")
4009494e
GM
15562@end lisp
15563
8a1cdce5
AC
15564@findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15565If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15566may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15567splits like this:
4009494e 15568
8a1cdce5
AC
15569@lisp
15570(: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15571@end lisp
4009494e 15572
8a1cdce5
AC
15573@var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15574parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15575@var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15576single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15577fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15578If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15579empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15580Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15581this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
4009494e 15582
8a1cdce5
AC
15583@findex gnus-group-split-setup
15584Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15585slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15586But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15587used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15588sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15589@code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15590@code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15591scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
4009494e 15592
8a1cdce5
AC
15593@findex gnus-group-split-update
15594However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15595@code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15596@code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15597automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15598you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4009494e 15599
8a1cdce5
AC
15600@lisp
15601(gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15602@end lisp
4009494e 15603
8a1cdce5
AC
15604If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15605will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15606have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15607don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15608@code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15609value.
4009494e 15610
8a1cdce5
AC
15611@vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15612Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15613by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15614@code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
4009494e 15615
8a1cdce5
AC
15616@node Incorporating Old Mail
15617@subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15618@cindex incorporating old mail
15619@cindex import old mail
4009494e 15620
8a1cdce5
AC
15621Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15622you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15623back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15624your mail groups.
4009494e 15625
8a1cdce5 15626Doing so can be quite easy.
4009494e 15627
8a1cdce5
AC
15628To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15629(@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15630satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15631file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15632your @code{nnml} groups.
4009494e 15633
8a1cdce5 15634Here's how:
4009494e 15635
8a1cdce5
AC
15636@enumerate
15637@item
15638Go to the group buffer.
4009494e 15639
8a1cdce5
AC
15640@item
15641Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15642@code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
4009494e 15643
8a1cdce5
AC
15644@item
15645Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
4009494e 15646
8a1cdce5
AC
15647@item
15648Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15649(@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
4009494e 15650
8a1cdce5
AC
15651@item
15652Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15653@samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15654@end enumerate
4009494e 15655
8a1cdce5
AC
15656All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15657all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15658have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15659deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15660sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
4009494e 15661
8a1cdce5
AC
15662Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15663back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15664using the new mail back end.
4009494e 15665
4009494e 15666
8a1cdce5
AC
15667@node Expiring Mail
15668@subsection Expiring Mail
15669@cindex article expiry
15670@cindex expiring mail
4009494e 15671
8a1cdce5
AC
15672Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15673you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15674different approach to mail reading.
4009494e 15675
8a1cdce5
AC
15676Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15677a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15678actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15679mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15680fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15681Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15682course.
4009494e 15683
8a1cdce5
AC
15684To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15685articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15686that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15687will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15688deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15689more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15690will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15691repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15692NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
4009494e 15693
d30dd079 15694@vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
8a1cdce5
AC
15695You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15696two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15697with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15698for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15699considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15700the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
d30dd079
G
15701@samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15702expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15703these marks.
4009494e 15704
8a1cdce5
AC
15705When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15706who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15707and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15708(@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15709into its own group.)
4009494e 15710
8a1cdce5
AC
15711Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15712answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15713advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15714the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15715between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15716only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15717total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15718Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15719scoring.
4009494e 15720
8a1cdce5
AC
15721@vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15722Groups that match the regular expression
15723@code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15724read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15725expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
4009494e 15726
8a1cdce5
AC
15727By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15728articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15729before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15730automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15731@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e 15732
8a1cdce5 15733@vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
4009494e 15734@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15735(remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15736 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15737(add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
4009494e
GM
15738@end lisp
15739
8a1cdce5
AC
15740Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15741articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15742will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15743articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15744mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15745
15746Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15747articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15748
4009494e 15749@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15750(setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15751 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
4009494e
GM
15752@end lisp
15753
8a1cdce5
AC
15754Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15755@code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
4009494e 15756
8a1cdce5
AC
15757If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15758auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15759don't really mix very well.
4009494e 15760
8a1cdce5
AC
15761@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15762The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15763expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15764message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15765days.
4009494e 15766
8a1cdce5
AC
15767Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15768are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15769have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15770expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15771everywhere else:
4009494e 15772
8a1cdce5
AC
15773@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15774@lisp
15775(setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15776 (lambda (group)
15777 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15778 31)
15779 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15780 1)
15781 ((string= group "important")
15782 'never)
15783 (t
15784 6))))
15785@end lisp
4009494e 15786
8a1cdce5
AC
15787The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15788names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
4009494e 15789
8a1cdce5
AC
15790The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15791@code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15792necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15793@code{never}.
4009494e 15794
8a1cdce5
AC
15795You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15796change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
4009494e 15797
8a1cdce5
AC
15798@vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15799The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15800However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15801to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15802@code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15803parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15804all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15805parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15806string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15807moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15808the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15809from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15810name or @code{delete}.
15811
15812Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15813@lisp
15814(setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15815@end lisp
15816
15817@findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15818@vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15819Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15820expire mail to groups according to the variable
15821@code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
4009494e 15822
8a1cdce5
AC
15823@lisp
15824 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15825 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15826 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15827 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15828 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15829@end lisp
4009494e 15830
8a1cdce5
AC
15831With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15832header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15833get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15834From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15835to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15836@code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
4009494e 15837
8a1cdce5
AC
15838@vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15839If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15840expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15841easier for procmail users.
4009494e 15842
8a1cdce5
AC
15843@vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15844By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15845articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15846parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15847articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15848caution. Even more dangerous is the
15849@code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15850this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15851which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15852will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15853crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15854wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15855@emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15856with! So there!
4009494e 15857
8a1cdce5 15858Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
4009494e 15859
8a1cdce5
AC
15860@vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15861If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15862commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15863auto-expire turned on.
4009494e 15864
8a1cdce5
AC
15865@vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15866The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15867them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15868preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15869hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15870articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15871when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15872will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15873marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15874articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15875don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15876into auto-expire groups, you can set
15877@code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15878non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15879be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15880group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
4009494e 15881
4009494e 15882
8a1cdce5
AC
15883@node Washing Mail
15884@subsection Washing Mail
15885@cindex mail washing
15886@cindex list server brain damage
15887@cindex incoming mail treatment
4009494e 15888
8a1cdce5
AC
15889Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15890really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15891prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15892end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15893Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15894considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
4009494e 15895
8a1cdce5
AC
15896Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15897} to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15898be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15899laugh.
4009494e 15900
8a1cdce5
AC
15901Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15902displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15903storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15904various functions that can be put in these hooks.
4009494e 15905
8a1cdce5
AC
15906@table @code
15907@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15908@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15909This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15910grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15911the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
4009494e 15912
8a1cdce5
AC
15913@table @code
15914@item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15915@findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15916Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15917Emacs running on MS machines.
a1da1e37 15918
4009494e
GM
15919@end table
15920
8a1cdce5
AC
15921@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15922@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15923This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15924cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
4009494e
GM
15925
15926@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
15927@item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15928@findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15929Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15930headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
4009494e 15931
8a1cdce5
AC
15932(Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15933messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15934of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15935rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15936into a feature by documenting it.)
4009494e 15937
8a1cdce5
AC
15938@item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15939@findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15940Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15941beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15942people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15943strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15944also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15945@code{\\(..\\)}.
4009494e 15946
8a1cdce5
AC
15947For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15948@samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
4009494e
GM
15949
15950@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15951(setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15952 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
4009494e
GM
15953@end lisp
15954
8a1cdce5
AC
15955This can also be done non-destructively with
15956@code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
4009494e 15957
8a1cdce5
AC
15958@item nnmail-remove-tabs
15959@findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15960Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
4009494e 15961
8a1cdce5
AC
15962@item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15963@findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15964@c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
15965@cindex Eudora
15966@cindex Pegasus
1df7defd 15967Some mail user agents (e.g., Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
8a1cdce5
AC
15968@code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15969function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15970contain a line matching the regular expression
15971@code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
4009494e 15972
8a1cdce5 15973@end table
4009494e 15974
8a1cdce5
AC
15975@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15976@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15977This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15978include:
4009494e
GM
15979
15980@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
15981@item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15982@findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15983Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
4009494e 15984
8a1cdce5
AC
15985@end table
15986@end table
4009494e 15987
4009494e 15988
8a1cdce5
AC
15989@node Duplicates
15990@subsection Duplicates
15991
15992@vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15993@vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15994@vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15995@cindex duplicate mails
15996If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15997receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15998@code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
f99f1641 15999this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s:
8a1cdce5
AC
16000@code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
16001default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
16002there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
16003variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
16004stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
16005@code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
16006default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
16007will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
16008that this is a duplicate of a different message.
16009
16010This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
16011will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
16012the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
16013@code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
4009494e 16014
8a1cdce5
AC
16015You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
16016@code{nil}.
4009494e 16017
8a1cdce5
AC
16018If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
16019@dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
16020methods:
4009494e 16021
8a1cdce5
AC
16022@lisp
16023(setq nnmail-split-fancy
16024 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
16025 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
16026 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
16027 (any mail "mail.misc")
16028 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16029 [...] ))
16030@end lisp
16031@noindent
16032Or something like:
16033@lisp
16034(setq nnmail-split-methods
16035 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16036 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16037 [...]))
16038@end lisp
4009494e 16039
8a1cdce5
AC
16040Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16041with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16042@code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16043using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16044received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
4009494e 16045
4009494e 16046
8a1cdce5
AC
16047@node Not Reading Mail
16048@subsection Not Reading Mail
4009494e 16049
8a1cdce5
AC
16050If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16051habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16052be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
4009494e 16053
8a1cdce5
AC
16054If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16055@code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16056mail, which should help.
4009494e 16057
8a1cdce5
AC
16058@vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16059@vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16060@vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16061@vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16062@vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16063This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16064happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
1606523) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16066variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16067the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16068group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
4009494e 16069
8a1cdce5
AC
16070All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16071narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16072incoming mail.
4009494e 16073
4009494e 16074
8a1cdce5
AC
16075@node Choosing a Mail Back End
16076@subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
4009494e 16077
8a1cdce5
AC
16078Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16079file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16080depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
4009494e 16081
8a1cdce5
AC
16082There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16083back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16084(because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16085Spool}).
4009494e 16086
8a1cdce5
AC
16087@menu
16088* Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16089* Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16090* Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16091* MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16092* Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
2fce4cd8
PE
16093* nnmaildir Group Parameters::
16094* Article Identification::
16095* NOV Data::
16096* Article Marks::
8a1cdce5
AC
16097* Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16098* Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16099@end menu
4009494e
GM
16100
16101
16102
8a1cdce5
AC
16103@node Unix Mail Box
16104@subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16105@cindex nnmbox
16106@cindex unix mail box
4009494e 16107
8a1cdce5
AC
16108@vindex nnmbox-active-file
16109@vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16110The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16111mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16112which group it belongs in.
4009494e 16113
8a1cdce5 16114Virtual server settings:
4009494e 16115
8a1cdce5
AC
16116@table @code
16117@item nnmbox-mbox-file
16118@vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16119The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16120@file{~/mbox}.
4009494e 16121
8a1cdce5
AC
16122@item nnmbox-active-file
16123@vindex nnmbox-active-file
16124The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16125@file{~/.mbox-active}.
4009494e 16126
8a1cdce5
AC
16127@item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16128@vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16129If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16130into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16131@end table
4009494e 16132
4009494e 16133
8a1cdce5
AC
16134@node Babyl
16135@subsubsection Babyl
16136@cindex nnbabyl
4009494e 16137
8a1cdce5
AC
16138@vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16139@vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16140The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16141@code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16142group it belongs in.
4009494e 16143
8a1cdce5 16144Virtual server settings:
4009494e 16145
8a1cdce5
AC
16146@table @code
16147@item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16148@vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16149The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
4009494e 16150
8a1cdce5
AC
16151@item nnbabyl-active-file
16152@vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16153The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16154@file{~/.rmail-active}
4009494e 16155
8a1cdce5
AC
16156@item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16157@vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16158If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16159@code{t}
4009494e
GM
16160@end table
16161
16162
8a1cdce5
AC
16163@node Mail Spool
16164@subsubsection Mail Spool
16165@cindex nnml
16166@cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16167
16168The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16169format. It should be used with some caution.
16170
16171@vindex nnml-directory
16172If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16173one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16174directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16175variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16176
16177You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16178care of all that.
16179
16180If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16181in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16182own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16183weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16184having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16185shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16186know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16187to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
4009494e 16188
8a1cdce5
AC
16189@code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16190splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16191@acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16192fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
4009494e 16193
8a1cdce5 16194Virtual server settings:
4009494e
GM
16195
16196@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
16197@item nnml-directory
16198@vindex nnml-directory
16199All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16200default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16201is @file{~/Mail}).
4009494e 16202
8a1cdce5
AC
16203@item nnml-active-file
16204@vindex nnml-active-file
16205The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16206@file{~/Mail/active}.
4009494e 16207
8a1cdce5
AC
16208@item nnml-newsgroups-file
16209@vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16210The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16211Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
4009494e 16212
8a1cdce5
AC
16213@item nnml-get-new-mail
16214@vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16215If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16216@code{t}.
4009494e 16217
8a1cdce5
AC
16218@item nnml-nov-is-evil
16219@vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16220If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16221default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 16222
8a1cdce5
AC
16223@item nnml-nov-file-name
16224@vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16225The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
4009494e 16226
8a1cdce5
AC
16227@item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16228@vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16229Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
4009494e 16230
8a1cdce5
AC
16231@item nnml-use-compressed-files
16232@vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16233If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16234files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16235(@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16236If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16237as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16238to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16239equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
4009494e 16240
8a1cdce5
AC
16241@item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16242@vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16243Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16244bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16245if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
4009494e 16246
8a1cdce5 16247@end table
4009494e 16248
8a1cdce5
AC
16249@findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16250If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16251whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16252nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16253entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16254might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16255functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16256Commands}).
4009494e 16257
4009494e 16258
8a1cdce5
AC
16259@node MH Spool
16260@subsubsection MH Spool
16261@cindex nnmh
16262@cindex mh-e mail spool
4009494e 16263
8a1cdce5
AC
16264@code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16265@acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16266file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16267@code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16268for.
4009494e 16269
8a1cdce5 16270Virtual server settings:
4009494e 16271
8a1cdce5
AC
16272@table @code
16273@item nnmh-directory
16274@vindex nnmh-directory
16275All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16276default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16277@file{~/Mail})
4009494e 16278
8a1cdce5
AC
16279@item nnmh-get-new-mail
16280@vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16281If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16282@code{t}.
4009494e 16283
8a1cdce5
AC
16284@item nnmh-be-safe
16285@vindex nnmh-be-safe
16286If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16287sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16288they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16289setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16290use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16291have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16292@end table
4009494e 16293
4009494e 16294
8a1cdce5
AC
16295@node Maildir
16296@subsubsection Maildir
16297@cindex nnmaildir
16298@cindex maildir
4009494e 16299
8a1cdce5
AC
16300@code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16301corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16302@uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16303@uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16304also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16305within a maildir.
16306
16307Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16308reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16309your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16310configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16311can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16312configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16313that appear as group in Gnus.
4009494e 16314
8a1cdce5
AC
16315@code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16316never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16317corrupt its data in the filesystem.
4009494e 16318
8a1cdce5
AC
16319@code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16320maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16321another, and you will keep your marks.
4009494e 16322
8a1cdce5 16323Virtual server settings:
4009494e 16324
8a1cdce5
AC
16325@table @code
16326@item directory
16327For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16328you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16329it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16330choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16331will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16332filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16333in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16334scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16335the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16336@code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
4009494e 16337
8a1cdce5
AC
16338The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16339which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16340the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16341only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16342server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16343don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16344optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16345@code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16346use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16347if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16348value.
4009494e 16349
8a1cdce5
AC
16350@item target-prefix
16351This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16352@code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16353server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16354closed.
4009494e 16355
8a1cdce5
AC
16356When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16357created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16358pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16359So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16360@code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16361the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16362@file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16363@file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16364@file{../maildirs/foo}.
4009494e 16365
8a1cdce5
AC
16366You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16367create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16368this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16369with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16370symlinks pointing to them will be).
4009494e 16371
8a1cdce5
AC
16372As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16373then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16374@code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16375cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16376@code{force} argument.
4009494e 16377
8a1cdce5
AC
16378@item directory-files
16379This should be a function with the same interface as
16380@code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16381used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16382parameter is optional; the default is
16383@code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16384@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16385@code{directory-files} otherwise.
16386(@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16387server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16388scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
4009494e 16389
8a1cdce5
AC
16390@item get-new-mail
16391If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16392maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16393the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16394@code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16395value is @code{nil}.
4009494e 16396
8a1cdce5
AC
16397Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16398an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16399that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16400different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16401remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16402@end table
4009494e 16403
2fce4cd8 16404@node nnmaildir Group Parameters
8a1cdce5 16405@subsubsection Group parameters
4009494e 16406
8a1cdce5
AC
16407@code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16408all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16409default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16410one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16411functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16412you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16413another back end.
4009494e 16414
8a1cdce5
AC
16415If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16416is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16417original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16418evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16419different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16420back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16421numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16422@code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16423quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
4009494e 16424
8a1cdce5
AC
16425@table @code
16426@item expire-age
16427An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16428before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16429articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16430@code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16431@code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16432@code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16433and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16434wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
1643560 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16436An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16437modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16438delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16439article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
4009494e 16440
8a1cdce5
AC
16441@item expire-group
16442If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16443@example
16444"backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16445@end example
16446and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16447to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16448before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16449group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16450was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16451destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16452the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16453you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16454article. So that form can refer to
16455@code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16456article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16457does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16458@code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
4009494e 16459
8a1cdce5
AC
16460@item read-only
16461If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16462in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16463from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16464@file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16465cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16466@file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16467containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16468maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16469a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16470have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16471contain extra copies of the articles.
4009494e 16472
8a1cdce5
AC
16473@item directory-files
16474A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16475used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16476group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16477server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
4009494e 16478
8a1cdce5
AC
16479@item distrust-Lines:
16480If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16481article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16482@code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
4009494e 16483
8a1cdce5
AC
16484@item always-marks
16485A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16486Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16487say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16488marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16489feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16490in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
4009494e 16491
8a1cdce5
AC
16492@item never-marks
16493A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16494Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16495say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16496stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16497@code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16498probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16499abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
4009494e 16500
8a1cdce5
AC
16501@item nov-cache-size
16502An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16503speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16504for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16505worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16506parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16507the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16508The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16509and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16510that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16511that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16512@code{read}, plus a little extra.
16513@end table
4009494e 16514
2fce4cd8 16515@node Article Identification
8a1cdce5
AC
16516@subsubsection Article identification
16517Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16518Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16519contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16520@code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16521the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16522identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16523@file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16524about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16525available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16526request the article in the summary buffer.
4009494e 16527
2fce4cd8 16528@node NOV Data
8a1cdce5
AC
16529@subsubsection NOV data
16530An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16531to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16532@code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16533@code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16534need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16535when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16536force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16537single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16538file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16539assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16540with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
4009494e 16541
2fce4cd8 16542@node Article Marks
8a1cdce5
AC
16543@subsubsection Article marks
16544An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16545@code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16546When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16547looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16548asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16549creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16550rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16551links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
4009494e 16552
8a1cdce5
AC
16553You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16554@file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16555your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16556remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16557this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16558it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16559type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16560@kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16561pick up the changes, and might undo them.
4009494e 16562
4009494e 16563
8a1cdce5
AC
16564@node Mail Folders
16565@subsubsection Mail Folders
16566@cindex nnfolder
16567@cindex mbox folders
16568@cindex mail folders
4009494e 16569
8a1cdce5
AC
16570@code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16571separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16572@code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16573numbers and arrival dates.
4009494e 16574
8a1cdce5 16575Virtual server settings:
4009494e 16576
8a1cdce5
AC
16577@table @code
16578@item nnfolder-directory
16579@vindex nnfolder-directory
16580All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16581directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16582(whose default is @file{~/Mail})
4009494e 16583
8a1cdce5
AC
16584@item nnfolder-active-file
16585@vindex nnfolder-active-file
16586The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
4009494e 16587
8a1cdce5
AC
16588@item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16589@vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16590The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16591Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
4009494e 16592
8a1cdce5
AC
16593@item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16594@vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16595If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16596default is @code{t}
4009494e 16597
8a1cdce5
AC
16598@item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16599@vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16600@cindex backup files
16601Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16602backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16603you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16604following in your @file{.emacs} file:
4009494e 16605
8a1cdce5
AC
16606@lisp
16607(defun turn-off-backup ()
16608 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
4009494e 16609
8a1cdce5
AC
16610(add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16611@end lisp
4009494e 16612
8a1cdce5
AC
16613@item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16614@vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16615Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16616This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16617extract some information from it before removing it.
4009494e 16618
8a1cdce5
AC
16619@item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16620@vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16621If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16622default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 16623
8a1cdce5
AC
16624@item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16625@vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16626The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
4009494e 16627
8a1cdce5
AC
16628@item nnfolder-nov-directory
16629@vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16630The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16631@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
4009494e 16632
8a1cdce5 16633@end table
4009494e 16634
4009494e 16635
8a1cdce5
AC
16636@findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16637@kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16638If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16639@code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16640command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16641@code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16642though.
4009494e 16643
8a1cdce5
AC
16644@node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16645@subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
4009494e 16646
8a1cdce5
AC
16647First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16648low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16649is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16650and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16651mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
4009494e 16652
8a1cdce5
AC
16653The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16654typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16655in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16656articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16657access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16658area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16659@code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16660actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16661via NFS).
4009494e 16662
8a1cdce5
AC
16663The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16664simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16665format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16666future. Here are some high and low points on each:
4009494e 16667
8a1cdce5
AC
16668@table @code
16669@item nnmbox
4009494e 16670
f99f1641
PE
16671UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-defined
16672format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
8a1cdce5
AC
16673they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16674@samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16675to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16676@samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16677historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16678mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16679this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16680area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16681(appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16682to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16683fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16684what's where.
4009494e 16685
8a1cdce5 16686@item nnbabyl
4009494e 16687
8a1cdce5
AC
16688Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16689systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16690reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16691was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16692format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16693spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16694headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
44e97401 16695Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
8a1cdce5
AC
16696and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16697to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16698VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16699perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16700headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16701course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16702uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
4009494e 16703
8a1cdce5
AC
16704Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16705file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16706look at your mail.
4009494e 16707
8a1cdce5 16708@item nnml
4009494e 16709
8a1cdce5
AC
16710@code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16711actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16712fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16713lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16714and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16715Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16716CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16717or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16718@dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16719@acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16720due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16721file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16722extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16723provided by the active file and overviews.
4009494e 16724
8a1cdce5
AC
16725@code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16726resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16727files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16728tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16729the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16730wins big.
4009494e 16731
8a1cdce5
AC
16732It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16733FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16734tiny files.
4009494e 16735
8a1cdce5 16736@item nnmh
4009494e 16737
8a1cdce5
AC
16738The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16739long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16740individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16741is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16742active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16743one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16744slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
4009494e 16745
8a1cdce5 16746@item nnfolder
4009494e 16747
8a1cdce5
AC
16748Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16749method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16750itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16751little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16752a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16753can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16754format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16755it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16756out how many messages there are in each separate group.
4009494e 16757
8a1cdce5
AC
16758If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16759messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16760only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16761friendly mail back end all over.
16762
16763@item nnmaildir
4009494e 16764
8a1cdce5
AC
16765For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16766incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16767mail back ends.
4009494e 16768
8a1cdce5
AC
16769@code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16770differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16771filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16772also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16773per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16774(Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16775slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16776file system.
4009494e 16777
8a1cdce5
AC
16778Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16779as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16780This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16781organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16782entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16783require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16784thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16785whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16786@code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16787@code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16788undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
4009494e 16789
8a1cdce5
AC
16790@code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16791corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16792them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
89b163db 16793else, and still have your marks.
4009494e 16794
8a1cdce5
AC
16795@code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16796(It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16797and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16798is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16799parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16800would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16801removed in the future.
4009494e 16802
8a1cdce5
AC
16803Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16804back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16805on your file system.
4009494e 16806
8a1cdce5
AC
16807@code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16808to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
4009494e 16809
8a1cdce5 16810@end table
b0b63450 16811
4009494e 16812
8a1cdce5
AC
16813@node Browsing the Web
16814@section Browsing the Web
16815@cindex web
16816@cindex browsing the web
16817@cindex www
16818@cindex http
4009494e 16819
8a1cdce5
AC
16820Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16821subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16822eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16823is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16824and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16825go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16826even know what a news group is.
4009494e 16827
8a1cdce5
AC
16828The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16829being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16830they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16831not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16832you mad in the end.
4009494e 16833
8a1cdce5
AC
16834So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16835to do it instead?
4009494e 16836
8a1cdce5
AC
16837Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16838interfaces to these sources.
4009494e 16839
8a1cdce5
AC
16840@menu
16841* Archiving Mail::
16842* Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16843* RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16844* Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16845@end menu
4009494e 16846
8a1cdce5
AC
16847All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16848alternatives to work.
4009494e 16849
8a1cdce5
AC
16850The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16851work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16852is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16853will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16854though, you should be ok.
4009494e 16855
8a1cdce5
AC
16856One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16857are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16858cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16859Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16860leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
4009494e 16861
8a1cdce5
AC
16862@node Archiving Mail
16863@subsection Archiving Mail
16864@cindex archiving mail
16865@cindex backup of mail
4009494e 16866
8a1cdce5
AC
16867Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16868@code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16869For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16870marks is fairly simple.
4009494e 16871
8a1cdce5
AC
16872(Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16873requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16874though.)
4009494e 16875
8a1cdce5
AC
16876To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16877server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16878to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16879similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16880adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16881@ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16882might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16883before you restore the data.
4009494e 16884
8a1cdce5
AC
16885@node Web Searches
16886@subsection Web Searches
16887@cindex nnweb
16888@cindex Google
16889@cindex dejanews
16890@cindex gmane
16891@cindex Usenet searches
16892@cindex searching the Usenet
4009494e 16893
8a1cdce5
AC
16894It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16895string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16896those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16897the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16898searches without having to use a browser.
4009494e 16899
8a1cdce5
AC
16900The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16901engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16902then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16903group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16904Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
4009494e 16905
8a1cdce5
AC
16906@code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16907groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16908each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16909pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16910manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16911Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16912@code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16913engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16914of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16915header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16916group as read.
4009494e 16917
8a1cdce5
AC
16918If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16919won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16920providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
16921make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16922community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16923might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
4009494e 16924
8a1cdce5
AC
16925You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16926(try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16927installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
4009494e 16928
8a1cdce5 16929Virtual server variables:
4009494e 16930
8a1cdce5
AC
16931@table @code
16932@item nnweb-type
16933@vindex nnweb-type
16934What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16935are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16936@code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
4009494e 16937
8a1cdce5
AC
16938@item nnweb-search
16939@vindex nnweb-search
16940The search string to feed to the search engine.
4009494e 16941
8a1cdce5
AC
16942@item nnweb-max-hits
16943@vindex nnweb-max-hits
16944Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16945999.
4009494e 16946
8a1cdce5
AC
16947@item nnweb-type-definition
16948@vindex nnweb-type-definition
16949Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16950with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16951present:
4009494e 16952
8a1cdce5
AC
16953@table @code
16954@item article
16955Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16956understands.
4009494e 16957
8a1cdce5
AC
16958@item map
16959Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
4009494e 16960
8a1cdce5
AC
16961@item search
16962Function to send the search string to the search engine.
4009494e 16963
8a1cdce5
AC
16964@item address
16965The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16966to.
4009494e 16967
8a1cdce5
AC
16968@item id
16969Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16970@end table
4009494e 16971
8a1cdce5 16972@end table
4009494e 16973
4009494e 16974
8a1cdce5
AC
16975@node RSS
16976@subsection RSS
16977@cindex nnrss
16978@cindex RSS
4009494e 16979
8a1cdce5
AC
16980Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16981@acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16982sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16983presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
f2a538a2 16984changes to a wiki (e.g., @url{http://cliki.net/site/recent-changes}).
4009494e 16985
8a1cdce5
AC
16986@acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16987possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
4009494e 16988
8a1cdce5
AC
16989Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16990system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16991text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16992group names.
4009494e 16993
8a1cdce5
AC
16994@kindex G R (Group)
16995Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16996prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16997The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16998and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
4009494e 16999
8a1cdce5
AC
17000An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
17001the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
17002subscribe to groups.
4009494e 17003
8a1cdce5
AC
17004The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
17005@code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
17006names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
17007coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
17008variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
17009information.
4009494e 17010
8a1cdce5
AC
17011The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
17012@acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
17013and a @samp{text/html} part.
4009494e 17014
8a1cdce5
AC
17015@cindex OPML
17016You can also use the following commands to import and export your
17017subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
17018Markup Language).
8ccbef23 17019
8a1cdce5
AC
17020@defun nnrss-opml-import file
17021Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
17022file.
17023@end defun
4009494e 17024
8a1cdce5
AC
17025@defun nnrss-opml-export
17026Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
17027@acronym{OPML} format.
17028@end defun
4009494e 17029
8a1cdce5 17030The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
4009494e
GM
17031
17032@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
17033@item nnrss-directory
17034@vindex nnrss-directory
17035The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
17036@file{~/News/rss/}.
4009494e 17037
8a1cdce5
AC
17038@item nnrss-file-coding-system
17039@vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
17040The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
17041data files. The default is the value of
17042@code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17043in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
4009494e 17044
8a1cdce5
AC
17045@item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17046@vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17047Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
1df7defd 17048e.g., to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
8a1cdce5
AC
17049a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17050is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17051variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17052@code{'(slash:comments)}.
4009494e 17053
8a1cdce5
AC
17054@item nnrss-use-local
17055@vindex nnrss-use-local
17056@findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17057If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17058the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17059the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17060download script using @command{wget}.
17061@end table
4009494e 17062
8a1cdce5
AC
17063The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17064the summary buffer.
4009494e 17065
8a1cdce5
AC
17066@lisp
17067(add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17068(setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
4009494e 17069
8a1cdce5
AC
17070(defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17071 (let ((descr
17072 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17073 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17074@end lisp
4009494e 17075
8a1cdce5
AC
17076The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17077summary buffer.
4009494e 17078
8a1cdce5
AC
17079@lisp
17080(require 'browse-url)
4009494e 17081
8a1cdce5
AC
17082(defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17083 (interactive "p")
17084 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17085 (mail-header-extra
17086 (gnus-data-header
17087 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17088 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17089 (if url
17090 (progn
17091 (browse-url (cdr url))
17092 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17093 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
4009494e 17094
8a1cdce5
AC
17095(eval-after-load "gnus"
17096 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17097 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17098(add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17099@end lisp
4009494e 17100
8a1cdce5
AC
17101Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17102@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17103Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17104Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17105more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17106@samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17107@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17108Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17109@code{nnrss} groups:
4009494e 17110
8a1cdce5
AC
17111@lisp
17112;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17113(eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17114 '(add-to-list
17115 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17116 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17117 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
4009494e 17118
8a1cdce5
AC
17119;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17120(add-to-list
17121 'gnus-parameters
17122 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17123@end lisp
4009494e 17124
4009494e 17125
8a1cdce5
AC
17126@node Customizing W3
17127@subsection Customizing W3
17128@cindex W3
17129@cindex html
17130@cindex url
17131@cindex Netscape
4009494e 17132
8a1cdce5
AC
17133Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17134alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17135manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17136users.
4009494e 17137
8a1cdce5
AC
17138For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17139using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17140browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
4009494e 17141
8a1cdce5
AC
17142@lisp
17143(eval-after-load "w3"
17144 '(progn
17145 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17146 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17147 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17148 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17149 (browse-url url)
17150 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17151@end lisp
4009494e 17152
8a1cdce5
AC
17153Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17154@acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17155follow the link.
4009494e 17156
4009494e 17157
8a1cdce5
AC
17158@node Other Sources
17159@section Other Sources
4009494e 17160
8a1cdce5
AC
17161Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17162below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17163newsgroups.
4009494e 17164
8a1cdce5
AC
17165@menu
17166* Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17167* Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17168* Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17169* Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
c5ecc769 17170* The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
8a1cdce5 17171@end menu
4009494e 17172
4009494e 17173
8a1cdce5
AC
17174@node Directory Groups
17175@subsection Directory Groups
17176@cindex nndir
17177@cindex directory groups
4009494e 17178
8a1cdce5
AC
17179If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17180it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17181names, of course.
4009494e 17182
8a1cdce5
AC
17183This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17184successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17185packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17186back end to read directories. Big deal.
4009494e 17187
8a1cdce5
AC
17188@code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17189enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17190@file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17191@code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17192directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
01c52d31 17193
8a1cdce5 17194@code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
4009494e 17195
8a1cdce5
AC
17196@code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17197articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17198whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17199methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
4009494e 17200
4009494e 17201
8a1cdce5
AC
17202@node Anything Groups
17203@subsection Anything Groups
17204@cindex nneething
4009494e 17205
8a1cdce5
AC
17206From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17207directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17208pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17209true.
4009494e 17210
8a1cdce5
AC
17211When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17212directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17213a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17214After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17215@code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17216file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17217few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
1df7defd 17218just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g., a C source file),
8a1cdce5
AC
17219@code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17220file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17221elements.
4009494e 17222
8a1cdce5
AC
17223All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17224with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17225newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17226in the article buffer, just as usual.
4009494e 17227
8a1cdce5
AC
17228If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17229a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17230traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17231Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
4009494e 17232
8a1cdce5
AC
17233There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17234doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17235will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17236are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17237normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17238article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17239other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17240be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
4009494e 17241
8a1cdce5 17242Some variables:
4009494e 17243
8a1cdce5
AC
17244@table @code
17245@item nneething-map-file-directory
17246@vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17247All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17248in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
4009494e 17249
8a1cdce5
AC
17250@item nneething-exclude-files
17251@vindex nneething-exclude-files
17252All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17253auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
4009494e 17254
8a1cdce5
AC
17255@item nneething-include-files
17256@vindex nneething-include-files
17257Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17258non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
4009494e 17259
8a1cdce5
AC
17260@item nneething-map-file
17261@vindex nneething-map-file
17262Name of the map files.
17263@end table
4009494e 17264
4009494e 17265
8a1cdce5
AC
17266@node Document Groups
17267@subsection Document Groups
17268@cindex nndoc
17269@cindex documentation group
17270@cindex help group
4009494e 17271
8a1cdce5
AC
17272@code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17273as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
4009494e
GM
17274
17275@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
17276@cindex Babyl
17277@item babyl
17278The Babyl format.
4009494e 17279
8a1cdce5
AC
17280@cindex mbox
17281@cindex Unix mbox
17282@item mbox
17283The standard Unix mbox file.
4009494e 17284
8a1cdce5
AC
17285@cindex MMDF mail box
17286@item mmdf
17287The MMDF mail box format.
4009494e 17288
8a1cdce5
AC
17289@item news
17290Several news articles appended into a file.
4009494e 17291
8a1cdce5
AC
17292@cindex rnews batch files
17293@item rnews
17294The rnews batch transport format.
4009494e 17295
8a1cdce5
AC
17296@item nsmail
17297Netscape mail boxes.
4009494e 17298
8a1cdce5
AC
17299@item mime-parts
17300@acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
4009494e 17301
8a1cdce5
AC
17302@item standard-digest
17303The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
4009494e 17304
8a1cdce5
AC
17305@item mime-digest
17306A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
4009494e 17307
8a1cdce5
AC
17308@item lanl-gov-announce
17309Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
4009494e 17310
8a1cdce5
AC
17311@cindex git commit messages
17312@item git
17313@code{git} commit messages.
4009494e 17314
8a1cdce5
AC
17315@cindex forwarded messages
17316@item rfc822-forward
17317A message forwarded according to RFC822.
4009494e 17318
8a1cdce5
AC
17319@item outlook
17320The Outlook mail box.
4009494e 17321
8a1cdce5
AC
17322@item oe-dbx
17323The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
4009494e 17324
8a1cdce5
AC
17325@item exim-bounce
17326A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
4009494e 17327
8a1cdce5
AC
17328@item forward
17329A message forwarded according to informal rules.
4009494e 17330
8a1cdce5
AC
17331@item rfc934
17332An RFC934-forwarded message.
4009494e 17333
8a1cdce5
AC
17334@item mailman
17335A mailman digest.
4009494e 17336
8a1cdce5
AC
17337@item clari-briefs
17338A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
4009494e 17339
8a1cdce5
AC
17340@item slack-digest
17341Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17342
17343@item mail-in-mail
17344The last resort.
4009494e
GM
17345@end table
17346
8a1cdce5
AC
17347You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17348that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17349@code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17350file is.
4009494e 17351
8a1cdce5
AC
17352@code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17353it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17354group. And that's it.
4009494e 17355
8a1cdce5
AC
17356If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17357new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17358that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17359to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17360@code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17361(@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17362the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17363using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17364file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17365delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
4009494e 17366
8a1cdce5 17367Virtual server variables:
4009494e 17368
8a1cdce5
AC
17369@table @code
17370@item nndoc-article-type
17371@vindex nndoc-article-type
17372This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17373@code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17374@code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17375@code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17376@code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
4009494e 17377
8a1cdce5
AC
17378@item nndoc-post-type
17379@vindex nndoc-post-type
17380This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17381a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17382and @code{news}.
17383@end table
4009494e 17384
8a1cdce5
AC
17385@menu
17386* Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17387@end menu
4009494e 17388
4009494e 17389
8a1cdce5
AC
17390@node Document Server Internals
17391@subsubsection Document Server Internals
4009494e 17392
8a1cdce5
AC
17393Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17394difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17395looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17396and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
4009494e 17397
8a1cdce5 17398First, here's an example document type definition:
4009494e 17399
8a1cdce5
AC
17400@example
17401(mmdf
17402 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17403 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17404@end example
4009494e 17405
8a1cdce5
AC
17406The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17407regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17408variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17409types can be defined with very few settings:
4009494e 17410
8a1cdce5
AC
17411@table @code
17412@item first-article
17413If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17414something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17415totally ignored.
4009494e 17416
8a1cdce5
AC
17417@item article-begin
17418This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17419says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17420complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17421use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
4009494e 17422
8a1cdce5
AC
17423@item article-begin-function
17424If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17425of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
4009494e 17426
8a1cdce5
AC
17427@item head-begin
17428If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17429article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17430simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
4009494e 17431
8a1cdce5
AC
17432@item head-begin-function
17433If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17434the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
4009494e 17435
8a1cdce5
AC
17436@item head-end
17437This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17438@samp{^$}---the empty line.
4009494e 17439
8a1cdce5
AC
17440@item body-begin
17441This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17442to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17443a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
4009494e 17444
8a1cdce5
AC
17445@item body-begin-function
17446If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17447of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
4009494e 17448
8a1cdce5
AC
17449@item body-end
17450If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17451more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17452can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
4009494e 17453
8a1cdce5
AC
17454@item body-end-function
17455If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17456the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17457
17458@item file-begin
17459If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17460before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17461
17462@item file-end
17463If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17464regexp will be totally ignored.
4009494e
GM
17465
17466@end table
17467
8a1cdce5
AC
17468So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17469file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17470few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17471news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17472something that's palatable for Gnus:
4009494e 17473
8a1cdce5
AC
17474@table @code
17475@item prepare-body-function
17476If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17477will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17478document has encoded some parts of its contents.
4009494e 17479
8a1cdce5
AC
17480@item article-transform-function
17481If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17482meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17483body of the article.
4009494e 17484
8a1cdce5
AC
17485@item generate-head-function
17486If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17487understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17488expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17489called when requesting the headers of all articles.
4009494e 17490
8a1cdce5
AC
17491@item generate-article-function
17492If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17493Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17494parameter when requesting all articles.
4009494e 17495
8a1cdce5
AC
17496@item dissection-function
17497If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17498overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17499@code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17500@code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17501@code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17502@code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
4009494e 17503
8a1cdce5 17504@end table
4009494e 17505
8a1cdce5
AC
17506Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17507digests:
4009494e 17508
8a1cdce5
AC
17509@example
17510(standard-digest
17511 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17512 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17513 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17514 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17515 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17516 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17517 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17518 (subtype digest guess))
17519@end example
4009494e 17520
8a1cdce5
AC
17521We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17522text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17523each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17524the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17525run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
4009494e 17526
8a1cdce5
AC
17527To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17528@code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17529is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17530where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17531The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17532@code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17533So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17534@code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17535@code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17536is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17537correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17538means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
4009494e 17539
4009494e 17540
8a1cdce5
AC
17541@node Mail-To-News Gateways
17542@subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17543@cindex mail-to-news gateways
17544@cindex gateways
4009494e 17545
8a1cdce5
AC
17546If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17547or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17548The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
4009494e 17549
8a1cdce5
AC
17550Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17551used to post with.
4009494e 17552
8a1cdce5 17553Server variables:
4009494e 17554
8a1cdce5
AC
17555@table @code
17556@item nngateway-address
17557@vindex nngateway-address
17558This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
4009494e 17559
8a1cdce5
AC
17560@item nngateway-header-transformation
17561@vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17562News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17563for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17564transformation should be called, and defaults to
17565@code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17566narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17567gateway address.
4009494e 17568
8a1cdce5
AC
17569This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17570@code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17571For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
4009494e 17572
8a1cdce5
AC
17573@example
17574Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17575@end example
4009494e 17576
8a1cdce5 17577will get this @code{To} header inserted:
4009494e 17578
8a1cdce5
AC
17579@example
17580To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17581@end example
4009494e 17582
8a1cdce5 17583The following pre-defined functions exist:
4009494e 17584
8a1cdce5
AC
17585@findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17586@table @code
4009494e 17587
8a1cdce5
AC
17588@item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17589Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17590@var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
4009494e 17591
8a1cdce5 17592@findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
4009494e 17593
8a1cdce5
AC
17594@item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17595Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17596@code{nngateway-address}.
17597@end table
4009494e
GM
17598
17599@end table
17600
8a1cdce5 17601Here's an example:
4009494e 17602
8a1cdce5
AC
17603@lisp
17604(setq gnus-post-method
17605 '(nngateway
17606 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17607 (nngateway-header-transformation
17608 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17609@end lisp
4009494e 17610
8a1cdce5 17611So, to use this, simply say something like:
4009494e 17612
8a1cdce5
AC
17613@lisp
17614(setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17615@end lisp
4009494e 17616
4009494e 17617
c5ecc769
G
17618@node The Empty Backend
17619@subsection The Empty Backend
17620@cindex nnnil
17621
17622@code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17623have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17624classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17625methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17626
17627@lisp
17628(setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17629(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17630 '((nnimap "foo")
17631 (nnml "")))
17632@end lisp
17633
8a1cdce5
AC
17634
17635@node Combined Groups
17636@section Combined Groups
17637
17638Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17639groups.
4009494e
GM
17640
17641@menu
8a1cdce5 17642* Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
4009494e
GM
17643@end menu
17644
4009494e 17645
8a1cdce5
AC
17646@node Virtual Groups
17647@subsection Virtual Groups
17648@cindex nnvirtual
17649@cindex virtual groups
17650@cindex merging groups
4009494e 17651
8a1cdce5
AC
17652An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17653other groups.
4009494e 17654
8a1cdce5
AC
17655For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17656put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17657big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
4009494e 17658
8a1cdce5
AC
17659You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17660regexp to match component groups.
4009494e 17661
8a1cdce5
AC
17662All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17663component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17664article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17665came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17666shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17667@kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17668and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17669(@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
4009494e 17670
8a1cdce5
AC
17671Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17672newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
4009494e 17673
8a1cdce5
AC
17674@lisp
17675(nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17676@end lisp
4009494e 17677
8a1cdce5
AC
17678The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17679smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
4009494e 17680
8a1cdce5
AC
17681Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17682idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17683If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17684and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
4009494e 17685
8a1cdce5
AC
17686@example
17687"^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17688@end example
4009494e 17689
8a1cdce5
AC
17690(Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17691shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17692characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
4009494e 17693
8a1cdce5
AC
17694This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17695end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17696the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17697sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17698(@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4009494e 17699
8a1cdce5
AC
17700One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17701group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17702zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
4009494e 17703
8a1cdce5
AC
17704@vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17705If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17706is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17707articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17708and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17709been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17710when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17711have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17712that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17713just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17714it---it'll have much the same effect.
4009494e 17715
8a1cdce5
AC
17716@code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17717When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17718has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17719whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17720there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17721and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17722not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
4009494e 17723
8a1cdce5
AC
17724@kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17725line from the article you respond to in these cases.
4009494e 17726
8a1cdce5
AC
17727@code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17728from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17729inherited.
4009494e 17730
4009494e 17731
8a1cdce5
AC
17732@node Email Based Diary
17733@section Email Based Diary
17734@cindex diary
17735@cindex email based diary
17736@cindex calendar
4009494e 17737
8a1cdce5
AC
17738This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17739and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17740sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17741reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17742Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17743namely, as event reminders.
4009494e 17744
8a1cdce5 17745Here is a typical scenario:
4009494e 17746
8a1cdce5
AC
17747@itemize @bullet
17748@item
17749You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17750to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17751@item
17752So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17753@item
17754You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17755@item
17756From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17757is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17758appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17759@item
17760Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17761of the night you're gonna have.
17762@item
17763Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17764message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17765@end itemize
4009494e 17766
8a1cdce5
AC
17767The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17768(that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17769real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17770explained in the sections below.
4009494e 17771
8a1cdce5
AC
17772@menu
17773* The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17774* The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17775* Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17776@end menu
4009494e
GM
17777
17778
8a1cdce5
AC
17779@node The NNDiary Back End
17780@subsection The NNDiary Back End
17781@cindex nndiary
17782@cindex the nndiary back end
4009494e 17783
8a1cdce5
AC
17784@code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17785Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17786@code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17787the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17788directory per group.
4009494e 17789
8a1cdce5
AC
17790 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17791@code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17792of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17793Timestamp} to see how it's done.
4009494e 17794
8a1cdce5
AC
17795@menu
17796* Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17797* Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17798* Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17799@end menu
4009494e 17800
8a1cdce5
AC
17801@node Diary Messages
17802@subsubsection Diary Messages
17803@cindex nndiary messages
17804@cindex nndiary mails
4009494e 17805
8a1cdce5
AC
17806@code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17807presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17808@code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17809@code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17810@code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17811@code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17812crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
4009494e 17813
8a1cdce5
AC
17814@itemize @bullet
17815@item
17816For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17817either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17818(separated by a comma).
17819@item
17820A field is either an integer, or a range.
17821@item
17822A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17823@item
17824Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17825@code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17826for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17827@item
17828As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17829mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17830that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17831@item
17832The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17833value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17834values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17835zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17836list of available time zone values, see the variable
17837@code{nndiary-headers}.
17838@end itemize
4009494e 17839
8a1cdce5
AC
17840As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17841for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
1784221:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17843what to do then):
4009494e 17844
8a1cdce5
AC
17845@example
17846X-Diary-Minute: 0
17847X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17848X-Diary-Dom: 1
17849X-Diary-Month: *
17850X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17851X-Diary-Dow: 1
17852X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17853@end example
4009494e 17854
8a1cdce5
AC
17855@node Running NNDiary
17856@subsubsection Running NNDiary
17857@cindex running nndiary
17858@cindex nndiary operation modes
4009494e 17859
8a1cdce5
AC
17860@code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17861and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17862mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17863from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17864as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17865mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
4009494e 17866
8a1cdce5
AC
17867One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17868``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17869sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17870messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17871being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17872the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17873(which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17874mode.
4009494e 17875
8a1cdce5
AC
17876In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17877things to do:
4009494e 17878
8a1cdce5
AC
17879@itemize @bullet
17880@item
17881Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17882line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e 17883
8a1cdce5
AC
17884@lisp
17885(setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17886@end lisp
17887@item
17888You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17889headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17890Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17891multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17892source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
01c52d31 17893
8a1cdce5
AC
17894As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17895@file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
4009494e 17896
8a1cdce5
AC
17897@example
17898:0 HD :
17899* ^X-Diary
17900.nndiary
17901@end example
17902@end itemize
4009494e 17903
8a1cdce5
AC
17904Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17905that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
4009494e 17906
8a1cdce5
AC
17907@defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17908This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17909@code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17910@code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17911@end defvar
4009494e 17912
8a1cdce5
AC
17913@defvar nndiary-split-methods
17914This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17915@code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17916@end defvar
4009494e 17917
8a1cdce5
AC
17918 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17919(something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17920@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
4009494e 17921
8a1cdce5
AC
17922 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17923@file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17924autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17925also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17926diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
4009494e 17927
8a1cdce5
AC
17928@node Customizing NNDiary
17929@subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17930@cindex customizing nndiary
17931@cindex nndiary customization
4009494e 17932
8a1cdce5
AC
17933Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17934The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17935browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17936two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
4009494e 17937
8a1cdce5
AC
17938@defvar nndiary-reminders
17939This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
1df7defd 17940appointments (e.g., 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
8a1cdce5
AC
17941before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17942diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17943mail.
17944@end defvar
4009494e 17945
8a1cdce5
AC
17946@defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17947Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17948default).
17949@end defvar
4009494e
GM
17950
17951
8a1cdce5
AC
17952@node The Gnus Diary Library
17953@subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17954@cindex gnus-diary
17955@cindex the gnus diary library
4009494e 17956
8a1cdce5
AC
17957Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17958so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17959@code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17960useful things for you.
4009494e 17961
8a1cdce5 17962 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e
GM
17963
17964@lisp
8a1cdce5 17965(require 'gnus-diary)
4009494e
GM
17966@end lisp
17967
8a1cdce5
AC
17968 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17969(@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17970(sorry if you used them before).
4009494e 17971
4009494e
GM
17972
17973@menu
8a1cdce5
AC
17974* Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17975* Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17976* Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17977* Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
4009494e
GM
17978@end menu
17979
8a1cdce5
AC
17980@node Diary Summary Line Format
17981@subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
17982@cindex diary summary buffer line
17983@cindex diary summary line format
4009494e 17984
8a1cdce5
AC
17985Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
17986something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
17987the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
17988see the event's date.
4009494e 17989
8a1cdce5
AC
17990 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
17991summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
1df7defd 17992for the next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
91af3942 17993while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
1df7defd 17994next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
4009494e 17995
8a1cdce5
AC
17996 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
17997@code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
17998expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
4009494e 17999
8a1cdce5
AC
18000@example
18001 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
18002@end example
4009494e 18003
8a1cdce5
AC
18004In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
18005following line to your diary groups'parameters:
4009494e 18006
8a1cdce5
AC
18007@lisp
18008(gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
18009@end lisp
4009494e 18010
8a1cdce5
AC
18011However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
18012Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
18013with the following user options:
4009494e 18014
8a1cdce5
AC
18015@defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
18016Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
18017Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
18018diary groups'parameters.
18019@end defvar
4009494e 18020
8a1cdce5
AC
18021@defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18022Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18023used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18024@end defvar
4009494e 18025
8a1cdce5
AC
18026@defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18027Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18028times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18029format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18030you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18031@end defvar
4009494e 18032
8a1cdce5
AC
18033@node Diary Articles Sorting
18034@subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18035@cindex diary articles sorting
18036@cindex diary summary lines sorting
18037@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18038@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18039@findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
4009494e 18040
8a1cdce5
AC
18041@code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18042Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18043@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18044@code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18045your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
4009494e 18046
8a1cdce5
AC
18047@code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18048@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18049buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18050default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18051Parameters}).
4009494e 18052
8a1cdce5
AC
18053@node Diary Headers Generation
18054@subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18055@cindex diary headers generation
18056@findex gnus-diary-check-message
4009494e 18057
8a1cdce5
AC
18058@code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18059@code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18060headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18061required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18062needed.
4009494e 18063
8a1cdce5
AC
18064 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18065moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18066automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18067@code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18068process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
4009494e 18069
8a1cdce5
AC
18070 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18071all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18072you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18073instance.
4009494e 18074
8a1cdce5
AC
18075@node Diary Group Parameters
18076@subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18077@cindex diary group parameters
4009494e 18078
8a1cdce5
AC
18079When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18080automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18081summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18082diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18083@code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18084to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18085on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18086automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
4009494e 18087
8a1cdce5
AC
18088@node Sending or Not Sending
18089@subsection Sending or Not Sending
4009494e 18090
8a1cdce5
AC
18091Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18092mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
4009494e 18093
8a1cdce5
AC
18094@itemize @bullet
18095@item
18096@code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
c7015153 18097messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
8a1cdce5
AC
18098appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18099sending the diary message to them as well.
18100@item
18101However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18102can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18103message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18104comes in very handy for private appointments.
18105@end itemize
4009494e 18106
8a1cdce5
AC
18107@node Gnus Unplugged
18108@section Gnus Unplugged
18109@cindex offline
18110@cindex unplugged
18111@cindex agent
18112@cindex Gnus agent
18113@cindex Gnus unplugged
4009494e 18114
8a1cdce5
AC
18115In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18116on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18117was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18118read news. Believe it or not.
4009494e 18119
8a1cdce5
AC
18120Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18121modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18122would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18123the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18124have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
4009494e 18125
8a1cdce5
AC
18126Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18127@code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18128for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18129functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18130reading news on a machine.
4009494e 18131
8a1cdce5
AC
18132Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18133fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18134by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
4009494e 18135
8a1cdce5 18136Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
4009494e 18137
8a1cdce5
AC
18138@menu
18139* Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18140* Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18141* Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18142* Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18143* Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18144* Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18145* Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18146* Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18147* Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18148* Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18149* Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18150* Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18151* Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18152* Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18153@end menu
4009494e 18154
c872595d 18155
8a1cdce5
AC
18156@node Agent Basics
18157@subsection Agent Basics
4009494e 18158
8a1cdce5 18159First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
4009494e 18160
8a1cdce5
AC
18161The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18162connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18163When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18164Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
4009494e 18165
8a1cdce5
AC
18166The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18167connected to the net continuously.
4009494e 18168
8a1cdce5
AC
18169@dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18170machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
4009494e 18171
8a1cdce5
AC
18172You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18173shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18174is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18175say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18176you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
4009494e 18177
8a1cdce5
AC
18178Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18179that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18180can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18181servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18182they're kinda like plugged always).
4009494e 18183
8a1cdce5
AC
18184So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18185connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18186servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18187the culprit.
4009494e 18188
8a1cdce5
AC
18189Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18190reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18191server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18192server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18193will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
4009494e 18194
8a1cdce5 18195Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
4009494e 18196
8a1cdce5 18197@itemize @bullet
4009494e 18198
8a1cdce5
AC
18199@item
18200@findex gnus-unplugged
18201You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18202Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18203already fetched while in this mode.
4009494e 18204
8a1cdce5
AC
18205@item
18206You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18207your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18208to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18209as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18210Source Specifiers}).
4009494e 18211
8a1cdce5
AC
18212@item
18213You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18214news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18215@kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18216all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18217articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
4009494e 18218
8a1cdce5
AC
18219@item
18220After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18221unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18222then you read the news offline.
4009494e 18223
8a1cdce5
AC
18224@item
18225And then you go to step 2.
18226@end itemize
4009494e 18227
8a1cdce5
AC
18228Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18229the Agent.
18230
18231@itemize @bullet
4009494e 18232
8a1cdce5
AC
18233@item
18234Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18235back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18236Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18237@kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18238Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18239added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
ba775afe 18240no servers are agentized.
4009494e 18241
8a1cdce5
AC
18242@item
18243Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18244you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18245parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18246is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
4009494e 18247
8a1cdce5
AC
18248Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18249(@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18250to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18251parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18252to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18253your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18254configure them.
4009494e 18255
8a1cdce5
AC
18256@item
18257Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18258@end itemize
4009494e 18259
4009494e 18260
8a1cdce5
AC
18261@node Agent Categories
18262@subsection Agent Categories
4009494e 18263
8a1cdce5
AC
18264One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18265newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18266There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18267find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18268to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18269mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18270you're interested in the articles anyway.
4009494e 18271
8a1cdce5
AC
18272One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18273downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18274groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18275category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18276buffer for creating and managing categories.
4009494e 18277
8a1cdce5
AC
18278If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18279Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18280alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18281difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18282less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18283sink.
4009494e 18284
8a1cdce5
AC
18285Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18286a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18287the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18288parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18289variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18290of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18291your settings.
4009494e 18292
8a1cdce5
AC
18293@menu
18294* Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18295* Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18296* Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18297@end menu
4009494e 18298
4009494e 18299
8a1cdce5
AC
18300@node Category Syntax
18301@subsubsection Category Syntax
4009494e 18302
8a1cdce5
AC
18303A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18304category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18305customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18306listed below.
4009494e 18307
8a1cdce5
AC
18308@cindex Agent Parameters
18309@table @code
18310@item agent-groups
18311The list of groups that are in this category.
4009494e 18312
8a1cdce5
AC
18313@item agent-predicate
18314A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18315are eligible for downloading; and
4009494e 18316
8a1cdce5
AC
18317@item agent-score
18318a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18319deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18320score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
4009494e 18321
8a1cdce5
AC
18322@item agent-enable-expiration
18323a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18324this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18325fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18326only groups that should not be expired.
4009494e 18327
8a1cdce5
AC
18328@item agent-days-until-old
18329an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18330before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
4009494e 18331
8a1cdce5
AC
18332@item agent-low-score
18333an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
4009494e 18334
8a1cdce5
AC
18335@item agent-high-score
18336an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
4009494e 18337
8a1cdce5
AC
18338@item agent-short-article
18339an integer that overrides the value of
18340@code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
4009494e 18341
8a1cdce5
AC
18342@item agent-long-article
18343an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
4009494e 18344
8a1cdce5
AC
18345@item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18346a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18347undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18348faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18349undownloaded faces.
18350@end table
4009494e 18351
8a1cdce5
AC
18352The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18353created.
4009494e 18354
8a1cdce5
AC
18355Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18356that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18357group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18358category.
4009494e 18359
8a1cdce5
AC
18360A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18361@code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18362article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18363predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
4009494e 18364
8a1cdce5
AC
18365Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18366their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18367@code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
4009494e 18368
8a1cdce5
AC
18369To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18370download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18371operators sprinkled in between.
4009494e 18372
8a1cdce5 18373Perhaps some examples are in order.
4009494e 18374
8a1cdce5
AC
18375Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18376for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
4009494e 18377
8a1cdce5
AC
18378@lisp
18379short
18380@end lisp
4009494e 18381
8a1cdce5
AC
18382Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18383short (for some value of ``short'').
4009494e 18384
8a1cdce5 18385Here's a more complex predicate:
4009494e 18386
8a1cdce5
AC
18387@lisp
18388(or high
18389 (and
18390 (not low)
18391 (not long)))
18392@end lisp
4009494e 18393
8a1cdce5
AC
18394This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18395or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18396drift.
4009494e 18397
8a1cdce5
AC
18398The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18399@code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18400@samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
4009494e 18401
8a1cdce5
AC
18402The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18403you want to do, you can write your own.
4009494e 18404
8a1cdce5
AC
18405When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18406bound to the value determined by calling
18407@code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18408example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18409@code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18410means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18411predicate to individual groups.
4009494e 18412
8a1cdce5
AC
18413@table @code
18414@item short
18415True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18416lines; default 100.
4009494e 18417
8a1cdce5
AC
18418@item long
18419True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18420lines; default 200.
4009494e 18421
8a1cdce5
AC
18422@item low
18423True if the article has a download score less than
18424@code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
4009494e 18425
8a1cdce5
AC
18426@item high
18427True if the article has a download score greater than
18428@code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
4009494e 18429
8a1cdce5
AC
18430@item spam
18431True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18432heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18433checksum and sees whether articles match.
4009494e 18434
8a1cdce5
AC
18435@item true
18436Always true.
4009494e 18437
8a1cdce5
AC
18438@item false
18439Always false.
4009494e
GM
18440@end table
18441
8a1cdce5
AC
18442If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18443to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18444@code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18445useful values.
4009494e 18446
8a1cdce5 18447For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
1df7defd 18448that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g., posted
8a1cdce5
AC
18449more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18450something along the lines of the following:
4009494e
GM
18451
18452@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
18453(defun my-article-old-p ()
18454 "Say whether an article is old."
18455 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18456 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
4009494e
GM
18457@end lisp
18458
8a1cdce5 18459with the predicate then defined as:
4009494e
GM
18460
18461@lisp
8a1cdce5 18462(not my-article-old-p)
4009494e
GM
18463@end lisp
18464
8a1cdce5
AC
18465or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18466@code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18467wherever.
4009494e 18468
8a1cdce5
AC
18469@lisp
18470(require 'gnus-agent)
18471(setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18472 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18473 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18474@end lisp
4009494e 18475
8a1cdce5 18476and simply specify your predicate as:
4009494e 18477
8a1cdce5
AC
18478@lisp
18479(not old)
18480@end lisp
4009494e 18481
8a1cdce5
AC
18482If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18483misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18484always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18485just don't give a damn.
4009494e 18486
8a1cdce5
AC
18487The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18488category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18489individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18490new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18491parameters like so:
4009494e 18492
8a1cdce5
AC
18493@lisp
18494(agent-predicate . short)
18495@end lisp
4009494e 18496
8a1cdce5
AC
18497This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18498Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18499@code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
4009494e 18500
8a1cdce5 18501The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
4009494e
GM
18502
18503@lisp
8a1cdce5 18504(agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
4009494e
GM
18505@end lisp
18506
8a1cdce5
AC
18507The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18508entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18509predicate is assumed to be a list.
4009494e 18510
4009494e 18511
8a1cdce5
AC
18512Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18513normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18514seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18515following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18516@code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18517@code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
4009494e 18518
8a1cdce5
AC
18519As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18520to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18521it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18522if it's to be specific to that group.
4009494e 18523
8a1cdce5
AC
18524In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18525three forms:
4009494e 18526
8a1cdce5
AC
18527@enumerate
18528@item
18529Score rule
4009494e 18530
8a1cdce5
AC
18531This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18532subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
4009494e 18533
8a1cdce5 18534example:
4009494e 18535
8a1cdce5
AC
18536@itemize @bullet
18537@item
18538Category specification
4009494e 18539
8a1cdce5
AC
18540@lisp
18541(("from"
18542 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18543("lines"
18544 (500 -100 nil <)))
18545@end lisp
4009494e 18546
8a1cdce5
AC
18547@item
18548Group/Topic Parameter specification
4009494e 18549
8a1cdce5
AC
18550@lisp
18551(agent-score ("from"
18552 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18553 ("lines"
18554 (500 -100 nil <)))
18555@end lisp
4009494e 18556
8a1cdce5
AC
18557Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18558@end itemize
4009494e 18559
8a1cdce5
AC
18560@item
18561Agent score file
18562
18563These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18564keywords stated above.
18565
18566example:
4009494e
GM
18567
18568@itemize @bullet
18569@item
8a1cdce5 18570Category specification
4009494e 18571
8a1cdce5
AC
18572@lisp
18573("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18574@end lisp
4009494e 18575
8a1cdce5 18576or perhaps
4009494e 18577
8a1cdce5
AC
18578@lisp
18579("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18580@end lisp
4009494e 18581
8a1cdce5
AC
18582@item
18583Group Parameter specification
4009494e 18584
8a1cdce5
AC
18585@lisp
18586(agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18587@end lisp
4009494e 18588
8a1cdce5
AC
18589Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18590about parenthesis?
18591@end itemize
4009494e 18592
8a1cdce5
AC
18593@item
18594Use @code{normal} score files
4009494e 18595
8a1cdce5
AC
18596If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18597your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18598@code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18599@code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
4009494e 18600
8a1cdce5
AC
18601These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18602parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18603files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18604relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
4009494e
GM
18605
18606@itemize @bullet
18607@item
8a1cdce5
AC
18608Category Specification
18609
18610@lisp
18611file
18612@end lisp
18613
4009494e 18614@item
8a1cdce5
AC
18615Group Parameter specification
18616
18617@lisp
18618(agent-score . file)
18619@end lisp
4009494e 18620@end itemize
8a1cdce5 18621@end enumerate
4009494e 18622
8a1cdce5
AC
18623@node Category Buffer
18624@subsubsection Category Buffer
4009494e 18625
8a1cdce5
AC
18626You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18627When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18628the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
4009494e 18629
8a1cdce5 18630The following commands are available in this buffer:
4009494e 18631
8a1cdce5
AC
18632@table @kbd
18633@item q
18634@kindex q (Category)
18635@findex gnus-category-exit
18636Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
4009494e 18637
8a1cdce5
AC
18638@item e
18639@kindex e (Category)
18640@findex gnus-category-customize-category
18641Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18642parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
4009494e 18643
8a1cdce5
AC
18644@item k
18645@kindex k (Category)
18646@findex gnus-category-kill
18647Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
4009494e 18648
8a1cdce5
AC
18649@item c
18650@kindex c (Category)
18651@findex gnus-category-copy
18652Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
4009494e 18653
8a1cdce5
AC
18654@item a
18655@kindex a (Category)
18656@findex gnus-category-add
18657Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
4009494e 18658
8a1cdce5
AC
18659@item p
18660@kindex p (Category)
18661@findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18662Edit the predicate of the current category
18663(@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
4009494e 18664
8a1cdce5
AC
18665@item g
18666@kindex g (Category)
18667@findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18668Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18669(@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
4009494e 18670
8a1cdce5
AC
18671@item s
18672@kindex s (Category)
18673@findex gnus-category-edit-score
18674Edit the download score rule of the current category
18675(@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
4009494e 18676
8a1cdce5
AC
18677@item l
18678@kindex l (Category)
18679@findex gnus-category-list
18680List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18681@end table
4009494e 18682
4009494e 18683
8a1cdce5
AC
18684@node Category Variables
18685@subsubsection Category Variables
4009494e 18686
8a1cdce5
AC
18687@table @code
18688@item gnus-category-mode-hook
18689@vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18690Hook run in category buffers.
4009494e 18691
8a1cdce5
AC
18692@item gnus-category-line-format
18693@vindex gnus-category-line-format
18694Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18695Variables}). Valid elements are:
4009494e 18696
8a1cdce5
AC
18697@table @samp
18698@item c
18699The name of the category.
4009494e 18700
8a1cdce5
AC
18701@item g
18702The number of groups in the category.
18703@end table
4009494e 18704
8a1cdce5
AC
18705@item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18706@vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18707Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
4009494e 18708
8a1cdce5
AC
18709@item gnus-agent-short-article
18710@vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18711Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
4009494e 18712
8a1cdce5
AC
18713@item gnus-agent-long-article
18714@vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18715Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
4009494e 18716
8a1cdce5
AC
18717@item gnus-agent-low-score
18718@vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18719Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
187200.
18721
18722@item gnus-agent-high-score
18723@vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18724Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
187250.
18726
18727@item gnus-agent-expire-days
18728@vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18729The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18730local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18731the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18732just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18733important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18734article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18735read.
18736Default 7.
18737
18738@item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18739@vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18740Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18741retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18742you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18743you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18744have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18745
18746@end table
4009494e 18747
4009494e 18748
8a1cdce5
AC
18749@node Agent Commands
18750@subsection Agent Commands
18751@findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18752@kindex J j (Agent)
4009494e 18753
8a1cdce5
AC
18754All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18755(@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18756toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
4009494e
GM
18757
18758
18759@menu
8a1cdce5
AC
18760* Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18761* Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18762* Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
4009494e
GM
18763@end menu
18764
4009494e 18765
4009494e 18766
4009494e 18767
8a1cdce5
AC
18768@node Group Agent Commands
18769@subsubsection Group Agent Commands
4009494e 18770
8a1cdce5
AC
18771@table @kbd
18772@item J u
18773@kindex J u (Agent Group)
18774@findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18775Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18776(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
4009494e 18777
8a1cdce5
AC
18778@item J c
18779@kindex J c (Agent Group)
18780@findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18781Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
4009494e 18782
8a1cdce5
AC
18783@item J s
18784@kindex J s (Agent Group)
18785@findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18786Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18787(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
4009494e 18788
8a1cdce5
AC
18789@item J S
18790@kindex J S (Agent Group)
18791@findex gnus-group-send-queue
18792Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18793(@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
4009494e 18794
8a1cdce5
AC
18795@item J a
18796@kindex J a (Agent Group)
18797@findex gnus-agent-add-group
18798Add the current group to an Agent category
18799(@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18800process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 18801
8a1cdce5
AC
18802@item J r
18803@kindex J r (Agent Group)
18804@findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18805Remove the current group from its category, if any
18806(@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18807process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 18808
8a1cdce5
AC
18809@item J Y
18810@kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18811@findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18812Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
4009494e 18813
4009494e 18814
8a1cdce5 18815@end table
4009494e 18816
4009494e 18817
8a1cdce5
AC
18818@node Summary Agent Commands
18819@subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
4009494e 18820
8a1cdce5
AC
18821@table @kbd
18822@item J #
18823@kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18824@findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18825Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
4009494e 18826
8a1cdce5
AC
18827@item J M-#
18828@kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18829@findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18830Remove the downloading mark from the article
18831(@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
4009494e 18832
8a1cdce5
AC
18833@cindex %
18834@item @@
18835@kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18836@findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18837Toggle whether to download the article
18838(@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18839default.
4009494e 18840
8a1cdce5
AC
18841@item J c
18842@kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18843@findex gnus-agent-catchup
18844Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
4009494e 18845
8a1cdce5
AC
18846@item J S
18847@kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18848@findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18849Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18850(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
4009494e 18851
8a1cdce5
AC
18852@item J s
18853@kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18854@findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18855Download all processable articles in this group.
18856(@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
4009494e 18857
8a1cdce5
AC
18858@item J u
18859@kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18860@findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18861Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18862(@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
4009494e 18863
8a1cdce5 18864@end table
4009494e 18865
4009494e 18866
8a1cdce5
AC
18867@node Server Agent Commands
18868@subsubsection Server Agent Commands
4009494e 18869
8a1cdce5
AC
18870@table @kbd
18871@item J a
18872@kindex J a (Agent Server)
18873@findex gnus-agent-add-server
18874Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18875(@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
4009494e 18876
8a1cdce5
AC
18877@item J r
18878@kindex J r (Agent Server)
18879@findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18880Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18881Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
4009494e 18882
8a1cdce5 18883@end table
4009494e 18884
4009494e 18885
8a1cdce5
AC
18886@node Agent Visuals
18887@subsection Agent Visuals
4009494e 18888
8a1cdce5
AC
18889If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18890active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18891stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18892something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18893placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18894there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18895When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18896placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18897You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18898placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
4009494e 18899
8a1cdce5
AC
18900While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18901available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18902fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18903way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18904less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18905adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18906the download status of each article so that you always know which
18907articles will be available when unplugged.
4009494e 18908
8a1cdce5
AC
18909The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18910@code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18911a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18912Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18913will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18914other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18915@samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18916(@samp{ }) will be displayed.
4009494e 18917
8a1cdce5
AC
18918The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18919are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18920result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18921that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18922face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18923tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18924conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18925that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18926to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
4009494e 18927
8a1cdce5
AC
18928If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18929each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18930undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18931being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18932downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18933users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18934database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18935to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18936of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18937normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
4009494e 18938
8a1cdce5
AC
18939If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18940undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18941group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18942parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18943a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18944(@pxref{Group Parameters}).
4009494e 18945
8a1cdce5
AC
18946The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18947can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18948even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18949is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18950This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18951fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18952the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18953expiring'' articles.
4009494e 18954
8a1cdce5
AC
18955@node Agent as Cache
18956@subsection Agent as Cache
4009494e 18957
8a1cdce5
AC
18958When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18959articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18960Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18961in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18962buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18963are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18964consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18965article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18966server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
4009494e 18967
8a1cdce5
AC
18968If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18969@pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18970plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18971synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18972sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
4009494e 18973
8a1cdce5
AC
18974@node Agent Expiry
18975@subsection Agent Expiry
4009494e 18976
8a1cdce5
AC
18977@vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18978@findex gnus-agent-expire
18979@kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18980@kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18981@findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18982@cindex agent expiry
18983@cindex Gnus agent expiry
18984@cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
4009494e 18985
8a1cdce5
AC
18986The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18987least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18988special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18989commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18990@code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18991that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18992efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18993@kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
4009494e 18994
0c502747
LMI
18995Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
18996to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
4009494e 18997
8a1cdce5
AC
18998The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18999prevent expiration in selected groups.
4009494e 19000
8a1cdce5
AC
19001@vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
19002If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
19003expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
19004and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
19005are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
19006be kept indefinitely.
4009494e 19007
8a1cdce5
AC
19008If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
19009perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
19010commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
19011@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
4009494e 19012
8a1cdce5
AC
19013@node Agent Regeneration
19014@subsection Agent Regeneration
4009494e 19015
8a1cdce5
AC
19016@cindex agent regeneration
19017@cindex Gnus agent regeneration
19018@cindex regeneration
4009494e 19019
8a1cdce5
AC
19020The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19021due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19022@code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19023to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19024internal inconsistencies.
4009494e 19025
8a1cdce5
AC
19026For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19027downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19028know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19029failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19030@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19031such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
4009494e 19032
8a1cdce5
AC
19033@findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19034@kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19035The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19036@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19037you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19038recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
4009494e 19039
8a1cdce5
AC
19040@findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19041@kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19042The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19043of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19044then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19045are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19046agent as unread.
4009494e 19047
8a1cdce5
AC
19048@node Agent and flags
19049@subsection Agent and flags
4009494e 19050
8a1cdce5 19051The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
65e7ca35 19052nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc.)@: on the server. Sadly,
8a1cdce5
AC
19053the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
19054the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19055Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19056to the flags in its own files.
19057
19058When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19059changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19060server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
4009494e 19061
8a1cdce5
AC
19062@vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19063If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19064never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19065the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19066ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19067any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
4009494e 19068
8a1cdce5
AC
19069If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19070re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19071@code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19072in the group buffer.
4009494e 19073
8a1cdce5
AC
19074Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19075all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19076server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19077the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19078re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19079removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19080operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19081directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
4009494e 19082
8a1cdce5
AC
19083@node Agent and IMAP
19084@subsection Agent and IMAP
4009494e 19085
8a1cdce5
AC
19086The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19087since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19088@acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19089make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
4009494e 19090
8a1cdce5
AC
19091Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19092expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
4009494e 19093
8a1cdce5 19094@itemize @bullet
4009494e 19095
8a1cdce5
AC
19096@item
19097Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
4009494e 19098
8a1cdce5
AC
19099@item
19100Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
4009494e 19101
8a1cdce5 19102@end itemize
4009494e 19103
8a1cdce5
AC
19104@node Outgoing Messages
19105@subsection Outgoing Messages
4009494e 19106
8a1cdce5
AC
19107By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19108and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19109You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
4009494e 19110
8a1cdce5
AC
19111You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19112(see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19113news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
4009494e 19114
8a1cdce5
AC
19115You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19116commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19117group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19118Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19119mail at any time.
4009494e 19120
8a1cdce5
AC
19121If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19122about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19123ask you to confirm your action (see
19124@code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
4009494e 19125
8a1cdce5
AC
19126@node Agent Variables
19127@subsection Agent Variables
4009494e 19128
8a1cdce5
AC
19129@table @code
19130@item gnus-agent
19131@vindex gnus-agent
19132Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19133the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19134automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19135back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
4009494e 19136
8a1cdce5
AC
19137To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19138(@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
4009494e 19139
4009494e 19140
8a1cdce5
AC
19141@item gnus-agent-directory
19142@vindex gnus-agent-directory
19143Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19144@file{~/News/agent/}.
4009494e 19145
8a1cdce5
AC
19146@item gnus-agent-handle-level
19147@vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19148Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19149be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19150which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19151by default.
4009494e 19152
8a1cdce5
AC
19153@item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19154@vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19155Hook run when connecting to the network.
4009494e 19156
8a1cdce5
AC
19157@item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19158@vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19159Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
4009494e 19160
8a1cdce5
AC
19161@item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19162@vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19163Hook run when finished fetching articles.
4009494e 19164
8a1cdce5
AC
19165@item gnus-agent-cache
19166@vindex gnus-agent-cache
19167Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
1df7defd 19168articles when plugged, e.g., essentially using the Agent as a cache.
8a1cdce5 19169The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
4009494e 19170
8a1cdce5
AC
19171@item gnus-agent-go-online
19172@vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19173If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19174automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19175@code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19176offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19177other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19178online status.
4009494e 19179
8a1cdce5
AC
19180@item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19181@vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19182If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19183mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19184thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19185read. The default is @code{t}.
4009494e 19186
8a1cdce5
AC
19187@item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19188@vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19189If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19190never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19191the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19192ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19193any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
4009494e 19194
8a1cdce5
AC
19195@item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19196@vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19197If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19198agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19199downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19200the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19201are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19202into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19203the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19204over and over again.
4009494e 19205
8a1cdce5
AC
19206@item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19207@vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19208The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19209them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19210the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19211have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19212limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19213performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19214connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19215@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19216However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19217available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19218see any cycling.
4009494e 19219
8a1cdce5
AC
19220@item gnus-server-unopen-status
19221@vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19222Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19223variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19224Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19225whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19226Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19227for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19228is only valid if the Agent is used.
4009494e 19229
8a1cdce5
AC
19230@item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19231@vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19232Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19233that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19234buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19235agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
4009494e 19236
8a1cdce5
AC
19237The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19238@code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19239have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19240ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19241(maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
4009494e 19242
8a1cdce5
AC
19243@item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19244@vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19245When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19246queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19247will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19248mail. The default is @code{t}.
4009494e 19249
8a1cdce5
AC
19250@item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19251@vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19252When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19253prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19254@kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 19255
8a1cdce5
AC
19256@item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19257@vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19258If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19259@file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19260automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19261which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19262to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19263as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19264If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19265removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
ba775afe 19266start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
4009494e 19267
4009494e
GM
19268@end table
19269
4009494e 19270
8a1cdce5
AC
19271@node Example Setup
19272@subsection Example Setup
19273
19274If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19275setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19276@file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
4009494e
GM
19277
19278@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
19279;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19280;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19281(setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
4009494e 19282
8a1cdce5
AC
19283;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19284;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19285(setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
4009494e 19286
8a1cdce5
AC
19287;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19288(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19289
19290;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19291;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19292;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
4009494e
GM
19293@end lisp
19294
8a1cdce5
AC
19295That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19296edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19297gnus}.
4009494e 19298
8a1cdce5
AC
19299If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19300automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19301subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19302@acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19303command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19304once.
4009494e 19305
8a1cdce5
AC
19306After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19307groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19308command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19309subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19310back all the killed groups.)
4009494e 19311
8a1cdce5
AC
19312You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19313with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19314find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
4009494e 19315
4009494e 19316
8a1cdce5
AC
19317@node Batching Agents
19318@subsection Batching Agents
19319@findex gnus-agent-batch
4009494e 19320
8a1cdce5
AC
19321Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19322written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19323following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
4009494e 19324
8a1cdce5
AC
19325You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19326following incantation:
4009494e 19327
8a1cdce5
AC
19328@example
19329#!/bin/sh
19330emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19331@end example
4009494e 19332
4009494e 19333
8a1cdce5
AC
19334@node Agent Caveats
19335@subsection Agent Caveats
4009494e 19336
8a1cdce5
AC
19337The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19338newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19339may ask:
4009494e 19340
8a1cdce5
AC
19341@table @dfn
19342@item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
4009494e 19343
8a1cdce5
AC
19344@strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19345@code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19346@code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
4009494e 19347
8a1cdce5
AC
19348@item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19349the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
4009494e 19350
8a1cdce5 19351@strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
4009494e 19352
8a1cdce5 19353@end table
4009494e 19354
8a1cdce5
AC
19355In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19356articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19357locally stored articles.
4009494e 19358
4009494e 19359
8a1cdce5
AC
19360@node Scoring
19361@chapter Scoring
19362@cindex scoring
4009494e 19363
8a1cdce5
AC
19364Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19365scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19366something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19367attention!
4009494e 19368
8a1cdce5
AC
19369@vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19370All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19371which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19372interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19373@code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
4009494e 19374
8a1cdce5
AC
19375Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19376before generating the summary buffer.
4009494e 19377
8a1cdce5
AC
19378There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19379entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19380lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
4009494e 19381
8a1cdce5
AC
19382There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19383Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19384temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19385silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
4009494e 19386
8a1cdce5
AC
19387@menu
19388* Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19389* Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19390* Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19391* Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19392* Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19393* Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19394* Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19395* Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19396* Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19397* Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19398* Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19399* Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19400* Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19401* Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19402* Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19403* Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19404@end menu
4009494e 19405
4009494e 19406
8a1cdce5
AC
19407@node Summary Score Commands
19408@section Summary Score Commands
19409@cindex score commands
4009494e 19410
8a1cdce5
AC
19411The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19412score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19413previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19414@dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19415entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
4009494e 19416
8a1cdce5
AC
19417The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19418if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
1df7defd 19419some other score file (e.g., @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
8a1cdce5
AC
19420score file the current one.
19421
19422General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
4009494e 19423
8a1cdce5 19424@table @kbd
4009494e 19425
8a1cdce5
AC
19426@item V s
19427@kindex V s (Summary)
19428@findex gnus-summary-set-score
19429Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
4009494e 19430
8a1cdce5
AC
19431@item V S
19432@kindex V S (Summary)
19433@findex gnus-summary-current-score
19434Display the score of the current article
19435(@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
4009494e 19436
8a1cdce5
AC
19437@item V t
19438@kindex V t (Summary)
19439@findex gnus-score-find-trace
19440Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19441(@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19442may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19443current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19444score file and edit it.
4009494e 19445
8a1cdce5
AC
19446@item V w
19447@kindex V w (Summary)
19448@findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19449List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
4009494e 19450
8a1cdce5
AC
19451@item V R
19452@kindex V R (Summary)
19453@findex gnus-summary-rescore
19454Run the current summary through the scoring process
19455(@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19456around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19457effect you're having.
4009494e 19458
8a1cdce5
AC
19459@item V c
19460@kindex V c (Summary)
19461@findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19462Make a different score file the current
19463(@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
4009494e 19464
8a1cdce5
AC
19465@item V e
19466@kindex V e (Summary)
19467@findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19468Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19469You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19470File Editing}).
4009494e 19471
8a1cdce5
AC
19472@item V f
19473@kindex V f (Summary)
19474@findex gnus-score-edit-file
19475Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19476(@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
4009494e 19477
8a1cdce5
AC
19478@item V F
19479@kindex V F (Summary)
19480@findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19481Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19482after editing score files.
4009494e 19483
8a1cdce5
AC
19484@item V C
19485@kindex V C (Summary)
19486@findex gnus-score-customize
19487Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19488(@code{gnus-score-customize}).
4009494e 19489
8a1cdce5 19490@end table
4009494e 19491
8a1cdce5 19492The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
4009494e
GM
19493
19494@table @kbd
4009494e 19495
8a1cdce5
AC
19496@item V m
19497@kindex V m (Summary)
19498@findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19499Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19500read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
4009494e 19501
8a1cdce5
AC
19502@item V x
19503@kindex V x (Summary)
19504@findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19505Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19506expunge all articles below this score
19507(@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19508@end table
4009494e 19509
8a1cdce5
AC
19510The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19511pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19512them.)
4009494e 19513
8a1cdce5
AC
19514@findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19515@findex gnus-summary-lower-score
4009494e 19516
8a1cdce5
AC
19517@enumerate
19518@item
19519The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19520or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19521@item
19522The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19523keys are available:
19524@table @kbd
4009494e 19525
8a1cdce5
AC
19526@item a
19527Score on the author name.
4009494e
GM
19528
19529@item s
8a1cdce5
AC
19530Score on the subject line.
19531
19532@item x
19533Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19534
19535@item r
19536Score on the @code{References} line.
19537
19538@item d
19539Score on the date.
4009494e
GM
19540
19541@item l
8a1cdce5 19542Score on the number of lines.
4009494e 19543
8a1cdce5
AC
19544@item i
19545Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
4009494e 19546
8a1cdce5
AC
19547@item e
19548Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19549if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
4009494e 19550
8a1cdce5
AC
19551@item f
19552Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19553the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19554@file{ADAPT} files.)
4009494e 19555
8a1cdce5
AC
19556@item b
19557Score on the body.
4009494e 19558
8a1cdce5
AC
19559@item h
19560Score on the head.
19561
19562@item t
19563Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19564files.)
4009494e 19565
4009494e
GM
19566@end table
19567
8a1cdce5
AC
19568@item
19569The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19570what headers you are scoring on.
4009494e 19571
8a1cdce5 19572@table @code
4009494e 19573
8a1cdce5 19574@item strings
4009494e 19575
8a1cdce5 19576@table @kbd
4009494e 19577
8a1cdce5
AC
19578@item e
19579Exact matching.
4009494e 19580
8a1cdce5
AC
19581@item s
19582Substring matching.
4009494e 19583
8a1cdce5
AC
19584@item f
19585Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
4009494e 19586
8a1cdce5
AC
19587@item r
19588Regexp matching
4009494e
GM
19589@end table
19590
8a1cdce5
AC
19591@item date
19592@table @kbd
4009494e 19593
8a1cdce5
AC
19594@item b
19595Before date.
4009494e 19596
8a1cdce5
AC
19597@item a
19598After date.
4009494e 19599
8a1cdce5
AC
19600@item n
19601This date.
19602@end table
4009494e 19603
8a1cdce5
AC
19604@item number
19605@table @kbd
4009494e 19606
8a1cdce5
AC
19607@item <
19608Less than number.
4009494e 19609
8a1cdce5
AC
19610@item =
19611Equal to number.
4009494e 19612
8a1cdce5
AC
19613@item >
19614Greater than number.
19615@end table
19616@end table
4009494e 19617
8a1cdce5
AC
19618@item
19619The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19620expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19621or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19622file.
4009494e 19623@table @kbd
4009494e 19624
8a1cdce5
AC
19625@item t
19626Temporary score entry.
4009494e 19627
8a1cdce5
AC
19628@item p
19629Permanent score entry.
4009494e 19630
8a1cdce5
AC
19631@item i
19632Immediately scoring.
19633@end table
4009494e 19634
8a1cdce5
AC
19635@item
19636If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19637the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19638in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
4009494e 19639
8a1cdce5 19640@end enumerate
4009494e 19641
8a1cdce5
AC
19642So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19643exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19644score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19645temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
4009494e 19646
8a1cdce5
AC
19647To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19648a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19649defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19650``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19651t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
4009494e 19652
8a1cdce5
AC
19653These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19654(@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19655(or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19656says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19657current score file.
4009494e 19658
8a1cdce5
AC
19659@vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19660The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19661pretend they are keymaps or not.
4009494e 19662
4009494e 19663
8a1cdce5
AC
19664@node Group Score Commands
19665@section Group Score Commands
19666@cindex group score commands
4009494e 19667
8a1cdce5 19668There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
4009494e 19669
8a1cdce5 19670@table @kbd
4009494e 19671
8a1cdce5
AC
19672@item W e
19673@kindex W e (Group)
19674@findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19675Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19676a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
4009494e 19677
8a1cdce5
AC
19678@item W f
19679@kindex W f (Group)
19680@findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19681Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19682all the time. This command will flush the cache
19683(@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
4009494e 19684
8a1cdce5 19685@end table
4009494e 19686
8a1cdce5 19687You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
4009494e 19688
8a1cdce5
AC
19689@findex gnus-batch-score
19690@cindex batch scoring
19691@example
19692$ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19693@end example
4009494e
GM
19694
19695
8a1cdce5
AC
19696@node Score Variables
19697@section Score Variables
19698@cindex score variables
4009494e 19699
8a1cdce5 19700@table @code
4009494e 19701
8a1cdce5
AC
19702@item gnus-use-scoring
19703@vindex gnus-use-scoring
19704If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19705general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
4009494e 19706
8a1cdce5
AC
19707@item gnus-kill-killed
19708@vindex gnus-kill-killed
19709If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19710articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19711may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19712to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19713group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19714variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
4009494e 19715
8a1cdce5
AC
19716@item gnus-kill-files-directory
19717@vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19718All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19719initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19720This is @file{~/News/} by default.
4009494e 19721
8a1cdce5
AC
19722@item gnus-score-file-suffix
19723@vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19724Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19725(@file{SCORE} by default.)
4009494e 19726
8a1cdce5
AC
19727@item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19728@vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19729@cindex score cache
19730All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19731score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19732bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19733to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19734@file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19735@file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19736variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19737be cached.
4009494e 19738
8a1cdce5
AC
19739@item gnus-save-score
19740@vindex gnus-save-score
19741If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19742scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19743Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
4009494e 19744
8a1cdce5
AC
19745If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19746with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19747across group visits.
4009494e 19748
8a1cdce5
AC
19749@item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19750@vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19751Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19752score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19753ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19754We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19755manually entered data.
4009494e 19756
8a1cdce5
AC
19757@item gnus-summary-default-score
19758@vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19759Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
01c52d31 19760
8a1cdce5
AC
19761@item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19762@vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19763Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19764this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19765articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19766and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
01c52d31 19767
8a1cdce5
AC
19768@item gnus-score-over-mark
19769@vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19770Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19771default. Default is @samp{+}.
4009494e 19772
8a1cdce5
AC
19773@item gnus-score-below-mark
19774@vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19775Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19776default. Default is @samp{-}.
4009494e 19777
8a1cdce5
AC
19778@item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19779@vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19780Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19781is called with the name of the group as the argument.
4009494e 19782
8a1cdce5
AC
19783Predefined functions available are:
19784@table @code
4009494e 19785
8a1cdce5
AC
19786@item gnus-score-find-single
19787@findex gnus-score-find-single
19788Only apply the group's own score file.
4009494e 19789
8a1cdce5
AC
19790@item gnus-score-find-bnews
19791@findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19792Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19793default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19794@file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19795@file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19796@samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19797then a regexp match is done.
4009494e 19798
8a1cdce5
AC
19799This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19800all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
4009494e 19801
8a1cdce5
AC
19802The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19803try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19804files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19805file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
4009494e 19806
8a1cdce5
AC
19807@item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19808@findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19809Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19810can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19811@file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19812server.
4009494e 19813
8a1cdce5
AC
19814@end table
19815This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19816these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19817all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19818functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19819that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19820should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19821ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19822Phu.
4009494e 19823
8a1cdce5
AC
19824For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19825overall score file, you could use the value
19826@example
19827(list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19828 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19829@end example
4009494e 19830
8a1cdce5
AC
19831@item gnus-score-expiry-days
19832@vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19833This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19834entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19835are expired. It's 7 by default.
4009494e 19836
8a1cdce5
AC
19837@item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19838@vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19839If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19840been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19841controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19842matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19843variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19844have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
4009494e 19845
8a1cdce5
AC
19846@item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19847@vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19848Function called with the name of the score file just written.
4009494e 19849
8a1cdce5
AC
19850@item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19851@vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19852If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19853simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19854threading---according to the current value of
19855@code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19856@code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19857simplified in this manner.
4009494e 19858
8a1cdce5 19859@end table
4009494e 19860
4009494e 19861
8a1cdce5
AC
19862@node Score File Format
19863@section Score File Format
19864@cindex score file format
4009494e 19865
8a1cdce5
AC
19866A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19867single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19868everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
4009494e 19869
8a1cdce5 19870Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
4009494e 19871
8a1cdce5
AC
19872@lisp
19873(("from"
19874 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19875 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19876 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19877 ("subject"
19878 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19879 ("xref"
19880 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19881 ("lines"
19882 (2 -100 nil <))
19883 (mark 0)
19884 (expunge -1000)
19885 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19886 (read-only nil)
19887 (orphan -10)
19888 (adapt t)
19889 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19890 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19891 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19892 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19893 (eval (ding)))
19894@end lisp
4009494e 19895
8a1cdce5
AC
19896This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19897Scoring}, for a different approach.
4009494e 19898
8a1cdce5
AC
19899Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19900@code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19901has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
01c52d31 19902
8a1cdce5 19903Six keys are supported by this alist:
01c52d31 19904
8a1cdce5 19905@table @code
01c52d31 19906
8a1cdce5
AC
19907@item STRING
19908If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19909match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19910@code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19911@code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19912these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19913article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19914will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19915perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19916perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19917last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19918final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19919entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19920to articles that matches these score entries.
4009494e 19921
8a1cdce5
AC
19922Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19923score entry has one to four elements.
19924@enumerate
4009494e
GM
19925
19926@item
8a1cdce5
AC
19927The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19928be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19929integer.
4009494e
GM
19930
19931@item
8a1cdce5
AC
19932If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19933element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19934interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19935is successful. If this element is not present, the
19936@code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19937instead. This is 1000 by default.
4009494e 19938
8a1cdce5
AC
19939@item
19940If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19941element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19942which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19943element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19944represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
4009494e 19945
8a1cdce5
AC
19946@item
19947If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19948element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19949whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19950be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19951@table @dfn
4009494e 19952
8a1cdce5
AC
19953@item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19954For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19955well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19956@code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19957element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19958be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19959that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19960one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19961@code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19962instead, if you feel like.
4009494e 19963
8a1cdce5
AC
19964@item Extra
19965Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19966gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19967case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19968header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19969@file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19970host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19971overviews:
4009494e 19972
8a1cdce5
AC
19973@lisp
19974("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19975 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19976@end lisp
4009494e 19977
8a1cdce5
AC
19978@item Lines, Chars
19979These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19980@code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
4009494e 19981
8a1cdce5 19982These predicates are true if
4009494e 19983
8a1cdce5
AC
19984@example
19985(PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19986@end example
01c52d31 19987
8a1cdce5
AC
19988evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19989@code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19990following form:
01c52d31 19991
8a1cdce5
AC
19992@lisp
19993(< header-value 4)
19994@end lisp
01c52d31 19995
8a1cdce5
AC
19996Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19997the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19998(It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19999it's not. I think.)
4009494e 20000
8a1cdce5
AC
20001When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
20002@code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
20003up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
20004you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
4009494e 20005
8a1cdce5
AC
20006@item Date
20007For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
20008@code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
20009ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
20010this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
20011Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
20012sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
20013quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
4009494e 20014
8a1cdce5
AC
20015@cindex ISO8601
20016@cindex date
20017A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
20018date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
20019ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20020you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20021every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20022for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20023this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20024the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20025whole family, eh?)
4009494e 20026
8a1cdce5 20027@item Head, Body, All
65e7ca35 20028These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc.)@:
8a1cdce5 20029header uses.
4009494e 20030
8a1cdce5
AC
20031@item Followup
20032This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20033@code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20034articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
1df7defd 20035you to increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
8a1cdce5
AC
20036decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20037trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20038uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20039files.)
4009494e 20040
8a1cdce5
AC
20041@item Thread
20042This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20043key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20044article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20045match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20046has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20047matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20048This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20049even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20050@code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
22bcf204 20051nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
8a1cdce5
AC
20052key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20053@end table
20054@end enumerate
4009494e 20055
8a1cdce5
AC
20056@cindex score file atoms
20057@item mark
20058The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20059lower than this number will be marked as read.
4009494e 20060
8a1cdce5
AC
20061@item expunge
20062The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20063lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
01c52d31 20064
8a1cdce5
AC
20065@item mark-and-expunge
20066The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20067lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20068summary buffer.
20069
20070@item thread-mark-and-expunge
20071The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20072a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20073and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20074says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20075
20076@item files
20077The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20078are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20079this one was.
20080
20081@item exclude-files
20082The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20083not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20084other.
20085
20086@item eval
20087The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20088ignored when handling global score files.
4009494e 20089
8a1cdce5
AC
20090@item read-only
20091Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20092should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20093@dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20094apply-to-all-groups score files.)
4009494e 20095
8a1cdce5
AC
20096@item orphan
20097The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20098parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20099some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20100will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
4009494e 20101
8a1cdce5 20102You can do this with the following two score file entries:
4009494e 20103
8a1cdce5
AC
20104@example
20105 (orphan -500)
20106 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20107@end example
4009494e 20108
8a1cdce5
AC
20109When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20110threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20111interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20112rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20113interesting threads, plus any new threads.
01c52d31 20114
1df7defd 20115I.e., the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
8a1cdce5
AC
20116interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20117scoring rules exist.
01c52d31 20118
8a1cdce5
AC
20119@item adapt
20120This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20121default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20122adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20123list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20124or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20125adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20126scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20127@code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20128not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20129groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20130insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20131it.
20132
20133@item adapt-file
20134All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20135will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20136if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20137file for a number of groups.
4009494e 20138
8a1cdce5
AC
20139@item local
20140@cindex local variables
20141The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20142@var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20143current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20144convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20145groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20146be evaluated.
4009494e
GM
20147@end table
20148
20149
8a1cdce5
AC
20150@node Score File Editing
20151@section Score File Editing
4009494e 20152
8a1cdce5
AC
20153You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20154might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20155with a mode for that.
4009494e 20156
8a1cdce5
AC
20157It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20158additional commands:
4009494e 20159
8a1cdce5 20160@table @kbd
4009494e 20161
8a1cdce5
AC
20162@item C-c C-c
20163@kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20164@findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20165Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20166(@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
4009494e 20167
8a1cdce5
AC
20168@item C-c C-d
20169@kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20170@findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20171Insert the current date in numerical format
20172(@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20173you were wondering.
4009494e 20174
8a1cdce5
AC
20175@item C-c C-p
20176@kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20177@findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20178The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20179intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20180first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20181you.
4009494e 20182
8a1cdce5 20183@end table
4009494e 20184
8a1cdce5 20185Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
4009494e 20186
8a1cdce5
AC
20187@vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20188@code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
4009494e 20189
8a1cdce5
AC
20190In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20191@kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
4009494e 20192
4009494e 20193
8a1cdce5
AC
20194@node Adaptive Scoring
20195@section Adaptive Scoring
20196@cindex adaptive scoring
4009494e 20197
8a1cdce5
AC
20198If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20199happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20200stupidity, to be precise.
4009494e 20201
8a1cdce5
AC
20202@vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20203When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20204article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20205these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20206You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20207@code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20208words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20209@code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20210variable to @code{(word line)}.
4009494e 20211
8a1cdce5
AC
20212@vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20213To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20214the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20215might look something like this:
4009494e 20216
8a1cdce5
AC
20217@lisp
20218(setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20219 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20220 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20221 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20222 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20223 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20224 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20225 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20226 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20227 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20228 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20229 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20230@end lisp
4009494e 20231
8a1cdce5
AC
20232As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20233variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20234a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20235pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20236that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20237@code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20238entries.
4009494e 20239
8a1cdce5
AC
20240Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20241will be applied to each article.
20242
20243To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20244articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20245score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20246lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20247
20248If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20249@code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20250That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20251should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20252
20253If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20254the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20255probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20256adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20257
20258The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20259@code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20260@code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20261@code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20262on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20263current article, thereby matching the following thread.
4009494e 20264
8a1cdce5
AC
20265If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20266to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20267changes result in articles getting marked as read.
4009494e 20268
8a1cdce5
AC
20269After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20270become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20271the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
4009494e 20272
8a1cdce5
AC
20273You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20274by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20275let you use different rules in different groups.
4009494e 20276
8a1cdce5
AC
20277@vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20278The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20279group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20280is @file{ADAPT}.
4009494e 20281
8a1cdce5
AC
20282@vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20283Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20284human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20285default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
4009494e 20286
8a1cdce5
AC
20287@vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20288When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20289give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20290matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20291the length of the match is less than
20292@code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20293this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20294this problem.
4009494e 20295
8a1cdce5
AC
20296@vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20297As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20298headers. If you adapt on words, the
20299@code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20300each instance of a word should add given a mark.
4009494e 20301
8a1cdce5
AC
20302@lisp
20303(setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20304 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20305 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20306 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20307 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20308@end lisp
4009494e 20309
8a1cdce5
AC
20310This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20311word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20312@code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20313score with 30 points.
4009494e 20314
8a1cdce5
AC
20315@vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20316@vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20317Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20318will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20319@code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
4009494e 20320
8a1cdce5
AC
20321@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20322Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20323scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20324an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20325variable defaults to @code{nil}.
4009494e 20326
8a1cdce5
AC
20327@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20328When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20329syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20330it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
4009494e 20331
8a1cdce5
AC
20332@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20333If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20334word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20335below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 20336
8a1cdce5
AC
20337@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20338If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20339won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20340for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20341lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
4009494e 20342
8a1cdce5
AC
20343After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20344@code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20345what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
4009494e 20346
8a1cdce5
AC
20347Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20348likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20349that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20350rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
4009494e 20351
4009494e 20352
8a1cdce5
AC
20353@node Home Score File
20354@section Home Score File
4009494e 20355
8a1cdce5
AC
20356The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20357@dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20358for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20359@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
4009494e 20360
8a1cdce5
AC
20361However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20362a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20363could perhaps use the same home score file.
4009494e 20364
8a1cdce5
AC
20365@vindex gnus-home-score-file
20366The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20367be:
4009494e 20368
8a1cdce5
AC
20369@enumerate
20370@item
20371A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20372groups.
4009494e 20373
8a1cdce5
AC
20374@item
20375A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20376file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20377parameter.
4009494e 20378
8a1cdce5
AC
20379@item
20380A list. The elements in this list can be:
4009494e 20381
8a1cdce5
AC
20382@enumerate
20383@item
20384@code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20385group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
4009494e 20386
8a1cdce5
AC
20387@item
20388A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20389be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20390name of the group as the parameter.
4009494e 20391
8a1cdce5
AC
20392@item
20393A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20394@end enumerate
4009494e 20395
8a1cdce5
AC
20396The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20397for matches.
4009494e 20398
8a1cdce5 20399@end enumerate
4009494e 20400
8a1cdce5 20401So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
4009494e 20402
8a1cdce5
AC
20403@lisp
20404(setq gnus-home-score-file
20405 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20406@end lisp
4009494e 20407
8a1cdce5
AC
20408If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20409@file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
4009494e 20410
8a1cdce5
AC
20411@findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20412@lisp
20413(setq gnus-home-score-file
20414 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20415@end lisp
4009494e 20416
8a1cdce5
AC
20417This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20418Other functions include
20419
20420@table @code
20421@item gnus-current-home-score-file
20422@findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20423Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20424commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
4009494e 20425
8a1cdce5 20426@end table
4009494e 20427
8a1cdce5
AC
20428If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20429another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20430their own home score files:
4009494e 20431
8a1cdce5
AC
20432@lisp
20433(setq gnus-home-score-file
20434 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20435 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20436 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20437 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20438@end lisp
4009494e 20439
8a1cdce5
AC
20440@vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20441@code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20442@code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20443is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20444specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
4009494e 20445
8a1cdce5
AC
20446In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20447@code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20448(@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20449Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20450precedence over this variable.
4009494e 20451
4009494e 20452
8a1cdce5
AC
20453@node Followups To Yourself
20454@section Followups To Yourself
4009494e 20455
8a1cdce5
AC
20456Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20457the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20458this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20459articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20460respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20461to easily note when people answer what you've said.
4009494e 20462
8a1cdce5 20463@table @code
4009494e 20464
8a1cdce5
AC
20465@item gnus-score-followup-article
20466@findex gnus-score-followup-article
20467This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20468article.
4009494e 20469
8a1cdce5
AC
20470@item gnus-score-followup-thread
20471@findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20472This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20473your own article.
20474@end table
4009494e 20475
8a1cdce5
AC
20476@vindex message-sent-hook
20477These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20478@code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20479@lisp
20480(add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20481@end lisp
4009494e 20482
4009494e 20483
8a1cdce5
AC
20484If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20485the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20486mine:
4009494e 20487
8a1cdce5
AC
20488@example
20489<x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20490<x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20491@end example
4009494e 20492
8a1cdce5
AC
20493So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20494exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20495myself:
4009494e 20496
8a1cdce5
AC
20497@lisp
20498("references"
20499 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20500 1000 nil r))
20501@end lisp
4009494e 20502
8a1cdce5
AC
20503Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20504is system-dependent.
4009494e 20505
4009494e 20506
8a1cdce5
AC
20507@node Scoring On Other Headers
20508@section Scoring On Other Headers
20509@cindex scoring on other headers
4009494e 20510
8a1cdce5
AC
20511Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20512headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20513other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20514that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20515matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
4009494e 20516
8a1cdce5
AC
20517@vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20518You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20519variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20520@code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20521the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
20522inhibited for all groups.
4009494e 20523
8a1cdce5
AC
20524Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20525mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20526it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20527a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20528@samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
4009494e 20529
8a1cdce5 20530Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
4009494e 20531
8a1cdce5
AC
20532@lisp
20533(setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20534 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20535@end lisp
4009494e 20536
8a1cdce5
AC
20537Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20538@kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20539time if you have much mail.
4009494e 20540
8a1cdce5
AC
20541Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20542so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
4009494e 20543
8a1cdce5 20544See? Simple.
4009494e 20545
4009494e 20546
8a1cdce5
AC
20547@node Scoring Tips
20548@section Scoring Tips
20549@cindex scoring tips
4009494e 20550
8a1cdce5 20551@table @dfn
4009494e 20552
8a1cdce5
AC
20553@item Crossposts
20554@cindex crossposts
20555@cindex scoring crossposts
20556If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20557the @code{Xref} header.
20558@lisp
20559("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20560@end lisp
4009494e 20561
8a1cdce5
AC
20562@item Multiple crossposts
20563If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20564more than, say, 3 groups:
20565@lisp
20566("xref"
20567 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20568 -1000 nil r))
20569@end lisp
4009494e 20570
8a1cdce5
AC
20571@item Matching on the body
20572This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20573Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20574you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20575keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20576and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20577will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20578@code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20579the matches.
4009494e 20580
8a1cdce5
AC
20581@item Marking as read
20582You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20583number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20584in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20585@lisp
20586((mark -100))
20587@end lisp
20588You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
4009494e 20589
8a1cdce5
AC
20590@item Negated character classes
20591If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20592That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20593@code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
4009494e
GM
20594@end table
20595
4009494e 20596
8a1cdce5
AC
20597@node Reverse Scoring
20598@section Reverse Scoring
20599@cindex reverse scoring
4009494e 20600
8a1cdce5
AC
20601If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20602subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20603like this in your score file:
4009494e 20604
8a1cdce5
AC
20605@lisp
20606(("subject"
20607 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20608 (mark 1)
20609 (expunge 1))
20610@end lisp
4009494e 20611
8a1cdce5
AC
20612So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20613rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
4009494e
GM
20614
20615
8a1cdce5
AC
20616@node Global Score Files
20617@section Global Score Files
20618@cindex global score files
4009494e 20619
8a1cdce5
AC
20620Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20621nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20622in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
4009494e 20623
8a1cdce5
AC
20624What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20625all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20626big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
4009494e 20627
8a1cdce5
AC
20628@vindex gnus-global-score-files
20629All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20630@code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20631or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20632files are applicable to which group.
01c52d31 20633
8a1cdce5
AC
20634To use the score file
20635@file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20636all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20637say this:
4009494e 20638
8a1cdce5
AC
20639@lisp
20640(setq gnus-global-score-files
20641 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20642 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20643@end lisp
4009494e 20644
8a1cdce5
AC
20645@findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20646@noindent
20647Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20648directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20649If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20650use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
4009494e 20651
8a1cdce5
AC
20652Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20653somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
4009494e 20654
8a1cdce5
AC
20655If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20656just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20657world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20658wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20659sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20660premises! Yay! The net is saved!
4009494e 20661
8a1cdce5
AC
20662Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20663head:
4009494e 20664
8a1cdce5 20665@itemize @bullet
4009494e 20666
8a1cdce5
AC
20667@item
20668Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20669@item
20670To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20671@item
20672Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20673@item
20674Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20675lowered out of existence.
20676@item
20677Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20678articles completely.
4009494e 20679
8a1cdce5
AC
20680@item
20681Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20682should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20683old articles for a long time.
20684@end itemize
4009494e 20685
8a1cdce5
AC
20686@dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20687in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20688Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20689holding our breath yet?
4009494e 20690
4009494e 20691
8a1cdce5
AC
20692@node Kill Files
20693@section Kill Files
20694@cindex kill files
4009494e 20695
8a1cdce5
AC
20696Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20697entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20698Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
4009494e 20699
8a1cdce5
AC
20700In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20701than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20702files into score files.
4009494e 20703
8a1cdce5
AC
20704Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20705forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20706sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20707that isn't a very good idea.
4009494e 20708
8a1cdce5 20709Normal kill files look like this:
4009494e 20710
8a1cdce5
AC
20711@lisp
20712(gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20713(gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20714(gnus-expunge "X")
20715@end lisp
4009494e 20716
8a1cdce5
AC
20717This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20718marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
4009494e 20719
8a1cdce5
AC
20720Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20721encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20722interpreting it.
4009494e 20723
8a1cdce5 20724Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
4009494e 20725
8a1cdce5 20726@table @kbd
4009494e 20727
8a1cdce5
AC
20728@item M-k
20729@kindex M-k (Summary)
20730@findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20731Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
4009494e 20732
8a1cdce5
AC
20733@item M-K
20734@kindex M-K (Summary)
20735@findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20736Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20737@end table
4009494e 20738
8a1cdce5 20739Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
4009494e 20740
8a1cdce5 20741@table @kbd
4009494e 20742
8a1cdce5
AC
20743@item M-k
20744@kindex M-k (Group)
20745@findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20746Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
4009494e 20747
8a1cdce5
AC
20748@item M-K
20749@kindex M-K (Group)
20750@findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20751Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
4009494e 20752@end table
4009494e 20753
8a1cdce5 20754Kill file variables:
4009494e 20755
8a1cdce5
AC
20756@table @code
20757@item gnus-kill-file-name
20758@vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20759A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20760@file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20761this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20762The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20763course) is just called @file{KILL}.
4009494e 20764
8a1cdce5
AC
20765@vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20766@item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20767If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20768kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20769kills.
4009494e 20770
8a1cdce5
AC
20771@item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20772@vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20773@findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20774@findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20775A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20776@code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20777kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20778hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20779kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
4009494e 20780
8a1cdce5
AC
20781@item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20782@vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20783A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
4009494e
GM
20784
20785@end table
20786
20787
8a1cdce5
AC
20788@node Converting Kill Files
20789@section Converting Kill Files
20790@cindex kill files
20791@cindex converting kill files
4009494e 20792
8a1cdce5
AC
20793If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20794score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20795the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20796by hand.
4009494e 20797
8a1cdce5
AC
20798The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20799You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20800from
20801@uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
4009494e 20802
8a1cdce5
AC
20803If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20804non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20805hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20806before.
4009494e 20807
4009494e 20808
8a1cdce5
AC
20809@node Advanced Scoring
20810@section Advanced Scoring
4009494e 20811
8a1cdce5
AC
20812Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20813really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20814about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20815read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20816want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
4009494e 20817
8a1cdce5
AC
20818By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20819scoring patterns.
4009494e 20820
8a1cdce5
AC
20821@menu
20822* Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20823* Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20824* Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20825@end menu
4009494e 20826
4009494e 20827
8a1cdce5
AC
20828@node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20829@subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
4009494e 20830
8a1cdce5
AC
20831Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20832Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20833element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20834non-@code{nil} value.
4009494e 20835
8a1cdce5
AC
20836These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20837operator, and various match operators.
4009494e 20838
8a1cdce5 20839Logical operators:
4009494e 20840
8a1cdce5
AC
20841@table @code
20842@item &
20843@itemx and
20844This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20845one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20846evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20847@code{true}.
4009494e 20848
8a1cdce5
AC
20849@item |
20850@itemx or
20851This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20852one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20853then this operator will return @code{false}.
4009494e 20854
8a1cdce5
AC
20855@item !
20856@itemx not
89b163db 20857@itemx ¬
8a1cdce5
AC
20858This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20859logical negation of the value of its argument.
4009494e 20860
8a1cdce5 20861@end table
4009494e 20862
8a1cdce5
AC
20863There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20864apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20865instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20866current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20867grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20868@code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20869the ancestry you want to go.
4009494e 20870
8a1cdce5
AC
20871Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20872real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20873and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20874"Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20875simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
4009494e 20876
4009494e 20877
8a1cdce5
AC
20878@node Advanced Scoring Examples
20879@subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
4009494e 20880
8a1cdce5
AC
20881Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20882make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20883of parentheses.
4009494e 20884
8a1cdce5
AC
20885Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20886when he's talking about Gnus:
4009494e 20887
8a1cdce5
AC
20888@example
20889@group
20890((&
20891 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20892 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20893 1000)
20894@end group
20895@end example
4009494e 20896
8a1cdce5 20897Quite simple, huh?
4009494e 20898
8a1cdce5 20899When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
4009494e 20900
8a1cdce5
AC
20901@example
20902((&
20903 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20904 (|
20905 ("subject" "Gnus")
20906 ("lines" 100 >)))
20907 1000)
20908@end example
4009494e 20909
8a1cdce5
AC
20910However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20911really don't want to read what he's written:
4009494e 20912
8a1cdce5
AC
20913@example
20914((&
20915 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20916 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20917 -100000)
20918@end example
4009494e 20919
8a1cdce5
AC
20920Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20921socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20922white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20923very interesting:
4009494e 20924
8a1cdce5
AC
20925@example
20926((&
20927 (1-
20928 (&
20929 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20930 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20931 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20932 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20933 1000)
20934@end example
4009494e 20935
8a1cdce5
AC
20936Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20937in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20938subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20939parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
4009494e 20940
8a1cdce5
AC
20941@example
20942((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20943 -200)
20944((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20945 200)
20946@end example
4009494e 20947
8a1cdce5 20948The possibilities are endless.
4009494e 20949
8a1cdce5
AC
20950@node Advanced Scoring Tips
20951@subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
4009494e 20952
8a1cdce5
AC
20953The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20954That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20955result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20956of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20957the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20958(@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20959@samp{subject}) first.
4009494e 20960
8a1cdce5
AC
20961The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20962arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20963something like:
4009494e
GM
20964
20965@example
8a1cdce5
AC
20966...
20967(1-
20968 (1-
20969 ("from" "lars")))
20970...
4009494e
GM
20971@end example
20972
8a1cdce5
AC
20973Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20974current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
4009494e 20975
8a1cdce5
AC
20976@example
20977(1-
20978 (&
20979 ("from" "Lars")
20980 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20981@end example
4009494e 20982
8a1cdce5 20983than it is to say:
4009494e 20984
8a1cdce5
AC
20985@example
20986(&
20987 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20988 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20989@end example
4009494e
GM
20990
20991
8a1cdce5
AC
20992@node Score Decays
20993@section Score Decays
20994@cindex score decays
20995@cindex decays
4009494e 20996
8a1cdce5
AC
20997You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20998bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20999big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
21000use them in any sensible way.
4009494e 21001
8a1cdce5
AC
21002@vindex gnus-decay-scores
21003@findex gnus-decay-score
21004@vindex gnus-decay-score-function
21005Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
21006When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
21007non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
21008mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
21009If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
1df7defd 21010regexp are treated. E.g., you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
8a1cdce5
AC
21011@emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
21012performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
21013@code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
21014function:
4009494e 21015
8a1cdce5
AC
21016@lisp
21017(defun gnus-decay-score (score)
21018 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
21019and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
21020 (let ((n (- score
21021 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
21022 (min (abs score)
21023 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
21024 (* (abs score)
21025 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
21026 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
44e97401 21027 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
8a1cdce5
AC
21028 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
21029 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
21030 (string-to-number
21031 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
21032 (floor n))))
21033@end lisp
4009494e 21034
8a1cdce5
AC
21035@vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
21036@vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
21037@code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
21038@code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
4009494e 21039
8a1cdce5
AC
21040@enumerate
21041@item
21042Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
4009494e 21043
8a1cdce5
AC
21044@item
21045Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
4009494e 21046
8a1cdce5
AC
21047@item
21048Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21049score.
21050@end enumerate
4009494e 21051
8a1cdce5
AC
21052If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21053with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21054the new score, which should be an integer.
4009494e 21055
8a1cdce5
AC
21056Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21057four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
4009494e 21058
8a1cdce5
AC
21059@node Searching
21060@chapter Searching
21061@cindex searching
4009494e 21062
8a1cdce5
AC
21063FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
21064comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
21065as well.
4009494e 21066
8a1cdce5
AC
21067This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
21068articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
fe3c5669
PE
21069provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
21070to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
4009494e 21071
8a1cdce5
AC
21072@menu
21073* nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21074* nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21075@end menu
4009494e 21076
8a1cdce5
AC
21077@node nnir
21078@section nnir
21079@cindex nnir
4009494e 21080
8a1cdce5
AC
21081This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21082within gnus.
4009494e 21083
8a1cdce5 21084@menu
156e3f9c 21085* What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
8a1cdce5 21086* Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
156e3f9c 21087* Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
8a1cdce5 21088@end menu
4009494e 21089
156e3f9c
G
21090@node What is nnir?
21091@subsection What is nnir?
8a1cdce5 21092
156e3f9c 21093@code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
8a1cdce5
AC
21094through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21095@code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
156e3f9c 21096@dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
8a1cdce5
AC
21097interface.
21098
21099The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21100configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
fe3c5669 21101created and maintained outside of Gnus.
8a1cdce5 21102
156e3f9c 21103
8a1cdce5
AC
21104@node Basic Usage
21105@subsection Basic Usage
21106
21107In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21108current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21109for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21110the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21111showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21112using the usual commands.
21113
89cccc2f
G
21114The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group,
21115and some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
8a1cdce5 21116deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
89cccc2f
G
21117alternative: you can @emph{warp} (i.e., jump) to the original group
21118for the article on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
8a1cdce5 21119@code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
89cccc2f
G
21120@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers
21121to @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works
21122its magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you
21123can read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article
21124marks, whatever. Go nuts.
8a1cdce5
AC
21125
21126You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21127No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21128even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21129will search all the groups under that heading.
21130
21131Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21132@code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21133groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21134certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21135@code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21136
21137One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21138features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21139to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21140groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
fe3c5669 21141special search features for each engine separately.
8a1cdce5 21142
156e3f9c 21143
8a1cdce5
AC
21144@node Setting up nnir
21145@subsection Setting up nnir
21146
21147To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21148to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21149@code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21150like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21151below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21152a backend.
21153
21154If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21155servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21156don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21157query language anyway.
4009494e 21158
8a1cdce5
AC
21159@menu
21160* Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21161* The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21162* The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21163* The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21164* The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21165* The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
89cccc2f 21166* The notmuch Engine:: Notmuch configuration and usage.
8a1cdce5
AC
21167* The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21168* Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21169@end menu
4009494e 21170
8a1cdce5
AC
21171@node Associating Engines
21172@subsubsection Associating Engines
4009494e 21173
4009494e 21174
8a1cdce5
AC
21175When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21176use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21177setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21178name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21179named @code{home} you can use
4009494e 21180
8a1cdce5 21181@lisp
156e3f9c 21182(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
fe3c5669 21183 '((nnml "home"
156e3f9c
G
21184 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21185 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
8a1cdce5 21186@end lisp
4009494e 21187
8a1cdce5
AC
21188Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21189with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21190engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21191can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21192an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21193variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21194@code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21195servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21196to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21197@code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21198could change this to
4009494e 21199
8a1cdce5
AC
21200@lisp
21201'((nnimap . namazu)
21202 (nntp . gmane))
21203@end lisp
4009494e 21204
8a1cdce5
AC
21205@node The imap Engine
21206@subsubsection The imap Engine
4009494e 21207
fe3c5669 21208The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
4009494e 21209
fe3c5669 21210Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
8a1cdce5
AC
21211The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21212features (inspired by the Google search input language):
01c52d31 21213
8a1cdce5 21214@table @samp
4009494e 21215
8a1cdce5
AC
21216@item Boolean query operators
21217AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
1df7defd 21218operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
8a1cdce5 21219operators must be written with all capital letters to be
f99f1641 21220recognized. Also preceding a term with a @minus{} sign is equivalent to NOT
8a1cdce5 21221term.
4009494e 21222
fe3c5669 21223@item Automatic AND queries
8a1cdce5
AC
21224If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21225expression intended to match all components.
4009494e 21226
8a1cdce5
AC
21227@item Phrase searches
21228If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21229literal string.
4009494e 21230
8a1cdce5 21231@end table
4009494e 21232
8a1cdce5
AC
21233By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21234to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21235the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21236Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21237``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21238example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21239the query to the Message-ID header.
4009494e 21240
8a1cdce5
AC
21241Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21242@acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21243RFC3501.
4009494e 21244
8a1cdce5
AC
21245If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21246customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21247@acronym{IMAP} queries by default
4009494e 21248
8a1cdce5
AC
21249@lisp
21250(setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21251@end lisp
4009494e 21252
8a1cdce5
AC
21253@node The gmane Engine
21254@subsubsection The gmane Engine
4009494e 21255
fe3c5669 21256The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
4009494e 21257
8a1cdce5 21258Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
4009494e 21259
8a1cdce5
AC
21260@table @samp
21261@item Boolean query operators
21262AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
1df7defd 21263used to control operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
8a1cdce5 21264Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
e1dbe924 21265recognized.
4009494e 21266
8a1cdce5 21267@item Required and excluded terms
f99f1641
PE
21268+ and @minus{} can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g., football
21269@minus{}american
4009494e 21270
fe3c5669 21271@item Unicode handling
8a1cdce5
AC
21272The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21273in any language.
4009494e 21274
fe3c5669 21275@item Stopwords
8a1cdce5 21276Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
1df7defd
PE
21277can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g., +the) or
21278enclosing the word in quotes (e.g., "the").
4009494e 21279
8a1cdce5 21280@end table
4009494e 21281
8a1cdce5
AC
21282The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21283prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21284name (or part of a name) to match.
4009494e 21285
8a1cdce5
AC
21286@node The swish++ Engine
21287@subsubsection The swish++ Engine
4009494e 21288
e4920bc9 21289FIXME: Say something more here.
4009494e 21290
8a1cdce5
AC
21291Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21292@uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
4009494e 21293
8151d490
AC
21294@table @code
21295
21296@item nnir-swish++-program
21297The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21298
21299@item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21300A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21301swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21302
21303@item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21304The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21305to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21306
21307@end table
21308
8a1cdce5
AC
21309@node The swish-e Engine
21310@subsubsection The swish-e Engine
4009494e 21311
e4920bc9 21312FIXME: Say something more here.
4009494e 21313
8a1cdce5
AC
21314Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21315@uref{http://swish-e.org}
4009494e 21316
8151d490
AC
21317@table @code
21318
21319@item nnir-swish-e-program
21320The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21321
21322@item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21323A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21324swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21325
21326@item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21327The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21328to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21329
21330@end table
21331
8a1cdce5
AC
21332@node The namazu Engine
21333@subsubsection The namazu Engine
4009494e 21334
8a1cdce5
AC
21335Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21336One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21337where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
fe3c5669 21338variable.
4009494e 21339
8a1cdce5
AC
21340To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21341also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21342returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with `/'
21343instead of `.').
4009494e 21344
8a1cdce5
AC
21345For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21346@samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21347following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21348"/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21349the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21350the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21351correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
4009494e 21352
8a1cdce5
AC
21353Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21354variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21355important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21356output format. Good switches to use include `--sort', `--ascending',
21357`--early' and `--late'. Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21358information on valid switches.
4009494e 21359
8a1cdce5
AC
21360Mail must first be indexed with the `mknmz' program. Read the documentation
21361for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an example:
4009494e 21362
8a1cdce5
AC
21363@cartouche
21364@example
21365 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
4009494e 21366
8a1cdce5
AC
21367 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use `^' or `$' anchors.
21368 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
4009494e 21369
8a1cdce5
AC
21370 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21371 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
4009494e 21372
8a1cdce5
AC
21373 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21374 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
4009494e 21375
8a1cdce5
AC
21376 # The max length of a word.
21377 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
4009494e 21378
8a1cdce5
AC
21379 # The max length of a field.
21380 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21381@end example
21382@end cartouche
4009494e 21383
8a1cdce5
AC
21384For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21385@samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21386the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21387the following command:
4009494e 21388
8a1cdce5
AC
21389@example
21390mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21391@end example
4009494e 21392
8a1cdce5
AC
21393For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21394this command periodically, say every four hours.
4009494e 21395
89cccc2f
G
21396
21397@node The notmuch Engine
21398@subsubsection The notmuch Engine
21399
21400@table @code
21401@item nnir-notmuch-program
21402The name of the notmuch search executable. Defaults to
21403@samp{notmuch}.
21404
21405@item nnir-notmuch-additional-switches
21406A list of strings, to be given as additional arguments to notmuch.
21407
21408@item nnir-notmuch-remove-prefix
21409The prefix to remove from each file name returned by notmuch in order
21410to get a group name (albeit with @samp{/} instead of @samp{.}). This
21411is a regular expression.
21412
21413@end table
21414
21415
8a1cdce5
AC
21416@node The hyrex Engine
21417@subsubsection The hyrex Engine
156e3f9c 21418This engine is obsolete.
4009494e 21419
8a1cdce5 21420@node Customizations
fe3c5669 21421@subsubsection Customizations
4009494e 21422
8a1cdce5
AC
21423@table @code
21424
21425@item nnir-method-default-engines
f99f1641 21426Alist of pairs of server backends and search engines. The default associations
8a1cdce5
AC
21427are
21428@example
21429(nnimap . imap)
21430(nntp . gmane)
21431@end example
4009494e 21432
8a1cdce5
AC
21433@item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21434A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21435when searching all groups on a server.
4009494e 21436
8a1cdce5
AC
21437@item nnir-summary-line-format
21438The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21439All the items from `gnus-summary-line-format' are available, along with
21440three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
4009494e
GM
21441
21442@example
8a1cdce5
AC
21443%Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21444%G Article original full group name (string)
21445%g Article original short group name (string)
4009494e
GM
21446@end example
21447
8a1cdce5 21448If nil (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
4009494e 21449
8a1cdce5
AC
21450@item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21451If non-nil, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21452the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21453group as arguments and populates the `nntp-server-buffer' with the
21454retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21455indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21456should return @code{nil}
4009494e 21457
8a1cdce5
AC
21458If this variable is nil, or if the provided function returns nil for a
21459search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be called instead."
4009494e
GM
21460
21461
8a1cdce5 21462@end table
4009494e 21463
4009494e 21464
8a1cdce5
AC
21465@node nnmairix
21466@section nnmairix
58333467 21467
8a1cdce5
AC
21468@cindex mairix
21469@cindex nnmairix
21470This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21471@code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21472Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21473bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
4009494e 21474
8a1cdce5
AC
21475@menu
21476* About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21477* nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21478* What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21479* Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21480* Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21481* nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21482* Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21483* nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21484* nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21485@end menu
4009494e 21486
8a1cdce5 21487@c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
1df7defd 21488@c E.g., adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
8a1cdce5 21489@c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
4009494e 21490
8a1cdce5
AC
21491@node About mairix
21492@subsection About mairix
4009494e 21493
8a1cdce5
AC
21494Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21495mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
1df7defd 21496GPL@. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
8a1cdce5
AC
21497runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21498be found at
21499@uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
4009494e 21500
8a1cdce5
AC
21501Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21502swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21503has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21504can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21505thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21506necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21507done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21508therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21509up.
4009494e 21510
8a1cdce5
AC
21511For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21512@code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21513end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21514results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21515which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21516made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21517mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21518for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21519searches.
4009494e 21520
8a1cdce5
AC
21521@node nnmairix requirements
21522@subsection nnmairix requirements
4009494e 21523
8a1cdce5
AC
21524Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21525direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
1df7defd
PE
21526server (e.g., an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21527access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g., via ssh.
4009494e 21528
8a1cdce5
AC
21529Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21530ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21531one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21532@code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
4009494e 21533
8a1cdce5
AC
21534If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21535you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21536@code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21537files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21538really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21539the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
4009494e 21540
8a1cdce5
AC
21541@node What nnmairix does
21542@subsection What nnmairix does
4009494e 21543
8a1cdce5
AC
21544The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21545either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21546database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
1df7defd 21547several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g., to quickly
8a1cdce5
AC
21548search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21549display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21550mails are in different folders.
4009494e 21551
8a1cdce5
AC
21552Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21553to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21554containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
1df7defd
PE
21555even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID@. If you check for
21556new mail in these folders (e.g., by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
8a1cdce5
AC
21557automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21558
21559You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21560creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21561then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21562does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21563strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21564claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21565the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
1df7defd 21566its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g., if you
8a1cdce5
AC
21567use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21568about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21569group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
4009494e 21570
8a1cdce5
AC
21571@code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21572a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21573the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21574different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21575@code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21576binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21577@code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21578present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21579You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21580but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
1df7defd 21581groups alongside your other mail, you can also create, e.g., a new
8a1cdce5
AC
21582@code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21583make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21584(@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21585mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21586folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
4009494e 21587
8a1cdce5
AC
21588@node Setting up mairix
21589@subsection Setting up mairix
4009494e 21590
8a1cdce5 21591First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
4009494e 21592
8a1cdce5
AC
21593Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21594(at least) the following entries:
4009494e 21595
8a1cdce5
AC
21596@example
21597# Your Maildir/MH base folder
21598base=~/Maildir
21599@end example
4009494e 21600
8a1cdce5
AC
21601This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21602are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21603with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21604directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
4009494e 21605
8a1cdce5
AC
21606@example
21607maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21608mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21609mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21610@end example
21611
21612This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21613base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21614@code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21615directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21616section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21617
21618@example
21619omit=zz_mairix-*
21620@end example
4009494e 21621
8a1cdce5
AC
21622@vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21623This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21624search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21625variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
4009494e 21626
8a1cdce5
AC
21627@example
21628mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21629database= ... location of database file ...
21630@end example
4009494e 21631
8a1cdce5
AC
21632The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21633search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21634with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
4009494e 21635
8a1cdce5 21636To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
4009494e 21637
8a1cdce5
AC
21638@example
21639base=~/Maildir
21640maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21641mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21642mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21643mformat=maildir
21644omit=zz_mairix-*
21645database=~/.mairixdatabase
21646@end example
4009494e 21647
8a1cdce5
AC
21648In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21649folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21650colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21651because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21652@code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21653@code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21654to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21655notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21656to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21657dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21658old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21659The other lines should be obvious.
4009494e 21660
8a1cdce5
AC
21661See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21662especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21663than you are used to.
4009494e 21664
8a1cdce5
AC
21665Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21666Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21667the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
4009494e 21668
8a1cdce5
AC
21669@node Configuring nnmairix
21670@subsection Configuring nnmairix
21671
21672In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21673(@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21674necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21675server. You will have to specify the following:
4009494e
GM
21676
21677@itemize @bullet
21678
21679@item
8a1cdce5
AC
21680The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21681want.
4009494e
GM
21682
21683@item
8a1cdce5
AC
21684The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21685searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21686Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21687which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21688@code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21689mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
1df7defd 21690However, you can also create, e.g., a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
8a1cdce5
AC
21691server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21692(@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21693just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21694@code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21695(@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21696@acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21697@code{nnimap} server here.
4009494e 21698
8a1cdce5
AC
21699@item
21700@vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21701The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21702be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
1df7defd 21703SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g., on your
8a1cdce5
AC
21704@acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21705mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21706@code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
4009494e 21707
8a1cdce5
AC
21708@item
21709The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
1df7defd 21710where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e., all searches which
8a1cdce5
AC
21711are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21712like.
4009494e 21713
8a1cdce5
AC
21714@item
21715If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
1df7defd 21716asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e., with hidden maildir
8a1cdce5
AC
21717folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21718@samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21719server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
4009494e 21720
8a1cdce5 21721@end itemize
4009494e 21722
8a1cdce5
AC
21723@node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21724@subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
4009494e 21725
8a1cdce5 21726In group mode:
4009494e 21727
8a1cdce5 21728@table @kbd
4009494e 21729
8a1cdce5
AC
21730@item G b c
21731@kindex G b c (Group)
21732@findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21733Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21734(@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21735this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
4009494e 21736
8a1cdce5
AC
21737@item G b s
21738@kindex G b s (Group)
21739@findex nnmairix-search
21740Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21741results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21742displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
4009494e 21743
8a1cdce5
AC
21744@item G b m
21745@kindex G b m (Group)
21746@findex nnmairix-widget-search
21747Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21748comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21749group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
4009494e 21750
8a1cdce5
AC
21751@item G b i
21752@kindex G b i (Group)
21753@findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21754Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21755only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
4009494e 21756
8a1cdce5
AC
21757@item G b g
21758@kindex G b g (Group)
21759@findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21760Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21761(@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21762automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21763@kbd{M-g}.
4009494e 21764
8a1cdce5
AC
21765@item G b q
21766@kindex G b q (Group)
21767@findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21768Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21769(@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
4009494e 21770
8a1cdce5
AC
21771@item G b t
21772@kindex G b t (Group)
21773@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21774Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
1df7defd 21775i.e., if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
8a1cdce5 21776(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
4009494e 21777
8a1cdce5
AC
21778@item G b u
21779@kindex G b u (Group)
21780@findex nnmairix-update-database
21781@vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21782Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21783(@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21784and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21785@code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21786options).
4009494e 21787
8a1cdce5
AC
21788@item G b r
21789@kindex G b r (Group)
21790@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21791Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21792marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
4009494e 21793
8a1cdce5
AC
21794@item G b d
21795@kindex G b d (Group)
21796@findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21797Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21798(@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21799you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
4009494e 21800
8a1cdce5
AC
21801@item G b a
21802@kindex G b a (Group)
21803@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21804Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21805(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21806behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21807update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21808mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21809upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21810lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21811entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
4009494e 21812
8a1cdce5
AC
21813@item G b p
21814@kindex G b p (Group)
21815@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21816Toggle marks propagation for this group
21817(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21818marks}).
4009494e 21819
8a1cdce5
AC
21820@item G b o
21821@kindex G b o (Group)
21822@findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21823Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21824@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
4009494e
GM
21825
21826@end table
21827
8a1cdce5 21828In summary mode:
4009494e 21829
8a1cdce5 21830@table @kbd
4009494e 21831
8a1cdce5
AC
21832@item $ m
21833@kindex $ m (Summary)
21834@findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21835Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21836message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21837(@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
4009494e 21838
8a1cdce5
AC
21839@item $ g
21840@kindex $ g (Summary)
21841@findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21842Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21843message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21844(@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
4009494e 21845
8a1cdce5
AC
21846@item $ t
21847@kindex $ t (Summary)
21848@findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21849Searches thread for the current article
21850(@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21851shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21852current article and enabled threads.
4009494e 21853
8a1cdce5
AC
21854@item $ f
21855@kindex $ f (Summary)
21856@findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21857Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21858(@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21859calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
4009494e 21860
8a1cdce5
AC
21861@item $ o
21862@kindex $ o (Summary)
21863@findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21864(Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
1df7defd
PE
21865originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that,
21866e.g., replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
8a1cdce5
AC
21867parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21868function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21869article file name as a fallback method.
4009494e 21870
8a1cdce5
AC
21871@item $ u
21872@kindex $ u (Summary)
21873@findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21874Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21875(@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21876tips and tricks}).
4009494e 21877
8a1cdce5 21878@end table
4009494e 21879
8a1cdce5
AC
21880@node Propagating marks
21881@subsection Propagating marks
4009494e 21882
8a1cdce5
AC
21883First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21884propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21885the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
4009494e 21886
8a1cdce5 21887@uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
4009494e 21888
8a1cdce5
AC
21889You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21890is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21891marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21892fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21893be useful to you.
4009494e 21894
8a1cdce5
AC
21895With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21896alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21897example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21898into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21899@samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21900all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21901create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21902can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21903implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21904groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
4009494e 21905
8a1cdce5
AC
21906There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21907@samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21908``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21909search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21910enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21911marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21912mail group it will be still shown as unread.
4009494e 21913
8a1cdce5
AC
21914You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21915tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21916created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21917@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21918shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21919even more cumbersome.
4009494e 21920
8a1cdce5
AC
21921Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21922automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21923@emph{marks propagation} is about.
4009494e 21924
e9a452d9 21925Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
8a1cdce5
AC
21926certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21927@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21928p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21929search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21930temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21931this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
4009494e 21932
8a1cdce5
AC
21933With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21934group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21935you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21936magically be set for the original article, too.
4009494e 21937
8a1cdce5 21938A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
4009494e 21939
8a1cdce5
AC
21940@vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21941Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21942not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21943dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21944will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21945via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21946details).
4009494e 21947
8a1cdce5
AC
21948Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21949article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
21950the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21951fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21952marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21953set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21954the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
4009494e 21955
8a1cdce5
AC
21956@vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21957If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21958original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21959search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21960way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21961marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21962setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
4009494e 21963
1df7defd 21964Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e., if you
8a1cdce5
AC
21965tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21966article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21967reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21968immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21969@code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21970not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21971groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21972maildir as its file format.
4009494e 21973
8a1cdce5
AC
21974@vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21975If you work with this setup, just set
21976@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
21977happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
21978problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
21979usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
21980groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
21981back end using @kbd{G b d}.
4009494e 21982
8a1cdce5
AC
21983@node nnmairix tips and tricks
21984@subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
21985
21986@itemize
21987@item
21988Checking Mail
4009494e 21989
8a1cdce5
AC
21990@findex nnmairix-update-groups
21991I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
21992have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
21993Levels}).
4009494e 21994
8a1cdce5 21995I use the following to check for mails:
4009494e 21996
8a1cdce5
AC
21997@lisp
21998(defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
21999 (interactive "P")
22000 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
22001 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
22002 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
22003 (gnus-group-list-groups))
4009494e 22004
8a1cdce5
AC
22005(define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
22006@end lisp
4009494e 22007
8a1cdce5
AC
22008Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
22009server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
22010details.
4009494e 22011
8a1cdce5
AC
22012@item
22013Example: search group for ticked articles
4009494e 22014
8a1cdce5
AC
22015For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
22016articles always stay unread:
4009494e 22017
1df7defd 22018Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g., @samp{important}), use
8a1cdce5 22019@samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
4009494e 22020
8a1cdce5
AC
22021Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
22022activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
4009494e 22023
8a1cdce5
AC
22024So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
22025group? There are two options: You may simply use
22026@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
22027tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
22028@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
22029comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
22030also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
1df7defd 22031e.g., by marking an article as read.
4009494e 22032
8a1cdce5
AC
22033When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
22034article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
22035mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
22036for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
22037snippet and the doc string for details.
4009494e 22038
8a1cdce5
AC
22039@item
22040Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
4009494e 22041
8a1cdce5
AC
22042As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
22043the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
22044see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
22045should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
22046usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
1df7defd 22047@code{nnml}, i.e., you will suddenly see groups of the form
8a1cdce5
AC
22048@samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
22049simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
22050auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
22051@code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
22052Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
22053for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
4009494e 22054
8a1cdce5
AC
22055@lisp
22056(setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
22057 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
22058@end lisp
4009494e 22059
8a1cdce5 22060@end itemize
4009494e 22061
8a1cdce5
AC
22062@node nnmairix caveats
22063@subsection nnmairix caveats
4009494e 22064
8a1cdce5
AC
22065@itemize
22066@item
22067You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
22068you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
22069@code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
22070put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
22071an example server definition:
4009494e 22072
8a1cdce5
AC
22073@lisp
22074(nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
22075@end lisp
4009494e 22076
ee7683eb 22077(The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
8a1cdce5
AC
22078@code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
22079have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
22080mairix.)
4009494e 22081
8a1cdce5
AC
22082@item
22083If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
22084@code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
c3c65d73
TZ
22085@code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
22086@emph{extra careful} if you use
22087@code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
22088into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
22089check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
4009494e 22090
8a1cdce5
AC
22091@item
22092Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22093groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
4009494e 22094
8a1cdce5
AC
22095@item
22096If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22097@code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
4009494e 22098
8a1cdce5
AC
22099@item
22100mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
4009494e 22101
8a1cdce5
AC
22102@item
22103@code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22104completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22105called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22106back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22107don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22108own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22109folders.
4009494e 22110
4009494e 22111@item
8a1cdce5
AC
22112All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22113(@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22114is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22115it is gone for good.
4009494e
GM
22116
22117@item
8a1cdce5
AC
22118@findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22119If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22120``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22121delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22122@code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22123save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22124@code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22125@code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22126@code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
4009494e
GM
22127
22128@item
8a1cdce5
AC
22129The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22130for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
4009494e 22131
8a1cdce5
AC
22132A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22133comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22134@samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22135file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22136update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22137mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22138while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22139@samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22140after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22141non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22142``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22143to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
4009494e 22144
8a1cdce5 22145@end itemize
4009494e
GM
22146
22147@iftex
22148@iflatex
22149@chapter Message
22150@include message.texi
22151@chapter Emacs MIME
22152@include emacs-mime.texi
22153@chapter Sieve
22154@include sieve.texi
3d439cd1
CY
22155@chapter EasyPG
22156@include epa.texi
01c52d31
MB
22157@chapter SASL
22158@include sasl.texi
4009494e
GM
22159@end iflatex
22160@end iftex
22161
22162@node Various
22163@chapter Various
22164
22165@menu
22166* Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22167* Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22168* Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22169* Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22170* Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22171* Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
4009494e
GM
22172* Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22173* Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
4009494e 22174* Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
4009494e
GM
22175* Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22176* Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22177* Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22178* Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22179* Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22180* Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22181* Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22182* Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
64763fe3 22183* The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
4009494e
GM
22184* Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22185* Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22186@end menu
22187
22188
22189@node Process/Prefix
22190@section Process/Prefix
22191@cindex process/prefix convention
22192
22193Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22194articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22195
22196This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22197command to be performed on.
22198
22199It goes like this:
22200
22201If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22202articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22203negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22204with the current one.
22205
22206@vindex transient-mark-mode
22207If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22208active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22209
22210If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22211process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22212the process mark.
22213
22214If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22215process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22216
22217Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22218are avoided.
22219
22220Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22221process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22222marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22223@kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22224
22225@vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22226One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22227instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22228Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22229goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22230will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22231summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22232@code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22233
22234Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22235that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22236convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22237command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22238expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22239
22240
22241@node Interactive
22242@section Interactive
22243@cindex interaction
22244
22245@table @code
22246
22247@item gnus-novice-user
22248@vindex gnus-novice-user
22249If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22250World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22251really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22252to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22253default.
22254
22255@item gnus-expert-user
22256@vindex gnus-expert-user
22257If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
5e7d4a75
KY
22258questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22259no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22260without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22261articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22262confirmation.
4009494e
GM
22263
22264@item gnus-interactive-catchup
22265@vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22266Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22267is @code{t} by default.
22268
22269@item gnus-interactive-exit
22270@vindex gnus-interactive-exit
e21bac42
G
22271If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22272@code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22273querying. The default value is @code{t}.
4009494e
GM
22274@end table
22275
22276
22277@node Symbolic Prefixes
22278@section Symbolic Prefixes
22279@cindex symbolic prefixes
22280
22281Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22282instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22283@kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22284rule of 900 to the current article.
22285
22286This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22287additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22288``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22289doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22290for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22291file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22292same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22293
22294@kindex M-i (Summary)
22295@findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22296I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22297prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22298character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22299prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22300command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22301``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22302@code{b}''. You get the drift.
22303
22304Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22305hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22306functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22307
22308If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22309Interactive}.
22310
22311
22312@node Formatting Variables
22313@section Formatting Variables
22314@cindex formatting variables
22315
22316Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22317things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22318@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22319output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22320Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22321be annoyed by.
22322
22323Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22324%(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22325lots of percentages everywhere.
22326
22327@menu
22328* Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22329* Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22330* Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22331* User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22332* Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22333* Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22334* Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22335* Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22336@end menu
22337
22338Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22339@code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22340@code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22341@code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22342@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22343@code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22344@code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22345@code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22346
22347All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22348case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22349
22350@kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22351@findex gnus-update-format
22352Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22353specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22354update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22355examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22356
22357
22358
22359@node Formatting Basics
22360@subsection Formatting Basics
22361
22362Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22363buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22364spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22365
22366As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22367modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22368@dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22369@samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22370padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22371the right instead.
22372
22373You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22374particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22375means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22376less than 4 characters wide.
22377
22378Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22379@samp{%&user-date;}.
22380
22381
22382@node Mode Line Formatting
22383@subsection Mode Line Formatting
22384
22385Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22386@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22387buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22388with the following two differences:
22389
22390@enumerate
22391
22392@item
22393There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22394
22395@item
22396The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22397Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22398@samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22399so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22400display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22401mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22402@code{mode-line-format} variable.
22403
22404@end enumerate
22405
22406
22407@node Advanced Formatting
22408@subsection Advanced Formatting
22409
22410It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22411Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22412be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22413look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22414
22415These are the valid modifiers:
22416
22417@table @code
22418@item pad
22419@itemx pad-left
22420Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22421length.
22422
22423@item pad-right
22424Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22425length.
22426
22427@item max
22428@itemx max-left
22429Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22430
22431@item max-right
22432Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22433length.
22434
22435@item cut
22436@itemx cut-left
22437Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22438
22439@item cut-right
22440Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22441
22442@item ignore
22443Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22444
22445@item form
22446Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22447used.
22448
22449Here's an example:
22450
22451@lisp
22452"~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22453@end lisp
22454
22455@end table
22456
22457Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22458will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22459This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22460the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22461@samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22462maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22463than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22464
22465Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22466last operation, padding.
22467
4009494e
GM
22468
22469@node User-Defined Specs
22470@subsection User-Defined Specs
22471
22472All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22473The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22474will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22475@samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22476a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22477it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22478be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22479specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22480should protect against that.
22481
22482Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22483Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22484
22485You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22486much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22487@samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22488given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22489inserted.
22490
22491
22492@node Formatting Fonts
22493@subsection Formatting Fonts
22494
9b3ebcb6
MB
22495@cindex %(, %)
22496@vindex gnus-mouse-face
4009494e
GM
22497There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22498variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22499the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22500highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22501over it.
22502
9b3ebcb6
MB
22503@cindex %@{, %@}
22504@vindex gnus-face-0
4009494e
GM
22505Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22506normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22507default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22508and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22509@code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22510@samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22511
9b3ebcb6 22512@cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
89b163db 22513@c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
9b3ebcb6 22514@vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
4009494e
GM
22515Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22516special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22517@code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22518@code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22519variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22520return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22521set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22522refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
47301027 22523(in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
4009494e
GM
22524XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22525guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22526paragraph.)
22527
22528Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22529
22530@lisp
22531;; @r{Create three face types.}
22532(setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22533(setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22534
22535;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22536;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22537;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22538(copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22539;; @r{Set the color.}
22540(set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22541(setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22542
22543;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22544(setq gnus-group-line-format
22545 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22546@end lisp
22547
22548I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22549and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22550
22551Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22552mode-line variables.
22553
22554@node Positioning Point
22555@subsection Positioning Point
22556
22557Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22558buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22559line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22560
22561You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22562
22563@findex gnus-goto-colon
22564You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22565function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22566
22567But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22568to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22569put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22570place point there.
22571
22572
22573@node Tabulation
22574@subsection Tabulation
22575
22576You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22577strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22578can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22579about lining up the following text afterwards.
22580
22581To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22582different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22583
22584@samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
2258550. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22586This is the soft tabulator.
22587
22588@samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
2258950. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
2259050 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22591
22592
22593@node Wide Characters
22594@subsection Wide Characters
22595
22596Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22597Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22598characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22599
22600The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22601characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22602these countries, that's not true.
22603
22604@vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22605To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22606@code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22607prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22608for Emacs.
22609
22610
22611@node Window Layout
22612@section Window Layout
22613@cindex window layout
22614
22615No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22616
22617@vindex gnus-use-full-window
22618If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22619other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22620@code{t} by default.
22621
22622Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22623glitches. Use at your own peril.
22624
22625@vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22626@code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22627buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22628
22629@lisp
71e691a5 22630((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
4009494e
GM
22631 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22632 (article 1.0))))
22633@end lisp
22634
22635This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22636other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22637configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22638possible names is listed below.
22639
22640The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
f99f1641 22641should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example:
4009494e
GM
22642
22643@lisp
22644(article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22645 (article 1.0)))
22646@end lisp
22647
22648This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22649half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22650you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22651reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22652@code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22653rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22654whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22655size spec per split.
22656
22657Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22658@code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
1df7defd 22659split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e., is the third or
4009494e
GM
22660fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22661present) gets focus.
22662
22663Here's a more complicated example:
22664
22665@lisp
22666(article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22667 (summary 0.25 point)
4009494e
GM
22668 (article 1.0)))
22669@end lisp
22670
22671If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22672then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22673occupy, not a percentage.
22674
22675If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22676precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22677split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
71e691a5 22678be used as a split.
4009494e
GM
22679
22680Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22681
22682@lisp
22683(article (horizontal 1.0
22684 (vertical 0.5
71e691a5 22685 (group 1.0))
4009494e
GM
22686 (vertical 1.0
22687 (summary 0.25 point)
4009494e
GM
22688 (article 1.0))))
22689@end lisp
22690
22691Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22692@code{horizontal} thingie?
22693
22694If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22695split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22696Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22697fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22698the screen is to be given to this strip.
22699
22700For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22701The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22702lines from the splits.
22703
22704To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22705may look like:
22706
22707@example
22708@group
22709split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22710frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22711horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22712vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22713buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22714size = number | frame-params
22715buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22716@end group
22717@end example
22718
22719The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22720top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22721return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22722may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22723
22724@vindex gnus-window-min-width
22725@vindex gnus-window-min-height
22726@cindex window height
22727@cindex window width
22728Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22729than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22730windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22731characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22732splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22733you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22734
22735If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22736@code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22737Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22738windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22739
22740@findex gnus-configure-frame
22741If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22742@code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22743that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22744nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22745three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22746@code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22747look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22748Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22749@code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22750configuration list.
22751
22752@lisp
22753(gnus-configure-frame
22754 '(horizontal 1.0
22755 (vertical 10
22756 (group 1.0)
22757 (article 0.3 point))
22758 (vertical 1.0
22759 (article 1.0)
22760 (horizontal 4
22761 (group 1.0)
22762 (article 10)))))
22763@end lisp
22764
22765You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22766@code{frame} split:
22767
22768@lisp
22769(gnus-configure-frame
22770 '(frame 1.0
22771 (vertical 1.0
22772 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22773 (article 1.0))
22774 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22775 (user-position . t)
22776 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22777 (picon 1.0))))
22778
22779@end lisp
22780
22781This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22782configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22783frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22784instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22785should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22786@xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22787Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22788accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22789is such a plist.
22790The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22791be found in its default value.
22792
22793Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22794@code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22795it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22796might be used:
22797
22798@lisp
22799(message (horizontal 1.0
22800 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22801 (vertical 0.24
22802 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22803 '(summary 0.5))
22804 (group 1.0))))
22805@end lisp
22806
22807One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22808for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22809accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22810
22811@lisp
22812(message
22813 (frame 1.0
22814 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22815 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22816 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22817 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22818 (name . "Message"))
22819 (message 1.0 point))))
22820@end lisp
22821
22822@findex gnus-add-configuration
22823Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22824complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22825of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22826you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22827
22828@lisp
22829(gnus-add-configuration
22830 '(article (vertical 1.0
22831 (group 4)
22832 (summary .25 point)
22833 (article 1.0))))
22834@end lisp
22835
22836You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22837@file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22838Gnus has been loaded.
22839
22840@vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22841If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22842won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22843``right'' window configuration, you can set
22844@code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22845
22846If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22847window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22848to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22849windows resized.
22850
06b840e0
LI
22851@subsection Window Configuration Names
22852
22853Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22854and when they're used:
22855
1e3b6001 22856@table @code
06b840e0
LI
22857@item group
22858The group buffer.
22859
22860@item summary
22861Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22862
22863@item article
22864Selecting an article.
22865
22866@item server
22867The server buffer.
22868
22869@item browse
22870Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22871
22872@item message
22873Composing a (new) message.
22874
22875@item only-article
22876Showing only the article buffer.
22877
22878@item edit-article
22879Editing an article.
22880
22881@item edit-form
22882Editing group parameters and the like.
22883
22884@item edit-score
22885Editing a server definition.
22886
22887@item post
22888Composing a news message.
22889
22890@item reply
22891Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22892
22893@item forward
22894Forwarding a message.
22895
22896@item reply-yank
22897Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22898
22899@item mail-bound
22900Bouncing a message.
22901
22902@item pipe
22903Sending an article to an external process.
22904
22905@item bug
22906Sending a bug report.
22907
22908@item score-trace
22909Displaying the score trace.
22910
22911@item score-words
22912Displaying the score words.
22913
22914@item split-trace
22915Displaying the split trace.
22916
22917@item compose-bounce
22918Composing a bounce message.
22919
22920@item mml-preview
22921Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22922
1e3b6001 22923@end table
06b840e0
LI
22924
22925
4009494e
GM
22926@subsection Example Window Configurations
22927
22928@itemize @bullet
22929@item
22930Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22931between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22932
22933@ifinfo
22934@example
22935+---+---------+
22936| G | Summary |
22937| r +---------+
22938| o | |
22939| u | Article |
22940| p | |
22941+---+---------+
22942@end example
22943@end ifinfo
22944
22945@lisp
22946(gnus-add-configuration
22947 '(article
22948 (horizontal 1.0
22949 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22950 (vertical 1.0
22951 (summary 0.16 point)
22952 (article 1.0)))))
22953
22954(gnus-add-configuration
22955 '(summary
22956 (horizontal 1.0
22957 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22958 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22959@end lisp
22960
22961@end itemize
22962
22963
22964@node Faces and Fonts
22965@section Faces and Fonts
22966@cindex faces
22967@cindex fonts
22968@cindex colors
22969
22970Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22971it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22972the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22973interface.
22974
22975
4009494e
GM
22976@node Mode Lines
22977@section Mode Lines
22978@cindex mode lines
22979
22980@vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22981@code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22982lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22983@code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22984@code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22985Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22986pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22987quicker.
22988
22989@cindex display-time
22990
22991@vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22992By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22993lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
1df7defd 22994to display (e.g., the subject of the article) is often longer than the
4009494e
GM
22995mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22996@code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22997elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
1df7defd 22998additional elements on the mode line (e.g., a clock), you should modify
4009494e
GM
22999this variable:
23000
8c106d17 23001@c Hook written by Francesco Potortì <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
4009494e
GM
23002@lisp
23003(add-hook 'display-time-hook
23004 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
23005 (+ 21
23006 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
23007 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
23008 (length display-time-string)))))
23009@end lisp
23010
23011If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
23012strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
23013that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
23014complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
23015configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
23016
23017
23018@node Highlighting and Menus
23019@section Highlighting and Menus
23020@cindex visual
23021@cindex highlighting
23022@cindex menus
23023
23024@vindex gnus-visual
23025The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
23026aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
23027colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
23028file.
23029
23030This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
23031following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
23032
23033@table @code
23034@item group-highlight
23035Do highlights in the group buffer.
23036@item summary-highlight
23037Do highlights in the summary buffer.
23038@item article-highlight
23039Do highlights in the article buffer.
23040@item highlight
23041Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
23042@item group-menu
23043Create menus in the group buffer.
23044@item summary-menu
23045Create menus in the summary buffers.
23046@item article-menu
23047Create menus in the article buffer.
23048@item browse-menu
23049Create menus in the browse buffer.
23050@item server-menu
23051Create menus in the server buffer.
23052@item score-menu
23053Create menus in the score buffers.
23054@item menu
23055Create menus in all buffers.
23056@end table
23057
23058So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
23059buffers, you could say something like:
23060
23061@lisp
23062(setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
23063@end lisp
23064
23065If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
23066
23067@lisp
23068(setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
23069@end lisp
23070
23071If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
23072in all Gnus buffers.
23073
23074Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
23075
23076@table @code
23077@item gnus-mouse-face
23078@vindex gnus-mouse-face
23079This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23080mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23081
23082@end table
23083
23084There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23085
23086@table @code
23087
23088@item gnus-article-menu-hook
23089@vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23090Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23091
23092@item gnus-group-menu-hook
23093@vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23094Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23095
23096@item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23097@vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23098Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23099
23100@item gnus-server-menu-hook
23101@vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23102Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23103
23104@item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23105@vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23106Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23107
23108@item gnus-score-menu-hook
23109@vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23110Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23111
23112@end table
23113
23114
4009494e
GM
23115@node Daemons
23116@section Daemons
23117@cindex demons
23118@cindex daemons
23119
23120Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23121of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23122present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23123while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23124when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23125
23126Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23127@dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23128@var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23129
23130Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23131been idle for thirty minutes:
23132
23133@lisp
23134(gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23135@end lisp
23136
23137Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23138Emacs is idle:
23139
23140@lisp
23141(gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23142@end lisp
23143
23144This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23145in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23146@code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23147
23148If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23149@var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23150the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23151function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23152
23153If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23154be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23155@var{idle} minutes.
23156
23157If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23158will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23159minutes.
23160
23161And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23162the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23163time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23164
23165@vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23166(When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23167seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23168all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23169
23170So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23171your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23172
23173@findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23174@lisp
23175(gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23176@end lisp
23177
4009494e
GM
23178@findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23179@findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23180@findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23181@findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23182Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
8ccbef23 23183@code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
4009494e
GM
23184@code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23185@code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23186@code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23187@file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23188
23189@findex gnus-demon-init
23190@findex gnus-demon-cancel
23191@vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23192If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23193run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23194daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23195
23196Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23197functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23198is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23199behave.
23200
23201
4009494e
GM
23202@node Undo
23203@section Undo
23204@cindex undo
23205
23206It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23207Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23208In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23209
23210The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23211Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23212Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23213disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23214removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23215Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23216@code{undo} function.
23217
23218Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23219does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23220takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23221the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23222However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23223a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23224yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23225That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23226added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23227never be totally undoable.
23228
23229@findex gnus-undo-mode
23230@vindex gnus-use-undo
23231@findex gnus-undo
23232The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23233is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23234default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23235command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23236command.
23237
23238
23239@node Predicate Specifiers
23240@section Predicate Specifiers
23241@cindex predicate specifiers
23242
23243Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23244form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23245to type all that much.
23246
23247These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23248
23249Here's an example:
23250
23251@lisp
23252(or gnus-article-unseen-p
23253 gnus-article-unread-p)
23254@end lisp
23255
23256The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23257functions all take one parameter.
23258
23259@findex gnus-make-predicate
23260Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23261to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23262function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23263specifier.
23264
23265
23266@node Moderation
23267@section Moderation
23268@cindex moderation
23269
23270If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23271It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23272@samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23273get a copy.
23274
23275The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23276buffers. Put
23277
23278@lisp
23279(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23280@end lisp
23281
23282in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23283
23284If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23285supposed to work:
23286
23287@enumerate
23288@item
23289You split your incoming mail by matching on
23290@samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23291articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23292
23293@item
23294You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23295(edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23296
23297@item
23298If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23299articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23300@kbd{c} command.
23301@end enumerate
23302
23303To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23304
23305@lisp
23306(setq gnus-moderated-list
23307 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23308@end lisp
23309
23310
23311@node Fetching a Group
23312@section Fetching a Group
23313@cindex fetching a group
23314
23315@findex gnus-fetch-group
23316It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23317group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23318perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23319command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23320It takes the group name as a parameter.
23321
23322
23323@node Image Enhancements
23324@section Image Enhancements
23325
23326XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23327support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23328stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23329
23330@menu
23331* X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23332* Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23333* Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23334* Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
61b1af82 23335* Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
4009494e
GM
23336* XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23337@end menu
23338
23339
23340@node X-Face
23341@subsection X-Face
23342@cindex x-face
23343
23344@code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23345depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23346It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23347readers.
23348
23349@cindex x-face
23350@findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23351@vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23352@vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23353@iftex
23354@iflatex
23355\include{xface}
23356@end iflatex
23357@end iftex
23358@c @anchor{X-Face}
23359
23360Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
4b70e299 23361@samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
4009494e
GM
23362have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23363has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23364@code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23365will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23366from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23367faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23368default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23369@code{display} program.
23370
23371On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23372ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23373with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23374On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23375from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23376@code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23377@c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23378@c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23379
23380The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23381are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23382string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23383function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23384If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23385@code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23386
23387(Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23388@code{xface}).
23389
23390@noindent
23391Face and variable:
23392
23393@table @code
23394@item gnus-x-face
23395@vindex gnus-x-face
23396Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23397foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23398default colors are black and white.
01c52d31
MB
23399
23400@item gnus-face-properties-alist
23401@vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23402Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23403X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23404(png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23405XEmacs. Here are examples:
23406
23407@lisp
23408;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23409(setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23410 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23411 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23412
23413;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23414(setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23415 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23416 (png . (:relief -2))))
23417@end lisp
23418
23419@pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23420Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23421Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23422for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23423on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23424@samp{libcompface} library.
4009494e
GM
23425@end table
23426
23427If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23428@code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23429provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23430insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23431above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23432(depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23433
23434@findex gnus-random-x-face
23435@vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23436@vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23437@code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23438@code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23439converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23440@code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23441@samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23442header data as a string.
23443
23444@findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23445@code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23446@code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23447randomly generated data.
23448
23449@findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23450@vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23451@code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23452converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23453@code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23454
23455Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23456like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23457
23458@lisp
23459(setq message-required-news-headers
23460 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23461 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23462@end lisp
23463
23464Using the last function would be something like this:
23465
23466@lisp
23467(setq message-required-news-headers
23468 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23469 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23470 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23471 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23472@end lisp
23473
23474
23475@node Face
23476@subsection Face
23477@cindex face
23478
23479@c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23480
23481@code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23482ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23483represent the author of the message.
23484
23485@cindex face
23486@findex gnus-article-display-face
23487The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23488See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23489specifications.
23490
01c52d31
MB
23491The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23492displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23493
85d870a9 23494Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
4009494e
GM
23495PNG images.
23496@c Maybe add this:
23497@c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23498@c (featurep 'png)
23499@c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23500
23501Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23502easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23503
23504@findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23505@code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23506726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23507
23508@findex gnus-face-from-file
23509@vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23510@code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23511converts the file to Face format by using the
23512@code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23513
23514Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23515following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23516
23517@lisp
23518(setq message-required-news-headers
23519 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23520 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23521 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23522@end lisp
23523
23524
23525@node Smileys
23526@subsection Smileys
23527@cindex smileys
23528
23529@iftex
23530@iflatex
23531\gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23532\input{smiley}
23533@end iflatex
23534@end iftex
23535
23536@dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23537currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23538
23539In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23540@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23541
23542@lisp
23543(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23544@end lisp
23545
23546Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23547the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23548faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23549text and maps that to file names.
23550
23551@vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23552The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23553variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23554the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23555the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23556displayed.
23557
9b3ebcb6 23558The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
4009494e
GM
23559
23560@table @code
23561
9b3ebcb6
MB
23562@item smiley-style
23563@vindex smiley-style
23564Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23565@code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23566(more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23567images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23568face.
23569
4009494e
GM
23570@item smiley-data-directory
23571@vindex smiley-data-directory
9b3ebcb6
MB
23572Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23573variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
4009494e
GM
23574
23575@item gnus-smiley-file-types
23576@vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23577List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23578
23579@end table
23580
23581
23582@node Picons
23583@subsection Picons
23584
23585@iftex
23586@iflatex
23587\include{picons}
23588@end iflatex
23589@end iftex
23590
23591So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23592good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23593over your shoulder as you read news.
23594
23595What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23596
23597@iftex
23598@iflatex
23599\margindex{}
23600@end iflatex
23601@end iftex
23602
23603@quotation
23604@dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23605constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23606organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23607e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23608databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23609in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23610@code{GIF} formats.
23611@end quotation
23612
23613@vindex gnus-picon-databases
23614For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23615point your Web browser at
23616@uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23617
23618If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23619picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23620
23621To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23622@code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23623Picons databases.
23624
01c52d31
MB
23625@vindex gnus-picon-style
23626The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23627If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23628@code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23629
89b163db
G
23630@vindex gnus-picon-properties
23631The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23632properties applied to picons.
23633
4009494e
GM
23634The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23635
23636@table @code
23637
23638@item gnus-picon-databases
23639@vindex gnus-picon-databases
23640The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23641containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23642subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23643"/usr/local/faces")}.
23644
23645@item gnus-picon-news-directories
23646@vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23647List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23648newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23649
23650@item gnus-picon-user-directories
23651@vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23652List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23653faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23654
23655@item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23656@vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23657List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23658domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23659want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23660
23661@item gnus-picon-file-types
23662@vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23663Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23664@code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23665
4478e074
G
23666@item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23667@vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23668If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23669things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23670interesting.
23671
4009494e
GM
23672@end table
23673
61b1af82
G
23674@node Gravatars
23675@subsection Gravatars
23676
23677@iftex
23678@iflatex
23679\include{gravatars}
23680@end iflatex
23681@end iftex
23682
23683A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23684
23685You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23686
23687The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23688
23689@table @code
23690
23691@item gnus-gravatar-size
23692@vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23693The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23694number for the size is enough.
23695
229b59da
G
23696@item gnus-gravatar-properties
23697@vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23698List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
61b1af82 23699
fcf2d385
KY
23700@item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23701@vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23702Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23703should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23704@code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23705
61b1af82
G
23706@end table
23707
23708If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23709@lisp
23710(setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23711@end lisp
23712
23713If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23714
23715@lisp
23716(setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23717@end lisp
23718
4009494e
GM
23719
23720@node XVarious
23721@subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23722
23723@table @code
23724@item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23725@vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23726This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23727auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23728unusual directory structure.
23729
23730@item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23731@vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23732A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23733default.
23734
23735@end table
23736
23737@subsubsection Toolbar
23738
23739@table @code
23740
23741@item gnus-use-toolbar
23742@vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23743This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23744@code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23745be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23746@code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23747toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23748names show. The default is @code{default}.
23749
23750@item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23751@vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23752Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23753The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23754the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23755The default is that of the default toolbar.
23756
23757@item gnus-group-toolbar
23758@vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23759The toolbar in the group buffer.
23760
23761@item gnus-summary-toolbar
23762@vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23763The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23764
23765@item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23766@vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23767The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23768
23769@end table
23770
23771@iftex
23772@iflatex
23773\margindex{}
23774@end iflatex
23775@end iftex
23776
23777
23778@node Fuzzy Matching
23779@section Fuzzy Matching
23780@cindex fuzzy matching
23781
23782Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23783things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23784
23785As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23786It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23787means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23788
23789Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23790@samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23791out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23792adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23793manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23794
23795
23796@node Thwarting Email Spam
23797@section Thwarting Email Spam
23798@cindex email spam
23799@cindex spam
23800@cindex UCE
23801@cindex unsolicited commercial email
23802
23803In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23804and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23805foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23806people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23807lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23808people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23809well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23810perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23811in the end.
23812
23813The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23814false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23815have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23816mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23817(``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23818and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23819
23820This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23821
23822@menu
23823* The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23824* Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23825* SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23826* Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23827@end menu
23828
23829@node The problem of spam
23830@subsection The problem of spam
23831@cindex email spam
23832@cindex spam filtering approaches
23833@cindex filtering approaches, spam
23834@cindex UCE
23835@cindex unsolicited commercial email
23836
23837First, some background on spam.
23838
23839If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23840termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23841exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23842so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23843make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23844common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23845further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23846but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23847@emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23848
23849Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23850dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23851example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23852unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23853their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23854of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23855be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23856through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23857requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23858and processing.
23859
23860The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23861server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23862messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23863@samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23864discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23865lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23866from Bulgarian IPs.
23867
23868This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23869risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
65e7ca35 23870etc.)@: or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.)@: from contacting
4009494e
GM
23871you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23872
23873In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23874been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23875words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23876cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23877
23878Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23879processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23880@var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23881Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23882@var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23883database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23884of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23885of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23886spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23887
23888Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23889a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23890fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23891spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23892well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23893sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23894down for some time because of the incident.
23895
23896The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23897based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23898the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23899words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23900analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23901classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23902run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23903to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23904server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23905user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23906the server that it has misclassified mail.
23907
23908Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23909magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23910Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23911because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23912are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23913idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23914a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23915spam plague.
23916
23917@node Anti-Spam Basics
23918@subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23919@cindex email spam
23920@cindex spam
23921@cindex UCE
23922@cindex unsolicited commercial email
23923
23924One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23925@samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23926
23927First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23928put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23929chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23930@samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23931sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23932part of the mail address.)
23933
23934@lisp
23935(setq message-default-news-headers
23936 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23937@end lisp
23938
23939Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23940(@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23941
23942@lisp
23943(...
23944 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23945 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23946 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23947 "spam"))
23948 ...)
23949@end lisp
23950
23951This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23952@code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23953header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23954(This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23955
23956In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23957and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23958header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23959thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23960put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23961your fancy split rule in this way:
23962
23963@lisp
23964(
23965 ...
23966 (to "larsi" "misc")
23967 "spam")
23968@end lisp
23969
23970In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23971group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23972check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23973citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23974each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23975
23976This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23977just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23978spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23979to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23980
23981Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23982
23983
23984@node SpamAssassin
23985@subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23986@cindex SpamAssassin
23987@cindex Vipul's Razor
23988@cindex DCC
23989
23990The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23991avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23992that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23993easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23994fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23995though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23996easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23997
23998Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23999which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
24000the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
24001recipes.
24002
24003If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
24004need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
24005@code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
24006Specifiers}) follow.
24007
24008@lisp
24009(setq mail-sources
24010 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
24011 (pop :user "jrl"
24012 :server "pophost"
24013 :postscript
24014 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
24015@end lisp
24016
24017Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
1df7defd 24018the mail contain, e.g., a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
4009494e
GM
24019filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
24020
24021@lisp
24022(setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
24023 ...))
24024@end lisp
24025
24026Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
24027
24028@lisp
24029(setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
24030 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
24031 ...))
24032@end lisp
24033
24034Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
24035programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
24036might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
24037call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
24038
24039@lisp
24040(setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
24041 ...))
24042(defun kevin-spamassassin ()
24043 (save-excursion
24044 (save-restriction
24045 (widen)
24046 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
24047 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
24048 "spam"))))
24049@end lisp
24050
01c52d31 24051Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
4009494e
GM
24052downloaded by default. You need to set
24053@code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
229b59da 24054(@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
4009494e
GM
24055
24056That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
24057might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
24058spam. And here is the nifty function:
24059
24060@lisp
d62672f3 24061(defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
4009494e
GM
24062 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
24063 (interactive)
d62672f3 24064 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
4009494e
GM
24065 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
24066@end lisp
24067
24068@node Hashcash
24069@subsection Hashcash
24070@cindex hashcash
24071
24072A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
01c52d31
MB
24073costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
24074the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
24075using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24076but it may be useful in smaller communities.
4009494e
GM
24077
24078While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24079work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24080new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24081will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24082to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24083instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24084scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24085The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24086often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24087one of them separately.
24088
24089@cindex X-Hashcash
24090The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24091compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
01c52d31
MB
24092resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24093For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24094need to install to use this feature, see
24095@uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24096at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
4009494e 24097
01c52d31
MB
24098If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24099customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24100Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
4009494e
GM
24101
24102@lisp
01c52d31 24103(setq message-generate-hashcash t)
4009494e
GM
24104@end lisp
24105
4009494e
GM
24106You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24107
24108@table @code
24109
24110@item hashcash-default-payment
24111@vindex hashcash-default-payment
24112This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
01c52d31
MB
24113should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24114include 17 to 29.
4009494e
GM
24115
24116@item hashcash-payment-alist
24117@vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24118Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24119default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24120@var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24121or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24122that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24123@var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24124(normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24125
01c52d31
MB
24126@item hashcash-path
24127@vindex hashcash-path
24128Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24129be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24130(usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24131you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24132when you generate hashcash payments.
4009494e
GM
24133
24134@end table
24135
01c52d31
MB
24136Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24137hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24138in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24139@code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24140package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24141cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24142Hashcash Payments}).
4009494e
GM
24143
24144@node Spam Package
24145@section Spam Package
24146@cindex spam filtering
24147@cindex spam
24148
24149The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24150detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24151messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24152name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24153
24154@menu
24155* Spam Package Introduction::
24156* Filtering Incoming Mail::
24157* Detecting Spam in Groups::
24158* Spam and Ham Processors::
24159* Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24160* Spam Back Ends::
24161* Extending the Spam package::
24162* Spam Statistics Package::
24163@end menu
24164
24165@node Spam Package Introduction
24166@subsection Spam Package Introduction
24167@cindex spam filtering
24168@cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24169@cindex spam
24170
24171You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24172Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24173
01c52d31
MB
24174Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24175events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24176
4009494e
GM
24177@cindex spam-initialize
24178@vindex spam-use-stat
24179To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24180@code{spam-initialize}:
24181
24182@example
24183(spam-initialize)
24184@end example
24185
24186This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24187to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24188package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24189which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24190Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24191
24192There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24193of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24194
24195Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24196incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24197
24198The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24199suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24200new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24201incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24202``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24203
24204The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24205no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24206splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24207the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24208Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24209Groups}.
24210
24211@cindex spam back ends
24212In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24213to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24214ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24215``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24216forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24217
24218In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24219always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24220
24221The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24222groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24223the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24224using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24225Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24226spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24227into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24228
24229Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24230second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24231point, the Spam package does several things:
24232
24233First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24234according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24235and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24236processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24237spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24238the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24239to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24240group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24241Ham Processors}.
24242
24243If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24244yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24245group:
24246
24247@table @kbd
f7aa248a
G
24248@item $
24249@itemx M-d
4009494e
GM
24250@itemx M s x
24251@itemx S x
f7aa248a
G
24252@kindex $ (Summary)
24253@kindex M-d (Summary)
24254@kindex S x (Summary)
24255@kindex M s x (Summary)
4009494e
GM
24256@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24257@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24258Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24259(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24260@end table
24261
24262@noindent
24263Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24264as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24265
24266Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24267ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24268further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24269to be processed as ham by setting
24270@code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24271@code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24272
24273@vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24274@vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24275The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24276to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24277groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24278variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24279@code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24280group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24281or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24282variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24283If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24284as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24285
24286If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24287you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24288want each article to be processed only once, load the
24289@code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24290@code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24291Configuration Examples}.
24292
24293Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24294However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24295@code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24296the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24297
24298The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24299expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24300
24301If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24302as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
2430350 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24304
24305@node Filtering Incoming Mail
24306@subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24307@cindex spam filtering
24308@cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24309@cindex spam
24310
24311To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24312fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24313defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24314split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24315@code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24316
24317@example
24318(: spam-split)
24319@end example
24320
24321@vindex spam-split-group
24322@noindent
24323The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24324chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24325spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24326but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24327sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24328name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24329the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24330@samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24331@samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24332
24333@code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24334
24335@vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24336Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24337@code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
8ccbef23
G
24338you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24339@code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24340the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24341the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24342retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24343because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24344appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
229b59da 24345IMAP Splitting}.
4009494e
GM
24346
24347You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24348to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24349Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24350you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24351use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24352@code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24353ends, and the following split rule:
24354
24355@example
24356 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24357 (any "ding" "ding")
24358 (: spam-split)
24359 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24360 "mail")
24361@end example
24362
24363@noindent
24364The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24365folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24366SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24367sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24368list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24369of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24370
24371The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24372perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24373invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24374done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24375
24376@example
24377nnimap-split-fancy
24378 '(|
24379 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24380 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24381 (any "ding" "ding")
24382 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24383 (: spam-split)
24384 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24385 "mail")
24386@end example
24387
24388@noindent
24389This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24390your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24391particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24392spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24393mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24394blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24395spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24396
24397You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24398ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24399@file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24400@code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24401
24402@c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24403@c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24404@c don't.}
24405
24406@node Detecting Spam in Groups
24407@subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24408
24409To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24410@code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24411parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24412usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24413
24414You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24415ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24416@file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24417@code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24418
24419By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24420force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24421variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24422
24423If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24424can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24425For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24426the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24427@code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24428enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24429over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24430
24431@node Spam and Ham Processors
24432@subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24433@cindex spam filtering
24434@cindex spam filtering variables
24435@cindex spam variables
24436@cindex spam
24437
24438@vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24439Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24440a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24441processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24442processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24443ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24444package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24445
24446The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24447the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24448parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24449@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24450
24451@vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24452Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24453one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24454@code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24455groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24456@code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24457by customizing the corresponding variable
24458@code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24459parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24460also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24461classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24462groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24463@code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24464considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24465default.
24466
24467@vindex gnus-spam-mark
24468@cindex $
24469In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24470they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24471group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24472unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24473thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24474will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24475@code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24476should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24477buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24478@samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24479@kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24480group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24481processor which will study them as spam samples.
24482
24483Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24484@code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24485and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24486@samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24487low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24488are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24489use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24490should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24491
24492@defvar ham-marks
24493You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24494marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24495deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24496that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24497useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24498recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24499indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24500happy for you.
24501@end defvar
24502
24503@defvar spam-marks
24504You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24505marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24506the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24507you really want to.
24508@end defvar
24509
24510When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24511@code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24512to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24513explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24514@samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24515spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24516and nothing else.
24517
24518@vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24519When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24520marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24521not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24522@strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24523determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24524parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24525variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24526names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24527customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24528group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24529the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24530parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24531@code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24532set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24533
01c52d31 24534If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
4009494e
GM
24535@acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24536
24537Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24538expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24539group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24540
24541When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24542a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24543
24544@vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24545By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24546@code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24547to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24548to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24549
24550@vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24551By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24552@code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24553or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24554you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24555it there.
24556
24557@vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24558When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24559@strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24560the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24561@code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24562regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24563customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24564gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24565Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24566@code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24567articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24568that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24569group buffer then you need it here as well.
24570
01c52d31 24571If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
4009494e
GM
24572@acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24573
24574Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24575expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24576training} groups.
24577
24578@vindex spam-log-to-registry
24579The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24580this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24581variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24582what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24583multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24584entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24585
24586@vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24587Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24588be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24589@code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24590
24591@vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24592Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24593out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24594like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24595in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24596from the mail server.
24597
24598@vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24599When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24600only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24601spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24602
24603@node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24604@subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24605@cindex spam filtering
24606@cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24607@cindex spam configuration examples
24608@cindex spam
24609
24610@subsubheading Ted's setup
24611
24612From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24613@example
24614;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24615;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24616(gnus-registry-initialize)
24617(spam-initialize)
24618
24619(setq
24620 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24621 spam-use-BBDB t
24622 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24623 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24624 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24625 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24626 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24627 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24628 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24629 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
4009494e 24630 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
6b958814 24631 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
4009494e
GM
24632 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24633 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24634 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24635 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24636 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24637 (any "ding" "ding")
24638 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24639 (: spam-split)
24640 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24641 "mail"))
24642
24643;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24644
24645;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24646;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24647;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24648;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24649
24650((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24651
24652;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24653;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24654((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24655;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24656 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24657
24658;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24659((spam-autodetect . t))
24660
24661;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24662
24663;; @r{this is a spam group}
24664((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24665
24666 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24667 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24668 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24669
24670 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24671
24672 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24673 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24674
24675 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24676 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24677 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24678 (ham-marks
24679 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24680 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24681 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24682 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24683
24684;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24685;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24686;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24687
24688@end example
24689
01c52d31 24690@subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
4009494e
GM
24691From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24692
24693My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24694the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24695@samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
1df7defd 24696i.e., to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
4009494e
GM
24697positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24698@samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24699the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24700options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24701@samp{training.spam} folders.
24702
24703With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24704does most of the job for me:
24705
24706@lisp
24707 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24708 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24709 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24710 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24711 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24712 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24713 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24714@end lisp
24715
24716@itemize
24717
24718@item @b{The Spam folder:}
24719
24720In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
1df7defd 24721(i.e., legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
4009494e
GM
24722bogofilter or DCC).
24723
24724Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24725messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24726positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24727(@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24728those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24729to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24730and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24731
24732The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24733false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
1df7defd 24734have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e., chars) makes finding
4009494e
GM
24735other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24736(@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24737an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24738
24739@item @b{Ham folders:}
24740
24741In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24742(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24743mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
01c52d31 24744@samp{training.spam}.
4009494e
GM
24745@end itemize
24746
24747@subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24748
24749From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24750
24751With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24752(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24753groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24754
24755@lisp
24756 ("^gmane\\."
24757 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24758@end lisp
24759
24760Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24761because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
1df7defd 24762through my local news server (leafnode). I.e., the article numbers are
4009494e
GM
24763not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24764the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24765
24766@node Spam Back Ends
24767@subsection Spam Back Ends
24768@cindex spam back ends
24769
24770The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24771Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24772(@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24773and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24774Processors}).
24775
24776@menu
24777* Blacklists and Whitelists::
24778* BBDB Whitelists::
24779* Gmane Spam Reporting::
24780* Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24781* Blackholes::
24782* Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24783* Bogofilter::
01c52d31 24784* SpamAssassin back end::
4009494e
GM
24785* ifile spam filtering::
24786* Spam Statistics Filtering::
24787* SpamOracle::
24788@end menu
24789
24790@node Blacklists and Whitelists
24791@subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24792@cindex spam filtering
24793@cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24794@cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24795@cindex spam
24796
24797@defvar spam-use-blacklist
24798
24799Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24800splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24801will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24802filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24803be spammers.
24804
24805@end defvar
24806
24807@defvar spam-use-whitelist
24808
24809Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24810splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24811whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24812explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24813messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24814
24815@end defvar
24816
24817@defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24818
24819Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24820implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24821unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24822
24823@end defvar
24824
24825@defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24826
24827Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24828customizing the group parameters or the
24829@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24830added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24831spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24832
24833@emph{WARNING}
24834
24835Instead of the obsolete
24836@code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
01c52d31 24837that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
24838the same way, we promise.
24839
24840@end defvar
24841
24842@defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24843
24844Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24845customizing the group parameters or the
24846@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24847added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24848ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
01c52d31 24849whitelist.
4009494e
GM
24850
24851@emph{WARNING}
24852
24853Instead of the obsolete
24854@code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
01c52d31 24855that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
24856the same way, we promise.
24857
24858@end defvar
24859
24860Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24861consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24862sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24863blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24864use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24865
24866Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24867legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24868non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24869Emacs regular expression syntax.
24870
24871The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24872@code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24873the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24874directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24875@code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24876@file{blacklist} respectively.
24877
24878@node BBDB Whitelists
24879@subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24880@cindex spam filtering
24881@cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24882@cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24883@cindex spam
24884
24885@defvar spam-use-BBDB
24886
24887Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24888Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24889addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24890for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24891not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24892explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24893messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24894
24895@end defvar
24896
24897@defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24898
24899Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24900implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
1df7defd 24901unless the sender is in the BBDB@. Use with care. Only sender
4009494e
GM
24902addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24903classified as spammers.
24904
01c52d31
MB
24905While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24906for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24907@emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24908@code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24909will be exclusive.
24910
4009494e
GM
24911@end defvar
24912
24913@defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24914
24915Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24916customizing the group parameters or the
24917@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24918added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24919ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
01c52d31 24920BBDB.
4009494e
GM
24921
24922@emph{WARNING}
24923
24924Instead of the obsolete
24925@code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
01c52d31 24926that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
24927the same way, we promise.
24928
24929@end defvar
24930
24931@node Gmane Spam Reporting
24932@subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24933@cindex spam reporting
24934@cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24935@cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24936@cindex spam
24937
24938@defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24939
24940Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24941customizing the group parameters or the
24942@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24943added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24944articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24945HTTP request.
24946
24947Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24948
24949@emph{WARNING}
24950
24951Instead of the obsolete
24952@code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
01c52d31 24953that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
4009494e
GM
24954same way, we promise.
24955
24956@end defvar
24957
24958@defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24959
24960This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24961running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24962numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24963@code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
01c52d31
MB
24964@code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24965
24966@end defvar
24967
24968@defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24969
24970Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24971the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24972default is @code{user-mail-address}.
4009494e
GM
24973
24974@end defvar
24975
24976@node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24977@subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24978@cindex spam filtering
24979@cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24980@cindex spam
24981
24982@defvar spam-use-hashcash
24983
24984Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24985Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
01c52d31
MB
24986instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
24987token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
24988filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
24989are not assumed to be spam or ham.
4009494e
GM
24990
24991@end defvar
24992
24993@node Blackholes
24994@subsubsection Blackholes
24995@cindex spam filtering
24996@cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24997@cindex spam
24998
24999@defvar spam-use-blackholes
25000
25001This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
25002blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
25003when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
25004holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
25005list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
25006contains outdated servers.
25007
25008The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
01c52d31 25009@code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
4009494e
GM
25010you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
25011this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
25012possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
25013use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
25014
25015@end defvar
25016
25017@defvar spam-blackhole-servers
25018
25019The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
25020
25021@end defvar
25022
25023@defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
25024
25025A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
25026blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
25027
25028@end defvar
25029
25030@defvar spam-use-dig
25031
25032Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
25033The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
25034
25035@end defvar
25036
25037Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
25038ham processor for blackholes.
25039
25040@node Regular Expressions Header Matching
25041@subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
25042@cindex spam filtering
25043@cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
25044@cindex spam
25045
25046@defvar spam-use-regex-headers
25047
25048This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
25049message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
25050option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
25051@code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
25052Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
25053message is spam or ham, respectively.
25054
25055@end defvar
25056
25057@defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
25058
25059The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25060the message, positively identify it as spam.
25061
25062@end defvar
25063
25064@defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
25065
25066The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25067the message, positively identify it as ham.
25068
25069@end defvar
25070
25071Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
25072There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
25073
25074@node Bogofilter
25075@subsubsection Bogofilter
25076@cindex spam filtering
25077@cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25078@cindex spam
25079
25080@defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25081
25082Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25083speedy Bogofilter.
25084
25085With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25086articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25087should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25088category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25089for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25090the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25091
25092Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25093threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25094documentation.
25095
25096If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25097processing will be turned off.
25098
25099You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25100
25101@end defvar
25102
25103@table @kbd
25104@item M s t
25105@itemx S t
25106@kindex M s t
25107@kindex S t
25108@findex spam-bogofilter-score
25109Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25110@end table
25111
25112@defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25113
25114Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25115speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25116similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25117must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25118procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25119installation documents for details.
25120
25121You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25122
25123@end defvar
25124
25125@defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25126Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25127customizing the group parameters or the
25128@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25129added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25130will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25131
25132@emph{WARNING}
25133
25134Instead of the obsolete
25135@code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25136that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25137the same way, we promise.
25138@end defvar
25139
25140@defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25141Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25142customizing the group parameters or the
25143@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25144added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25145articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
01c52d31 25146of non-spam messages.
4009494e
GM
25147
25148@emph{WARNING}
25149
25150Instead of the obsolete
25151@code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25152that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25153the same way, we promise.
25154@end defvar
25155
25156@defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25157
25158This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25159is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25160database directory.
25161
25162@end defvar
25163
25164The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25165purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25166@code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25167variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25168used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25169Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25170
01c52d31
MB
25171@node SpamAssassin back end
25172@subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25173@cindex spam filtering
25174@cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25175@cindex spam
25176
25177@defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25178
25179Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25180
25181SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25182and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25183trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25184spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25185mode.
25186
25187If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25188SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25189preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25190SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25191instead.
25192
25193You should not enable this if you use
25194@code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25195
25196@end defvar
25197
25198@defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25199
25200Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25201want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25202
25203You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25204
25205@end defvar
25206
25207@defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25208
25209This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25210@code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25211executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25212for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25213
25214@end defvar
25215
25216SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25217variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25218provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25219@code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25220spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25221been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25222to test this functionality.
25223
4009494e
GM
25224@node ifile spam filtering
25225@subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25226@cindex spam filtering
25227@cindex ifile, spam filtering
25228@cindex spam
25229
25230@defvar spam-use-ifile
25231
25232Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25233statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25234
25235@end defvar
25236
25237@defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25238
25239Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25240the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25241sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25242
25243@end defvar
25244
25245@defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25246
25247This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25248The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25249the default value of @samp{spam}.
25250@end defvar
25251
25252@defvar spam-ifile-database
25253
25254This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25255default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25256
25257@end defvar
25258
25259The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25260purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25261@code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25262should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25263functionality.
25264
25265@node Spam Statistics Filtering
25266@subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25267@cindex spam filtering
25268@cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25269@cindex spam-stat
25270@cindex spam
25271
25272This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25273statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25274using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25275initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25276spam-stat dictionary}.
25277
25278@defvar spam-use-stat
25279
25280@end defvar
25281
25282@defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25283Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25284customizing the group parameters or the
25285@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25286added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25287articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25288
25289@emph{WARNING}
25290
25291Instead of the obsolete
25292@code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25293that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25294the same way, we promise.
25295@end defvar
25296
25297@defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25298Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25299customizing the group parameters or the
25300@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25301added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25302articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
01c52d31 25303of non-spam messages.
4009494e
GM
25304
25305@emph{WARNING}
25306
25307Instead of the obsolete
25308@code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25309that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25310the same way, we promise.
25311@end defvar
25312
01c52d31 25313This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
4009494e
GM
25314@file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25315which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25316A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25317@code{spam-split} are provided.
25318
25319@node SpamOracle
25320@subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25321@cindex spam filtering
25322@cindex SpamOracle
25323@cindex spam
25324
25325An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25326statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25327installed separately.
25328
25329There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25330mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25331then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25332mail as a spam mail or not.
25333
25334One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25335@xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25336the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25337
25338The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25339call SpamOracle.
25340
25341@vindex spam-use-spamoracle
01c52d31 25342To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
4009494e
GM
25343@code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25344@code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25345Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25346filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25347moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25348messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25349
25350@example
25351(setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25352 spam-split-group "Junk"
6b958814 25353 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
4009494e 25354 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
4009494e
GM
25355 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25356@end example
25357
25358@defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25359Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25360SpamOracle.
25361@end defvar
25362
25363@defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25364Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
1df7defd 25365user's PATH@. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
4009494e
GM
25366can be customized.
25367@end defvar
25368
25369@defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25370By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25371store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25372@code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25373the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25374database to live somewhere special, set
25375@code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25376@end defvar
25377
25378SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25379message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25380false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25381the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25382(training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25383SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25384buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25385@file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25386convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25387@xref{Spam Package}.
25388
25389@defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25390Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25391customizing the group parameter or the
25392@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25393to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25394sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25395
25396@emph{WARNING}
25397
25398Instead of the obsolete
25399@code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25400that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25401the same way, we promise.
25402@end defvar
25403
25404@defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25405Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25406customizing the group parameter or the
25407@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25408to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25409@emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
01c52d31 25410messages.
4009494e
GM
25411
25412@emph{WARNING}
25413
25414Instead of the obsolete
25415@code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25416that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25417the same way, we promise.
25418@end defvar
25419
25420@emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25421classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25422messages.
25423@example
25424 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25425 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25426 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25427@end example
25428For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25429ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
1df7defd 25430(e.g., because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
4009494e
GM
25431the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25432processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25433SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25434
25435@node Extending the Spam package
25436@subsection Extending the Spam package
25437@cindex spam filtering
25438@cindex spam elisp package, extending
25439@cindex extending the spam elisp package
25440
25441Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25442incoming mail, provide the following:
25443
25444@enumerate
25445
25446@item
25447Code
25448
25449@lisp
25450(defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25451 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25452@end lisp
25453
01c52d31 25454Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
4009494e 25455
01c52d31
MB
25456Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25457@code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
40ba43b4 25458register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
01c52d31
MB
25459routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25460register/unregister spam and ham.
4009494e
GM
25461
25462@item
25463Functionality
25464
01c52d31
MB
25465The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25466@code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25467existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25468do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25469why you aren't.
4009494e
GM
25470
25471@end enumerate
25472
25473For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25474
25475@enumerate
25476
25477@item
25478Code
25479
25480Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25481provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25482
25483Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
01c52d31
MB
25484variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25485@code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
4009494e
GM
25486processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25487
25488@lisp
25489(defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25490 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25491Only applicable to spam groups.")
25492
25493(defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25494 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25495Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25496
25497@end lisp
25498
25499@item
25500Gnus parameters
25501
25502Add
25503@lisp
25504(const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25505(const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25506@end lisp
25507to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25508sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25509variable customization.
25510
25511Add
25512@lisp
25513(variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25514@end lisp
25515to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
01c52d31
MB
25516@code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25517
25518Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25519@code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25520
25521
25522@enumerate
25523
25524@item
25525@code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25526
25527This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25528everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25529make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25530
25531@item
25532@code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25533
25534This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25535register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25536such a back end.
25537
25538@item
25539@code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25540
25541This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25542for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25543@code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25544back ends.
25545
25546@item
25547@code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25548
25549This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25550full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25551for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25552
25553@item
25554@code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25555
25556This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25557registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25558set up this way.
25559
25560@item
25561@code{spam-install-backend}
25562
25563This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25564check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25565abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25566
25567@item
25568@code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25569
25570Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25571articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25572never install such a back end.
25573@end enumerate
4009494e
GM
25574
25575@end enumerate
25576
25577@node Spam Statistics Package
25578@subsection Spam Statistics Package
25579@cindex Paul Graham
25580@cindex Graham, Paul
25581@cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25582@cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25583@cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25584
25585Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25586statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25587Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25588filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25589the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25590always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25591on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25592this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25593that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25594or not.
25595
25596The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25597with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25598either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25599collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25600word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25601non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25602probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25603than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25604
25605The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25606filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25607(@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25608
25609Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25610First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25611non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25612collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25613this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25614
25615@menu
25616* Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25617* Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25618* Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25619@end menu
25620
25621@node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25622@subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25623
25624Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25625create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25626one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25627for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25628need several hundred emails in both collections.
25629
25630Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25631creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25632per mail. Use the following:
25633
25634@defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25635Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25636is treated as one spam mail.
25637@end defun
25638
25639@defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25640Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25641file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25642@end defun
25643
25644Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25645directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25646the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25647@code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25648@file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25649@samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25650
25651When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25652locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25653to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25654@file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25655@code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25656
25657@defvar spam-stat
25658This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25659dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25660collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25661word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25662@end defvar
25663
25664If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25665reset the dictionary.
25666
25667@defun spam-stat-reset
25668Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25669@end defun
25670
25671When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25672be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25673(instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25674can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25675not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25676only non-spam mails.
25677
25678@defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25679Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25680to update the dictionary incrementally.
25681@end defun
25682
25683@defun spam-stat-save
25684Save the dictionary.
25685@end defun
25686
25687@defvar spam-stat-file
25688The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25689@file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25690@end defvar
25691
25692@node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25693@subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25694
25695This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25696@emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25697
25698First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25699
25700@lisp
25701(require 'spam-stat)
25702(spam-stat-load)
25703@end lisp
25704
25705This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25706created.
25707
25708Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25709determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25710the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25711use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25712
25713In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25714@samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25715spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25716@code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25717
25718@lisp
25719(setq nnmail-split-fancy
25720 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25721 "mail.misc"))
25722@end lisp
25723
25724@defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25725The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25726@end defvar
25727
25728If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25729the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25730expression are considered potential spam.
25731
25732@lisp
25733(setq nnmail-split-fancy
25734 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25735 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25736 "mail.misc"))
25737@end lisp
25738
25739If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25740creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25741consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25742non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25743mails, when creating the dictionary!
25744
25745@lisp
25746(setq nnmail-split-fancy
25747 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25748 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25749 "mail.misc"))
25750@end lisp
25751
25752You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25753HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25754@code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25755@samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25756nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25757dictionary!
25758
25759@lisp
25760(setq nnmail-split-fancy
25761 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25762 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25763 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25764 "mail.misc"))
25765@end lisp
25766
25767
25768@node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25769@subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25770
25771The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25772
25773@defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25774Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25775Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25776@end defun
25777
25778@defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25779Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25780mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25781@end defun
25782
25783@defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25784Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25785mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25786already been processed as non-spam.
25787@end defun
25788
25789@defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25790Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25791normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25792been processed as spam.
25793@end defun
25794
25795@defun spam-stat-save
25796Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25797variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25798@end defun
25799
25800@defun spam-stat-load
25801Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25802variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25803@end defun
25804
25805@defun spam-stat-score-word
25806Return the spam score for a word.
25807@end defun
25808
25809@defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25810Return the spam score for a buffer.
25811@end defun
25812
25813@defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25814Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25815spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25816@end defun
25817
25818Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25819following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25820
25821@lisp
25822(require 'spam-stat)
25823(spam-stat-load)
25824@end lisp
25825
25826Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25827
25828@smallexample
25829Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25830Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25831Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25832Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25833File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25834Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25835Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25836Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25837Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25838Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25839File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25840Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25841Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25842Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25843@end smallexample
25844
25845Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25846
25847@smallexample
25848Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25849Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25850Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25851Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25852Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25853Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25854@end smallexample
25855
64763fe3
MB
25856@node The Gnus Registry
25857@section The Gnus Registry
64763fe3
MB
25858@cindex registry
25859@cindex split
25860@cindex track
25861
25862The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25863Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25864cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25865experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25866features are pretty cool.
25867
25868Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25869of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25870
25871@enumerate
e52cac88
MB
25872@item
25873Split messages to their parent
64763fe3 25874
64763fe3 25875This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
1df7defd 25876the sender in addition to the Message-ID@. Several strategies are
64763fe3
MB
25877available.
25878
36d3245f
G
25879@item
25880Refer to messages by ID
25881
25882Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25883advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25884of the group the message is in.
25885
e52cac88
MB
25886@item
25887Store custom flags and keywords
25888
64763fe3
MB
25889The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25890instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25891persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25892etc. backends.
25893
e52cac88
MB
25894@item
25895Store arbitrary data
25896
64763fe3
MB
25897Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25898message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25899of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
64763fe3
MB
25900@end enumerate
25901
64763fe3 25902@menu
627abcdd 25903* Gnus Registry Setup::
36d3245f 25904* Registry Article Refer Method::
2fce4cd8 25905* Fancy splitting to parent::
867d4bb3
JB
25906* Store custom flags and keywords::
25907* Store arbitrary data::
64763fe3
MB
25908@end menu
25909
627abcdd
TZ
25910@node Gnus Registry Setup
25911@subsection Gnus Registry Setup
64763fe3
MB
25912
25913Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25914
25915@lisp
c3c65d73 25916(setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
64763fe3
MB
25917
25918(gnus-registry-initialize)
25919@end lisp
25920
25921This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25922and when you press @kbd{s} from the @code{*Group*} buffer. It also
65e7ca35 25923adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.)@: so
64763fe3
MB
25924it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25925@code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25926
25927Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25928what they do before you copy them blindly).
25929
25930@lisp
25931(setq
25932 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25933 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25934 ("nnrss" t)
25935 ("spam" t)
25936 ("train" t))
25937 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
c3c65d73 25938 ;; this is the default
64763fe3
MB
25939 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25940@end lisp
25941
c3c65d73
TZ
25942They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25943subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25944incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25945if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25946should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25947``spam'', or ``train.''
64763fe3
MB
25948
25949You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25950user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25951the general settings.
25952
25953@defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25954The groups that will not be followed by
25955@code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25956remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
54a8f337
KY
25957By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25958``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
c3c65d73 25959the word ``archive'' is not followed.
64763fe3
MB
25960@end defvar
25961
25962@defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25963The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25964registry will keep.
25965@end defvar
25966
c3c65d73
TZ
25967@defvar gnus-registry-max-pruned-entries
25968The maximum number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries
25969the registry will keep after pruning.
25970@end defvar
25971
64763fe3 25972@defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
c3c65d73
TZ
25973The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
25974default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eioio} in the same
25975directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
64763fe3
MB
25976@end defvar
25977
36d3245f
G
25978@node Registry Article Refer Method
25979@subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
25980
25981The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
25982in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
25983the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
25984Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25985
25986@vindex nnregistry
25987@vindex gnus-refer-article-method
25988
25989The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
25990advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
25991in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
25992be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
25993lines:
25994
25995@example
25996;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
25997;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
25998;; knows where the article is.
c3c65d73 25999(setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
36d3245f
G
26000
26001(gnus-registry-initialize)
26002
26003(setq gnus-refer-article-method
26004 '(current
e08ea0f8
KY
26005 (nnregistry)
26006 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
36d3245f
G
26007@end example
26008
26009The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
26010current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
26011all else fails, using Gmane.
26012
64763fe3
MB
26013@node Fancy splitting to parent
26014@subsection Fancy splitting to parent
26015
26016Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
26017
26018Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
26019remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
26020notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
26021strategy.
26022
26023When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
26024Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
26025mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
26026have to put a rule like this:
26027
26028@lisp
26029(setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
26030
26031 ;; split to parent: you need this
26032 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
26033
26034 ;; other rules, as an example
26035 (: spam-split)
26036 ;; default mailbox
26037 "mail")
26038@end lisp
26039
26040in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
26041following variables.
26042
26043@defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
26044This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
c17b81a7
G
26045Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender recipient)},
26046which may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large
26047and people don't stick to the same groups.
26048
26049When you decide to stop tracking any of those extra data, you can use
26050the command @code{gnus-registry-remove-extra-data} to purge it from
26051the existing registry entries.
64763fe3
MB
26052@end defvar
26053
26054@defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
26055This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
26056interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
26057@code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
c3c65d73
TZ
26058the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
26059works best.
64763fe3
MB
26060@end defvar
26061
26062@node Store custom flags and keywords
26063@subsection Store custom flags and keywords
26064
26065The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
26066can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
26067shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
26068
26069@defvar gnus-registry-marks
26070The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
26071default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
26072before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
26073it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
26074want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
26075
26076By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
26077@code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
26078keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
26079letter.
26080@end defvar
26081
26082@defun gnus-registry-mark-article
26083Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
26084will offer the available marks for completion.
26085@end defun
26086
627abcdd
TZ
26087You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
26088function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
26089this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
26090their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
26091
26092@lisp
26093;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
26094;; `gnus-registry-marks'):
2da9c605 26095;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
627abcdd
TZ
26096
26097;; show the marks by name (see `gnus-registry-marks'):
2da9c605 26098;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
627abcdd
TZ
26099@end lisp
26100
26101
64763fe3
MB
26102@node Store arbitrary data
26103@subsection Store arbitrary data
26104
26105The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26106store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26107storage).
26108
c3c65d73
TZ
26109@defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26110Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
64763fe3
MB
26111@end defun
26112
c3c65d73
TZ
26113@defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26114Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
64763fe3
MB
26115@end defun
26116
26117@defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26118If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26119registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26120the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26121default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26122precious.
26123@end defvar
26124
4009494e
GM
26125@node Other modes
26126@section Interaction with other modes
26127
26128@subsection Dired
26129@cindex dired
26130
26131@code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26132buffers. It is enabled with
26133@lisp
26134(add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26135@end lisp
26136
26137@table @kbd
26138@item C-c C-m C-a
26139@findex gnus-dired-attach
26140@cindex attachments, selection via dired
26141Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26142You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26143
26144@item C-c C-m C-l
26145@findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26146Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26147(@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26148buffer.
26149
26150@item C-c C-m C-p
26151@findex gnus-dired-print
26152Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26153there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26154@end table
26155
26156@node Various Various
26157@section Various Various
26158@cindex mode lines
26159@cindex highlights
26160
26161@table @code
26162
26163@item gnus-home-directory
26164@vindex gnus-home-directory
26165All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26166variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26167
26168@item gnus-directory
26169@vindex gnus-directory
26170Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26171this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26172variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26173
26174Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26175This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26176variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26177@file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26178
26179@item gnus-default-directory
26180@vindex gnus-default-directory
26181Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26182default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26183like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26184default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26185default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26186buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26187
26188@item gnus-verbose
26189@vindex gnus-verbose
26190This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26191the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26192will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26193most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26194shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26195
26196@item gnus-verbose-backends
26197@vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26198This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26199to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26200
01c52d31
MB
26201@item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26202@vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26203This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26204controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26205are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26206timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26207that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26208@w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26209@code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26210displayed in the echo area.
26211
4009494e
GM
26212@item nnheader-max-head-length
26213@vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26214When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26215as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26216the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26217on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26218variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26219@code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26220but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26221@code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26222
26223@item nnheader-head-chop-length
26224@vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26225This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26226read when doing the operation described above.
26227
26228@item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26229@vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26230@cindex file names
26231@cindex invalid characters in file names
26232@cindex characters in file names
26233This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26234For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26235on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26236
26237@lisp
26238@group
26239(setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26240 '((?: . ?_)))
26241@end group
26242@end lisp
26243
26244In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26245Windows (phooey) systems.
26246
26247@item gnus-hidden-properties
26248@vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26249This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26250@code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26251makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26252
26253@item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26254@vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26255A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26256gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26257some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26258
26259@item gnus-shell-command-separator
26260@vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26261String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26262
26263@item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26264@vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26265
26266Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26267name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26268names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26269@samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26270group).
26271
26272@acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26273
b0b63450
MB
26274@item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26275@vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26276Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26277value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26278@code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26279value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26280renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26281set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26282emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
4009494e
GM
26283
26284@end table
26285
26286@node The End
26287@chapter The End
26288
26289Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26290touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26291
26292My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26293
26294Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26295
26296@quotation
26297@strong{Te Deum}
26298
26299@sp 1
26300Not because of victories @*
26301I sing,@*
26302having none,@*
26303but for the common sunshine,@*
26304the breeze,@*
26305the largess of the spring.
26306
26307@sp 1
26308Not for victory@*
26309but for the day's work done@*
26310as well as I was able;@*
26311not for a seat upon the dais@*
26312but at the common table.@*
26313@end quotation
26314
26315
26316@node Appendices
26317@chapter Appendices
26318
26319@menu
26320* XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26321* History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26322* On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26323* Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26324* Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26325* Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26326* Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26327* Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26328* Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26329@end menu
26330
26331
26332@node XEmacs
26333@section XEmacs
26334@cindex XEmacs
26335@cindex installing under XEmacs
26336
26337XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26338whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26339requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26340@samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26341@samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26342@samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26343
26344
26345@node History
26346@section History
26347
26348@cindex history
26349@sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26350'94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26351
26352If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26353you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26354@uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26355distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26356known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26357
26358During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26359called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26360@dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26361(Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26362pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26363appropriate name, don't you think?)
26364
26365In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26366spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26367renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26368``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26369
26370@menu
26371* Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
4009494e
GM
26372* Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26373* Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26374* Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26375* Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26376* Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26377* Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26378* New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26379@end menu
26380
26381
26382@node Gnus Versions
26383@subsection Gnus Versions
26384@cindex ding Gnus
26385@cindex September Gnus
26386@cindex Red Gnus
26387@cindex Quassia Gnus
26388@cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26389@cindex Oort Gnus
26390@cindex No Gnus
89b163db 26391@cindex Ma Gnus
4009494e
GM
26392@cindex Gnus versions
26393
26394The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26395was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26396plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26397
26398In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26399releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26400
26401On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26402January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26403
26404On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26405It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26406
26407Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26408``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
264091999.
26410
26411On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26412Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26413
26414On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26415
bff3818b
KY
26416On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26417http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26418with the information when possible).
26419
89b163db
G
26420On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26421
f99f1641
PE
26422If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name---``(ding)
26423Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26424``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus''---don't
89b163db
G
26425panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26426Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26427its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26428that instead.
4009494e
GM
26429
26430
4009494e
GM
26431@node Why?
26432@subsection Why?
26433
26434What's the point of Gnus?
26435
26436I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26437newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26438original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26439me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26440Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26441volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26442newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26443newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26444keep track of millions of people who post?
26445
26446Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26447like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26448reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26449to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26450interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26451and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26452everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26453every one of you to explore and invent.
26454
26455May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26456@kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26457
26458
26459@node Compatibility
26460@subsection Compatibility
26461
26462@cindex compatibility
26463Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26464bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26465but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26466
26467Our motto is:
26468@quotation
26469@cartouche
26470@center In a cloud bones of steel.
26471@end cartouche
26472@end quotation
26473
26474All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26475their names.
26476
26477The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26478Articles}.
26479
26480One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26481buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26482buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26483important variables have their values copied into their global
26484counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26485change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26486
26487All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26488fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26489changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26490maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26491speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26492peculiar results.
26493
26494@cindex hilit19
26495@cindex highlighting
26496Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26497remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26498(@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26499Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26500faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26501by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26502Away!
26503
26504Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26505fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26506code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26507does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26508
26509Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26510new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26511doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26512to stop doing it the old way.
26513
26514Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26515
26516@kindex M-x gnus-bug
26517@findex gnus-bug
26518@cindex reporting bugs
26519@cindex bugs
26520Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26521@sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26522please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26523
26524@vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26525If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26526may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26527@code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26528up at you.
26529
26530
26531@node Conformity
26532@subsection Conformity
26533
26534No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26535to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26536with, of course.
26537
26538@table @strong
26539
26540@item RFC (2)822
26541@cindex RFC 822
26542@cindex RFC 2822
26543There are no known breaches of this standard.
26544
26545@item RFC 1036
26546@cindex RFC 1036
26547There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26548
26549@item Son-of-RFC 1036
26550@cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26551We do have some breaches to this one.
26552
26553@table @emph
26554
26555@item X-Newsreader
26556@itemx User-Agent
26557These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26558to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26559articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26560either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26561it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26562@end table
26563
26564@item USEFOR
26565@cindex USEFOR
26566USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26567on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26568various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26569look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26570
f99f1641 26571@item MIME---RFC 2045--2049 etc
4009494e
GM
26572@cindex @acronym{MIME}
26573All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26574
f99f1641 26575@item Disposition Notifications---RFC 2298
4009494e
GM
26576Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26577
f99f1641 26578@item PGP---RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
4009494e
GM
26579@cindex RFC 1991
26580@cindex RFC 2440
26581RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
1df7defd 26582published as an informational RFC@. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
4009494e
GM
26583called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26584non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26585encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26586decryption).
26587
f99f1641 26588@item PGP/MIME---RFC 2015/3156
4009494e
GM
26589RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
265901991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26591Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26592
f99f1641 26593@item S/MIME---RFC 2633
4009494e
GM
26594RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26595
f99f1641 26596@item IMAP---RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
4009494e
GM
26597RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26598(@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26599authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26600lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26601protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26602integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26603GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26604
26605@end table
26606
26607If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26608mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26609know.
26610
26611
26612@node Emacsen
26613@subsection Emacsen
26614@cindex Emacsen
26615@cindex XEmacs
26616@cindex Mule
26617@cindex Emacs
26618
d55fe5bb 26619This version of Gnus should work on:
4009494e
GM
26620
26621@itemize @bullet
26622
26623@item
6ed7a66a 26624Emacs 23.1 and up.
4009494e
GM
26625
26626@item
26627XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26628
26629@end itemize
26630
26631This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26632that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26633Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
2663420.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26635
d55fe5bb
MB
26636@c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26637@c synced here!
4009494e
GM
26638
26639@node Gnus Development
26640@subsection Gnus Development
26641
26642Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
9b3ebcb6 26643discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
4009494e
GM
26644propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26645phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26646phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26647circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26648unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
9b3ebcb6 26649have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
4009494e 26650
f99f1641 26651After futzing around for 10--100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
4009494e 26652@dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
9b3ebcb6 26653and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
4009494e 26654supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
9b3ebcb6
MB
26655@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26656mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26657as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26658in Emacs.
4009494e
GM
26659
26660@cindex Incoming*
26661@vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
37a68866
MB
26662Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26663in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
4009494e 26664lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
37a68866 26665@xref{Mail Source Customization}.
4009494e
GM
26666
26667The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26668newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26669having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26670can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26671importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26672introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26673introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26674either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26675usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26676can't be assumed to do so.
26677
9b3ebcb6
MB
26678So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26679direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26680is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
4009494e 26681
9b3ebcb6
MB
26682@cindex Incoming*
26683@vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26684Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26685in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26686lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26687@xref{Mail Source Customization}.
4009494e
GM
26688
26689@node Contributors
26690@subsection Contributors
26691@cindex contributors
26692
26693The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26694people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26695gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26696every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26697tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26698type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26699work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26700off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26701Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26702``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26703
26704I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26705wrong show.
26706
26707@itemize @bullet
26708
26709@item
26710Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26711
26712@item
6b958814 26713Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
4009494e
GM
26714nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26715other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26716functionality and stuff.
26717
26718@item
26719Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26720well as numerous other things).
26721
26722@item
26723Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26724
26725@item
26726Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26727
26728@item
26729Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26730
26731@item
26732Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26733
26734@item
26735Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26736@dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26737
26738@item
26739Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26740
26741@item
01c52d31 26742Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
4009494e
GM
26743
26744@item
26745Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26746
26747@item
26748Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26749
26750@item
4c36be58 26751Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
4009494e
GM
26752
26753@item
26754Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26755
26756@item
26757Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26758distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26759
26760@item
26761Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26762
26763@item
26764Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26765
26766@item
26767Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26768
26769@item
26770Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26771.newsrc files.
26772
26773@item
26774Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26775
26776@item
26777David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26778
26779@item
26780Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26781
26782@item
01c52d31 26783Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
4009494e
GM
26784well as autoconf support.
26785
26786@end itemize
26787
26788This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26789Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26790
26791The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26792
26793Christopher Davis,
26794Andrew Eskilsson,
26795Kai Grossjohann,
26796Kevin Greiner,
26797Jesper Harder,
26798Paul Jarc,
26799Simon Josefsson,
01c52d31 26800David K@aa{}gedal,
4009494e
GM
26801Richard Pieri,
26802Fabrice Popineau,
26803Daniel Quinlan,
26804Michael Shields,
26805Reiner Steib,
26806Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26807Jack Vinson,
26808Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26809and
26810Teodor Zlatanov.
26811
26812Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26813
26814Jari Aalto,
26815Adrian Aichner,
26816Vladimir Alexiev,
26817Russ Allbery,
26818Peter Arius,
26819Matt Armstrong,
26820Marc Auslander,
26821Miles Bader,
26822Alexei V. Barantsev,
26823Frank Bennett,
26824Robert Bihlmeyer,
26825Chris Bone,
26826Mark Borges,
26827Mark Boyns,
26828Lance A. Brown,
26829Rob Browning,
26830Kees de Bruin,
26831Martin Buchholz,
26832Joe Buehler,
26833Kevin Buhr,
26834Alastair Burt,
26835Joao Cachopo,
26836Zlatko Calusic,
26837Massimo Campostrini,
26838Castor,
26839David Charlap,
26840Dan Christensen,
26841Kevin Christian,
26842Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26843James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26844Laura Conrad,
26845Michael R. Cook,
26846Glenn Coombs,
26847Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26848Neil Crellin,
26849Frank D. Cringle,
26850Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26851Andre Deparade,
26852Ulrik Dickow,
26853Dave Disser,
26854Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26855Joev Dubach,
26856Michael Welsh Duggan,
26857Dave Edmondson,
26858Paul Eggert,
26859Mark W. Eichin,
26860Karl Eichwalder,
26861Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26862Michael Ernst,
26863Luc Van Eycken,
26864Sam Falkner,
26865Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26866Sigbjorn Finne,
26867Sven Fischer,
26868Paul Fisher,
26869Decklin Foster,
26870Gary D. Foster,
26871Paul Franklin,
26872Guy Geens,
26873Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26874David S. Goldberg,
26875Michelangelo Grigni,
26876Dale Hagglund,
26877D. Hall,
26878Magnus Hammerin,
26879Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26880Raja R. Harinath,
26881Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26882P. E. Jareth Hein,
26883Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26884Scott Hofmann,
01c52d31 26885Tassilo Horn,
4009494e
GM
26886Marc Horowitz,
26887Gunnar Horrigmo,
26888Richard Hoskins,
26889Brad Howes,
26890Miguel de Icaza,
01c52d31 26891Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
4009494e
GM
26892Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26893Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26894Lee Iverson,
26895Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26896Rajappa Iyer,
26897Andreas Jaeger,
26898Adam P. Jenkins,
26899Randell Jesup,
26900Fred Johansen,
26901Gareth Jones,
26902Greg Klanderman,
26903Karl Kleinpaste,
26904Michael Klingbeil,
26905Peter Skov Knudsen,
26906Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26907Petr Konecny,
26908Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26909Thor Kristoffersen,
26910Jens Lautenbacher,
26911Martin Larose,
26912Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26913Joerg Lenneis,
26914Carsten Leonhardt,
26915James LewisMoss,
26916Christian Limpach,
26917Markus Linnala,
26918Dave Love,
26919Mike McEwan,
26920Tonny Madsen,
26921Shlomo Mahlab,
26922Nat Makarevitch,
26923Istvan Marko,
26924David Martin,
26925Jason R. Mastaler,
26926Gordon Matzigkeit,
26927Timo Metzemakers,
26928Richard Mlynarik,
26929Lantz Moore,
26930Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26931Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26932Hrvoje Niksic,
26933Andy Norman,
26934Fred Oberhauser,
26935C. R. Oldham,
26936Alexandre Oliva,
26937Ken Olstad,
26938Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26939Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26940Ettore Perazzoli,
26941William Perry,
26942Stephen Peters,
26943Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26944Ulrich Pfeifer,
26945Matt Pharr,
26946Andy Piper,
26947John McClary Prevost,
26948Bill Pringlemeir,
26949Mike Pullen,
26950Jim Radford,
26951Colin Rafferty,
26952Lasse Rasinen,
26953Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26954Joe Reiss,
26955Renaud Rioboo,
26956Roland B. Roberts,
26957Bart Robinson,
26958Christian von Roques,
26959Markus Rost,
26960Jason Rumney,
26961Wolfgang Rupprecht,
26962Jay Sachs,
26963Dewey M. Sasser,
26964Conrad Sauerwald,
26965Loren Schall,
26966Dan Schmidt,
26967Ralph Schleicher,
26968Philippe Schnoebelen,
26969Andreas Schwab,
26970Randal L. Schwartz,
26971Danny Siu,
26972Matt Simmons,
26973Paul D. Smith,
26974Jeff Sparkes,
26975Toby Speight,
26976Michael Sperber,
26977Darren Stalder,
26978Richard Stallman,
26979Greg Stark,
26980Sam Steingold,
26981Paul Stevenson,
26982Jonas Steverud,
26983Paul Stodghill,
26984Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
26985Kurt Swanson,
26986Samuel Tardieu,
26987Teddy,
26988Chuck Thompson,
26989Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
26990Philippe Troin,
26991James Troup,
26992Trung Tran-Duc,
26993Jack Twilley,
26994Aaron M. Ucko,
26995Aki Vehtari,
26996Didier Verna,
26997Vladimir Volovich,
26998Jan Vroonhof,
26999Stefan Waldherr,
27000Pete Ware,
27001Barry A. Warsaw,
27002Christoph Wedler,
27003Joe Wells,
27004Lee Willis,
27005and
27006Lloyd Zusman.
27007
27008
27009For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
27010included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
27011(550kB and counting).
27012
27013Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
27014sure.
27015
27016Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
27017actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
27018
27019
27020@node New Features
27021@subsection New Features
27022@cindex new features
27023
27024@menu
27025* ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
27026* September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
27027* Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
27028* Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
27029* Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
27030* Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
89b163db
G
27031* No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
27032* Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
4009494e
GM
27033@end menu
27034
27035These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
27036@emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
27037Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
27038
27039@node ding Gnus
27040@subsubsection (ding) Gnus
27041
27042New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
27043
27044@itemize @bullet
27045
27046@item
27047The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
27048(@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
27049
27050@item
27051Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
27052(@pxref{Select Methods}).
27053
27054@item
27055You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
27056
27057@item
27058You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
27059All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
27060(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
27061
27062@item
27063Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
27064their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
27065can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
27066(@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27067
27068@item
27069Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
27070them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27071
27072@item
27073Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
27074entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
27075(@pxref{The Active File}).
27076
27077@item
27078Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
27079(@pxref{Group Levels}).
27080
27081@item
27082You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27083(@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27084articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27085
27086@item
27087Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27088manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27089read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27090
27091@item
27092Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27093cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27094
27095@item
27096You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27097operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27098
4009494e
GM
27099@item
27100You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27101(@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27102
27103@item
27104You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27105servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27106
27107@item
27108Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27109server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27110
27111@item
27112You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27113
27114@item
27115The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27116(@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27117
27118@item
27119You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27120of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27121
27122@item
27123Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27124glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27125
27126@item
27127Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27128
27129@item
27130Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27131(@pxref{Document Groups}).
27132
27133@item
27134Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27135Articles}).
27136
27137@item
27138URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27139Buttons}).
27140
27141@item
27142You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27143configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27144
4009494e
GM
27145@end itemize
27146
27147
27148@node September Gnus
27149@subsubsection September Gnus
27150
27151@iftex
27152@iflatex
27153\gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27154@end iflatex
27155@end iftex
27156
27157New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27158
27159@itemize @bullet
27160
27161@item
27162A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27163for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27164now obsolete.
27165
27166@item
27167Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27168missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27169Threading}).
27170
27171@lisp
27172(setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27173@end lisp
27174
27175@item
27176Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27177(@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27178
27179@item
27180Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27181referred.
27182
27183@item
01c52d31 27184Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
4009494e
GM
27185
27186@item
27187Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27188
27189@item
27190A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27191
27192@lisp
27193(setq gnus-use-trees t)
27194@end lisp
27195
27196@item
27197An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27198buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27199
27200@lisp
27201(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27202@end lisp
27203
27204@item
27205In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27206Groups}).
27207
27208@item
27209Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27210Topics}).
27211
27212@lisp
27213(add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27214@end lisp
27215
27216@item
27217Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27218
27219@item
27220Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27221is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27222
27223@lisp
27224(add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27225@end lisp
27226
27227@item
27228Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27229groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27230
27231@item
27232Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27233
27234@item
27235@code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27236news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27237else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27238
27239@item
c4d82de8 27240Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
4009494e
GM
27241
27242@item
27243The Gnus cache is much faster.
27244
27245@item
27246Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27247Groups}).
27248
27249@item
27250New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27251expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27252
27253@item
27254All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27255(@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27256
27257@item
27258There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27259marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27260
27261@item
27262The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27263articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27264bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27265
27266@item
27267Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27268(@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27269
27270@item
27271All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27272
27273@item
27274Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27275
27276@item
27277All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27278
27279@item
27280Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27281
27282@item
27283All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27284buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27285
27286@item
27287Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27288Layout}).
27289
27290@item
27291Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27292@iftex
27293@iflatex
27294\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27295@end iflatex
27296@end iftex
27297
4009494e
GM
27298@item
27299Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27300
27301@lisp
27302(setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27303@end lisp
27304
27305@item
27306Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27307
27308@item
27309Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27310
27311@item
27312Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27313(@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27314
27315@lisp
27316(setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27317 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27318@end lisp
27319
27320@item
27321Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27322refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27323
27324@lisp
27325(setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27326@end lisp
27327
27328@item
27329A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27330buffer to allow easier treatment.
27331
27332@item
27333Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27334
27335@item
27336Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27337Articles}).
27338
27339@lisp
27340(setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27341@end lisp
27342
27343@item
27344@code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27345articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27346
27347@lisp
27348(setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27349@end lisp
27350
27351@item
27352Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27353(@pxref{Article Washing}).
27354
27355@item
27356Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27357cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27358
27359@lisp
27360(setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27361@end lisp
27362
27363@item
27364Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27365
27366@item
27367Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27368
27369@item
27370Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27371
27372@end itemize
27373
27374
27375@node Red Gnus
27376@subsubsection Red Gnus
27377
27378New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27379
27380@iftex
27381@iflatex
27382\gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27383@end iflatex
27384@end iftex
27385
27386@itemize @bullet
27387
27388@item
27389@file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27390
27391@item
27392Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27393Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27394
27395@item
27396Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27397@code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27398Scoring}).
27399
27400@item
27401Article washing status can be displayed in the
27402article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27403
27404@item
27405@file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27406
27407@item
27408Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27409(@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27410
27411@lisp
27412(setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27413@end lisp
27414
27415@item
27416New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27417considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27418been added.
27419
27420@item
e4769531 27421@code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
4009494e
GM
27422Server Internals}).
27423
27424@item
27425Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27426Parameters}).
27427
27428@item
27429Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27430
27431@item
27432Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27433(@pxref{Article Signature}).
27434
27435@item
27436Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27437numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27438articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27439
27440@item
27441Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27442another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27443
27444@item
27445There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27446when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27447
27448@item
27449Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27450(@pxref{Undo}).
27451
27452@item
27453Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27454(@pxref{Score File Format}).
27455
27456@item
27457Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27458(@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27459
27460@lisp
27461(setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27462@end lisp
27463
27464@item
27465Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27466
27467@lisp
27468(setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27469@end lisp
27470
27471@item
27472Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27473normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27474
27475@item
27476A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27477the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27478
27479@item
27480A new command for reading collections of documents
27481(@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27482(@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27483
27484@item
27485Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27486Marks}).
27487
27488@item
27489A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27490server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27491
27492@item
27493A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27494(@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27495(@pxref{Web Searches}).
27496
27497@item
27498Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27499functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27500Sorting}).
27501
27502@item
27503Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27504Groups}).
27505
27506@item
27507Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27508Commands}).
27509@iftex
27510@iflatex
27511\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27512@end iflatex
27513@end iftex
27514
27515@item
27516Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27517Variables}).
27518
27519@item
27520Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27521Mail}).
27522
27523@item
27524More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27525mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27526
27527@item
27528Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27529
27530@end itemize
27531
27532
27533@node Quassia Gnus
27534@subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27535
27536New features in Gnus 5.6:
27537
27538@itemize @bullet
27539
27540@item
27541New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27542added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27543@xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27544
27545@item
27546The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27547before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27548group, which is created automatically.
27549
27550@item
27551@code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27552values.
27553
27554@item
1df7defd 27555@code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-IDs.
4009494e
GM
27556
27557@item
27558A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27559outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27560
27561@item
27562You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27563@kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27564
27565@item
27566 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27567
27568@item
27569@code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27570re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27571
27572@item
27573New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27574
27575@item
27576@kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27577details.
27578
27579@item
27580@kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27581@kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27582
27583@item
27584@code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27585control over simplification.
27586
27587@item
27588@kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27589
27590@item
27591@kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27592limit.
27593
27594@item
27595@kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27596
27597@item
27598@samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27599
27600@item
27601The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27602If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27603rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27604
27605@item
27606Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27607@kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27608
27609@item
27610New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27611text---@kbd{W d}.
27612
27613@item
27614For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27615@code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27616
27617@item
27618@code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27619controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27620
27621@item
27622A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27623has been added.
27624
27625@item
27626A history of where mails have been split is available.
27627
27628@item
27629A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27630
27631@item
27632Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27633@code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27634
27635@item
27636A new function for citing in Message has been
27637added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27638
27639@item
27640@code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27641
27642@item
27643A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27644been added.
27645
27646@item
27647A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27648@code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27649
27650@item
27651The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27652updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27653
27654@item
27655Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27656
27657@item
27658Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27659
27660@end itemize
27661
27662@node Pterodactyl Gnus
27663@subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27664
27665New features in Gnus 5.8:
27666
27667@itemize @bullet
27668
27669@item
27670The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27671many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27672
27673If you used procmail like in
27674
27675@lisp
27676(setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27677(setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27678(setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27679(setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27680@end lisp
27681
27682this now has changed to
27683
27684@lisp
27685(setq mail-sources
27686 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27687 :suffix ".in")))
27688@end lisp
27689
27690@xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27691
27692@item
27693Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27694Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27695
27696@item
27697Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27698many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27699
27700@item
27701@code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27702called to position point.
27703
27704@item
27705The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27706summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27707
27708@item
27709@code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27710of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27711
27712@item
27713The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27714subtly different manner.
27715
27716@item
27717New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27718@code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27719again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27720
27721@item
27722Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27723
27724@end itemize
27725
27726@node Oort Gnus
27727@subsubsection Oort Gnus
27728@cindex Oort Gnus
27729
27730New features in Gnus 5.10:
27731
27732@itemize @bullet
27733
27734@item Installation changes
27735@c ***********************
27736
27737@itemize @bullet
27738@item
27739Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27740
27741If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27742release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27743this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27744@file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27745read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27746@file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27747later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27748isn't save in general.
27749
27750@item
27751Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27752It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27753the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27754will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27755shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27756remove-installed-shadows}.
27757
27758@item
27759New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27760
27761Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27762first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27763@file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27764to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27765the second parameter.
27766
27767@file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
47301027 27768automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
4009494e
GM
27769@file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27770generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27771process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27772back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27773install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27774complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27775cycle used under Unix systems.
27776
27777The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27778superfluous, so they have been removed.
27779
27780@item
27781@file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27782
27783As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27784directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27785hierarchy.
27786
27787@c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
bff3818b 27788@c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
4009494e
GM
27789@item
27790@code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27791
27792If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27793@code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27794lisp directory into load-path.
27795
27796File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27797some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27798
27799@end itemize
27800
27801@item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27802@c *****************************************
27803
27804@itemize @bullet
27805
27806@item
27807The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27808@xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27809
27810@item
27811@acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27812
27813@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
321decc8 27814@acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
4009494e
GM
27815
27816@item
27817Improved anti-spam features.
27818
27819Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27820using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27821methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27822for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
01c52d31 27823are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
4009494e
GM
27824@c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27825
27826@item
27827Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27828
27829Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27830complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27831buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27832generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27833manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27834
27835@end itemize
27836
27837@item Changes in group mode
27838@c ************************
27839
27840@itemize @bullet
27841
27842@item
27843@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27844using @kbd{G M}.
27845
27846@item
27847Retrieval of charters and control messages
27848
27849There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27850control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27851
27852@item
27853The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27854
27855Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27856the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27857enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27858variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27859variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27860parameters, a'la:
27861@lisp
27862(setq gnus-parameters
27863 '(("mail\\..*"
27864 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27865 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27866 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27867 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27868@end lisp
27869
27870@item
27871Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27872
27873The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27874be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27875@code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27876@code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27877@code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
27878mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27879want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27880you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27881when getting new mail, remove the function.
27882
27883@item
27884Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27885
27886This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27887@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27888@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27889
27890@item
27891@code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27892@code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27893
27894The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27895instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27896variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27897@lisp
27898("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27899@end lisp
27900
37a68866
MB
27901@item
27902Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27903after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
9b3ebcb6 27904Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
37a68866 27905
4009494e
GM
27906@end itemize
27907
27908@item Changes in summary and article mode
27909@c **************************************
27910
27911@itemize @bullet
27912
27913@item
27914@kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27915(@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27916region if the region is active.
27917
27918@item
27919In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27920Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27921
27922@item
27923Article Buttons
27924
27925More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27926pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27927variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27928appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27929
27930@item
27931Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27932
27933@item
27934Picons
27935
27936The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27937the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27938
27939Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27940newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27941@xref{Picons}.
27942
27943@item
27944If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27945boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27946
27947@item
27948Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27949
27950@item
27951The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27952article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27953
27954@item
27955Warn about email replies to news
27956
27957Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27958the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27959you.
27960
27961@item
27962If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
27963non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
27964built.
27965
4009494e
GM
27966@item
27967Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
27968related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
27969
27970@item
27971The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
27972in English. @xref{Article Date}.
27973
27974@item
27975diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
27976@code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
27977
27978@item
27979Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
27980
27981Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
27982mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
27983though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
27984@code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
27985citations.
27986
27987The new command @kbd{W Y f}
27988(@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
27989Outlook (Express) articles.
27990
27991@item
27992@code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
27993
27994If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
27995not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
27996which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
27997what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
27998
27999This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
28000consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
28001message cited below.
28002
28003@item
65e7ca35 28004Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc.)@: are now displayed graphically in
4009494e
GM
28005Emacs too.
28006
28007Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
28008disable it.
28009
28010@item
28011Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
28012
28013@item
28014In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
28015and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
28016
28017@item
28018Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
28019
28020@item
28021@code{gnus-summary-line-format}
28022
28023The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
28024%s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
28025@code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
28026changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
28027recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
28028groups.
28029
28030@item
28031Deleting of attachments.
28032
28033The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
28034on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
28035external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
28036@acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
28037that support editing.
28038
28039@item
28040@code{gnus-default-charset}
28041
28042The default value is determined from the
28043@code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
28044@code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
28045@code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
28046
28047@item
28048Printing capabilities are enhanced.
28049
28050Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
28051Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
28052printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
28053
28054@item
28055Extended format specs.
28056
28057Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
28058@code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
28059format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
28060@samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
28061@code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
28062escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
28063
28064@item
28065@kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
28066@c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
28067
28068It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
28069(@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
28070out other articles.
28071
28072@item
28073Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
28074
28075If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
28076s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
28077(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
28078result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
28079
28080@item
28081Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28082
28083@end itemize
28084
28085@item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28086@c ****************************************************
28087
28088@itemize @bullet
28089
28090@item
28091Delayed articles
28092
28093You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28094buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28095for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28096
28097@item
28098If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28099the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28100
28101@item
28102The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28103Gcc articles as read.
28104
28105@item
28106Externalizing of attachments
28107
28108If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28109@code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28110local files as external parts.
28111
28112@item
28113The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28114@xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28115
28116@item
28117Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28118
28119Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28120different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28121algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28122only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28123cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28124see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28125default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28126@code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28127@code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28128
28129@item
28130Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28131
28132Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28133subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28134M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28135@kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28136appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28137followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28138
28139@item
28140References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28141start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28142@code{nil}.
28143
28144@item
28145Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28146
28147@item
28148Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28149
28150To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28151are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28152variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28153contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28154you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28155into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28156@code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28157incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28158was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28159was inserted directly.
28160
28161@item
28162@code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28163
bc79f9ab 28164@c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
4009494e
GM
28165Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28166mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28167compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28168enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28169
28170@item
28171@code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28172
28173The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28174@lisp
28175(define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28176 'bbdb-complete-name)
28177@end lisp
28178
28179@item
28180@code{gnus-posting-styles}
28181
28182Add a new format of match like
28183@lisp
28184((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28185 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28186@end lisp
28187The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28188@lisp
28189(header "to" "larsi.*org"
28190 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28191@end lisp
28192
28193@item
28194@code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28195
28196@samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28197added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28198need add those two headers too.
28199
28200@item
28201Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28202composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28203Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28204versions.
28205
28206@item
28207The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28208``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28209inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28210emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28211@c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28212
28213@item
28214Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28215
28216This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28217
28218@item
28219Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28220
28221In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28222the valid values.
28223
28224@item
28225Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28226
28227This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28228used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28229superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28230you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28231system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28232security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28233will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28234The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28235
28236@item
28237Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
f99f1641 282382015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630--2633).
4009494e
GM
28239
28240It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28241additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28242Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28243messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28244
28245@item
28246@acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28247C-m}.
28248
28249This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28250@code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28251
28252@item
28253The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28254@code{best}.
28255
28256The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28257convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28258used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28259invalidate the digital signature.
28260
28261@item
28262If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28263decompressed when activated.
28264@c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28265
28266@item
28267Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28268
28269Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28270Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28271send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28272Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28273and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28274controls this.
28275
28276@item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28277See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28278@xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
2b968687 28279@c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
d55fe5bb
MB
28280
28281@item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28282See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28283Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28284@c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
4009494e
GM
28285
28286@end itemize
28287
28288@item Changes in back ends
28289@c ***********************
28290
28291@itemize @bullet
28292@item
28293Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28294
28295@item
28296The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28297
28298@item
28299Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28300
28301Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28302
28303@item
28304The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28305
28306This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28307separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28308makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
1df7defd 28309sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within, e.g., a department. It
4009494e
GM
28310works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28311file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28312nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28313another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28314@file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28315The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28316@code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28317
28318@end itemize
28319
28320@item Appearance
28321@c *************
28322
28323@itemize @bullet
28324
28325@item
28326The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28327been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28328
28329@item
28330The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28331renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28332related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28333message, Message Manual}).
28334
28335@item
28336The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
d55fe5bb
MB
28337Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28338customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28339feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
4009494e
GM
28340
28341@item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28342in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28343Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28344in Gnus 5.10.9.
28345@end itemize
28346
28347
28348@item Miscellaneous changes
28349@c ************************
28350
28351@itemize @bullet
28352
28353@item
28354@code{gnus-agent}
28355
28356The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28357and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28358@code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28359only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28360default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28361enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28362of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28363unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28364@kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28365the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28366@kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28367behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28368nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28369is not needed any more.
28370
28371@item
28372Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28373
28374If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28375in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28376gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28377
28378@item
28379Dired integration
28380
28381@code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28382bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28383using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28384entry.
28385
28386@item
28387The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28388
28389@item
28390@code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28391
28392A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28393
28394@end itemize
28395
28396@end itemize
28397
01c52d31
MB
28398@node No Gnus
28399@subsubsection No Gnus
28400@cindex No Gnus
28401
28402New features in No Gnus:
28403@c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28404
28405@include gnus-news.texi
28406
89b163db
G
28407@node Ma Gnus
28408@subsubsection Ma Gnus
28409@cindex Ma Gnus
28410
28411I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28412Gnus.
28413
28414New features in Ma Gnus:
28415
28416@itemize @bullet
28417
28418@item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28419@c ****************************************************
28420
28421@itemize @bullet
28422
28423@item
28424The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28425@code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28426the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28427@xref{Archived Messages}.
28428
28429@end itemize
28430
28431@end itemize
28432
4009494e
GM
28433@iftex
28434
28435@page
28436@node The Manual
28437@section The Manual
28438@cindex colophon
28439@cindex manual
28440
28441This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28442either @code{texi2dvi}
28443@iflatex
28444or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28445and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28446@end iflatex
28447to get what you hold in your hands now.
28448
28449The following conventions have been used:
28450
28451@enumerate
28452
28453@item
28454This is a @samp{string}
28455
28456@item
28457This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28458
28459@item
28460This is a @file{file}
28461
28462@item
28463This is a @code{symbol}
28464
28465@end enumerate
28466
28467So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28468mean:
28469
28470@lisp
28471(setq flargnoze "yes")
28472@end lisp
28473
28474If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28475
28476@lisp
28477(setq flumphel 'yes)
28478@end lisp
28479
28480@samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28481ever get them confused.
28482
28483@iflatex
28484@c @head
28485Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28486read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28487manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28488there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28489the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28490important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28491of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28492@end iflatex
28493
28494@end iftex
28495
28496
28497@node On Writing Manuals
28498@section On Writing Manuals
28499
28500I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28501that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28502implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28503straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28504functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
4b70e299
MB
28505implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28506in hand.
4009494e
GM
28507
28508This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28509documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28510looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28511started with Gnus.
28512
28513That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
4b70e299 28514reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
4009494e
GM
28515
28516
28517@page
28518@node Terminology
28519@section Terminology
28520
28521@cindex terminology
28522@table @dfn
28523
28524@item news
28525@cindex news
28526This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28527News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28528generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28529world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28530snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28531
28532@item mail
28533@cindex mail
28534Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28535readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28536there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28537not posting, and replying is not following up.
28538
28539@item reply
28540@cindex reply
28541Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28542
28543@item follow up
28544@cindex follow up
28545Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28546are reading.
28547
28548@item back end
28549@cindex back end
28550Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28551difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28552commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28553messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28554architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28555``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28556@key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28557Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28558``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28559number 4711''.
28560
28561So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28562end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28563accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28564layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28565``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28566file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28567
28568Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28569done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28570access the articles.
28571
28572However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28573would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28574method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28575confusing.
28576
28577@item native
28578@cindex native
28579Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
0afb49a1
LMI
28580default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28581have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
4009494e
GM
28582
28583@item foreign
28584@cindex foreign
0afb49a1
LMI
28585You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28586time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28587for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28588@samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
4009494e
GM
28589
28590@item secondary
28591@cindex secondary
0afb49a1
LMI
28592Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28593being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28594have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
4009494e
GM
28595
28596@item article
28597@cindex article
28598A message that has been posted as news.
28599
28600@item mail message
28601@cindex mail message
28602A message that has been mailed.
28603
28604@item message
28605@cindex message
28606A mail message or news article
28607
28608@item head
28609@cindex head
65e7ca35 28610The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.)@: is
4009494e
GM
28611put.
28612
28613@item body
28614@cindex body
28615The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28616body.
28617
28618@item header
28619@cindex header
28620A line from the head of an article.
28621
28622@item headers
28623@cindex headers
28624A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28625collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28626
28627@item @acronym{NOV}
28628@cindex @acronym{NOV}
4b70e299
MB
28629@acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28630header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28631of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28632back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28633Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28634
4009494e
GM
28635When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28636unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28637format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28638normal @sc{head} format.
28639
4b70e299
MB
28640The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28641Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28642where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28643information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28644an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28645references, etc.
28646
28647Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28648the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28649for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28650parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28651Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28652(@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28653know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28654
4009494e
GM
28655@item level
28656@cindex levels
f99f1641 28657Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1--9). The ones
4009494e 28658that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
f99f1641
PE
28659higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1--5 are considered
28660@dfn{subscribed}; 6--7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
4009494e
GM
28661are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28662articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28663
28664@item killed groups
28665@cindex killed groups
28666No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28667groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28668
28669@item zombie groups
28670@cindex zombie groups
28671Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28672
28673@item active file
28674@cindex active file
28675The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28676groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28677is rather large, as you might surmise.
28678
28679@item bogus groups
28680@cindex bogus groups
28681A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28682server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28683This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28684
28685@item activating
28686@cindex activating groups
28687The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28688number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28689Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28690
28691@item spool
28692@cindex spool
28693News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28694One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28695article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28696
28697@item server
28698@cindex server
28699A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28700
28701@item select method
28702@cindex select method
28703A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28704server settings.
28705
28706@item virtual server
28707@cindex virtual server
28708A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28709know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28710whole is a virtual server.
28711
28712@item washing
28713@cindex washing
28714Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28715result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28716original.
28717
28718@item ephemeral groups
28719@cindex ephemeral groups
28720@cindex temporary groups
28721Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28722groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28723group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28724
28725@item solid groups
28726@cindex solid groups
28727This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28728group buffer are solid groups.
28729
28730@item sparse articles
28731@cindex sparse articles
28732These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28733@code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28734
28735@item threading
28736@cindex threading
28737To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28738to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28739
28740@item root
28741@cindex root
28742@cindex thread root
28743The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28744articles in the thread.
28745
28746@item parent
28747@cindex parent
28748An article that has responses.
28749
28750@item child
28751@cindex child
28752An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28753
28754@item digest
28755@cindex digest
28756A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28757specified by RFC 1153.
28758
28759@item splitting
28760@cindex splitting, terminology
28761@cindex mail sorting
28762@cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28763The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28764incorrectly called mail filtering.
28765
28766@end table
28767
28768
28769@page
28770@node Customization
28771@section Customization
28772@cindex general customization
28773
28774All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28775section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28776for some quite common situations.
28777
28778@menu
28779* Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28780* Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28781* Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28782* Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28783@end menu
28784
28785
28786@node Slow/Expensive Connection
4b70e299 28787@subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
4009494e
GM
28788
28789If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28790over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
4b70e299 28791Gnus has to get from the server.
4009494e
GM
28792
28793@table @code
28794
28795@item gnus-read-active-file
28796Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28797entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28798also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28799@code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28800doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28801
28802@item gnus-nov-is-evil
4b70e299
MB
28803@vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28804Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28805default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28806(@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28807Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28808instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28809@code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28810@acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28811headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28812Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28813
28814As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28815@code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28816@code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
3c08d668
KY
28817@code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28818non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
261ff377 28819variables.
4009494e
GM
28820@end table
28821
28822
28823@node Slow Terminal Connection
28824@subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28825
28826Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28827Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28828possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28829
28830@table @code
28831
28832@item gnus-auto-center-summary
28833Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28834buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28835re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28836horizontal and vertical recentering.
28837
28838@item gnus-visible-headers
28839Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28840minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28841useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28842@samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28843
28844Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28845@lisp
28846(setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28847 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28848 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28849@end lisp
28850
28851@item gnus-use-full-window
28852By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28853While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28854have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28855want to read them anyway.
28856
28857@item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28858If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28859hidden initially.
28860
28861
28862@item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28863If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28864lines, which might save some time.
28865@end table
28866
28867
28868@node Little Disk Space
28869@subsection Little Disk Space
28870@cindex disk space
28871
28872The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28873sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28874
28875@table @code
28876
28877@item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28878If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28879only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28880use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28881default.
28882
28883@item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28884If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28885only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28886use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28887default.
28888
28889@item gnus-save-killed-list
28890If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28891should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28892and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28893variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28894
28895@end table
28896
28897
28898@node Slow Machine
28899@subsection Slow Machine
28900@cindex slow machine
28901
28902If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28903few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28904
28905Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28906@code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28907
28908Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28909@code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
4b70e299 28910summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
4009494e
GM
28911
28912
28913@page
28914@node Troubleshooting
28915@section Troubleshooting
28916@cindex troubleshooting
28917
28918Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28919problems, really.
28920
28921Ahem.
28922
28923@enumerate
28924
28925@item
28926Make sure your computer is switched on.
28927
28928@item
28929Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28930been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28931Gnus will work.
28932
28933@item
28934Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
5c3a9e4c 28935like @c
437ce4be 28936@samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
5c3a9e4c
MB
28937@c
28938you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28939files lying around. Delete these.
4009494e
GM
28940
28941@item
28942Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28943@acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28944
28945@item
28946@vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
28947Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
28948rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
28949you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
28950something like that.
28951@end enumerate
28952
28953If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
28954
28955@cindex bugs
28956@cindex reporting bugs
28957
28958@kindex M-x gnus-bug
28959@findex gnus-bug
28960If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
28961command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
28962me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
28963me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
28964
28965You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
28966@kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
28967a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
28968environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
28969time.
28970
28971It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
28972you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
28973back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
28974insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
28975for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
28976mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
28977
28978If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
28979it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
28980it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
28981the bug report.
28982
28983@cindex patches
28984If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
28985improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
28986
28987@cindex edebug
28988If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
28989in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
28990edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
28991(@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
28992Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
28993you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
28994step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
28995the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
28996then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
28997return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
28998placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
28999evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
29000@kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
29001@kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
29002
29003@cindex elp
29004@cindex profile
29005@cindex slow
29006Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
29007manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
29008can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
29009slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
29010helps isolating the real problem areas).
29011
1df7defd 29012A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP@. The profiler is
4009494e
GM
29013(or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
29014there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
1df7defd 29015part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g., @kbd{M-x
4009494e
GM
29016elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
29017RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
29018@kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
29019time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
29020longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
29021output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
29022profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
29023elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
29024complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
29025work perfectly.
29026
29027@cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
29028@cindex ding mailing list
29029If you just need help, you are better off asking on
29030@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
29031@email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
29032@email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
29033
29034
29035@page
29036@node Gnus Reference Guide
29037@section Gnus Reference Guide
29038
29039It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
29040can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
29041facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
29042workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
29043it.
29044
29045You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
29046will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
29047back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
29048(ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
29049and general methods of operation.
29050
29051@menu
29052* Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
29053* Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
29054* Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
29055* Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
29056* Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
29057* Group Info:: The group info format.
29058* Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
29059* Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
29060* Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
29061@end menu
29062
29063
29064@node Gnus Utility Functions
29065@subsection Gnus Utility Functions
29066@cindex Gnus utility functions
29067@cindex utility functions
29068@cindex functions
29069@cindex internal variables
29070
29071When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
29072vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
29073Below is a list of the most common ones.
29074
29075@table @code
29076
29077@item gnus-newsgroup-name
29078@vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
29079This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29080
29081@item gnus-find-method-for-group
29082@findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29083A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29084
29085@item gnus-group-real-name
29086@findex gnus-group-real-name
29087Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29088name.
29089
29090@item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29091@findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29092Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29093(prefixed) Gnus group name.
29094
29095@item gnus-get-info
29096@findex gnus-get-info
465d0300 29097Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
4009494e
GM
29098
29099@item gnus-group-unread
29100@findex gnus-group-unread
29101The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29102unknown.
29103
29104@item gnus-active
29105@findex gnus-active
465d0300
G
29106The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29107article numbers) for @var{group}.
4009494e
GM
29108
29109@item gnus-set-active
29110@findex gnus-set-active
29111Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29112
29113@item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29114@findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29115Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29116exit.
29117
29118@item gnus-continuum-version
29119@findex gnus-continuum-version
29120Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29121number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29122versions.
29123
29124@item gnus-group-read-only-p
29125@findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29126Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29127
29128@item gnus-news-group-p
29129@findex gnus-news-group-p
29130Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29131
29132@item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29133@findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29134Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29135
29136@item gnus-server-to-method
29137@findex gnus-server-to-method
29138Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29139
29140@item gnus-server-equal
29141@findex gnus-server-equal
465d0300
G
29142Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29143two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29144this function will consider them equal.
4009494e
GM
29145
29146@item gnus-group-native-p
29147@findex gnus-group-native-p
29148Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29149
29150@item gnus-group-secondary-p
29151@findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29152Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29153
29154@item gnus-group-foreign-p
29155@findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29156Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29157
29158@item gnus-group-find-parameter
29159@findex gnus-group-find-parameter
465d0300
G
29160Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29161If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29162@var{group}.
4009494e
GM
29163
29164@item gnus-group-set-parameter
29165@findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29166Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29167
29168@item gnus-narrow-to-body
29169@findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29170Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29171
29172@item gnus-check-backend-function
29173@findex gnus-check-backend-function
29174Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29175@var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29176
29177@lisp
29178(gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29179@result{} t
29180@end lisp
29181
29182@item gnus-read-method
29183@findex gnus-read-method
29184Prompts the user for a select method.
29185
29186@end table
29187
29188
29189@node Back End Interface
29190@subsection Back End Interface
29191
29192Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29193groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29194server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29195of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29196examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29197@code{nnmbox-directory}.
29198
29199When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29200something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29201function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29202virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29203server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29204been opened, the function should fail.
29205
29206Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29207name. Take this example:
29208
29209@lisp
29210(nntp "odd-one"
29211 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29212 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29213@end lisp
29214
29215Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29216the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29217
29218The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29219The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29220server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29221
29222There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29223which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29224always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29225
29226All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29227@code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29228unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29229@dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29230talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29231the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29232return value.
29233
29234Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29235some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
f99f1641
PE
29236only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server'';
29237they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
4009494e
GM
29238more.
29239
29240Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29241few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29242the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29243possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29244confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29245numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29246mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29247@code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29248Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29249group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29250
29251The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29252article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29253assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29254if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29255the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29256also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29257of numbers as long as possible.
29258
29259Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29260Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29261@file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29262
29263In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29264@code{nnchoke}.
29265
29266@cindex @code{nnchoke}
29267
29268@menu
29269* Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29270* Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29271* Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29272* Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29273* Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29274* Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29275@end menu
29276
29277
29278@node Required Back End Functions
29279@subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29280
29281@table @code
29282
29283@item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29284
29285@var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29286@code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29287sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29288retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29289
29290The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29291value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29292This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29293of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29294
29295If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29296headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29297fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29298article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29299presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29300cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29301number, do maximum fetches.
29302
29303Here's an example HEAD:
29304
29305@example
29306221 1056 Article retrieved.
29307Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29308From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29309Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29310Subject: Re: Something very droll
29311Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29312Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29313Lines: 26
29314Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29315References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29316NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29317.
29318@end example
29319
29320So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29321these in the data buffer.
29322
29323Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29324
29325@example
29326headers = *head
29327head = error / valid-head
29328error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29329valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29330valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29331header = <text> eol
29332@end example
29333
29334@cindex BNF
29335(The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29336
29337If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29338@dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29339separated by tabs.
29340
29341@example
29342nov-buffer = *nov-line
29343nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29344field = <text except TAB>
29345@end example
29346
29347For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29348@pxref{Headers}.
29349
29350
29351@item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29352
29353@var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29354list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29355
29356If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29357may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29358server. In fact, it should do so.
29359
29360If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29361non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29362
29363
29364@item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29365
29366Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29367to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29368reason.
29369
29370There should be no data returned.
29371
29372
29373@item (nnchoke-request-close)
29374
29375Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29376have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29377should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29378function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29379
29380There should be no data returned.
29381
29382
29383@item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29384
29385If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29386physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29387non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29388attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29389
29390There should be no data returned.
29391
29392
29393@item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29394
29395This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29396
29397There should be no data returned.
29398
29399
29400@item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29401
29402The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29403@var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29404It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29405it would be nice if that were possible.
29406
29407If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29408in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29409possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29410another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29411into its article buffer.
29412
29413If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29414the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29415the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29416group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29417@code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29418on successful article retrieval.
29419
29420
bdaa75c7 29421@item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
4009494e
GM
29422
29423Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29424making @var{group} the current group.
29425
29426If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29427the current group.
29428
bdaa75c7
LMI
29429If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29430structure.
29431
4009494e
GM
29432Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29433
29434@example
29435211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29436@end example
29437
29438The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29439total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29440highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29441number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29442considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29443may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29444whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29445problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29446articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29447highest as 0.
29448
29449@example
29450group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29451error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29452info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29453@end example
29454
29455
29456@item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29457
29458Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29459a no-op on most back ends.
29460
29461There should be no data returned.
29462
29463
29464@item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29465
29466Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29467@emph{all}.
29468
29469Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29470
29471@example
29472ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29473ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29474@end example
29475
29476On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29477that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29478contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29479and the highest as 0.
29480
29481@example
29482active-file = *active-line
29483active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29484name = <string>
29485flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29486@end example
29487
29488The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29489(@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29490(@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29491
29492
29493@item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29494
29495This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29496the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29497instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29498completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29499function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29500clear if the posting could not be completed.
29501
29502There should be no result data from this function.
29503
29504@end table
29505
29506
29507@node Optional Back End Functions
29508@subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29509
29510@table @code
29511
29512@item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29513
29514@var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29515on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29516should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29517
29518The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29519@code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29520former is in the same format as the data from
29521@code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29522in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29523
29524@example
29525group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29526@end example
29527
29528
29529@item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29530
29531A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29532alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29533the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29534function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
01c52d31
MB
29535should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29536@code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29537the network resources).
4009494e
GM
29538
29539There should be no result data from this function.
29540
29541
29542@item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29543
29544When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29545summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29546user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29547@code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29548is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29549@var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29550might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29551and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29552
29553There should be no result data from this function.
29554
29555
29556@item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29557
29558Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
65e7ca35 29559marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc.)@: internally, and store them in
4009494e
GM
29560@file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29561all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29562propagate the mark information to the server.
29563
29564@var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29565
29566@example
29567(RANGE ACTION MARK)
29568@end example
29569
29570@var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29571@var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29572marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29573marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29574@code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
e21bac42
G
29575@code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29576@code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29577itself to these.
4009494e
GM
29578
29579Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29580effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29581@code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29582remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29583
29584An example action list:
29585
29586@example
29587(((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29588 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29589 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29590@end example
29591
29592The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29593mark on (currently not used for anything).
29594
29595There should be no result data from this function.
29596
29597@item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29598
29599If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29600function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29601returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29602@var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29603@var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29604
29605The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29606it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29607in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29608expirable.
29609
29610There should be no result data from this function.
29611
29612
29613@item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29614
29615This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29616request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29617another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29618the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29619@var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29620it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29621total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29622local if that's practical.
29623
29624There should be no result data from this function.
29625
29626
29627@item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29628
29629The result data from this function should be a description of
29630@var{group}.
29631
29632@example
29633description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29634name = <string>
29635description = <text>
29636@end example
29637
29638@item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29639
29640The result data from this function should be the description of all
29641groups available on the server.
29642
29643@example
29644description-buffer = *description-line
29645@end example
29646
29647
29648@item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29649
29650The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29651created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29652(i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29653the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29654in the active buffer format.
29655
29656It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29657might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29658just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29659Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29660many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29661back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29662server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29663
29664
29665@item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29666
29667This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29668
29669There should be no return data.
29670
29671
29672@item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29673
29674This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29675@var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29676numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29677should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29678non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29679they are.
29680
29681This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29682able to delete.
29683
29684There should be no result data returned.
29685
29686
29687@item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29688
29689This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29690@var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29691
29692This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29693removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29694should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29695@var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29696will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29697non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29698
29699If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29700that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29701optimizations.
29702
29703The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29704the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29705
29706There should be no data returned.
29707
29708
29709@item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29710
29711This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29712If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29713this function in short order.
29714
29715The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29716the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29717
29718The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29719article for that group.
29720
29721There should be no data returned.
29722
29723
29724@item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29725
29726This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29727@var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29728
29729There should be no data returned.
29730
29731
29732@item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29733
29734This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29735really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29736itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29737
29738There should be no data returned.
29739
29740
29741@item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29742
29743This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29744articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29745
29746There should be no data returned.
29747
29748@end table
29749
29750
29751@node Error Messaging
29752@subsubsection Error Messaging
29753
29754@findex nnheader-report
29755@findex nnheader-get-report
29756The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29757error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29758perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29759symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29760there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29761This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29762
29763@lisp
29764(nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29765
29766(nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29767@end lisp
29768
29769Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29770@code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29771recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29772takes one argument---the server symbol.
29773
29774Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29775so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29776@code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29777
29778
29779@node Writing New Back Ends
29780@subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29781
29782Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29783@code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29784@code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29785and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29786@code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29787editing articles.
29788
29789It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29790back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29791want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29792
29793All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29794package called @code{nnoo}.
29795
29796To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29797inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29798following macros:
29799
29800@table @code
29801
29802@item nnoo-declare
29803This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29804parameters. For instance:
29805
29806@lisp
29807(nnoo-declare nndir
29808 nnml nnmh)
29809@end lisp
29810
29811@code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29812both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29813
29814@item defvoo
29815This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29816a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29817declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29818
29819In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29820variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29821a function in those back ends.
29822
29823@lisp
29824(defvoo nndir-directory nil
29825 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29826 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29827@end lisp
29828
29829This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29830@code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29831of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29832
29833@item nnoo-define-basics
29834This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29835have.
29836
29837@lisp
29838(nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29839@end lisp
29840
29841@item deffoo
29842This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29843addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29844function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29845
29846@item nnoo-map-functions
29847This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29848functions from the parent back ends.
29849
29850@lisp
29851(nnoo-map-functions nndir
29852 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29853 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29854@end lisp
29855
29856This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29857third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29858@code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29859value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29860
29861@item nnoo-import
29862This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29863last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29864haven't already been defined.
29865
29866@lisp
29867(nnoo-import nndir
29868 (nnmh
29869 nnmh-request-list
29870 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29871 (nnml))
29872@end lisp
29873
29874This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29875on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29876@code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29877defined now.
29878
29879@end table
29880
29881Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29882
29883@lisp
29884;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
5dc584b5 29885;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
4009494e
GM
29886
29887;;; @r{Code:}
29888
29889(require 'nnheader)
29890(require 'nnmh)
29891(require 'nnml)
29892(require 'nnoo)
29893(eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29894
29895(nnoo-declare nndir
29896 nnml nnmh)
29897
29898(defvoo nndir-directory nil
29899 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29900 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29901
29902(defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29903 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29904 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29905
29906(defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29907 nil
29908 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29909(defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29910(defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29911
29912(defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29913(defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29914
29915;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29916
29917(nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29918
29919(deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29920 (setq nndir-directory
29921 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29922 server))
29923 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29924 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29925 (push `(nndir-current-group
29926 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29927 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29928 defs)
29929 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29930 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29931 defs)
29932 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29933
29934(nnoo-map-functions nndir
29935 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29936 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29937 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29938 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29939
29940(nnoo-import nndir
29941 (nnmh
29942 nnmh-status-message
29943 nnmh-request-list
29944 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29945
29946(provide 'nndir)
29947@end lisp
29948
29949
29950@node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29951@subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29952
29953@vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
29954@findex gnus-declare-backend
29955Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
29956declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
29957enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
29958
29959@code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
29960an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
29961
29962Here's an example:
29963
29964@lisp
29965(gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
29966@end lisp
29967
29968The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
29969
29970The abilities can be:
29971
29972@table @code
29973@item mail
29974This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
29975@item post
29976This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
29977@item post-mail
29978This back end supports both mail and news.
29979@item none
29980This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
29981different.
29982@item respool
29983It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
29984articles and groups.
29985@item address
29986The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
29987true for almost all back ends.
29988@item prompt-address
29989The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
29990@kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
29991@code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
29992@end table
29993
29994
29995@node Mail-like Back Ends
29996@subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
29997
29998One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
29999back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
30000common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
30001definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
30002
30003@lisp
30004(deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
30005 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
30006 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
30007@end lisp
30008
30009It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
30010and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
30011mail.
30012
30013This function takes four parameters.
30014
30015@table @var
30016@item method
30017This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
30018the call.
30019
30020@item exit-function
30021This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
30022
30023@item temp-directory
30024Where the temporary files should be stored.
30025
30026@item group
30027This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
30028performed for one group only.
30029@end table
30030
30031@code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
30032save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
30033find the article number assigned to this article.
30034
30035The function also uses the following variables:
30036@var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
30037this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
30038@var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
30039@var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
30040this:
30041
30042@example
30043(("a-group" (1 . 10))
30044 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
30045@end example
30046
30047
30048@node Score File Syntax
30049@subsection Score File Syntax
30050
fac916bf 30051Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
53964682 30052malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
4009494e
GM
30053as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
30054
30055Here's a typical score file:
30056
30057@lisp
30058(("summary"
b46a6a83 30059 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
4009494e
GM
30060 ("Gnus"))
30061 ("from"
30062 ("Lars" -1000))
30063 (mark -100))
30064@end lisp
30065
30066BNF definition of a score file:
30067
30068@example
30069score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
30070element = rule / atom
30071rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
30072string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
30073number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
30074date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
30075quote = <ascii 34>
30076string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
30077 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
30078number-header = "lines" / "chars"
30079date-header = "date"
30080string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30081 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30082score = "nil" / <integer>
30083date = "nil" / <natural number>
30084string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30085 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30086 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30087 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30088number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30089 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30090number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30091date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30092 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30093date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30094atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30095required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30096 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30097optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30098mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30099nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30100expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30101mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30102files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30103exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30104read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30105adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30106adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30107local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30108eval = "eval" space <form>
30109space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30110@end example
30111
30112Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30113discarded.
30114
30115As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30116space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30117left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30118one looong line, then that's ok.
30119
30120The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30121manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30122
30123
30124@node Headers
30125@subsection Headers
30126
30127Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30128corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30129almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30130just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30131
30132@dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30133RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30134@code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30135``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30136opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30137which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30138basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30139
30140These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30141@code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30142@code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30143setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30144@code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30145
30146All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30147contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30148
30149
30150@node Ranges
30151@subsection Ranges
30152
30153@sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30154using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30155
30156The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30157identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30158that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30159very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30160
30161The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30162sequence.
30163
30164@example
30165(1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30166@end example
30167
30168is transformed into
30169
30170@example
30171((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30172@end example
30173
30174To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30175lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30176
30177@example
30178((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30179@end example
30180
30181This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30182is slightly tricky:
30183
30184@example
30185((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30186@end example
30187
30188and
30189
30190@example
30191((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30192@end example
30193
30194are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30195
30196@example
30197(1 2 3 4 5)
30198@end example
30199
30200is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30201also valid:
30202
30203@example
30204(1 . 5)
30205@end example
30206
30207and is equal to the previous range.
30208
30209Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30210semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30211of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30212range handling.)
30213
30214@example
30215range = simple-range / normal-range
30216simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30217normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30218contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30219 number *[ " " contents ]
30220@end example
30221
30222Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30223marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30224Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30225need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30226totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30227sequences.)
30228
30229
30230@node Group Info
30231@subsection Group Info
30232
30233Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30234This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30235describes the group.
30236
30237Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30238second is a more complex one:
30239
30240@example
30241("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30242
30243("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30244 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30245 (nnml "")
30246 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30247@end example
30248
30249The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30250anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30251normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30252cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30253score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30254fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30255The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30256The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30257this section is about.
30258
30259Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30260In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30261three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30262
30263Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30264
30265@example
30266info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30267 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30268 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30269group = quote <string> quote
30270ralevel = rank / level
30271level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30272rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30273score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30274read = range
30275marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30276marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30277method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30278parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30279@end example
30280
30281Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30282@samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30283in pseudo-BNF.
30284
30285If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30286series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30287
30288@table @code
30289@item gnus-info-group
30290@itemx gnus-info-set-group
30291@findex gnus-info-group
30292@findex gnus-info-set-group
30293Get/set the group name.
30294
30295@item gnus-info-rank
30296@itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30297@findex gnus-info-rank
30298@findex gnus-info-set-rank
30299Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30300
30301@item gnus-info-level
30302@itemx gnus-info-set-level
30303@findex gnus-info-level
30304@findex gnus-info-set-level
30305Get/set the group level.
30306
30307@item gnus-info-score
30308@itemx gnus-info-set-score
30309@findex gnus-info-score
30310@findex gnus-info-set-score
30311Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30312
30313@item gnus-info-read
30314@itemx gnus-info-set-read
30315@findex gnus-info-read
30316@findex gnus-info-set-read
30317Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30318
30319@item gnus-info-marks
30320@itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30321@findex gnus-info-marks
30322@findex gnus-info-set-marks
30323Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30324
30325@item gnus-info-method
30326@itemx gnus-info-set-method
30327@findex gnus-info-method
30328@findex gnus-info-set-method
30329Get/set the group select method.
30330
30331@item gnus-info-params
30332@itemx gnus-info-set-params
30333@findex gnus-info-params
30334@findex gnus-info-set-params
30335Get/set the group parameters.
30336@end table
30337
30338All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30339functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30340
30341The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30342necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30343is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30344the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30345
30346
30347@node Extended Interactive
30348@subsection Extended Interactive
30349@cindex interactive
30350@findex gnus-interactive
30351
30352Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30353slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30354Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30355
30356@lisp
30357(defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30358 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30359 ...
30360 )
30361@end lisp
30362
30363The best thing to do would have been to implement
30364@code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30365@code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30366whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30367on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30368function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30369@code{interactive}.
30370
30371This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30372adds a few more.
30373
30374@table @samp
30375@item y
30376@vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30377The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30378variable.
30379
30380@item Y
30381@vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30382A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30383@code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30384
30385@item A
30386The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30387function.
30388
30389@item H
30390The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30391function.
30392
30393@item g
30394The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30395function.
30396
30397@end table
30398
30399
30400@node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30401@subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30402@cindex XEmacs
30403@cindex Emacsen
30404
30405While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30406platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30407like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30408
30409This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30410while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30411As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30412Gnus, that's very useful.
30413
30414I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30415Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30416@code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30417function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30418takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30419Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30420However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30421following function:
30422
30423@lisp
30424(defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30425 (start-itimer
30426 "gnus-run-at-time"
30427 `(lambda ()
30428 (,function ,@@args))
30429 time repeat))
30430@end lisp
30431
30432This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30433not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30434does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30435all over.
30436
30437In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30438I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30439for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30440
30441Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30442mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30443hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30444
30445
30446@node Various File Formats
30447@subsection Various File Formats
30448
30449@menu
30450* Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30451* Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30452@end menu
30453
30454
30455@node Active File Format
30456@subsubsection Active File Format
30457
30458The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30459question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30460in each group.
30461
30462Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30463
30464@example
30465soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30466alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30467comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30468comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30469no.general 1000 900 y
30470@end example
30471
30472Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30473
30474@example
30475active = *group-line
30476group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30477group = <non-white-space string>
30478spc = " "
30479high-number = <non-negative integer>
30480low-number = <positive integer>
30481flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30482@end example
30483
30484For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30485@samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30486
30487
30488@node Newsgroups File Format
30489@subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30490
30491The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30492groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30493have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30494the user.
30495
30496The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30497Here's the definition:
30498
30499@example
30500newsgroups = *line
30501line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30502group = <non-white-space string>
30503tab = <TAB>
30504description = <string>
30505@end example
30506
30507
30508@page
30509@node Emacs for Heathens
30510@section Emacs for Heathens
30511
30512Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30513Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30514If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30515region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30516is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30517phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30518you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30519cat instead.
30520
30521@menu
30522* Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30523* Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30524@end menu
30525
30526
30527@node Keystrokes
30528@subsection Keystrokes
30529
30530@itemize @bullet
30531@item
30532Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30533
30534@item
30535A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30536@end itemize
30537
30538Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30539key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30540(notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30541of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30542``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30543may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30544
30545The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30546normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30547the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30548that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30549keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30550which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30551to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30552
30553Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30554because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30555key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30556prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30557down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30558``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30559the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30560
30561This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30562meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30563means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30564work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30565suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30566it.
30567
30568
30569
30570@node Emacs Lisp
30571@subsection Emacs Lisp
30572
30573Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30574Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30575Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30576any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30577
30578Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30579functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30580interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30581certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30582(Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30583beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30584some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30585file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30586in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30587@file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30588
30589If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30590write the following:
30591
30592@lisp
30593(setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30594@end lisp
30595
30596This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30597set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30598you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30599change how Gnus works.
30600
30601If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30602read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30603start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30604@kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30605previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30606
30607Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30608@kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30609is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30610
30611Some pitfalls:
30612
30613If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30614that means:
30615
30616@lisp
30617(setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30618@end lisp
30619
99e65b2d
G
30620On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30621@samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
4009494e
GM
30622
30623@lisp
99e65b2d 30624(setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
4009494e
GM
30625@end lisp
30626
30627So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30628former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30629
30630@page
30631@include gnus-faq.texi
30632
30633@node GNU Free Documentation License
30634@chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30635@include doclicense.texi
30636
30637@node Index
30638@chapter Index
30639@printindex cp
30640
30641@node Key Index
30642@chapter Key Index
30643@printindex ky
30644
4009494e
GM
30645@bye
30646
30647@iftex
30648@iflatex
30649\end{document}
30650@end iflatex
30651@end iftex
30652
30653@c Local Variables:
30654@c mode: texinfo
89b163db 30655@c coding: utf-8
4009494e 30656@c End: